496
2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M In Brief ........................ 1-1 Instrument Panel .............. 1-2 Initial Drive Information ........ 1-4 Vehicle Features ............. 1-20 Performance and Maintenance ................ 1-26 Keys, Doors, and Windows .................... 2-1 Keys and Locks ............... 2-1 Doors .......................... 2-9 Vehicle Security .............. 2-12 Exterior Mirrors ............... 2-15 Interior Mirrors ................ 2-19 Windows ..................... 2-20 Roof .......................... 2-22 Seats and Restraints ......... 3-1 Head Restraints ............... 3-2 Front Seats .................... 3-3 Rear Seats .................... 3-9 Safety Belts .................. 3-16 Airbag System ................ 3-26 Child Restraints .............. 3-41 Storage ....................... 4-1 Storage Compartments ........ 4-1 Additional Storage Features . . . 4-2 Roof Rack System ............. 4-3 Instruments and Controls .... 5-1 Controls ....................... 5-2 Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators ................... 5-10 Information Displays .......... 5-26 Vehicle Messages ............ 5-34 Vehicle Personalization ....... 5-44 Universal Remote System .... 5-52 Lighting ....................... 6-1 Exterior Lighting ............... 6-1 Interior Lighting ................ 6-7 Lighting Features .............. 6-8 Infotainment System ......... 7-1 Introduction .................... 7-1 Radio ......................... 7-10 Audio Players ................ 7-16 Rear Seat Infotainment ....... 7-36 Phone ........................ 7-48 Trademarks and License Agreements ................. 7-55 Climate Controls ............. 8-1 Climate Control Systems .... . . 8-1 Air Vents ..................... 8-12 Driving and Operating ........ 9-1 Driving Information ............. 9-2 Starting and Operating ....... 9-19 Engine Exhaust .............. 9-27 Automatic Transmission ...... 9-28 Drive Systems ................ 9-33 Brakes ....................... 9-40 Ride Control Systems ........ 9-42 Cruise Control ................ 9-46 Object Detection Systems .... 9-48 Fuel .......................... 9-55 Towing ....................... 9-61 Conversions and Add-Ons . . . 9-78

2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

  • Upload
    others

  • View
    3

  • Download
    0

Embed Size (px)

Citation preview

Page 1: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M

In Brief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . 1-4Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20Performance andMaintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26

Keys, Doors, andWindows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1Keys and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9Vehicle Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12Exterior Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15Interior Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22

Seats and Restraints . . . . . . . . . 3-1Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41

Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1Storage Compartments . . . . . . . . 4-1Additional Storage Features . . . 4-2Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3

Instruments and Controls . . . . 5-1Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2Warning Lights, Gauges, andIndicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10

Information Displays . . . . . . . . . . 5-26Vehicle Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-34Vehicle Personalization . . . . . . . 5-44Universal Remote System . . . . 5-52

Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7Lighting Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8

Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . 7-1Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10Audio Players . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16Rear Seat Infotainment . . . . . . . 7-36Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-48

Trademarks and LicenseAgreements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-55

Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1Climate Control Systems . . . . . . 8-1Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12

Driving and Operating . . . . . . . . 9-1Driving Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2Starting and Operating . . . . . . . 9-19Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-27Automatic Transmission . . . . . . 9-28Drive Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-33Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-40Ride Control Systems . . . . . . . . 9-42Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-46Object Detection Systems . . . . 9-48Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-55Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-61Conversions and Add-Ons . . . 9-78

Page 2: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M

Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1General Information . . . . . . . . . . 10-2Vehicle Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 10-30Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32Wheels and Tires . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-77Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-82Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . 10-87

Service and Maintenance . . . 11-1General Information . . . . . . . . . . 11-1Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . 11-2Special ApplicationServices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8

Additional Maintenanceand Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8

Recommended Fluids,Lubricants, and Parts . . . . . . 11-12

Maintenance Records . . . . . . . 11-15

Technical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . 12-1Vehicle Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2

Customer Information . . . . . . . 13-1Customer Information . . . . . . . . 13-2Reporting Safety Defects . . . . 13-17Vehicle Data Recording andPrivacy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-19

OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-1OnStar Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-1OnStar Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2OnStar AdditionalInformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-5

Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i-1

Page 3: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Introduction iii

The names, logos, emblems,slogans, vehicle model names, andvehicle body designs appearing inthis manual including, but not limitedto, GM, the GM logo, CHEVROLET,the CHEVROLET Emblem, TAHOE,SUBURBAN, and Z71 aretrademarks and/or service marks ofGeneral Motors LLC, itssubsidiaries, affiliates, or licensors.

This manual describes features thatmay or may not be on your specificvehicle either because they areoptions that you did not purchase ordue to changes subsequent to theprinting of this owner manual.

Please refer to the purchasedocumentation relating to yourspecific vehicle to confirm each ofthe features found on your vehicle.For vehicles first sold in Canada,substitute the name “GeneralMotors of Canada Limited” forChevrolet Motor Division wherever itappears in this manual.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Keep this manual in the vehicle forquick reference.

Canadian Vehicle Owners

Propriétaires Canadiens

A French language copy of thismanual can be obtained from yourdealer or from:

On peut obtenir un exemplaire dece guide en français auprès duconcessionnaire ou à l'adressesuivante:

Helm, IncorporatedAttention: Customer Service47911 Halyard DrivePlymouth, MI 48170

Using this ManualTo quickly locate information aboutthe vehicle, use the Index in theback of the manual. It is analphabetical list of what is in themanual and the page number whereit can be found.

Litho in U.S.A.Part No. 20955527 B Second Printing ©2012 General Motors LLC. All Rights Reserved.

Page 4: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

iv Introduction

Danger, Warnings, andCautionsWarning messages found on vehiclelabels and in this manual describehazards and what to do to avoid orreduce them.

Danger indicates a hazard with ahigh level of risk which will result inserious injury or death.

Warning or Caution indicates ahazard that could result in injury ordeath.

{ WARNING

These mean there is somethingthat could hurt you or otherpeople.

Notice: This means there issomething that could result inproperty or vehicle damage. Thiswould not be covered by thevehicle's warranty.

A circle with a slash through it is asafety symbol which means “DoNot,” “Do not do this,” or “Do not letthis happen.”

SymbolsThe vehicle has components andlabels that use symbols instead oftext. Symbols are shown along withthe text describing the operation orinformation relating to a specificcomponent, control, message,gauge, or indicator.

M : This symbol is shown whenyou need to see your owner manualfor additional instructions orinformation.

* : This symbol is shown whenyou need to see a service manualfor additional instructions orinformation.

Vehicle Symbol Chart

Here are some additional symbolsthat may be found on the vehicleand what they mean. For moreinformation on the symbol, refer tothe Index.

0 : Adjustable Pedals

9 : Airbag Readiness Light

# : Air Conditioning

! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)

% : Audio Steering Wheel Controlsor OnStar®

$ : Brake System Warning Light

" : Charging System

I : Cruise Control

B : Engine Coolant Temperature

O : Exterior Lamps

# : Fog Lamps

. : Fuel Gauge

+ : Fuses

3 : Headlamp High/Low-BeamChanger

Page 5: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Introduction v

( : Heated Steering Wheel

j : LATCH System ChildRestraints

* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp

: : Oil Pressure

g : Outside Power FoldawayMirrors

O : Power

/ : Remote Vehicle Start

> : Safety Belt Reminders

7 : Tire Pressure Monitor

_ : Tow/Haul Mode

d : Traction Control/StabiliTrak®

M : Windshield Washer Fluid

Page 6: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

vi Introduction

2 NOTES

Page 7: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-1

In Brief

Instrument PanelInstrument Panel Overview . . . . 1-2

Initial Drive InformationInitial Drive Information . . . . . . . . 1-4Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4

Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . 1-4Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7Memory Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9Second Row Seats . . . . . . . . . . 1-10Third Row Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10Heated and VentilatedSeats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10

Head RestraintAdjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10

Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11Passenger SensingSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11

Mirror Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12Steering WheelAdjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14

Throttle and Brake PedalAdjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14

Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15Windshield Wiper/Washer . . . . 1-16Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18Four-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19

Vehicle FeaturesRadio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22Portable Audio Devices . . . . . . 1-22Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . 1-22Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23

Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23Side Blind ZoneAlert (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24

Rear VisionCamera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24

Ultrasonic Parking Assist . . . . 1-24Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24Universal Remote System . . . 1-25Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25

Performance and MaintenanceStabiliTrak® System . . . . . . . . . 1-26Tire Pressure Monitor . . . . . . . . 1-26Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . 1-27Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol) . . . . . 1-27Driving for Better FuelEconomy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27

Roadside AssistanceProgram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28

OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28

Page 8: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-2 In Brief

Instrument Panel

Instrument Panel Overview

English Version Shown; Metric Similar

Page 9: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-3

A. Air Vents on page 8‑12.

B. Turn and Lane‐Change Lever.See Turn and Lane-ChangeSignals on page 6‑5.

Windshield Wiper/Washer onpage 5‑4.

Rear Window Wiper/Washer onpage 5‑5.

C. Instrument Cluster onpage 5‑11.

D. Hazard Warning Flashers onpage 6‑5 (Out of View).

E. Shift Lever. See AutomaticTransmission on page 9‑28.

F. Manual Mode on page 9‑31(If Equipped).

Tow/Haul Mode on page 9‑32(If Equipped).

G. Driver Information Center (DIC)Buttons. See Driver InformationCenter (DIC) on page 5‑26.

H. Infotainment on page 7‑1.

I. Exterior Lamp Controls onpage 6‑1.

J. Dome Lamps on page 6‑7.

Instrument Panel IlluminationControl on page 6‑7.

Fog Lamps on page 6‑6(If Equipped).

K. Hood Release. See Hood onpage 10‑4.

L. Integrated Trailer BrakeController (If Equipped). SeeTowing Equipment onpage 9‑69.

M. Data Link Connector (DLC) (Outof View). See MalfunctionIndicator Lamp on page 5‑19.

N. Automatic Transfer CaseControl (If Equipped). SeeFour-Wheel Drive (SingleSpeed Automatic TransferCase) on page 9‑38 orFour-Wheel Drive (Two SpeedAutomatic Transfer Case) onpage 9‑33.

O. Cruise Control on page 9‑46.

P. Steering Wheel Adjustment onpage 5‑2.

Q. Horn on page 5‑4.

R. Steering Wheel Controls onpage 5‑2.

S. Climate Control Systems onpage 8‑1 (If Equipped).

Dual Automatic Climate ControlSystem on page 8‑3(If Equipped).

T. Power Outlets on page 5‑8.

U. StabiliTrak® System onpage 9‑42 (If Equipped).

Pedal Adjust Button (IfEquipped). See AdjustableThrottle and Brake Pedal onpage 9‑20.

Ultrasonic Parking Assist onpage 9‑48 (If Equipped).

Power Assist Steps onpage 2‑12 (If Equipped).

Page 10: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-4 In Brief

Initial DriveInformationThis section provides a briefoverview about some of theimportant features that may or maynot be on your specific vehicle.

For more detailed information, referto each of the features which can befound later in this owner manual.

Remote Keyless Entry(RKE) SystemThe RKE transmitter is used toremotely lock and unlock the doorsfrom up to 60 m (195 ft) away fromthe vehicle.

RKE Transmitter with RemoteStart and Power Liftgate/Liftglass

K : Press to unlock the driver door.Press K again within three secondsto unlock all remaining doors.

Q : Press to lock all doors.

Lock and unlock feedback can bepersonalized. See VehiclePersonalization (With DIC Buttons)on page 5‑44.

m : Press and hold to unlock theliftglass.

8 : Press and hold to open orclose the power liftgate.

L : Press and release to locatethe vehicle.

PressL and hold for more thantwo seconds to sound the panicalarm.

PressL again to cancel the panicalarm.

See Keys on page 2‑1 and RemoteKeyless Entry (RKE) System onpage 2‑2.

Remote Vehicle StartWith this feature the engine can bestarted from outside of the vehicle.

Starting the Vehicle

1. Aim the RKE transmitter at thevehicle.

2. Press and release Q.3. Immediately after completing

Step 2, press and hold/ for atleast two seconds or until theturn signal lamps flash.

Page 11: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-5

When the vehicle starts, the parkinglamps will turn on and remain on aslong as the engine is running. Thedoors will be locked and the climatecontrol system may come on.

The engine will continue to run for10 minutes. Repeat the steps for a10-minute time extension. Remotestart can be extended only once.

Canceling a Remote Start

To cancel a remote start, do one ofthe following:. Aim the RKE transmitter at the

vehicle and press and hold/until the parking lamps turn off.

. Turn on the hazard warningflashers.

. Turn the vehicle on and thenback off.

See Remote Vehicle Start onpage 2‑5.

Door LocksThere are several ways to lock andunlock the vehicle.

From outside, use the RemoteKeyless Entry (RKE) transmitter orthe key in the driver door.

From inside, use the power doorlocks or the manual door locks. Tolock or unlock the door with themanual locks, push down or pull upon the manual lock knob.

Power Door Locks

Press Q or K on the RKEtransmitter. See Remote KeylessEntry (RKE) System Operation onpage 2‑2.

Power Folding Mirrors Shown,Other Models Similar

Q : Press to lock the doors.

K : Press to unlock the doors.

See Door Locks on page 2‑6.

Page 12: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-6 In Brief

Liftgate

A. License Plate Applique

B. Liftgate Handle

The liftglass or liftgate cannot beopened if the rear wiper is in motion.Attempting to open the liftglass orliftgate while the rear wiper is inmotion will cause the release of theliftglass or liftgate to delay until thewipers are parked off the liftglass.

Manual Liftgate Operation

To unlock the liftgate, press K onthe power door lock switch or pressK on the Remote Keyless Entry(RKE) transmitter twice. SeeRemote Keyless Entry (RKE)System Operation on page 2‑2.

Press the touch pad on theunderside of the liftgate handle (B)and lift up.

Use the pull cup to lower and closethe liftgate. Do not press the touchpad while closing the liftgate. Thiswill cause the liftgate to beunlatched.

Power Liftgate Operation

On vehicles with a power liftgate,the switch is on the overheadconsole.

The vehicle must be in P (Park) touse the power feature. The taillampswill flash and a chime will soundwhen the power liftgate moves.

There are several ways to open andclose the power liftgate:

. Press and hold8 on the RKEtransmitter until the liftgate startsmoving.

. Press8 on the overheadconsole.

. Pressl on the bottom of theliftgate next to the latch to close.

Pressing a second time while theliftgate is moving reverses thedirection.

To disable the power liftgatefunction, press OFF on the liftgateswitch. See Liftgate on page 2‑9.

Liftglass

If equipped, there are two ways toopen the liftglass:. Press the button on the

underside of the license plateapplique (A).

. Pressm on the RKEtransmitter.

Page 13: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-7

Windows

Power Folding Mirrors Shown,Other Models Similar

The driver door has switches thatcontrol all windows. Eachpassenger door switch only controlsthat window. The power windowswork when the ignition is in ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY, or inRetained Accessory Power (RAP).See Retained Accessory Power(RAP) on page 9‑24.

Press the switch to lower thewindow. Pull the switch up to raiseit. See Windows on page 2‑20 andPower Windows on page 2‑20.

Seat Adjustment

Manual Seats

To adjust the seat:

1. Lift the bar to unlock the seat.

2. Slide the seat to the desiredposition and release the bar.

3. Try to move the seat back andforth to be sure the seat islocked in place.

See Seat Adjustment on page 3‑3.

Power Seats

To adjust a power seat, if equipped:. Move the seat forward or

rearward by sliding the controlforward or rearward.

. If available, raise or lower thefront or rear part of the seatcushion by moving the front orrear of the control up or down.

Page 14: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-8 In Brief

. If available, raise or lower theentire seat by moving the entirecontrol up or down.

See Power Seat Adjustment onpage 3‑3.

Lumbar Adjustment

Manual Lumbar

If equipped, increase or decreasemanual lumbar support by turningthe knob forward or rearward.

See Lumbar Adjustment onpage 3‑4.

Power Lumbar

To adjust the power lumbar support,if equipped:. On vehicles with two-way

lumbar, press and hold the topor bottom of the control toincrease or decrease lumbarsupport.

. On vehicles with four-waylumbar, press and hold the frontor rear of the control to increaseor decrease lumbar support. Toraise or lower the height of thesupport, press and hold the topor bottom of the control.

See Lumbar Adjustment onpage 3‑4.

Reclining Seatbacks

Manual Reclining Seatbacks

To recline a manual seatback:

1. Lift the lever.

Page 15: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-9

2. Move the seatback to thedesired position, and thenrelease the lever to lock theseatback in place.

3. Push and pull on the seatback tomake sure it is locked.

To return the seatback to the uprightposition:

1. Lift the lever fully withoutapplying pressure to theseatback, and the seatback willreturn to the upright position.

2. Push and pull on the seatback tomake sure it is locked.

See Reclining Seatbacks onpage 3‑4.

Power Reclining Seatbacks

To adjust a power seatback,if equipped:. Tilt the top of the control

rearward to recline.. Tilt the top of the control forward

to raise.

See Reclining Seatbacks onpage 3‑4.

Memory Features

If available, the controls on thedriver door are used to program andrecall memory settings for the driverseat, outside mirrors, and theadjustable throttle and brake pedals,if equipped.

See Memory Seats on page 3‑6 andVehicle Personalization (With DICButtons) on page 5‑44.

Page 16: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-10 In Brief

Second Row SeatsOn vehicles with a 60/40 split-benchor buckets seats, the seatbacks canbe folded for additional cargo space,or the seats can be folded andtumbled for easy entry/exit to thethird row seats, if equipped. Onvehicles with bucket seats, theseatbacks also recline.

See Second Row Seats onpage 3‑9.

Third Row SeatsOn vehicles with third row seats, theseatbacks can be folded, and theentire seat can be tumbled orremoved from the vehicle.

For detailed instructions, see ThirdRow Seats on page 3‑13.

Heated and VentilatedSeats

Heated and Cooled Seat ButtonsShown, Heated Seat Buttons

Similar

If available, the buttons are on thefront doors. To operate, the ignitionmust be in ON/RUN.

H : If available, press to coolthe seat.

I : Press to heat theseatback only.

J : Press to heat the seat andseatback.

Press the button once for thehighest setting. With each press ofthe button, the seat will change tothe next lower setting, and then tothe off setting. The lights indicatethree for the highest setting and onefor the lowest.

See Heated and Ventilated FrontSeats on page 3‑8.

Head RestraintAdjustmentDo not drive until the head restraintsfor all occupants are installed andadjusted properly.

To achieve a comfortable seatingposition, change the seatbackrecline angle as little as necessarywhile keeping the seat and the headrestraint height in the properposition.

See Head Restraints on page 3‑2and Seat Adjustment on page 3‑3.

Page 17: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-11

Safety Belts

Refer to the following sections forimportant information on how to usesafety belts properly.. Safety Belts on page 3‑16.. How to Wear Safety Belts

Properly on page 3‑18.. Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 3‑19.. Lower Anchors and Tethers for

Children (LATCH System) onpage 3‑48.

Passenger SensingSystemThe passenger sensing system,if equipped, turns off the frontoutboard passenger frontal airbagunder certain conditions. No otherairbag is affected by the passengersensing system.

If the vehicle has one of theindicators pictured in the followingillustrations, then the vehicle has apassenger sensing system for theright front passenger position.

The passenger airbag statusindicator, if equipped, will be visibleon the overhead console when thevehicle is started.

United States

Canada and Mexico

See Passenger Sensing System onpage 3‑34 for important information.

Page 18: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-12 In Brief

Mirror Adjustment

Exterior Mirrors

With Power Folding Mirrors

To adjust the mirrors:

1. Press (A) or (B) to select thedriver or passenger side mirror.

2. Press one of the four arrowslocated on the control pad toadjust the mirror.

3. Adjust the outside mirror so thatthe side of the vehicle and thearea behind are seen.

4. Press either (A) or (B) again todeselect the mirror.

See Power Mirrors on page 2‑16.

To power fold the mirrors:

1. Press (C) to fold the mirrors outto the driving position.

2. Press (D) to fold the mirrors in tothe folded position. With Manual Folding Mirrors

To adjust the mirrors:

1. Move the selector switch locatedabove the four-way control padto the left or right to chooseeither the driver side orpassenger side mirror.

2. Press one of the four arrowslocated on the control pad tomove the mirror in the desireddirection.

3. Adjust the outside mirror so thatthe side of the vehicle and thearea behind are seen.

Page 19: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-13

See Power Mirrors on page 2‑16.

Keep the selector switch in thecenter position when not adjustingeither outside mirror.

To manual fold the mirrors:

Fold the mirrors inward to preventdamage when going through anautomatic car wash. To fold, pull themirror toward the vehicle. Push themirror outward, to return to itsoriginal position.

Heated Mirrors

Press1 to heat the mirrors.

See “Rear Window Defogger” underDual Automatic Climate ControlSystem on page 8‑3 or ClimateControl Systems on page 8‑1.

Park Tilt Mirrors

If the vehicle has the memorypackage, the exterior mirrors tilt to apreselected position when thevehicle is in R (Reverse). Thisfeature lets the driver view the curbwhen parallel parking. The mirrorsreturn to the original position when

the vehicle is shifted out ofR (Reverse), or the ignition is turnedoff or to OFF/LOCK.

This feature can be programedthrough the Driver InformationCenter (DIC). See VehiclePersonalization (With DIC Buttons)on page 5‑44.

Trailer-Tow Mirrors

For vehicle with towing mirrors, theycan be extended for a clearer viewof the objects behind the vehicle.Manually pull out the mirror head toextend it for better visibility whentowing a trailer. See Trailer-TowMirrors on page 2‑16.

Interior Mirror

Adjustment

Hold the rearview mirror in thecenter and move it to view the areabehind the vehicle.

Manual Rearview Mirror

For vehicles with a manual rearviewmirror, push the tab forward fordaytime use and pull it for nighttimeuse to avoid glare from theheadlamps from behind. SeeManual Rearview Mirror onpage 2‑19.

Automatic Dimming RearviewMirror

For vehicles with an automaticdimming rearview mirror. The mirrorwill automatically reduce the glarefrom the headlamps from behind.The dimming feature comes on andthe indicator light illuminates eachtime the ignition is turned to start.See Automatic Dimming RearviewMirror on page 2‑19.

Page 20: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-14 In Brief

Steering WheelAdjustment

To adjust the steering wheel:

1. Hold the steering wheel and pullthe lever.

2. Move the steering wheel upor down.

3. Release the lever to lock thewheel in place.

Do not adjust the steering wheelwhile driving.

Throttle and Brake PedalAdjustmentOn vehicles with this feature, youcan change the position of thethrottle and brake pedals.

The control used to adjust thepedals is located on the instrumentpanel below the climate controlsystem.

Press the bottom of the control tomove the pedals closer to yourbody. Press the top of the control tomove the pedals away.

See Adjustable Throttle and BrakePedal on page 9‑20.

Interior LightingDome Lamps

The dome lamps are located in theoverhead console.

They come on when any door isopened and turn off after all thedoors are closed.

Turn the instrument panelbrightness knob located below thedome lamp override button,clockwise to the farthest position tomanually turn on the dome lamps.The dome lamps remain on until theknob is turned counterclockwise.

Dome Lamp Override

The dome lamp override button islocated next to the exterior lampscontrol.

Page 21: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (15,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-15

k : Press the button in and thedome lamps remain off when a dooris opened. Press the button again toreturn it to the extended position sothat the dome lamps come on whena door is opened.

Reading Lamps

For vehicles with reading lamps inthe overhead console, press thebutton located next to the lamp toturn it on or off.

The vehicle may also have readinglamps in other locations. The lampsare fixed and cannot be adjusted.

For more information about interiorlamps, see:. Dome Lamps on page 6‑7.. Reading Lamps on page 6‑8.. Instrument Panel Illumination

Control on page 6‑7.

Exterior Lighting

The exterior lamp control is on theinstrument panel to the left of thesteering wheel.

There are four positions.

O : Turns off the automaticheadlamps and Daytime RunningLamps (DRL). Turn the headlampcontrol to the off position again toturn the automatic headlamps orDRL back on.

For vehicles first sold in Canada,the off position will only work whenthe vehicle is shifted into P (Park).

AUTO: Automatically turns on theheadlamps, parking lamps,taillamps, instrument panel lights,roof marker lamps (if equipped), andlicense plate lamps.

; : Turns on the parking lamps,taillamps, instrument panel lights,roof marker lamps (if equipped), andlicense plate lamps.

5 : Turns on the headlamps,parking lamps, taillamps, instrumentpanel lights, roof marker lamps (ifequipped), and license plate lamps.

Page 22: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (16,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-16 In Brief

See:. Exterior Lamp Controls on

page 6‑1. Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)

on page 6‑3. Fog Lamps on page 6‑6

Windshield Wiper/Washer

The front wiper control is located onthe turn and lane-change lever. Turnthe band with the wiper symbol tocontrol the windshield wipers.

8 : For a single wipe, turn to8 ,then release. For several wipes,hold the band on8 longer.

9 : Turns the windshieldwipers off.

6 : Turn the band up for morefrequent wipes or down for lessfrequent wipes.

w : Slow wipes.

1 : Fast wipes.

L : Push this paddle to spraywasher fluid on the windshield.

Rear Wiper Window Wiper/Washer

To turn the rear wiper on, slide thelever to a wiper position.

9 : Turns the wiper off.

5 : Turns on the rear wiper delay.

Z : Turns on the rear wiper.

= : Press the button on the end ofthe lever to spray washer fluid onthe rear window.

See Windshield Wiper/Washer onpage 5‑4 and Rear Window Wiper/Washer on page 5‑5.

Page 23: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (17,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-17

Climate ControlsThe heating, cooling, and ventilation in the vehicle can be controlled withthese systems.

If this vehicle is a hybrid, see the hybrid supplement for more information.

Climate Control System

A. Fan Control

B. REAR (Rear Climate Control)

C. Recirculation

D. Air Delivery Mode Control

E. Air Conditioning

F. Driver and PassengerTemperature Controls

G. Rear Window Defogger

See Climate Control Systems onpage 8‑1.

Page 24: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (18,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-18 In Brief

Dual Automatic Climate Control System

A. Fan Control

B. AUTO (Automatic Operation)

C. Defrost

D. Recirculation

E. REAR (Rear Climate Control)

F. Air Delivery Mode Control

G. Driver Temperature Control

H. Display

I. Power Button

J. Rear Window Defogger

K. Air Conditioning

L. PASS

M. Passenger Temperature Control

See Dual Automatic Climate ControlSystem on page 8‑3 (If Equipped).For vehicles with rear heating andair conditioning controls, see RearClimate Control System (RearClimate Control Only) on page 8‑9or Rear Climate Control System(with Rear Seat Audio) onpage 8‑10.

Transmission

Range Selection Mode

Base Trim Shown (Uplevel Similar)

The Range Selection Mode switchis located on the shift lever.

1. To enable the Range Selectionfeature, move the column shiftlever to the M (Manual) position.The current range will appearnext to the M. This is the highestattainable range with all lowergears accessible. As anexample, when 5 (Fifth) gear isselected, 1 (First) through5 (Fifth) gears are available.

Page 25: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (19,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-19

2. Press the plus/minus buttons,located on the steering columnshift lever, to select the desiredrange of gears for current drivingconditions. See Manual Mode onpage 9‑31.

While using Range Selection Mode,cruise control and the Tow/Haulmode can be used.

Grade Braking is not available whenRange Selection Mode is active.See Tow/Haul Mode on page 9‑32.

Four-Wheel DriveIf the vehicle has Four-Wheel Drive,you can send the engine's drivingpower to all four wheels for extratraction.

Automatic Transfer Case

Two Speed Transfer Case

Single Speed Transfer Case

The transfer case knob is located tothe left of the instrument panelcluster. Use this knob to shift intoand out of the different Four-WheelDrive modes.

2 m : This setting is used for drivingin most street and highwaysituations.

AUTO: This setting is ideal for usewhen road surface tractionconditions are variable.

4 m : Use the Four-Wheel-DriveHigh position when extra traction isneeded, such as on snowy or icyroads or in most off-road situations.

4 n : Vehicles with a two speedtransfer case have aFour-Wheel-Drive Low position. Thissetting sends maximum power to allfour wheels. You might chooseFour-Wheel-Drive Low if you aredriving off-road in deep sand, deepmud, deep snow, and while climbingor descending steep hills.

Page 26: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (20,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-20 In Brief

N (Neutral): Vehicles with a twospeed transfer case have aN (Neutral) position. Shift thetransfer case to N (Neutral) onlywhen towing the vehicle. SeeRecreational Vehicle Towing onpage 10‑82 or Towing the Vehicleon page 10‑82.

See Four-Wheel Drive (SingleSpeed Automatic Transfer Case) onpage 9‑38 or Four-Wheel Drive (TwoSpeed Automatic Transfer Case) onpage 9‑33.

Vehicle Features

Radio(s)

Radio with USB, CD, and DVD (MP3)

O : Press to turn the system onand off. Turn to increase ordecrease the volume.

BAND: Press to choose betweenFM, AM, or SiriusXM®, if equipped.

Page 27: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (21,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-21

f : Turn to manually select radiostations or press to set the bass ortreble.

© SEEK or ¨ SEEK: Seek or scanstations.

4 : Press to switch the displaybetween the radio station frequencyand the time. While the ignition isoff, press this button to display thetime. Press to display additional textinformation related to the currentFM-RDS or SiriusXM station; or CD,MP3, or WMA song. If information isavailable during SiriusXM, CD, MP3,or WMA playback, the song titleinformation displays on the top lineof the display and artist informationdisplays on the bottom line. Wheninformation is not available, “NOINFO” displays.

For more information about theseand other radio features, seeOperation on page 7‑6.

For vehicles with a Rear SeatEntertainment System (RSE) andRear Seat Audio System (RSA), seeRear Seat Entertainment (RSE)System on page 7‑36 and RearSeat Audio (RSA) System onpage 7‑46 for more information.

Storing Radio Stations

A maximum of 36 stations can bestored as favorites using the sixsoftkeys located below the radiostation frequency tabs and by usingthe radio FAV button. Press FAV togo through up to six pages offavorites, each having six favoritestations available per page. Eachpage of favorites can contain anycombination of AM, FM, or SiriusXMstations.

For more information, see “StoringRadio Stations” in AM-FM Radio onpage 7‑10.

Setting the Clock

To set the time and date:

1. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN, thenpress O , to turn the radio on.

2. Press H to display HR, MIN,MM, DD, and YYYY (hour,minute, month, day, and year).

3. Press the softkey located underany one of the labels to bechanged.

4. To increase or decrease the timeor date, turn f clockwise orcounter-clockwise.

For detailed instructions on settingthe clock for the vehicle's specificaudio system, see Clock onpage 5‑7.

Page 28: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (22,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-22 In Brief

Satellite RadioSiriusXM® is a satellite radio servicebased in the 48 contiguous UnitedStates and 10 Canadian provinces.SiriusXM satellite radio has a widevariety of programming andcommercial-free music, coast tocoast, and in digital-quality sound.

A fee is required to receive theSiriusXM service.

For more information, refer to:. www.siriusxm.com or call

1-866-635-2349 (U.S.). www.xmradio.ca or call

1-877-209-0079 (Canada)

See Satellite Radio on page 7‑11.

Portable Audio DevicesThis vehicle has an auxiliary input,located on the audio faceplate, anda USB port located on theinstrument panel or in the centerconsole. External devices such asiPod®, laptop computers,MP3 players, CD changers, USB

storage device, etc. can beconnected to the auxiliary port usinga 3.5 mm (1/8 in) input jack or theUSB port depending on the audiosystem.

See Auxiliary Devices on page 7‑31for further information.

Bluetooth®

For vehicles with a Bluetoothsystem, it allows users with aBluetooth-enabled cell phone tomake and receive hands-free callsusing the vehicle’s audio systemand controls.

The Bluetooth-enabled cell phonemust be paired with the Bluetoothsystem before it can be used in thevehicle. Not all phones will supportall functions. For more information,see www.gm.com/bluetooth andBluetooth on page 7‑48.

Steering Wheel Controls

If equipped, some audio controlscan be adjusted at the steeringwheel.

w : Press to go to the next favoriteradio station, track on a CD,or folder on an iPod® or USBdevice.

c /x : Press to go to theprevious favorite radio station, trackon a CD, or folder on an iPod® orUSB device. Press to reject anincoming call, or to end a call.

Page 29: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (23,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-23

b / g : Press to silence the vehiclespeakers only. Press again to turnthe sound on. Press and hold longerthan two seconds to interact withOnStar® or Bluetooth systems,if equipped.

+ e : Press to increase volume.

− e : Press to decrease volume.

SRCE: Press to switch betweenthe radio and CD, and for equippedvehicles, the DVD, front auxiliary,and rear auxiliary.

¨ : Press to seek the next radiostation, the next track or chapterwhile sourced to the CD or DVDslot, or to select tracks and folderson an iPod or USB device.

For more information, see SteeringWheel Controls on page 5‑2.

Cruise Control

T : Press to turn the system onor off. The indicator light is on whencruise control is on and turns offwhen cruise control is off.

+ RES: Press briefly to make thevehicle resume to a previously setspeed, or press and hold toaccelerate.

SET −: Press to set the speed andactivate cruise control or make thevehicle decelerate.

[ : Press to disengage cruisecontrol without erasing the setspeed from memory.

See Cruise Control on page 9‑46.

Navigation SystemIf the vehicle has a navigationsystem, there is a separatenavigation manual that includesinformation on the radio, audioplayers, and navigation system.

The navigation system providesdetailed maps of most majorfreeways and roads. After adestination has been set, thesystem provides turn-by-turninstructions for reaching thedestination. In addition, the systemcan help locate a variety of points ofinterest (POIs), such as banks,airports, restaurants, and more.

See the navigation manual for moreinformation.

Page 30: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (24,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-24 In Brief

Side Blind ZoneAlert (SBZA)If available, this feature will alert youto vehicles located in the vehicle'sside blind zone. When the systemdetects a vehicle in the side blindzone, the SBZA display will light upin the corresponding outside sidemirror.

The system can be disabled throughthe Driver Information Center (DIC).

If the message SIDE BLIND ZONESYSTEM UNAVAILABLE appearson the DIC, the system has beendisabled because the sensor isblocked and cannot detect vehiclesin the blind zone. The sensor maybe blocked by mud, dirt, snow, ice,slush, or even heavy rainstorms.This message may also activateduring heavy rain or due to roadspray. The vehicle does not needservice.

See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)on page 9‑49 for more information.

Rear VisionCamera (RVC)If available, the RVC displays a viewof the area behind the vehicle whenthe vehicle is shifted intoR (Reverse). The display will appearon either the inside rearview mirroror navigation screen, if equipped.

To clean the camera lens, locatedabove the license plate, rinse it withwater and wipe it with a soft cloth.

See Rear Vision Camera (RVC) onpage 9‑52.

Ultrasonic Parking AssistIf available, this system usessensors on the rear bumper toassist with parking and avoidingobjects while in R (Reverse).It operates at speeds less than8 km/h (5 mph). URPA uses audiblebeeps to provide distance andsystem information.

Keep the sensors on the vehicle'srear bumper clean to ensure properoperation.

See Ultrasonic Parking Assist onpage 9‑48.

Power OutletsThe accessory power outlets can beused to plug in electrical equipment,such as a cell phone or MP3 player.

There are two under the climatecontrols, one inside the center floorconsole, one on the rear of thecenter floor console and oneaccessory power outlet in the rearcargo area on the passenger side.

The accessory power outlets arepowered, even with the ignition off.Continuing to use accessory poweroutlets while the ignition is in LOCK/OFF may cause the vehicle'sbattery to run down.

See Power Outlets on page 5‑8.

Page 31: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (25,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-25

Universal Remote System

Vehicles with the Universal RemoteSystem will have these buttonslocated in the headliner.

This system provides a way toreplace up to three remote controltransmitters used to activatedevices such as garage dooropeners, security systems, andhome automation devices.

Read the instructions completelybefore attempting to program thetransmitter. Because of the stepsinvolved, it may be helpful to haveanother person assist withprogramming the transmitter.

See Universal Remote System onpage 5‑52.

Sunroof

A. Open or Close

B. Vent

On vehicles with a sunroof, thesunroof only operates when theignition is in ACC/ACCESSORY orON/RUN, or when RetainedAccessory Power (RAP) is active.See Retained Accessory Power(RAP) on page 9‑24.

Vent: From the closed position,press the rear of switch (B) to ventthe sunroof.

Open/Close: To open the sunroof,press and hold switch (A) until thesunroof reaches the desiredposition. Press and hold the front ofswitch (A) to close it.

Express-Open/Express-Close: Toexpress-open the sunroof, fullypress and release the rear ofswitch (A) until the sunroof reachesthe desired position. Toexpress-close the sunroof, fullypress and release the front ofswitch (A). Press the switch again tostop it.

Page 32: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (26,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-26 In Brief

When the sunroof is opened, an airdeflector will automatically raise.The air deflector will retract whenthe sunroof is closed.

The sunroof also has a sunshadewhich can be pulled forward to blocksun rays. The sunshade must beopened and closed manually.

If an object is in the path of thesunroof while it is closing, theanti-pinch feature will detect theobject and stop the sunroof.

See Sunroof on page 2‑22.

Performance andMaintenance

StabiliTrak® SystemIf equipped, the vehicle has atraction control system that limitswheel spin and the StabiliTraksystem that assists with directionalcontrol of the vehicle in difficultdriving conditions. Both systemsturn on automatically every time thevehicle is started.. To turn off traction control, press

and release g on the instrumentpanel. The appropriate DICmessage displays. See RideControl System Messages onpage 5‑40.

. To turn off both traction controland StabiliTrak, press and holdg until g illuminates and theappropriate DIC messagedisplays. See Ride ControlSystem Messages on page 5‑40.

. Press and release g again toturn on both systems.

For more information, seeStabiliTrak® System on page 9‑42.

Tire Pressure MonitorThis vehicle may have a TirePressure Monitor System (TPMS).

The low tire pressure warning lightalerts to a significant loss inpressure of one of the vehicle'stires. If the warning light comes on,stop as soon as possible and inflatethe tires to the recommendedpressure shown on the Tire andLoading Information label. SeeVehicle Load Limits on page 9‑15.The warning light will remain on untilthe tire pressure is corrected.

Page 33: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (27,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

In Brief 1-27

The low tire pressure warning lightmay come on in cool weather whenthe vehicle is first started, and thenturn off as the vehicle is driven. Thismay be an early indicator that thetire pressures are getting low andthe tires need to be inflated to theproper pressure.

The TPMS does not replace normalmonthly tire maintenance. Maintainthe correct tire pressures.

See Tire Pressure Monitor Systemon page 10‑50.

Engine Oil Life SystemThe engine oil life system calculatesengine oil life based on vehicle useand, on most vehicles, displays aDIC message when it is necessaryto change the engine oil and filter.The oil life system should be resetto 100% only following an oilchange.

Resetting the Oil Life System

To reset the Engine Oil Life Systemon most vehicles:

1. Display OIL LIFE REMAININGon the DIC. If the vehicle doesnot have DIC buttons, thevehicle must be in P (Park) toaccess this display.

2. Press and hold the SET/RESETbutton on the DIC, or the tripodometer reset stem if thevehicle does not have DICbuttons, for more thanfive seconds. The oil life willchange to 100%.

On all vehicles, the Engine Oil LifeSystem can be reset as follows:

1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN withthe engine off.

2. Fully press the accelerator pedalslowly three times withinfive seconds.

3. Display OIL LIFE REMAININGon the DIC. If the display shows100%, the system is reset.

See Engine Oil Life System onpage 10‑9.

Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol)Vehicles that have a yellow fuel capcan use either unleaded gasoline orethanol fuel containing up to 85%ethanol (E85). See Fuel E85 (85%Ethanol) on page 9‑58. For all othervehicles, use only the unleadedgasoline described underRecommended Fuel on page 9‑56.

Driving for Better FuelEconomyDriving habits can affect fuelmileage. Here are some driving tipsto get the best fuel economypossible.. Avoid fast starts and accelerate

smoothly.. Brake gradually and avoid

abrupt stops.. Avoid idling the engine for long

periods of time.

Page 34: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (28,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

1-28 In Brief

. When road and weatherconditions are appropriate, usecruise control.

. Always follow posted speedlimits or drive more slowly whenconditions require.

. Keep vehicle tires properlyinflated.

. Combine several trips into asingle trip.

. Replace the vehicle's tires withthe same TPC Spec numbermolded into the tire's sidewallnear the size.

. Follow recommended scheduledmaintenance.

Roadside AssistanceProgramU.S.: 1-800-243-8872

TTY Users (U.S. Only):1-888-889-2438

Canada: 1-800-268-6800

Mexico: 01-800-466-0800

As the owner of a new Chevrolet,you are automatically enrolled in theRoadside Assistance program.

See Roadside Assistance Program(Mexico) on page 13‑7 or RoadsideAssistance Program (U.S. andCanada) on page 13‑11.

Roadside Assistance and OnStar(U.S. and Canada)

If the vehicle has an active OnStarsubscription, contact OnStar and thevehicle’s current GPS location willbe sent to an OnStar advisor toassess the situation, contactRoadside Assistance, and relay theexact location to send help.

OnStar®

If equipped, this vehicle has acomprehensive, in-vehicle systemthat can connect to a live Advisorfor Emergency, Security, Navigation,Connection, and DiagnosticServices. See OnStar Overview onpage 14‑1.

Page 35: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-1

Keys, Doors, andWindows

Keys and LocksKeys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2

Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)System Operation . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2

Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . 2-5Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . 2-8Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8

DoorsLiftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9Power Assist Steps . . . . . . . . . . 2-12

Vehicle SecurityVehicle Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12Vehicle Alarm System . . . . . . . 2-12Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14Immobilizer Operation . . . . . . . 2-14

Exterior MirrorsConvex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15Manual Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16Trailer-Tow Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18Automatic Dimming Mirror . . . 2-18Park Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18

Interior MirrorsManual Rearview Mirror . . . . . . 2-19Automatic Dimming RearviewMirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19

WindowsWindows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21

RoofSunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22

Keys and Locks

Keys

{ WARNING

Leaving children in a vehicle withthe ignition key is dangerous andchildren or others could beseriously injured or killed. Theycould operate the power windowsor other controls or make thevehicle move. The windows willfunction with the keys in theignition, and children or otherscould be caught in the path of aclosing window. Do not leavechildren in a vehicle with theignition key.

Page 36: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-2 Keys, Doors, and Windows

The key is used for the ignition andall door locks.

The key has a bar-coded key tagthat the dealer or qualified locksmithcan use to make new keys. Storethis information in a safe place, notin the vehicle.

See your dealer if a replacementkey or additional key is needed.

If the vehicle has an ignition and itbecomes difficult to turn the key,inspect the key blade for debris.Periodically clean with a brushor pick.

With an active OnStar subscription,an OnStar Advisor may remotelyunlock the vehicle. See OnStarOverview on page 14‑1.

Remote Keyless Entry(RKE) SystemSee Radio Frequency Statement onpage 13‑20 for informationregarding Part 15 of the FederalCommunications Commission (FCC)rules and Industry CanadaStandards RSS-GEN/210/220/310.

If there is a decrease in the RKEoperating range:. Check the distance. The

transmitter may be too far fromthe vehicle.

. Check the location. Othervehicles or objects may beblocking the signal.

. Check the transmitter's battery.See “Battery Replacement” laterin this section.

. If the transmitter is still notworking correctly, see yourdealer or a qualified technicianfor service.

Remote Keyless Entry(RKE) System OperationThe Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)transmitter functions work up to60 m (195 ft) away from the vehicle.

There are other conditions whichcan affect the performance of thetransmitter. See Remote KeylessEntry (RKE) System on page 2‑2.

Page 37: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-3

With Remote Start and Liftglass

With Remote Start and PowerLiftgate and Liftglass

The following functions may beavailable if your vehicle has theRKE system:

/ (Remote Vehicle Start): Ifavailable, press to start the enginefrom outside the vehicle using theRKE transmitter. See RemoteVehicle Start on page 2‑5 foradditional information.

Q (Lock): Press to lock all thedoors.

If enabled through the DriverInformation Center (DIC), the turnsignal lamps flash once to indicatelocking has occurred. If enabledthrough the DIC, the horn chirpswhen the lock button is pressedagain within three seconds. SeeVehicle Personalization (With DICButtons) on page 5‑44 for additionalinformation.

Pressing Q arms the contenttheft-deterrent system. See VehicleAlarm System on page 2‑12.

K (Unlock): Press once to unlockonly the driver door. If K is pressedagain within three seconds, allremaining doors unlock. The interiorlamps may come on and stay on for20 seconds or until the ignition isturned on.

If enabled through the DIC, the turnsignal lamps flash twice to indicateunlocking has occurred. See VehiclePersonalization (With DIC Buttons)on page 5‑44. If enabled throughthe DIC, the exterior lights turn onbriefly if it is dark enough outside.See “Approach Lighting” underVehicle Personalization (With DICButtons) on page 5‑44.

Pressing K on the RKE transmitterdisarms the content theft-deterrentsystem. See Vehicle Alarm Systemon page 2‑12.

m (Liftglass): Press and hold tounlock the liftglass.

Page 38: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-4 Keys, Doors, and Windows

8 (Power Liftgate): Press andhold to open and close the liftgate.The taillamps flash and a chimesounds to indicate when the liftgateis opening and closing.

L (Vehicle Locator/PanicAlarm): Press and release tolocate the vehicle. The turn signallamps flash and the horn soundsthree times.

Press and holdL for more thantwo seconds to activate the panicalarm. The turn signal lamps flashand the horn sounds repeatedly for30 seconds. The alarm turns offwhen the ignition is moved to ON/RUN or L is pressed again. Theignition must be in LOCK/OFF forthe panic alarm to work.

Programming Transmitters tothe Vehicle

Only RKE transmitters programmedto this vehicle will work. If atransmitter is lost or stolen, areplacement can be purchased andprogrammed through your dealer.

When the replacement transmitter isprogrammed to this vehicle, allremaining transmitters must also bereprogrammed. Any lost or stolentransmitters will no longer workonce the new transmitter isprogrammed. The vehicle can havea maximum of eight transmittersprogrammed to it. See your dealerto program transmitters to thevehicle.

Battery Replacement

Replace the battery if the REPLACEBATTERY IN REMOTE KEYmessage displays in the DIC. See“REPLACE BATTERY IN REMOTEKEY” under Key and LockMessages on page 5‑38 foradditional information.

Notice: When replacing thebattery, do not touch any of thecircuitry on the transmitter. Staticfrom your body could damage thetransmitter.

To replace the battery:

1. Separate the transmitter with aflat, thin object, such as a flathead screwdriver.. Carefully insert the tool into

the notch located along theparting line of thetransmitter. Do not insertthe tool too far. Stop assoon as resistance is felt.

. Twist the tool until thetransmitter is separated.

2. Remove the old battery. Do notuse a metal object.

Page 39: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-5

3. Insert the new battery, positiveside facing down. Replace with aCR2032 or equivalent battery.

4. Snap the transmitter backtogether.

Remote Vehicle StartIf available, this feature allows youto start the engine from outside ofthe vehicle. It may also start up thevehicle's heating or air conditioningsystems and rear window defogger.Normal operation of the system willreturn after the key is turned to theON/RUN position.

If the vehicle has an automaticclimate control system, the climatecontrol system will default to aheating or cooling mode dependingon the outside temperatures. If thevehicle does not have an automaticclimate control system, the systemwill turn on at the setting the vehiclewas set to when the vehicle waslast turned off.

During a remote start, if the vehiclehas an automatic climate controlsystem and heated seats, theheated seats will turn on duringcolder outside temperatures and willshut off when the key is turned toON/RUN. If the vehicle does nothave an automatic climate controlsystem, during remote start,manually turn the heated seats onand off. See Heated and VentilatedFront Seats on page 3‑8 foradditional information.

Laws in some communities mayrestrict the use of remote starters.For example, some laws mayrequire a person using the remotestart to have the vehicle in viewwhen doing so. Check localregulations for any requirements onremote starting of vehicles.

Do not use the remote start featureif the vehicle is low on fuel. Thevehicle may run out of fuel.

The RKE transmitter range may beless while the vehicle is running.

There are other conditions whichcan affect the performance of thetransmitter. See Remote KeylessEntry (RKE) System on page 2‑2 foradditional information.

/ (Remote Start): This button willbe on the RKE transmitter if thevehicle has remote start.

To start the vehicle using the remotestart feature:

1. Aim the RKE transmitter at thevehicle.

2. Press and release Q.

3. Immediately press and hold /until the turn signal lamps flash.If you cannot see the vehicle'slamps, press and hold/ for atleast two seconds.

When the vehicle starts, theparking lamps will turn on andremain on while the vehicle isrunning. The doors will belocked and the climate controlsystem may come on.

Page 40: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-6 Keys, Doors, and Windows

The engine will continue to runfor 10 minutes. Repeat the stepsfor a 10-minute time extension.Remote start can be extendedonly once.

After entering the vehicle during aremote start, insert and turn the keyto ON/RUN to drive the vehicle.

To cancel a remote start:. Aim the RKE transmitter at the

vehicle and press and hold/until the parking lamps turn off.

. Turn on the hazard warningflashers.

. Turn the ignition on and thenback off.

The vehicle can be remote startedtwo separate times between drivingsequences. The engine will run for10 minutes after each remote start.

Or, you can extend the engine runtime by another 10 minutes withinthe first 10 minute remote start timeframe, and before the engine stops.

For example, if Q and then/ arepressed again after the vehicle hasbeen running for 5 minutes,10 minutes are added, allowing theengine to run for 15 minutes.

The additional 10 minutes areconsidered a second remote vehiclestart.

Once two remote starts, or a singleremote start with one time extensionhas been done, the vehicle must bestarted with the key. After the key isremoved from the ignition, thevehicle can be remote started again.

The vehicle cannot be remotestarted if the key is in the ignition,the hood is not closed, or if there isan emission control systemmalfunction and the check enginelight is on.

Also, the engine will turn off during aremote vehicle start if the coolanttemperature gets too high or if theoil pressure gets low.

Remote Start Ready

If the vehicle does not have theremote vehicle start feature, it mayhave the remote start ready feature.This feature allows your dealer toadd the manufacturer's remotevehicle start feature.

See your dealer to add themanufacturer's remote vehicle startfeature to the vehicle.

Door Locks

{ WARNING

Unlocked doors can bedangerous.

. Passengers, especiallychildren, can easily open thedoors and fall out of a movingvehicle. When a door islocked, the handle will notopen it. The chance of beingthrown out of the vehicle in acrash is increased if the

(Continued)

Page 41: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-7

WARNING (Continued)

doors are not locked. So, allpassengers should wearsafety belts properly and thedoors should be lockedwhenever the vehicle isdriven.

. Young children who get intounlocked vehicles may beunable to get out. A child canbe overcome by extreme heatand can suffer permanentinjuries or even death fromheat stroke. Always lock thevehicle whenever leaving it.

. Outsiders can easily enterthrough an unlocked doorwhen you slow down or stopthe vehicle. Locking the doorscan help prevent this fromhappening.

There are several ways to lock andunlock the vehicle.

From outside, use the RemoteKeyless Entry (RKE) transmitter orthe key in the driver door.

From inside, use the power doorlocks or manual door locks. To lockor unlock the door with the manuallocks, push down or pull up on themanual lock knob.

Power Door Locks

Press Q or K on the RemoteKeyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)System Operation on page 2‑2.

Power Folding Mirrors Shown,Other Models Similar

Q (Lock): Press to lock the doors.

K (Unlock): Press to unlock thedoors.

Delayed LockingWhen locking the doors with thepower lock switch and a door or theliftgate is open, the doors will lockfive seconds after the last door isclosed. You will hear three chimesto signal that the delayed lockingfeature is in use.

Page 42: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-8 Keys, Doors, and Windows

Pressing the power lock switchtwice will override the delayedlocking feature and immediately lockall the doors.

This feature will not operate if thekey is in the ignition.

This feature can be programmedusing the Driver InformationCenter (DIC). See “Delay DoorLock” under Vehicle Personalization(With DIC Buttons) on page 5‑44.

Automatic Door LocksThe vehicle may have an automaticlock/unlock feature. This feature canbe programmed using the DriverInformation Center (DIC). SeeVehicle Personalization (With DICButtons) on page 5‑44.

Lockout ProtectionIf the driver side power door lockswitch is pressed when the driverdoor is open and the key is in theignition, all of the doors will lock andthen the driver door will unlock.

If the passenger side power doorlock switch is pressed when thefront passenger door is open andthe key is in the ignition, all of thedoors will lock and then the frontpassenger door will unlock.

Safety LocksThe vehicle has rear door securitylocks to prevent passengers fromopening the rear doors from theinside.

Open the rear doors to access thesecurity locks on the inside edge ofeach door.

To set the locks, insert a key intothe slot and turn it to the horizontalposition. The door can only beopened from the outside with thedoor unlocked. To return the door tonormal operation, turn the slot to thevertical position.

Page 43: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-9

Doors

Liftgate

{ WARNING

Exhaust gases can enter thevehicle if it is driven with theliftgate or trunk/hatch open,or with any objects that passthrough the seal between thebody and the trunk/hatch orliftgate. Engine exhaust containscarbon monoxide (CO) whichcannot be seen or smelled. It cancause unconsciousness and evendeath.

If the vehicle must be driven withthe liftgate or trunk/hatch open:

. Close all of the windows.

. Fully open the air outlets onor under the instrumentpanel.

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

. Adjust the climate controlsystem to a setting thatbrings in only outside air andset the fan speed to thehighest setting. See “ClimateControl Systems” in theIndex.

. If the vehicle is equipped witha power liftgate, disable thepower liftgate function.

See Engine Exhaust onpage 9‑27.

Notice: If you open the liftgatewithout checking for overheadobstructions such as a garagedoor, you could damage theliftgate or the liftgate glass.Always check to make sure thearea above and behind the liftgateis clear before opening it.

A. License Plate Applique

B. Liftgate Handle

The liftglass or liftgate cannot beopened if the rear wiper is in motion.Attempting to open the liftglass orliftgate while the rear wiper is inmotion will cause the release of theliftglass or liftgate to delay until thewipers are parked off the liftglass.

Page 44: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-10 Keys, Doors, and Windows

Manual Liftgate Operation

To unlock the liftgate, press K onthe power door lock switch or pressK on the Remote Keyless Entry(RKE) transmitter twice. SeeRemote Keyless Entry (RKE)System Operation on page 2‑2.

Press the touch pad on theunderside of the liftgate handle (B)and lift up.

Use the pull cup to lower and closethe liftgate. Do not press the touchpad while closing the liftgate. Thiswill cause the liftgate to beunlatched.

Power Liftgate Operation

On vehicles with a power liftgate,the switch is on the overheadconsole.

The vehicle must be in P (Park) touse the power feature. The taillampswill flash and a chime will soundwhen the power liftgate moves.

{ WARNING

You, or others, could be injured ifcaught in the path of the powerliftgate. Make sure there is no onein the way of the liftgate as it isopening and closing.

There are several ways to open andclose the power liftgate:

. Press and hold8 on the RKEtransmitter until the liftgate startsmoving.

. Press8 on the overheadconsole.

. Pressl on the bottom of theliftgate next to the latch to close.

Pressing a second time while theliftgate is moving reverses thedirection.

To disable the power liftgatefunction, press OFF on the liftgateswitch.

The power liftgate may betemporarily disabled under extremetemperatures, or under low batteryconditions. If this occurs, the liftgatecan still be operated manually.

If the transmission is shifted out of P(Park) while the power function is inprogress, the liftgate power functionwill continue to completion. If thetransmission is shifted out of P(Park) and the vehicle acceleratesbefore the power liftgate latchesclosed, the liftgate may reverse tothe open position. Cargo could fallout of the vehicle. Always makesure the power liftgate is closed andlatched before driving away.

If the liftgate is opened using poweroperation and the liftgate supportstruts have lost pressure, the turnsignals flash and a chime willsound. The liftgate stays opentemporarily, and then slowly closes.See a dealer for service beforeusing the liftgate.

Page 45: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-11

Obstacle Detection Features

If the liftgate encounters an obstacleduring a power open or close cycle,a warning chime will sound and theliftgate will automatically reversedirection to the full closed or openposition. After removing theobstruction, the power liftgateoperation can be used again. If theliftgate encounters multipleobstacles on the same power cycle,the power function will deactivateand a message will display in theDriver Information Center (DIC).See Object Detection SystemMessages on page 5‑39. Afterremoving the obstructions, theliftgate will resume normal poweroperation.

Pinch sensors are located on theside edges of the liftgate. If anobject is caught between the liftgateand the vehicle and presses againstthis sensor, the liftgate will reversedirection and open fully. The liftgatewill remain open until it is activatedagain or closed manually.

Manual Operation of PowerLiftgate

To change the liftgate to manualoperation, press OFF on the liftgateswitch.

With the power liftgate disabled andall of the doors unlocked, the liftgatecan be manually opened andclosed.

To open the liftgate, press the touchpad on the handle (B) and lift up.Use the pull cup to lower and closethe liftgate. Do not press the touchpad while closing the liftgate. Thiswill cause the liftgate to beunlatched. The liftgate latch willpower close. Always close theliftgate before driving.

If8 on the RKE transmitter orl on the liftgate is pressed whilepower operation is disabled, thelamps will flash three times, but theliftgate will not move.

It is not recommended to drive withthe liftgate open, however, whendriving with the liftgate open; the

liftgate should be set to manualoperation by pressing OFF on theliftgate switch on the center console.

The liftgate has an electric latch.If the battery is disconnected or haslow voltage, the liftgate will notopen. The liftgate will resumeoperation when the battery isreconnected and charged.

If the battery is properly connectedwith adequate voltage, the switch isnot disabled, and the liftgate still willnot function, see a dealer forservice.

Liftglass

If equipped, there are two ways toopen the liftglass:. Press the button on the

underside of the license plateapplique (A).

. Pressm on the RKEtransmitter.

Page 46: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-12 Keys, Doors, and Windows

Power Assist Steps

The vehicle may have power assiststeps. To enable or disable thepower assist steps pushj.

The power assist stepsautomatically extend from beneaththe vehicle on the side in which thedoor has been opened. Once thedoor is closed, the assist stepsautomatically move back under thevehicle after a brief delay. Thevehicle must not be moving for theassist steps to extend or retract.

The assist steps cannot be disabledin the extended position.

Vehicle SecurityThis vehicle has theft-deterrentfeatures; however, they do not makethe vehicle impossible to steal.

Vehicle Alarm SystemYour vehicle has a contenttheft-deterrent alarm system.

This is the security light.

To arm the theft-deterrent system:

1. Open the door.

Page 47: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-13

2. Lock the door with the RemoteKeyless Entry (RKE) transmitteror the power door lock switch.The security light will come on toinform the driver the system isarming. If a door is open whenthe doors are locked, thesecurity light will flash.

If the delayed locking feature isturned on, the theft-deterrentsystem will not start the armingprocess until the last door isclosed and the delay timer hasexpired. See Delayed Lockingon page 2‑7.

3. Close all doors. The securitylight should go off after about30 seconds. The alarm is notarmed until the security lightgoes off.

If a locked driver door is openedwithout using the RKE transmitter, a10-second pre-alarm will occur. Thehorn will chirp and the lights willflash. If the key is not placed in theignition and turned to START or thedoor is not unlocked by pressing the

unlock button on the RKEtransmitter during the 10-secondpre-alarm, the alarm will go off. Yourvehicle's headlamps will flash andthe horn will sound for about30 seconds, then will turn off to savethe battery power.

The theft-deterrent system will notactivate if the doors are locked withthe vehicle's key or the manual doorlock. It activates only if you use thepower door lock switch with the dooropen or the RKE transmitter. Youshould also remember that you canstart your vehicle with the correctignition key if the alarm has beenset off.

To avoid setting off the alarm byaccident:. If you do not want to activate the

theft-deterrent system, thevehicle should be locked withthe door key after the doors areclosed.

. Always unlock the doors with theRKE transmitter. Unlocking adoor any other way will set offthe alarm if it is armed.

If you set off the alarm by accident,press unlock on the RKE transmitteror place the key in the ignition andturn it to START to turn off thealarm. The alarm will not stop if youtry to unlock a door any other way.

Testing the Alarm

To test the alarm:

1. From inside the vehicle, lowerthe driver window and open thedriver door.

2. Activate the system by lockingthe doors with the power doorlock switch while the door isopen, or with the RKEtransmitter.

3. Get out of the vehicle, close thedoor and wait for the securitylight to go out.

Page 48: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-14 Keys, Doors, and Windows

4. Then reach in through thewindow, unlock the door with themanual door lock and open thedoor. This should set off thealarm.

While the alarm is set, the powerdoor unlock switch will not work.

If the alarm does not sound when itshould but the headlamps flash,check to see if the horn works. Thehorn fuse may be blown. To replacethe fuse, see Fuses and CircuitBreakers on page 10‑33.

If the alarm does not sound or theheadlamps do not flash, the vehicleshould be serviced by your dealer.

ImmobilizerSee Radio Frequency Statement onpage 13‑20 for informationregarding Part 15 of the FederalCommunications Commission (FCC)rules and Industry CanadaStandards RSS-GEN/210/220/310.

Immobilizer OperationThis vehicle has PASS-Key® III+(Personalized Automotive SecuritySystem) theft-deterrent system.PASS-Key III+ is a passivetheft-deterrent system.

The system is automatically armedwhen the key is removed from theignition.

The system is automaticallydisarmed when the key is turned toON/RUN, ACC/ACCESSORY,or START from the LOCK/OFFposition.

You do not have to manually arm ordisarm the system.

The security light will come on ifthere is a problem with arming ordisarming the theft-deterrentsystem.

When the PASS-Key III+ systemsenses that someone is using thewrong key, it prevents the vehiclefrom starting. Anyone using atrial-and-error method to start the

vehicle will be discouraged becauseof the high number of electrical keycodes.

If the engine does not start and thesecurity light on the instrumentpanel cluster comes on when tryingto start the vehicle, there may be aproblem with the theft-deterrentsystem. Turn the ignition off and tryagain.

If the engine still does not start, andthe key appears to be undamaged,try another ignition key. At this time,you may also want to check thefuse. See Fuses and CircuitBreakers on page 10‑33. If theengine still does not start with theother key, the vehicle needs service.If the vehicle does start, the first keymay be faulty. See your dealer whocan service the PASS-Key III+ tohave a new key made.

It is possible for the PASS-Key III+decoder to learn the transpondervalue of a new or replacement key.Up to 10 keys may be programmedfor the vehicle. The following

Page 49: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (15,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-15

procedure is for programmingadditional keys only. If all thecurrently programmed keys are lostor do not operate, you must seeyour dealer or a locksmith who canservice PASS-Key III+ to have keysmade and programmed to thesystem.

See your dealer or a locksmith whocan service PASS-Key III+ to get anew key blank cut exactly as theignition key that operates thesystem.

To program the new additional key:

1. Verify that the new key has a 1stamped on it.

2. Insert the original, alreadyprogrammed key in the ignitionand start the engine. If theengine will not start, see yourdealer for service.

3. After the engine has started, turnthe key to LOCK/OFF, andremove the key.

4. Insert the new key to beprogrammed and turn it to theON/RUN position withinfive seconds of turning theignition to the LOCK/OFFposition in Step 3.

The security light will turn offonce the key has beenprogrammed.

5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 ifadditional keys are to beprogrammed.

If you lose or damage yourPASS-Key III+ key, see your dealeror a locksmith who can servicePASS-Key III+ to have a newkey made.

Do not leave the key or device thatdisarms or deactivates thetheft-deterrent system in the vehicle.

Exterior Mirrors

Convex Mirrors

{ WARNING

A convex mirror can make things,like other vehicles, look fartheraway than they really are. If youcut too sharply into the right lane,you could hit a vehicle on theright. Check the inside mirror orglance over your shoulder beforechanging lanes.

The passenger side mirror is convexshaped. A convex mirror's surface iscurved so more can be seen fromthe driver seat.

Page 50: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (16,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-16 Keys, Doors, and Windows

Manual MirrorsVehicles with manual mirrors can beadjusted by moving the mirror upand down or left to right to see alittle of the side of the vehicle, andhave a clear view behind thevehicle.

Using hood-mounted air deflectorsand add-on convex mirrorattachments could decrease mirrorperformance.

Trailer-Tow Mirrors

If the vehicle has towing mirrors,they can be adjusted for a clearerview of the objects behind you.

Manually pull out the mirror head toextend it for better visibility whentowing a trailer.

The lower portion of the mirror isconvex. A convex mirror's surface iscurved to see more from the driverseat. The convex mirror can beadjusted manually to the driverpreferred position for better vision.

The mirror may have a turn signalarrow that flashes in the direction ofthe turn or lane change.

Power Mirrors

With Power Folding Mirrors

To adjust the mirrors:

1. Press (A) or (B) to select thedriver or passenger side mirror.

2. Press the arrows on the controlpad to move the mirror up,down, right, or left.

3. Adjust the outside mirror so thatthe side of the vehicle and thearea behind are seen.

4. Press either (A) or (B) again todeselect the mirror.

Page 51: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (17,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-17

With Manual Folding Mirrors

To adjust the mirrors:

1. Move the selector switch locatedabove the four-way control padto the left or right to chooseeither the driver side orpassenger side mirror.

2. Press one of the four arrowslocated on the control pad tomove the mirror in the desireddirection.

3. Adjust the outside mirror so thatthe side of the vehicle and thearea behind are seen.

Keep the selector switch in thecenter position when not adjustingeither outside mirror.

Exterior Automatic DimmingMirror

If the vehicle has the exteriorautomatic dimming mirror, the driveroutside mirror automatically adjustsfor the glare of headlamps behind.This feature is controlled by the onand off setting on the insideautomatic dimming rearview mirror.See Automatic Dimming RearviewMirror on page 2‑19.

Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)

If the vehicle has the Side BlindZone Alert (SBZA) system. See SideBlind Zone Alert (SBZA) onpage 9‑49.

Turn Signal Indicator

The vehicle may also have a turnsignal indicator on the mirror. Anarrow on the mirror flashes in thedirection of the turn or lane change.

Folding Mirrors

Power Folding

1. Press (A) to fold the mirrors outto the driving position.

2. Press (B) to fold the mirrors in tothe folded position.

Page 52: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (18,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-18 Keys, Doors, and Windows

Resetting the Power FoldingMirrors

Reset the power folding mirrors if:. The mirrors are accidentally

obstructed while folding.. They are accidentally manually

folded/unfolded.. The mirrors will not stay in the

unfolded position.. The mirrors vibrate at normal

driving speeds.

Fold and unfold the mirrors one timeusing the mirror controls to resetthem to their normal position.A popping noise may be heardduring the resetting of the powerfolding mirrors. This sound is normalafter a manual folding operation.

Manual Folding

Fold the mirrors inward to preventdamage when going through anautomatic car wash. To fold, pull themirror toward the vehicle. Push themirror outward, to return to itsoriginal position.

Heated MirrorsFor vehicles with heated mirrors:

1 (Rear Window Defogger):Press to heat the mirrors.

See “Rear Window Defogger” underDual Automatic Climate ControlSystem on page 8‑3 or ClimateControl Systems on page 8‑1 formore information.

Automatic DimmingMirrorIf the vehicle has the automaticdimming mirror, the driver outsidemirror automatically adjusts for theglare of the headlamps from behind.This feature is controlled by the onand off setting on the insiderearview mirror. See AutomaticDimming Rearview Mirror onpage 2‑19.

Park Tilt MirrorsIf the vehicle has the memorypackage, the exterior mirrors tilt to apreselected position when thevehicle is in R (Reverse). Thisfeature lets the driver view the curbwhen parallel parking. The mirrorsreturn to the original position whenthe vehicle is shifted out ofR (Reverse), or the ignition is turnedoff or to OFF/LOCK.

This feature can be programedthrough the Driver InformationCenter (DIC). See VehiclePersonalization (With DIC Buttons)on page 5‑44 for more information.

Page 53: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (19,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-19

Interior Mirrors

Manual Rearview MirrorTo adjust the inside rearview mirror,hold the rearview mirror in thecenter and move it to view the areabehind the vehicle.

For vehicles with a manual rearviewmirror, push the tab forward fordaytime use and pull it rearward fornighttime use to avoid glare fromthe headlamps from behind.

Vehicles with OnStar® have threecontrol buttons at the bottom of themirror. See a dealer for moreinformation about OnStar and howto subscribe to it. See OnStarOverview on page 14‑1.

Automatic DimmingRearview MirrorAdjustment

Hold the rearview mirror in thecenter and move it to view the areabehind the vehicle.

Operation

For vehicles with an automaticdimming rearview mirror, the mirrorwill automatically reduce the glare ofthe headlamps from behind. Thedimming feature comes on eachtime the vehicle is started.

O (On/Off): Press to turn thedimming feature on or off.

The vehicle may also have a RearVision Camera (RVC). See RearVision Camera (RVC) on page 9‑52

If the vehicle has a RVC, the Obutton for turning the dimmingfeature on or off will not beavailable.

Vehicles with OnStar have threeadditional control buttons located atthe bottom of the mirror. See adealer for more information aboutOnStar and how to subscribe to it.See OnStar Overview on page 14‑1.

Cleaning the Mirror

Do not spray glass cleaner directlyon the mirror. Use a soft toweldampened with water.

Page 54: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (20,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-20 Keys, Doors, and Windows

Windows

{ WARNING

Never leave a child, a helplessadult, or a pet alone in a vehicle,especially with the windowsclosed in warm or hot weather.They can be overcome by theextreme heat and sufferpermanent injuries or even deathfrom heat stroke.

The vehicle aerodynamics aredesigned to improve fuel economyperformance. This may result in apulsing sound when either rearwindow is down and the frontwindows are up. To reduce thesound, open either a front windowor the sunroof, if equipped.

Power Windows

{ WARNING

Children could be seriouslyinjured or killed if caught in thepath of a closing window. Neverleave keys in a vehicle withchildren. When there are childrenin the rear seat, use the windowlockout button to preventoperation of the windows. SeeKeys on page 2‑1.

Power Folding Mirrors Shown,Other Models Similar

The driver door has switches thatcontrol all windows. Eachpassenger door switch only controlsthat window. The power windowswork when the ignition is in ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY, or inRetained Accessory Power (RAP).See Retained Accessory Power(RAP) on page 9‑24 for moreinformation.

Press the switch to lower thewindow. Pull the switch up toraise it.

Page 55: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (21,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Keys, Doors, and Windows 2-21

Express Down Windows

Windows that have theexpress-down feature allow thewindows to be lowered withoutholding the switch. Press thewindow switch fully and release it toactivate the express-down feature.The express mode can be canceledat any time by briefly pressing,or pulling the switch.

Window Lockout

Power Folding Mirrors Shown,Other Models Similar

This feature prevents the rearpassenger windows from operating,except from the driver position.

. Presso to activate the rearwindow locks. An indicator lightwill illuminate when the featureis on.

. Presso again to deactivate therear window locks.

Sun Visors

Pull the sun visor down to blockglare. Detach the sun visor from thecenter mount to pivot to the sidewindow, or to extend along the rod,if available.

Page 56: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (22,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

2-22 Keys, Doors, and Windows

Roof

Sunroof

A. Open or Close

B. Vent

On vehicles with a sunroof, thesunroof only operates when theignition is in ACC/ACCESSORY orON/RUN, or when RetainedAccessory Power (RAP) is active.See Retained Accessory Power(RAP) on page 9‑24.

Vent: From the closed position,press the rear of switch (B) to ventthe sunroof.

Open/Close: To open the sunroof,press and hold switch (A) until thesunroof reaches the desiredposition. Press and hold the front ofswitch (A) to close it.

Express-Open/Express-Close: Toexpress-open the sunroof, fullypress and release the rear ofswitch (A) until the sunroof reachesthe desired position. Toexpress-close the sunroof, fullypress and release the front ofswitch (A). Press the switch again tostop it.

When the sunroof is opened, an airdeflector will automatically raise.The air deflector will retract whenthe sunroof is closed.

The sunroof also has a sunshadewhich can be pulled forward to blocksun rays. The sunshade must beopened and closed manually.

If an object is in the path of thesunroof while it is closing, theanti-pinch feature will detect theobject and stop the sunroof.

Dirt and debris may collect on thesunroof seal or in the track. Thiscould cause an issue with sunroofoperation or noise. It could also plugthe water drainage system.Periodically open the sunroof andremove any obstacles or loosedebris. Wipe the sunroof seal androof sealing area using a cleancloth, mild soap, and water. Do notremove grease from the sunroof.

Page 57: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-1

Seats andRestraints

Head RestraintsHead Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2

Front SeatsSeat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3Power Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . 3-3Lumbar Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . 3-4Memory Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6Heated and Ventilated FrontSeats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8

Rear SeatsHeated Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9Second Row Seats . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9Third Row Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13

Safety BeltsSafety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16How to Wear Safety BeltsProperly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18

Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19Safety Belt Use DuringPregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24

Lap Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24Safety Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . 3-25Safety System Check . . . . . . . . 3-25Safety Belt Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25Replacing Safety Belt SystemParts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . 3-26

Airbag SystemAirbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . 3-28When Should an AirbagInflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30

What Makes an AirbagInflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32

How Does an AirbagRestrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32

What Will You See after anAirbag Inflates? . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33

Passenger SensingSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34

Servicing the Airbag-EquippedVehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38

Adding Equipment to theAirbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . 3-38

Airbag System Check . . . . . . . . 3-40Replacing Airbag SystemParts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . 3-40

Child RestraintsOlder Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41Infants and YoungChildren . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43

Child Restraint Systems . . . . . 3-45Where to Put the Restraint . . . 3-47Lower Anchors and Tethersfor Children (LATCHSystem) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-48

Replacing LATCH SystemParts After a Crash . . . . . . . . . 3-55

Securing Child Restraints(Center Front SeatPosition) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-55

Securing Child Restraints(Right Front SeatPosition) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56

Securing Child Restraints(Rear Seat Position) . . . . . . . . 3-58

Page 58: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-2 Seats and Restraints

Head Restraints

{ WARNING

With head restraints that are notinstalled and adjusted properly,there is a greater chance thatoccupants will suffer a neck/spinal injury in a crash. Do notdrive until the head restraints forall occupants are installed andadjusted properly.

Adjust the head restraint so that thetop of the restraint is at the sameheight as the top of the occupant'shead. This position reduces thechance of a neck injury in a crash.

Front Seats

The front seats have adjustablehead restraints in the outboardseating positions.

The height of the head restraint canbe adjusted. Pull the head restraintup to raise it. Try to move the headrestraint to make sure that it islocked in place.

To lower the head restraint, pressthe button, located on the top of theseatback, and push the headrestraint down. Try to move thehead restraint after the button isreleased to make sure that it islocked in place.

The front seat outboard headrestraints are not designed to beremoved.

Rear Seats

The vehicle's second-row seatshave head restraints in the outboardseating positions that cannot beadjusted.

The vehicle's third-row seats,if equipped, have adjustableheadrests in the outboard seatingpositions.

The height of the headrest can beadjusted. Pull the headrest up toraise it. To lower the headrest, pushdown on the headrest.

Rear seat head restraints andheadrests are not designed to beremoved.

Page 59: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-3

Front Seats

Seat Adjustment

{ WARNING

You can lose control of thevehicle if you try to adjust a driverseat while the vehicle is moving.Adjust the driver seat only whenthe vehicle is not moving.

To adjust the seat:

1. Lift the bar under the front edgeof the seat cushion to unlockthe seat.

2. Slide the seat to the desiredposition and release the bar.

3. Try to move the seat back andforth to be sure the seat islocked in place.

Center SeatIf equipped, the center frontseatback doubles as an armrest andcupholder/storage area for the driverand passenger when the centerfront seat is not used. Do not use itas a seating position when theseatback is folded down.

Power Seat Adjustment

To adjust a power seat, if equipped:. Move the seat forward or

rearward by sliding the controlforward or rearward.

. If available, raise or lower thefront or rear part of the seatcushion by moving the front orrear of the control up or down.

. If available, raise or lower theentire seat by moving the entirecontrol up or down.

Page 60: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-4 Seats and Restraints

To adjust the seatback, see “PowerReclining Seatbacks” underReclining Seatbacks on page 3‑4.

Lumbar Adjustment

Manual Lumbar

If equipped, increase or decreasemanual lumbar support by turningthe knob forward or rearward.

Power Lumbar

To adjust the power lumbar support,if equipped:. On vehicles with two-way

lumbar, press and hold the topor bottom of the control toincrease or decrease lumbarsupport.

. On vehicles with four-waylumbar, press and hold the frontor rear of the control to increaseor decrease lumbar support. To

raise or lower the height of thesupport, press and hold the topor bottom of the control.

Reclining Seatbacks

{ WARNING

Sitting in a reclined position whenthe vehicle is in motion can bedangerous. Even when buckledup, the safety belts cannot dotheir job.

The shoulder belt will not beagainst your body. Instead, it willbe in front of you. In a crash, youcould go into it, receiving neck orother injuries.

The lap belt could go up overyour abdomen. The belt forceswould be there, not at your pelvicbones. This could cause seriousinternal injuries.

(Continued)

Page 61: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-5

WARNING (Continued)

For proper protection when thevehicle is in motion, have theseatback upright. Then sit wellback in the seat and wear thesafety belt properly.

Do not have a seatback reclined ifthe vehicle is moving.

Manual Reclining Seatbacks

{ WARNING

If either seatback is not locked, itcould move forward in a suddenstop or crash. That could causeinjury to the person sitting there.Always push and pull on theseatbacks to be sure they arelocked.

To adjust a manual seatback:

1. Lift the lever.

The seatback will automaticallyfold forward.

2. To recline, move the seatbackrearward to the desired position,then release the lever to lock theseatback in place.

3. Push and pull on the seatback tomake sure it is locked.

To return the seatback to the uprightposition:

1. Lift the lever fully withoutapplying pressure to theseatback, and the seatback willreturn to the upright position.

2. Push and pull on the seatback tomake sure it is locked.

Page 62: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-6 Seats and Restraints

Power Reclining Seatbacks

To recline a power seatback,if equipped:. Tilt the top of the control

rearward to recline.. Tilt the top of the control forward

to raise.

Memory Seats

If available, the controls on thedriver door are used to program andrecall memory settings for the driverseat, outside mirrors, and theadjustable throttle and brake pedals,if equipped.

Storing Memory Positions

To save into memory:

1. Adjust the driver seat, seatbackrecliner, both outside mirrors,and the throttle and brakepedals, if equipped.

See Power Mirrors on page 2‑16and Adjustable Throttle andBrake Pedal on page 9‑20.

Not all mirrors and adjustablethrottle and brake pedals willhave the ability to save andrecall their positions.

2. Press and hold “1” untiltwo beeps sound.

3. Repeat for a second driverposition using “2.”

To recall, press and release “1” or“2.” The vehicle must be in P (Park).A single beep will sound. The seat,outside mirrors, and adjustablethrottle and brake pedals will moveto the position previously stored forthe identified driver.

Page 63: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-7

Memory Remote Recall

The memory feature can recall thedriver seat, outside mirrors, andpedals, if equipped, to storedpositions when entering the vehicle.

To activate, unlock the driver doorwith the Remote KeylessEntry (RKE) transmitter. The driverseat, outside mirrors, and adjustablepedals, if equipped, will move to thememory position associated with thetransmitter used to unlock thevehicle.

This feature can be turned on or offusing the vehicle personalizationmenu. See Vehicle Personalization(With DIC Buttons) on page 5‑44.

To stop recall movement, press oneof the power seat controls, memorybuttons, or power mirror buttons,or the adjustable pedal switch.

If something has blocked the driverseat and/or the adjustable pedalswhile recalling a memory position,the recall may stop. Remove theobstruction; then press and hold theappropriate manual control for thememory item that is not recalling fortwo seconds. Try recalling thememory position again by pressingthe appropriate memory button.If the memory position is still notrecalling, see your dealer forservice.

Easy Exit Driver Seat

This feature can move the seatrearward to allow extra room to exitthe vehicle.

B (Easy Exit Driver Seat): Pressto recall the easy exit seat position.The vehicle must be in P (Park).

If the easy exit seat feature isprogrammed on in the vehiclepersonalization menu, automaticseat movement occurs when theignition key is removed.

A single beep sounds. The driverseat moves back approximately8 cm (3 in). To move the seat backfarther, pressB again until theseat is all the way back.

If something has blocked the driverseat while recalling the exit position,the recall may stop. Remove theobstruction; then press and hold thepower seat control rearward fortwo seconds. Try recalling the exitposition again. If the exit position isstill not recalling, see your dealer forservice.

See Vehicle Personalization (WithDIC Buttons) on page 5‑44.

Page 64: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-8 Seats and Restraints

Heated and VentilatedFront Seats

{ WARNING

If you cannot feel temperaturechange or pain to the skin, theseat heater may cause burns. Toreduce the risk of burns, peoplewith such a condition should usecare when using the seat heater,especially for long periods oftime. Do not place anything onthe seat that insulates againstheat, such as a blanket, cushion,cover, or similar item. This maycause the seat heater tooverheat. An overheated seatheater may cause a burn or maydamage the seat.

Heated and Cooled Seat ButtonsShown, Heated Seat Buttons

Similar

If available, the buttons are on thefront doors. To operate, the ignitionmust be in ON/RUN.

H (Cooled Seat): If available,press to cool the seat.

I (Heated Seatback): Press toheat the seatback only.

J (Heated Seat and Seatback):Press to heat the seat andseatback.

Press the button once for thehighest setting. With each press ofthe button, the seat will change tothe next lower setting, and then tothe off setting. The lights indicatethree for the highest setting and onefor the lowest.

The passenger seat may takelonger to heat up.

On vehicles with heated seats, theheated seats are canceled10 seconds after the ignition isturned off.

On vehicles with heated and cooledseats, the heated and cooled seatsare canceled when the ignition isturned off.

To use this feature after restartingthe vehicle, press the desired buttonagain.

Page 65: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-9

Remote Start Heated Seats

When it is cold outside, the heatedseats may turn on automaticallyduring a remote vehicle start. Theheated seats will be canceled whenthe ignition is turned on. Press thedesired button to use the heatedseats after the vehicle is started.

The lights on the heated seatbuttons do not turn on during aremote start.

The temperature performance of anunoccupied seat may be reduced.This is normal.

See Remote Vehicle Start onpage 2‑5.

Rear Seats

Heated Rear Seats

{ WARNING

If you cannot feel temperaturechange or pain to the skin, theseat heater may cause burns.See the Warning under Heatedand Ventilated Front Seats onpage 3‑8.

If available, the buttons are on theRear Seat Audio (RSA) panel on therear of the center console.

Press M or L to heat the leftoutboard or right outboard seatcushion. An indicator on the RSAdisplay appears when this featureis on.

Press the button once for thehighest setting. With each press ofthe button, the heated seat changesto the next lower setting, and thenthe off setting. Indicator bars next tothe symbol show the setting: threefor high, two for medium, and onefor low.

The heated seats are canceledwhen the ignition is turned off.

Second Row SeatsThe second row seats can be foldedfor additional cargo space or foldedand tumbled for easy entry and exitto the third row seat, if equipped.The seat has either the manual fold

Page 66: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-10 Seats and Restraints

and tumble feature or the automaticseat release fold and tumblefeature.

Reclining Seatbacks (BucketSeats Only)

On vehicles with second row bucketseats, the seatbacks can bereclined.

To recline the seatback:

1. Lift the lever on the outboardside of the seat.

2. Move the seatback to thedesired position, and thenrelease the lever to lock theseatback in place.

3. Push and pull on the seatback tomake sure it is locked.

To return the seatback to the uprightposition:

1. Lift the lever fully withoutapplying pressure to theseatback, and the seatback willreturn to the upright position.

{ WARNING

If either seatback is not locked, itcould move forward in a suddenstop or crash. That could causeinjury to the person sitting there.Always push and pull on theseatbacks to be sure they arelocked.

2. Push and pull on the seatback tomake sure it is locked.

Manual Fold and TumbleFeature

Folding and Tumbling the Seat

To fold and tumble the seat:

1. Make sure that there is nothingunder, in front of, or on the seat.

Notice: Folding a rear seat withthe safety belts still fastened maycause damage to the seat or thesafety belts. Always unbuckle thesafety belts and return them totheir normal stowed positionbefore folding a rear seat.

Page 67: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-11

2. Lift the lever, on the outboardside of the seat, to release theseatback.

The seatback will fold forward tocreate a flat load floor.

If the seatback cannot fold flat,try moving the front seat forwardand/or put the front seatback inthe upright position.

3. Lift the lever again to release therear of the seat from the floor.The seat will tumble forward.

Folding and Tumbling the Seatfrom the Third Row Seat

{ WARNING

Using the third row seatingposition while the second row isfolded, or folded and tumbled,could cause injury in a suddenstop or crash. Be sure to return

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

the seat to the passenger seatingposition. Push and pull on theseat to make sure it is locked intoplace.

To fold and tumble the seat from thethird row seat, if equipped:

1. Make sure that there is nothingunder, in front of, or on the seat.

Notice: Folding a rear seat withthe safety belts still fastened maycause damage to the seat or thesafety belts. Always unbuckle thesafety belts and return them totheir normal stowed positionbefore folding a rear seat.

Page 68: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-12 Seats and Restraints

60/40 Split-Bench Seat Shown,Bucket Seat Similar

2. Lift the lever, on the bottom rearof the second row seat on theinboard side, to release theseatback. The seatback will foldforward.

3. Lift the same lever again torelease the rear of the seat fromthe floor. The seat will tumbleforward.

Automatic Fold and TumbleFeature

The transmission must be inP (Park) for this feature to work.

{ WARNING

Automatically folding andtumbling the seat when someoneis sitting in the seat, could causeinjury to the person sitting there.Always make sure there is no onesitting in the seat before pressingthe automatic seat release button.

Folding and Tumbling the SecondRow Seat from the Third Row Seator Outside the Vehicle

{ WARNING

Using the third row seatingposition while the second row isfolded, or folded and tumbled,could cause injury in a sudden

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

stop or crash. Be sure to returnthe seat to the passenger seatingposition. Push and pull on theseat to make sure it is locked intoplace.

To fold and tumble the seat from thethird row seat, if equipped:

1. Make sure that there is nothingunder, in front of, or on the seat.

Notice: Folding a rear seat withthe safety belts still fastened maycause damage to the seat or thesafety belts. Always unbuckle thesafety belts and return them totheir normal stowed positionbefore folding a rear seat.

Page 69: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-13

Driver Side Rear Panel ButtonShown

2. Press the automatic seat releasebutton on the panel behind therear doors.

The seatback automatically foldsflat and the seat tumblesforward. There will be a slightdelay between the folding of theseatback and the tumbling ofthe seat.

Returning the Seat to theSitting Position

To return the seat to the sittingposition from the tumbled position:

1. Pull the seat down until it latchesto the floor. The seatback cannotbe raised if the seat is notlatched to the floor.

{ WARNING

If either seatback is not locked, itcould move forward in a suddenstop or crash. That could causeinjury to the person sitting there.Always push and pull on theseatbacks to be sure they arelocked.

2. Lift the seatback and push itrearward. Push and pull on theseatback to make sure it islocked.

3. For the 60/40 split-bench seat,make sure the safety belt in thecenter seating position is notcaught between the two seatsand is not twisted.

Third Row SeatsIf the vehicle has a third row seat,the seatback can be folded, and theentire seat can be tumbled orremoved from the vehicle.

Folding the Seatback

To fold the seatback:

1. Open the liftgate to access thecontrols for the seat.

2. Remove all items on the seatcushion.

Notice: Folding a rear seat withthe safety belts still fastened maycause damage to the seat or thesafety belts. Always unbuckle thesafety belts and return them totheir normal stowed positionbefore folding a rear seat.

Page 70: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-14 Seats and Restraints

3. Lift the release lever “1,” on thebottom rear of the seatback onthe outboard side of the seat,and the seatback folds forward.

Returning the Seatback to theUpright Position

To return the seatback to the uprightposition:

1. Open the liftgate to access thecontrols for the seat.

2. Raise the seatback to theupright position.

{ WARNING

If either seatback is not locked, itcould move forward in a suddenstop or crash. That could causeinjury to the person sitting there.Always push and pull on theseatbacks to be sure they arelocked.

3. Push and pull on the seatback tomake sure it is locked.

Tumbling the Third Row Seat

To tumble the seat:

1. Open the liftgate to access thecontrols for the seat.

2. Make sure the headrests arecompletely lowered and there isnothing under, in front of, or onthe seat.

3. Fold the seatbacks forwardusing lever “1” and theinstructions listed previouslyunder “Folding the Seatback.”

The seat cannot be unlatchedfrom the floor unless theseatback is folded.

4. Unlatch the seat from the floorby lifting lever “2” next to thecarrying handle on the rear ofthe seat, near the bottom.

5. Lift the rear of the seat up fromthe floor.

6. Tilt the seat fully forward to lockit into place.

7. Push and pull on the seat tomake sure it is locked.

Page 71: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (15,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-15

Put the seat in this position onlywhen necessary for additional cargospace.

Returning the Third Row Seatfrom a Tumbled Position

To return the seat to the normalseating position:

1. Open the liftgate to access thecontrols for the seat.

2. Make sure there is nothing thatcould become trapped underthe seat.

3. Release the seat from thetumbled position by lifting lever“2” next to the carrying handle atthe bottom rear of the seat.

4. Pull the seat down until it latchesto the floor. The seatback cannotbe raised to the upright positionunless the seat is latched to thefloor.

5. Raise the seatback to theupright position.

{ WARNING

If either seatback is not locked, itcould move forward in a suddenstop or crash. That could causeinjury to the person sitting there.Always push and pull on theseatbacks to be sure they arelocked.

6. Push and pull on the seatback tomake sure it is locked.

Removing the Third Row Seat

To remove the seat:

1. Open the liftgate to access thecontrols for the seat.

2. Fold the seatbacks forwardusing lever “1” and theinstructions listed previouslyunder “Folding the Seatback.”The seat cannot be unlatchedfrom the floor unless theseatback is folded.

3. Unlatch the seat from the floorby pulling the handle at the rearof the seat “3 Removal Only”toward the rear of the vehicle.

4. Roll the seat out of the vehicle.There is a track in the floor toguide the seat wheels out of thevehicle.

Page 72: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (16,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-16 Seats and Restraints

Installing the Third Row Seat

To install the seat:

1. Open the liftgate to access therear of the vehicle.

2. Slide the front outboard seatwheels into the track on the floorand roll the seat forward. Thefront latches should lock intoplace. If the latches do not lock,try tilting the rear of the seatupward slightly.

3. Lower the rear of the seat andpush down on the seat toengage the rear floor latches.

{ WARNING

A seat that is not locked intoplace properly can move aroundin a collision or sudden stop.People in the vehicle could beinjured. Be sure to lock the seatinto place properly wheninstalling it.

4. Push and pull on the seat tomake sure it is locked into place.The seatback cannot be raisedto the upright position unless theseat is latched to the floor.

5. Raise the seatback to theupright position.

6. Push and pull on the seatback tomake sure it is locked.

7. Make sure the safety belts arereturned to the original positionover the seatbacks.

Safety BeltsThis section of the manualdescribes how to use safety beltsproperly. It also describes somethings not to do with safety belts.

{ WARNING

Do not let anyone ride where asafety belt cannot be wornproperly. In a crash, if you or yourpassenger(s) are not wearingsafety belts, injuries can be muchworse than if you are wearingsafety belts. You can be seriouslyinjured or killed by hitting thingsinside the vehicle harder or bybeing ejected from the vehicle. Inaddition, anyone who is notbuckled up can strike otherpassengers in the vehicle.

It is extremely dangerous to ridein a cargo area, inside or outsideof a vehicle. In a collision,passengers riding in these areas

(Continued)

Page 73: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (17,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-17

WARNING (Continued)

are more likely to be seriouslyinjured or killed. Do not allowpassengers to ride in any area ofthe vehicle that is not equippedwith seats and safety belts.

Always wear a safety belt, andcheck that all passenger(s) arerestrained properly too.

This vehicle has indicators as areminder to buckle the safety belts.See Safety Belt Reminders onpage 5‑16.

Why Safety Belts Work

When riding in a vehicle, you travelas fast as the vehicle does. If thevehicle stops suddenly, you keepgoing until something stops you.It could be the windshield, theinstrument panel, or the safety belts!

When you wear a safety belt, youand the vehicle slow down together.There is more time to stop becauseyou stop over a longer distance and,when worn properly, your strongestbones take the forces from the

safety belts. That is why wearingsafety belts makes such goodsense.

Questions and Answers AboutSafety Belts

Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicleafter a crash if I am wearing asafety belt?

A: You could be— whether you arewearing a safety belt or not.Your chance of being consciousduring and after a crash, so youcan unbuckle and get out, ismuch greater if you are belted.

Q: If my vehicle has airbags, whyshould I have to wear safetybelts?

A: Airbags are supplementalsystems only; so they work withsafety belts— not instead ofthem. Whether or not an airbagis provided, all occupants stillhave to buckle up to get themost protection.

Page 74: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (18,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-18 Seats and Restraints

Also, in nearly all states and inall Canadian provinces, the lawrequires wearing safety belts.

How to Wear Safety BeltsProperlyThis section is only for people ofadult size.

There are special things to knowabout safety belts and children. Andthere are different rules for smallerchildren and infants. If a child will beriding in the vehicle, see OlderChildren on page 3‑41 or Infantsand Young Children on page 3‑43.Follow those rules for everyone'sprotection.

It is very important for all occupantsto buckle up. Statistics show thatunbelted people are hurt more oftenin crashes than those who arewearing safety belts.

There are important things to knowabout wearing a safety belt properly.

. Sit up straight and always keepyour feet on the floor in frontof you.

. Always use the correct bucklefor your seating position.

. Wear the lap part of the belt lowand snug on the hips, justtouching the thighs. In a crash,this applies force to the strongpelvic bones and you would beless likely to slide under the lapbelt. If you slid under it, the belt

would apply force on yourabdomen. This could causeserious or even fatal injuries.

. Wear the shoulder belt over theshoulder and across the chest.These parts of the body are bestable to take belt restrainingforces. The shoulder belt locks ifthere is a sudden stop or crash.

{ WARNING

You can be seriously injured,or even killed, by not wearingyour safety belt properly.

. Never allow the lap orshoulder belt to becomeloose or twisted.

. Never wear the shoulder beltunder both arms or behindyour back.

. Never route the lap orshoulder belt over anarmrest.

Page 75: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (19,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-19

Lap-Shoulder BeltAll seating positions in the vehiclehave a lap-shoulder belt except forthe center front passenger position,if equipped, which has a lap belt.See Lap Belt on page 3‑24 for moreinformation.

The lap-shoulder belts for the firstand second row seating positionsare equipped with free-falling latchplates. If the vehicle has a third row,the lap-shoulder belts have cinchinglatch plates.

Use the following pictures todetermine the latch plate style:

Free-Falling Latch Plate

Cinching Latch Plate

The following instructions explainhow to wear a lap-shoulder beltproperly.

1. Adjust the seat, if the seat isadjustable, so you can sit upstraight. To see how, see “Seats”in the Index.

Page 76: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (20,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-20 Seats and Restraints

2. Pick up the latch plate and pullthe belt across you. Do not let itget twisted.

The lap-shoulder belt may lock ifyou pull the belt across you veryquickly. If this happens, let thebelt go back slightly to unlock it.Then pull the belt across youmore slowly.

If the shoulder portion of apassenger belt with a free-fallinglatch plate is pulled out all theway, the child restraint lockingfeature may be engaged. If thishappens, let the belt go back allthe way and start again.

Engaging the child restraintlocking feature in the right frontseating position may affect thepassenger sensing system,if equipped. See PassengerSensing System on page 3‑34for more information.

If the belt stops before it reachesthe buckle, for lap-shoulder beltswith cinching latch plates, tilt thelatch plate and keep pulling thesafety belt until it can bebuckled.

3. Push the latch plate into thebuckle until it clicks. If you findthat the latch plate will not gofully into the buckle, see if youare using the correct buckle.

Pull up on the latch plate tomake sure it is secure. If the beltis not long enough, see SafetyBelt Extender on page 3‑25.

Position the release button onthe buckle so that the safety beltcould be quickly unbuckled ifnecessary.

Page 77: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (21,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-21

4. If equipped with a shoulder beltheight adjuster, move it to theheight that is right for you. See“Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster”in this section for instructions onuse and important safetyinformation.

5. To make the lap part tight, pullup on the shoulder belt.

It may be necessary to pullstitching on the safety beltthrough the latch plate to fullytighten the lap belt on smalleroccupants.

To unlatch the belt, push the buttonon the buckle. The belt shouldreturn to its stowed position.

Before a door is closed, be sure thesafety belt is out of the way. If adoor is slammed against a safetybelt, damage can occur to both thebelt and the vehicle.

Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster

The vehicle has a shoulder beltheight adjuster for the driver andright front passenger positions.

Adjust the height so the shoulderportion of the belt is on the shoulderand not falling off of it. The beltshould be close to, but notcontacting, the neck. Impropershoulder belt height adjustmentcould reduce the effectiveness ofthe safety belt in a crash. See Howto Wear Safety Belts Properly onpage 3‑18.

Squeeze the buttons (A) on thesides of the height adjuster andmove the height adjuster to thedesired position.

Page 78: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (22,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-22 Seats and Restraints

The adjuster can be moved up justby pushing up on the shoulder beltguide.

After the adjuster is set to thedesired position, try to move it downwithout squeezing the buttons tomake sure it has locked intoposition.

Safety Belt Pretensioners

This vehicle has safety beltpretensioners for front outboardoccupants. Although the safety beltpretensioners cannot be seen, theyare part of the safety belt assembly.They can help tighten the safetybelts during the early stages of amoderate to severe frontal, nearfrontal, or rear crash if the thresholdconditions for pretensioneractivation are met. And, if thevehicle has side impact airbags,safety belt pretensioners can helptighten the safety belts in a sidecrash or a rollover event.

Pretensioners work only once. If thepretensioners activate in a crash,the pretensioners and probably

other parts of the vehicle's safetybelt system will need to be replaced.See Replacing Safety Belt SystemParts after a Crash on page 3‑26.

Rear Safety Belt ComfortGuides

This vehicle may have rear shoulderbelt comfort guides. If not, they areavailable through your dealer. Theguides may provide added safetybelt comfort for older children whohave outgrown booster seats andfor some adults. When installed andproperly adjusted, the comfort guidepositions the belt away from theneck and head.

There is one guide, if equipped, foreach outside passenger position inthe second row seat.

Here is how to install a comfortguide to the safety belt:

1. Remove the guide from itsstorage clip on the interior body.

Page 79: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (23,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-23

2. Place the guide over the belt,and insert the two edges of thebelt into the slots of the guide.

3. Be sure that the belt is nottwisted and it lies flat. Theelastic cord must be under thebelt and the guide on top.

{ WARNING

A safety belt that is not properlyworn may not provide theprotection needed in a crash. Theperson wearing the belt could beseriously injured. The shoulderbelt should go over the shoulder

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

and across the chest. These partsof the body are best able to takebelt restraining forces.

4. Buckle, position, and release thesafety belt as describedpreviously in this section. Makesure the shoulder portion of thebelt is on the shoulder and notfalling off of it. The belt shouldbe close to, but not contacting,the neck.

Page 80: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (24,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-24 Seats and Restraints

To remove and store the comfortguide, squeeze the belt edgestogether so that the safety belt canbe removed from the guide. Slidethe guide onto its storage clip on theinterior body.

Safety Belt Use DuringPregnancySafety belts work for everyone,including pregnant women. Like alloccupants, they are more likely tobe seriously injured if they do notwear safety belts.

A pregnant woman should wear alap-shoulder belt, and the lapportion should be worn as low aspossible, below the rounding,throughout the pregnancy.

The best way to protect the fetus isto protect the mother. When a safetybelt is worn properly, it is more likelythat the fetus will not be hurt in acrash. For pregnant women, as foranyone, the key to making safetybelts effective is wearing themproperly.

Lap BeltThis part is only for the lap belt. Tolearn how to wear a lap-shoulderbelt, see Lap-Shoulder Belt onpage 3‑19.

The vehicle may have a centerseating position. When you sit in thecenter front seating position, youhave a lap safety belt, which has noretractor.

To make the belt longer, tilt the latchplate and pull it along the belt.

Buckle, position and release it thesame way as the lap part of alap-shoulder belt.

Page 81: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (25,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-25

To make the belt shorter, pull its freeend as shown until the belt is snug.

If the belt is not long enough, seeSafety Belt Extender on page 3‑25.

Make sure the release button on thebuckle is positioned so you wouldbe able to unbuckle the safety beltquickly if necessary.

If you find that the latch plate willnot go fully into the buckle, see ifyou are using the correct buckle. Besure that the latch plate clicks wheninserted into the buckle.

Safety Belt ExtenderIf the vehicle's safety belt will fastenaround you, you should use it.

But if a safety belt is not longenough, your dealer will order youan extender. When you go in toorder it, take the heaviest coat youwill wear, so the extender will belong enough for you. To help avoidpersonal injury, do not let someoneelse use it, and use it only for theseat it is made to fit. The extenderhas been designed for adults. Neveruse it for securing child seats. Towear it, attach it to the regular safetybelt. For more information, see theinstruction sheet that comes withthe extender.

Safety System CheckNow and then, check that the safetybelt reminder light, safety belts,buckles, latch plates, retractors, andanchorages are all working properly.Look for any other loose ordamaged safety belt system partsthat might keep a safety belt system

from doing its job. See your dealerto have it repaired. Torn or frayedsafety belts may not protect you in acrash. They can rip apart underimpact forces. If a belt is torn orfrayed, get a new one right away.

Make sure the safety belt reminderlight is working. See Safety BeltReminders on page 5‑16.

Keep safety belts clean and dry.See Safety Belt Care on page 3‑25.

Safety Belt CareKeep belts clean and dry.

{ WARNING

Do not bleach or dye safety belts.It may severely weaken them. Ina crash, they might not be able toprovide adequate protection.Clean safety belts only with mildsoap and lukewarm water.

Page 82: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (26,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-26 Seats and Restraints

Replacing Safety BeltSystem Parts after aCrash

{ WARNING

A crash can damage the safetybelt system in the vehicle.A damaged safety belt systemmay not properly protect theperson using it, resulting inserious injury or even death in acrash. To help make sure thesafety belt systems are workingproperly after a crash, have theminspected and any necessaryreplacements made as soon aspossible.

After a minor crash, replacement ofsafety belts may not be necessary.But the safety belt assemblies thatwere used during any crash mayhave been stressed or damaged.See your dealer to have the safetybelt assemblies inspected orreplaced.

New parts and repairs may benecessary even if the safety beltsystem was not being used at thetime of the crash.

Have the safety belt pretensionerschecked if the vehicle has been in acrash, or if the airbag readiness lightstays on after you start the vehicleor while you are driving. See AirbagReadiness Light on page 5‑16.

Airbag SystemThe vehicle has the followingairbags:. A frontal airbag for the driver.. A frontal airbag for the right front

passenger.. A roof-rail airbag for the driver

and passenger directly behindthe driver.

. A roof-rail airbag for the rightfront passenger and the personseated directly behind thatpassenger.

The vehicle may have the followingairbags:. A seat‐mounted side impact

airbag for the driver.. A seat‐mounted side impact

airbag for the right frontpassenger.

. If the vehicle has a third rowseat, it will have a third rowroof-rail airbag.

Page 83: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (27,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-27

All of the airbags in the vehicle willhave the word AIRBAG embossedin the trim or on an attached labelnear the deployment opening.

For frontal airbags, the wordAIRBAG will appear on the middlepart of the steering wheel for thedriver and on the instrument panelfor the right front passenger.

With seat‐mounted side impactairbags, the word AIRBAG willappear on the side of the seatbackclosest to the door.

With roof-rail airbags, the wordAIRBAG will appear along theheadliner or trim.

Airbags are designed to supplementthe protection provided by safetybelts. Even though today's airbagsare also designed to help reducethe risk of injury from the force of aninflating bag, all airbags must inflatevery quickly to do their job.

Here are the most important thingsto know about the airbag system:

{ WARNING

You can be severely injured orkilled in a crash if you are notwearing your safety belt— even ifyou have airbags. Airbags aredesigned to work with safetybelts, but do not replace them.Also, airbags are not designed todeploy in every crash. In somecrashes safety belts are your onlyrestraint. See When Should anAirbag Inflate? on page 3‑30.

Wearing your safety belt during acrash helps reduce your chanceof hitting things inside the vehicleor being ejected from it. Airbagsare “supplemental restraints” tothe safety belts. Everyone in yourvehicle should wear a safety beltproperly—whether or not there isan airbag for that person.

{ WARNING

Because airbags inflate with greatforce and faster than the blink ofan eye, anyone who is upagainst, or very close to anyairbag when it inflates can beseriously injured or killed. Do notsit unnecessarily close to anyairbag, as you would be if sittingon the edge of the seat or leaningforward. Safety belts help keepyou in position before and duringa crash. Always wear a safetybelt, even with airbags. The drivershould sit as far back as possiblewhile still maintaining control ofthe vehicle.

Occupants should not lean on orsleep against the door or sidewindows in seating positions withseat-mounted side impact airbagsand/or roof-rail airbags.

Page 84: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (28,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-28 Seats and Restraints

{ WARNING

Children who are up against,or very close to, any airbag whenit inflates can be seriously injuredor killed. Airbags pluslap-shoulder belts offer protectionfor adults and older children, butnot for young children and infants.Neither the vehicle safety beltsystem nor its airbag system isdesigned for them. Youngchildren and infants need theprotection that a child restraintsystem can provide. Alwayssecure children properly in thevehicle. To read how, see OlderChildren on page 3‑41 or Infantsand Young Children onpage 3‑43.

There is an airbag readiness lighton the instrument panel cluster,which shows the airbag symbol.

The system checks the airbagelectrical system for malfunctions.The light tells you if there is anelectrical problem. See AirbagReadiness Light on page 5‑16 formore information.

Where Are the Airbags?

The driver frontal airbag is in themiddle of the steering wheel.

Page 85: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (29,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-29

The right front passenger frontalairbag is in the instrument panel onthe passenger's side.

Driver Side Shown, PassengerSide Similar

If the vehicle has seat‐mounted sideimpact airbags for the driver andright front passenger, they are in theside of the seatbacks closest tothe door.

Driver Side Shown, PassengerSide Similar

The roof-rail airbags for the driver,right front passenger, and secondrow outboard passengers are in theceiling above the side windows.

Page 86: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (30,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-30 Seats and Restraints

Driver Side Shown, PassengerSide Similar

If the vehicle has a third rowpassenger seat, the roof-rail airbagsare located in the ceiling above therear windows for the outboardpassenger positions in the third row.

{ WARNING

If something is between anoccupant and an airbag, theairbag might not inflate properlyor it might force the object into

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

that person causing severe injuryor even death. The path of aninflating airbag must be keptclear. Do not put anythingbetween an occupant and anairbag, and do not attach or putanything on the steering wheelhub or on or near any otherairbag covering.

Do not use seat accessories thatblock the inflation path of aseat-mounted side impact airbag.

Never secure anything to the roofof a vehicle with roof-rail airbagsby routing a rope or tie‐downthrough any door or windowopening. If you do, the path of aninflating roof-rail airbag will beblocked.

When Should an AirbagInflate?Frontal airbags are designed toinflate in moderate to severe frontalor near-frontal crashes to helpreduce the potential for severeinjuries mainly to the driver's or rightfront passenger's head and chest.However, they are only designed toinflate if the impact exceeds apredetermined deploymentthreshold. Deployment thresholdsare used to predict how severe acrash is likely to be in time for theairbags to inflate and help restrainthe occupants.

Whether the frontal airbags will orshould deploy is not based on howfast the vehicle is traveling.It depends largely on what you hit,the direction of the impact, and howquickly the vehicle slows down.

Page 87: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (31,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-31

Frontal airbags may inflate atdifferent crash speeds. Forexample:. If the vehicle hits a stationary

object, the airbags could inflateat a different crash speed than ifthe vehicle hits a moving object.

. If the vehicle hits an object thatdeforms, the airbags couldinflate at a different crash speedthan if the vehicle hits an objectdoes not deform.

. If the vehicle hits a narrow object(like a pole), the airbags couldinflate at a different crash speedthan if the vehicle hits a wideobject (like a wall).

. If the vehicle goes into an objectat an angle, the airbags couldinflate at a different crash speedthan if the vehicle goes straightinto the object.

Thresholds can also vary withspecific vehicle design.

Frontal airbags are not intended toinflate during vehicle rollovers, rearimpacts, or in many side impacts.

In addition, the vehicle hasdual-stage frontal airbags.Dual-stage airbags adjust therestraint according to crash severity.The vehicle has electronic frontalsensors, which help the sensingsystem distinguish between amoderate frontal impact and a moresevere frontal impact. For moderatefrontal impacts, dual-stage airbagsinflate at a level less than fulldeployment. For more severe frontalimpacts, full deployment occurs.

Vehicles with dual stage airbagsalso have seat position sensorswhich enable the sensing system tomonitor the position of the driverseat and may or may not monitorthe position of the frontpassenger seat.

The seat position sensor providesinformation that is used to determineif the airbags should deploy at areduced level or at full deployment.

The vehicle may or may not haveseat-mounted side impact airbags.The vehicle has roof-rail airbags.See Airbag System on page 3‑26.Seat-mounted side impact airbagsand roof-rail airbags are intended toinflate in moderate to severe sidecrashes. In addition, these roof-railairbags are intended to inflateduring a rollover or in a severefrontal impact. Seat-mounted sideimpact airbags and roof-rail airbagswill inflate if the crash severity isabove the system's designedthreshold level. The threshold levelcan vary with specific vehicledesign.

Roof-rail airbags are not intended toinflate in rear impacts.A seat-mounted side impact airbagis intended to deploy on the side ofthe vehicle that is struck. Bothroof-rail airbags will deploy wheneither side of the vehicle is struck orif the sensing system predicts thatthe vehicle is about to roll over onits side, or in a severe frontalimpact.

Page 88: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (32,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-32 Seats and Restraints

In any particular crash, no one cansay whether an airbag should haveinflated simply because of thedamage to a vehicle or because ofwhat the repair costs were. Forfrontal airbags, inflation isdetermined by what the vehicle hits,the angle of the impact, and howquickly the vehicle slows down. Forseat-mounted side impact androof-rail airbags, deployment isdetermined by the location andseverity of the side impact. In arollover event, roof-rail airbagdeployment is determined by thedirection of the roll.

What Makes an AirbagInflate?In a deployment event, the sensingsystem sends an electrical signaltriggering a release of gas from theinflator. Gas from the inflator fills theairbag causing the bag to break outof the cover and deploy. The inflator,the airbag, and related hardware areall part of the airbag module.

Frontal airbag modules are locatedinside the steering wheel andinstrument panel. For vehicles withseat‐mounted side impact airbags,there are airbags modules in theside of the front seatbacks closestto the door. For vehicles withroof-rail airbags, there are airbagmodules in the ceiling of the vehicle,near the side windows that haveoccupant seating positions.

How Does an AirbagRestrain?In moderate to severe frontal ornear frontal collisions, even beltedoccupants can contact the steeringwheel or the instrument panel. Inmoderate to severe side collisions,even belted occupants can contactthe inside of the vehicle.

Airbags supplement the protectionprovided by safety belts. Frontalairbags distribute the force of theimpact more evenly over theoccupant's upper body, stopping theoccupant more gradually. Seat‐

mounted side impact and roof-railairbags distribute the force of theimpact more evenly over theoccupant's upper body.

Rollover capable roof-rail airbagsare designed to help contain thehead and chest of occupants in theoutboard seating positions in thefirst, second, and third rows,if equipped with a third row seat.The rollover capable roof-railairbags are designed to help reducethe risk of full or partial ejection inrollover events, although no systemcan prevent all such ejections.

But airbags would not help in manytypes of collisions, primarilybecause the occupant's motion isnot toward those airbags. See WhenShould an Airbag Inflate? onpage 3‑30 for more information.

Airbags should never be regardedas anything more than a supplementto safety belts.

Page 89: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (33,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-33

What Will You See afteran Airbag Inflates?After the frontal airbags andseat-mounted side impact airbagsinflate, they quickly deflate, soquickly that some people may noteven realize an airbag inflated.Roof-rail airbags may still be at leastpartially inflated for some time afterthey deploy. Some components ofthe airbag module may be hot forseveral minutes. For location of theairbag modules, see What Makesan Airbag Inflate? on page 3‑32.

The parts of the airbag that comeinto contact with you may be warm,but not too hot to touch. There maybe some smoke and dust comingfrom the vents in the deflatedairbags. Airbag inflation does notprevent the driver from seeing out ofthe windshield or being able to steerthe vehicle, nor does it preventpeople from leaving the vehicle.

{ WARNING

When an airbag inflates, theremay be dust in the air. This dustcould cause breathing problemsfor people with a history ofasthma or other breathing trouble.To avoid this, everyone in thevehicle should get out as soon asit is safe to do so. If you havebreathing problems but cannotget out of the vehicle after anairbag inflates, then get fresh airby opening a window or a door.If you experience breathingproblems following an airbagdeployment, you should seekmedical attention.

The vehicle may have a feature thatmay automatically unlock the doors,turn on the interior lamps andhazard warning flashers, and shutoff the fuel system after the airbagsinflate. You can lock the doors, turn

off the interior lamps and hazardwarning flashers by using thecontrols for those features.

{ WARNING

A crash severe enough to inflatethe airbags may have alsodamaged important functions inthe vehicle, such as the fuelsystem, brake and steeringsystems, etc. Even if the vehicleappears to be drivable after amoderate crash, there may beconcealed damage that couldmake it difficult to safely operatethe vehicle.

Use caution if you should attemptto restart the engine after a crashhas occurred.

Page 90: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (34,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-34 Seats and Restraints

In many crashes severe enough toinflate the airbag, windshields arebroken by vehicle deformation.Additional windshield breakage mayalso occur from the right frontpassenger airbag.. Airbags are designed to inflate

only once. After an airbaginflates, you will need some newparts for the airbag system.If you do not get them, theairbag system will not be thereto help protect you in anothercrash. A new system will includeairbag modules and possiblyother parts. The service manualfor your vehicle covers the needto replace other parts.

. The vehicle has a crash sensingand diagnostic module whichrecords information after acrash. See Vehicle DataRecording and Privacy onpage 13‑19 and Event DataRecorders on page 13‑19.

. Let only qualified technicianswork on the airbag systems.Improper service can mean thatan airbag system will not workproperly. See your dealer forservice.

Passenger SensingSystemIf the vehicle has the passengerairbag status indicator pictured inthe following illustration, then thevehicle has a passenger sensingsystem for the right front passengerposition. The passenger airbagstatus indicator, if equipped, isvisible on the overhead consolewhen the vehicle is started.

In addition, if the vehicle has apassenger sensing system for theright front passenger position, thelabel on the vehicle's sun visorsrefers to “ADVANCED AIRBAGS”.

United States

Canada and Mexico

The words ON and OFF, or thesymbols for on and off, will bevisible during the system check.If you are using remote start,if equipped, to start the vehicle froma distance, you may not see thesystem check. When the systemcheck is complete, either the wordON or OFF, or the symbol for on oroff, will be visible. See PassengerAirbag Status Indicator onpage 5‑17.

Page 91: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (35,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-35

The passenger sensing system willturn off the right front passengerfrontal airbag under certainconditions. The driver airbag, seat‐mounted side impact airbags (ifequipped) and the roof-rail airbagsare not affected by the passengersensing system.

The passenger sensing systemworks with sensors that are part ofthe right front passenger seat andsafety belt. The sensors aredesigned to detect the presence ofa properly-seated occupant anddetermine if the right frontpassenger frontal airbag should beenabled (may inflate) or not.

According to accident statistics,children are safer when properlysecured in a rear seat in the correctchild restraint for their weightand size.

We recommend that children besecured in a rear seat, including: aninfant or a child riding in arear-facing child restraint; a childriding in a forward-facing child seat;

an older child riding in a boosterseat; and children, who are largeenough, using safety belts.

A label on the sun visor says,“Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front.” This is because the risk tothe rear-facing child is so great,if the airbag deploys.

{ WARNING

A child in a rear-facing childrestraint can be seriously injuredor killed if the right frontpassenger airbag inflates. This isbecause the back of therear-facing child restraint wouldbe very close to the inflatingairbag. A child in a forward-facingchild restraint can be seriouslyinjured or killed if the right frontpassenger airbag inflates and thepassenger seat is in a forwardposition.

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

Even if the passenger sensingsystem has turned off the rightfront passenger frontal airbag, nosystem is fail-safe. No one canguarantee that an airbag will notdeploy under some unusualcircumstance, even though theairbag is turned off.

Secure rear-facing child restraintsin a rear seat, even if the airbagis off. If you secure aforward-facing child restraint inthe right front seat, always movethe front passenger seat as farback as it will go. It is better tosecure the child restraint in arear seat.

The passenger sensing system isdesigned to turn off the right frontpassenger frontal airbag if:. The right front passenger seat is

unoccupied.

Page 92: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (36,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-36 Seats and Restraints

. The system determines an infantis present in a child restraint.

. A right front passenger takeshis/her weight off of the seat fora period of time.

. There is a critical problem withthe airbag system or thepassenger sensing system.

When the passenger sensingsystem has turned off the right frontpassenger frontal airbag, the offindicator will light and stay lit as areminder that the airbag is off. SeePassenger Airbag Status Indicatoron page 5‑17.

The passenger sensing system isdesigned to turn on (may inflate) theright front passenger frontal airbaganytime the system senses that aperson of adult size is sittingproperly in the right frontpassenger seat.

When the passenger sensingsystem has allowed the airbag to beenabled, the on indicator will lightand stay lit as a reminder that theairbag is active.

For some children, includingchildren in child restraints, and forvery small adults, the passengersensing system may or may not turnoff the right front passenger frontalairbag, depending upon theperson's seating posture and bodybuild. Everyone in the vehicle whohas outgrown child restraints shouldwear a safety belt properly —whether or not there is an airbag forthat person.

{ WARNING

If the airbag readiness light evercomes on and stays on, it meansthat something may be wrongwith the airbag system. To helpavoid injury to yourself or others,have the vehicle serviced rightaway. See Airbag ReadinessLight on page 5‑16 for moreinformation, including importantsafety information.

If the On Indicator is Lit for aChild Restraint

If a child restraint has been installedand the on indicator is lit:

1. Turn the vehicle off.

2. Remove the child restraint fromthe vehicle.

3. Remove any additional itemsfrom the seat such as blankets,cushions, seat covers, seatheaters, or seat massagers.

4. Reinstall the child restraintfollowing the directions providedby the child restraintmanufacturer and refer toSecuring Child Restraints (RightFront Seat Position) onpage 3‑56 or Securing ChildRestraints (Center Front SeatPosition) on page 3‑55 orSecuring Child Restraints (RearSeat Position) on page 3‑58.

Page 93: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (37,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-37

5. If, after reinstalling the childrestraint and restarting thevehicle, the on indicator is still lit,turn the vehicle off. Then slightlyrecline the vehicle seatback andadjust the seat cushion,if adjustable, to make sure thatthe vehicle seatback is notpushing the child restraint intothe seat cushion.

Also make sure the childrestraint is not trapped under thevehicle head restraint. If thishappens, adjust the headrestraint. See Head Restraintson page 3‑2.

6. Restart the vehicle.

The passenger sensing systemmay or may not turn off theairbag for a child in a childrestraint depending upon thechild’s seating posture and bodybuild. It is better to secure thechild restraint in a rear seat.

If the Off Indicator is Lit for anAdult-Size Occupant

If a person of adult size is sitting inthe right front passenger seat, butthe off indicator is lit, it could bebecause that person is not sittingproperly in the seat. If this happens,use the following steps to allow thesystem to detect that person andenable the right front passengerfrontal airbag:

1. Turn the vehicle off.

2. Remove any additional materialfrom the seat, such as blankets,cushions, seat covers, seatheaters, or seat massagers.

3. Place the seatback in the fullyupright position.

4. Have the person sit upright inthe seat, centered on the seatcushion, with legs comfortablyextended.

5. Restart the vehicle and have theperson remain in this position fortwo to three minutes after the onindicator is lit.

Additional Factors AffectingSystem Operation

Safety belts help keep thepassenger in position on the seatduring vehicle maneuvers andbraking, which helps the passengersensing system maintain thepassenger airbag status. See“Safety Belts” and “Child Restraints”in the Index for additionalinformation about the importance ofproper restraint use.

Page 94: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (38,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-38 Seats and Restraints

If the shoulder portion of the belt ispulled out all the way, the childrestraint locking feature will beengaged. This may unintentionallycause the passenger sensingsystem to turn the airbag off forsome adult‐size occupants. If thishappens, let the belt go back all theway and start again.

A thick layer of additional material,such as a blanket or cushion,or aftermarket equipment such asseat covers, seat heaters, and seatmassagers, can affect how well thepassenger sensing systemoperates. We recommend that younot use seat covers or otheraftermarket equipment except whenapproved by GM for your specificvehicle. See Adding Equipment tothe Airbag-Equipped Vehicle onpage 3‑38 for more informationabout modifications that can affecthow the system operates.

The on indicator may be lit if anobject, such as a briefcase,handbag, grocery bag, laptop,or other electronic device, is put on

an unoccupied seat. If this is notdesired, remove the object fromthe seat.

{ WARNING

Stowing of articles under thepassenger seat or between thepassenger seat cushion andseatback may interfere with theproper operation of the passengersensing system.

Servicing theAirbag-Equipped VehicleAirbags affect how the vehicleshould be serviced. There are partsof the airbag system in severalplaces around the vehicle. Yourdealer and the service manual haveinformation about servicing thevehicle and the airbag system. Topurchase a service manual, seeService Publications OrderingInformation on page 13‑16.

{ WARNING

For up to 10 seconds after thevehicle is turned off and thebattery is disconnected, an airbagcan still inflate during improperservice. You can be injured if youare close to an airbag when itinflates. Avoid yellow connectors.They are probably part of theairbag system. Be sure to followproper service procedures, andmake sure the person performingwork for you is qualified to do so.

Adding Equipment to theAirbag-Equipped VehicleQ: Is there anything I might add

to or change about the vehiclethat could keep the airbagsfrom working properly?

A: Yes. If you add things thatchange your vehicle's frame,bumper system, height, front endor side sheet metal, they may

Page 95: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (39,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-39

keep the airbag system fromworking properly. Changing ormoving any parts of the frontseats, safety belts, the airbagsensing and diagnostic module,steering wheel, instrumentpanel, roof-rail airbag modules,ceiling headliner or pillar garnishtrim, overhead console, frontsensors, side impact sensors,or airbag wiring can affect theoperation of the airbag system.

In addition, the vehicle may havea passenger sensing system forthe right front passenger'sposition, which includes sensorsthat are part of the passenger'sseat. The passenger sensingsystem may not operate properlyif the original seat trim isreplaced with non-GM covers,upholstery or trim, or with GMcovers, upholstery or trimdesigned for a different vehicle.Any object, such as anaftermarket seat heater or acomfort enhancing pad ordevice, installed under or on top

of the seat fabric, could alsointerfere with the operation ofthe passenger sensing system.This could either prevent properdeployment of the passengerairbag(s) or prevent thepassenger sensing system fromproperly turning off thepassenger airbag(s). SeePassenger Sensing System onpage 3‑34.

If you have any questions aboutthis, you should contactCustomer Assistance before youmodify your vehicle. The phonenumbers and addresses forCustomer Assistance are inStep Two of the CustomerSatisfaction Procedure in thismanual. See CustomerSatisfaction Procedure (U.S. andCanada) on page 13‑2 orCustomer SatisfactionProcedure (Mexico) onpage 13‑4.

If the vehicle has rolloverroof-rail airbags, see DifferentSize Tires and Wheels onpage 10‑58 for additionalimportant information.

Q: What if I added a snow plow?Will it keep the airbags fromworking properly?

A: We have designed our airbagsystems to work properly undera wide range of conditions,including snow plowing withvehicles that have the optionalSnow Plow Prep Package(RPO VYU). But do not changeor defeat the snow plow's“tripping mechanism.” If you do,it can damage your snow plowand your vehicle, and it maycause an airbag inflation.

Page 96: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (40,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-40 Seats and Restraints

Q: Because I have a disability,I have to get my vehiclemodified. How can I find outwhether this will affect myairbag system?

A: If you have questions, callCustomer Assistance. Thephone numbers and addressesfor Customer Assistance are inStep Two of the CustomerSatisfaction Procedure in thismanual. See CustomerSatisfaction Procedure (U.S. andCanada) on page 13‑2 orCustomer SatisfactionProcedure (Mexico) onpage 13‑4.

In addition, your dealer and theservice manual have informationabout the location of the airbagsensors, sensing and diagnosticmodule and airbag wiring.

Airbag System CheckThe airbag system does not needregularly scheduled maintenance orreplacement. Make sure the airbag

readiness light is working. SeeAirbag Readiness Light onpage 5‑16.

Notice: If an airbag covering isdamaged, opened, or broken, theairbag may not work properly. Donot open or break the airbagcoverings. If there are anyopened or broken airbag covers,have the airbag covering and/orairbag module replaced. For thelocation of the airbags, seeWhere Are the Airbags? onpage 3‑28. See your dealer forservice.

Replacing Airbag SystemParts after a Crash

{ WARNING

A crash can damage the airbagsystems in the vehicle.A damaged airbag system maynot work properly and may notprotect you and your

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

passenger(s) in a crash, resultingin serious injury or even death. Tohelp make sure the airbagsystems are working properlyafter a crash, have theminspected and any necessaryreplacements made as soon aspossible.

If an airbag inflates, you will need toreplace airbag system parts. Seeyour dealer for service.

If the airbag readiness light stays onafter the vehicle is started or comeson when you are driving, the airbagsystem may not work properly. Havethe vehicle serviced right away. SeeAirbag Readiness Light onpage 5‑16.

Page 97: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (41,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-41

Child Restraints

Older Children

Older children who have outgrownbooster seats should wear thevehicle safety belts.

The manufacturer instructions thatcome with the booster seat state theweight and height limitations for thatbooster. Use a booster seat with alap-shoulder belt until the childpasses the fit test below:. Sit all the way back on the seat.

Do the knees bend at the seatedge? If yes, continue. If no,return to the booster seat.

. Buckle the lap-shoulder belt.Does the shoulder belt rest onthe shoulder? If yes, continue.If no, try using the rear safetybelt comfort guide. See “RearSafety Belt Comfort Guides”under Lap-Shoulder Belt onpage 3‑19. If the shoulder beltstill does not rest on theshoulder, then return to thebooster seat.

. Does the lap belt fit low andsnug on the hips, touching thethighs? If yes, continue. If no,return to the booster seat.

. Can proper safety belt fit bemaintained for the length of thetrip? If yes, continue. If no,return to the booster seat.

Q: What is the proper way towear safety belts?

A: An older child should wear alap-shoulder belt and get theadditional restraint a shoulderbelt can provide. The shoulderbelt should not cross the face orneck. The lap belt should fitsnugly below the hips, justtouching the top of the thighs.This applies belt force to thechild's pelvic bones in a crash.It should never be worn over theabdomen, which could causesevere or even fatal internalinjuries in a crash.

Also see “Rear Safety Belt ComfortGuides” under Lap-Shoulder Belt onpage 3‑19.

According to accident statistics,children and infants are safer whenproperly restrained in a child

Page 98: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (42,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-42 Seats and Restraints

restraint system or infant restraintsystem secured in a rear seatingposition.

In a crash, children who are notbuckled up can strike other peoplewho are buckled up, or can bethrown out of the vehicle. Olderchildren need to use safety beltsproperly.

{ WARNING

Never allow more than one childto wear the same safety belt. Thesafety belt cannot properly spreadthe impact forces. In a crash, theycan be crushed together andseriously injured. A safety beltmust be used by only one personat a time.

{ WARNING

Never allow a child to wear thesafety belt with the shoulder beltbehind their back. A child can beseriously injured by not wearingthe lap-shoulder belt properly. In acrash, the child would not berestrained by the shoulder belt.The child could move too farforward increasing the chance ofhead and neck injury. The childmight also slide under the lap

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

belt. The belt force would then beapplied right on the abdomen.That could cause serious or fatalinjuries. The shoulder belt shouldgo over the shoulder and acrossthe chest.

Page 99: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (43,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-43

Infants and YoungChildrenEveryone in a vehicle needsprotection! This includes infants andall other children. Neither thedistance traveled nor the age andsize of the traveler changes theneed, for everyone, to use safetyrestraints. In fact, the law in everystate in the United States and inevery Canadian province sayschildren up to some age must berestrained while in a vehicle.

{ WARNING

Children can be seriously injuredor strangled if a shoulder belt iswrapped around their neck andthe safety belt continues totighten. Never leave childrenunattended in a vehicle and neverallow children to play with thesafety belts.

Airbags plus lap-shoulder belts offerprotection for adults and olderchildren, but not for young childrenand infants. Neither the vehicle'ssafety belt system nor its airbagsystem is designed for them. Everytime infants and young children ridein vehicles, they should have theprotection provided by appropriatechild restraints.

Children who are not restrainedproperly can strike other people,or can be thrown out of the vehicle.

{ WARNING

Never hold an infant or a childwhile riding in a vehicle. Due tocrash forces, an infant or a childwill become so heavy it is notpossible to hold it during a crash.For example, in a crash at only40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb)infant will suddenly become a110 kg (240 lb) force on a person's

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

arms. An infant should besecured in an appropriaterestraint.

{ WARNING

Children who are up against,or very close to, any airbag whenit inflates can be seriously injuredor killed. Never put a rear-facing

(Continued)

Page 100: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (44,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-44 Seats and Restraints

WARNING (Continued)

child restraint in the right frontseat. Secure a rear-facing childrestraint in a rear seat. It is alsobetter to secure a forward-facingchild restraint in a rear seat. If youmust secure a forward-facingchild restraint in the right frontseat, always move the frontpassenger seat as far back as itwill go.

Q: What are the different types ofadd-on child restraints?

A: Add-on child restraints, whichare purchased by the vehicleowner, are available in four basictypes. Selection of a particularrestraint should take intoconsideration not only the child'sweight, height, and age but alsowhether or not the restraint willbe compatible with the motorvehicle in which it will be used.

For most basic types of childrestraints, there are manydifferent models available. Whenpurchasing a child restraint, besure it is designed to be used ina motor vehicle. If it is, therestraint will have a label sayingthat it meets federal motorvehicle safety standards.

The restraint manufacturerinstructions that come with therestraint state the weight andheight limitations for a particularchild restraint. In addition, thereare many kinds of restraintsavailable for children withspecial needs.

{ WARNING

To reduce the risk of neck andhead injury during a crash, infantsneed complete support. In acrash, if an infant is in arear-facing child restraint, thecrash forces can be distributedacross the strongest part of aninfant's body, the back andshoulders. Infants should alwaysbe secured in rear-facing childrestraints.

Page 101: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (45,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-45

{ WARNING

A young child's hip bones are stillso small that the vehicle's regularsafety belt may not remain low onthe hip bones, as it should.Instead, it may settle up aroundthe child's abdomen. In a crash,the belt would apply force on abody area that is unprotected byany bony structure. This alonecould cause serious or fatalinjuries. To reduce the risk ofserious or fatal injuries during acrash, young children shouldalways be secured in appropriatechild restraints.

Child Restraint Systems

Rear-Facing Infant Seat

A rear-facing infant seat providesrestraint with the seating surfaceagainst the back of the infant.

The harness system holds the infantin place and, in a crash, acts tokeep the infant positioned in therestraint.

Forward-Facing Child Seat

A forward-facing child seat providesrestraint for the child's body with theharness.

Page 102: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (46,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-46 Seats and Restraints

Booster Seats

A booster seat is a child restraintdesigned to improve the fit of thevehicle's safety belt system.A booster seat can also help a childto see out the window.

Securing an Add-On ChildRestraint in the Vehicle

{ WARNING

A child can be seriously injured orkilled in a crash if the childrestraint is not properly secured inthe vehicle. Secure the childrestraint properly in the vehicleusing the vehicle safety belt orLATCH system, following theinstructions that came with thatchild restraint and the instructionsin this manual.

To help reduce the chance of injury,the child restraint must be securedin the vehicle. Child restraintsystems must be secured in vehicleseats by lap belts or the lap beltportion of a lap-shoulder belt, or bythe LATCH system. See LowerAnchors and Tethers for Children(LATCH System) on page 3‑48.

Children can be endangered in acrash if the child restraint is notproperly secured in the vehicle.

When securing an add-on childrestraint, refer to the instructionsthat come with the restraint whichmay be on the restraint itself or in abooklet, or both, and to this manual.The child restraint instructions areimportant, so if they are notavailable, obtain a replacementcopy from the manufacturer.

Keep in mind that an unsecuredchild restraint can move around in acollision or sudden stop and injurepeople in the vehicle. Be sure toproperly secure any child restraint inthe vehicle— even when no child isin it.

In some areas of the United Statesand Canada, Certified ChildPassenger Safety Technicians(CPSTs) are available to inspectand demonstrate how to correctlyuse and install child restraints. Inthe U.S., refer to the NationalHighway Traffic Safety

Page 103: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (47,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-47

Administration (NHTSA) website tolocate the nearest child safety seatinspection station. For CPSTavailability in Canada, check withTransport Canada or the ProvincialMinistry of Transportation office.

Securing the Child Within theChild Restraint

{ WARNING

A child can be seriously injured orkilled in a crash if the child is notproperly secured in the childrestraint. Secure the childproperly following the instructionsthat came with that child restraint.

Where to Put theRestraintAccording to accident statistics,children and infants are safer whenproperly restrained in a childrestraint system or infant restraintsystem secured in a rear seatingposition.

We recommend that children andchild restraints be secured in a rearseat, including: an infant or a childriding in a rear-facing child restraint;a child riding in a forward-facingchild seat; an older child riding in abooster seat; and children, who arelarge enough, using safety belts.

A label on your sun visor says,“Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front.” This is because the risk tothe rear-facing child is so great,if the airbag deploys.

{ WARNING

A child in a rear-facing childrestraint can be seriously injuredor killed if the right frontpassenger airbag inflates. This isbecause the back of therear-facing child restraint wouldbe very close to the inflatingairbag. A child in a forward-facingchild restraint can be seriouslyinjured or killed if the right front

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

passenger airbag inflates and thepassenger seat is in a forwardposition.

The vehicle may have apassenger sensing system whichis designed to turn off the rightfront passenger frontal airbagunder certain conditions.

Even if the passenger sensingsystem, if equipped, has turnedoff the right front passengerfrontal airbag, no system isfail-safe. No one can guaranteethat an airbag will not deployunder some unusualcircumstance, even though it isturned off.

Secure rear-facing child restraintsin a rear seat, even if the airbagis off. If you secure aforward-facing child restraint inthe right front seat, always move

(Continued)

Page 104: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (48,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-48 Seats and Restraints

WARNING (Continued)

the front passenger seat as farback as it will go. It is better tosecure the child restraint in arear seat.

See Passenger Sensing Systemon page 3‑34 for additionalinformation.

{ WARNING

A child in a child restraint in thecenter front seat can be badlyinjured or killed by the frontalairbags if they inflate. Neversecure a child restraint in thecenter front seat. It is alwaysbetter to secure a child restraint ina rear seat.

Do not use child restraints in thecenter front seat position.

When securing a child restraint in arear seating position, study theinstructions that came with yourchild restraint to make sure it iscompatible with this vehicle.

Child restraints and booster seatsvary considerably in size, and somemay fit in certain seating positionsbetter than others. Always makesure the child restraint is properlysecured.

Depending on where you place thechild restraint and the size of thechild restraint, you may not be ableto access adjacent safety beltassemblies or LATCH anchors foradditional passengers or childrestraints. Adjacent seatingpositions should not be used if thechild restraint prevents access to orinterferes with the routing of thesafety belt.

Wherever a child restraint isinstalled, be sure to secure the childrestraint properly.

Keep in mind that an unsecuredchild restraint can move around in acollision or sudden stop and injurepeople in the vehicle. Be sure toproperly secure any child restraint inyour vehicle— even when no childis in it.

Lower Anchors andTethers for Children(LATCH System)The LATCH system secures a childrestraint during driving or in a crash.LATCH attachments on the childrestraint are used to attach the childrestraint to the anchors in thevehicle. This system is designed tomake installation of a child restrainteasier.

Make sure that a LATCH-compatiblechild restraint is properly installedusing the anchors, or use thevehicle's safety belts to secure therestraint, following the instructionsthat came with that restraint, andalso the instructions in this manual.When installing a child restraint with

Page 105: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (49,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-49

a top tether, you must also useeither the lower anchors or thesafety belts to properly secure thechild restraint. A child restraint mustnever be attached using only the toptether and anchor.

In order to use the LATCH system inyour vehicle, you need a childrestraint that has LATCHattachments. The child restraintmanufacturer will provide you withinstructions on how to use the childrestraint and its attachments. Thefollowing explains how to attach achild restraint with theseattachments in your vehicle.

Not all vehicle seating positions orchild restraints have lower anchorsand attachments or top tetheranchors and attachments.

Lower Anchors

Lower anchors (A) are metal barsbuilt into the vehicle. There are twolower anchors for each LATCHseating position that willaccommodate a child restraint withlower attachments (B).

Top Tether Anchor

A top tether (A, C) anchors the topof the child restraint to the vehicle.A top tether anchor is built into thevehicle. The top tetherattachment (B) on the child restraintconnects to the top tether anchor inthe vehicle in order to reduce theforward movement and rotation ofthe child restraint during driving or ina crash.

Your child restraint may have asingle tether (A) or a dual tether (C).Either will have a singleattachment (B) to secure the toptether to the anchor.

Page 106: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (50,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-50 Seats and Restraints

Some child restraints with toptethers are designed for use with orwithout the top tether beingattached. Others require the toptether always to be attached. InCanada, the law requires thatforward-facing child restraints havea top tether, and that the tether beattached. Be sure to read and followthe instructions for your childrestraint.

Lower Anchor and Top TetherAnchor Locations

Second Row— 60/40

H (Lower Anchor): Seatingpositions with two lower anchors.

I (Top Tether Anchor): Seatingpositions with top tether anchors.

For models with 60/40 second rowseating, the rear right sidepassenger and center seatingpositions have exposed metalanchors in the crease between theseatback and the seat cushion.

Second Row— Bucket

H (Lower Anchor): Seatingpositions with two lower anchors.

I (Top Tether Anchor): Seatingpositions with top tether anchors.

For models with second row bucketseats, both rear seating positionshave exposed metal anchors in thecrease between the seatback andthe seat cushion.

Page 107: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (51,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-51

Third Row Seat

I (Top Tether Anchor): Seatingpositions with top tether anchors.There is one top tether anchor thatcan be used for either the third rowcenter or driver side seating positionbut not both at the same time.

For models with a third row seat,see the information following forinstalling a child restraint with a toptether in the third row. Never installtwo top tethers using the same toptether anchor.

To assist in locating the top tetheranchors, the top tether anchorsymbol appears near the anchors.

Second Row Seat — Bucket

For models with bucket second rowseating, the top tether anchors areat the bottom rear of the seatcushion for each seating position inthe second row. Be sure to use an

anchor on the same side of thevehicle as the seating positionwhere the child restraint will beplaced.

Second Row Seat — 60/40

For models with 60/40 second rowseating, the top tether anchors areat the bottom rear of the seatcushion for each seating position inthe second row. Be sure to use ananchor on the same side of thevehicle as the seating positionwhere the child restraint will beplaced.

Page 108: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (52,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-52 Seats and Restraints

Third Row Seat

For vehicles with a third row seat,there is one top tether anchor at thebottom rear of the seat cushion thatcan be used for either the third rowcenter or driver side seatingposition. Never install two toptethers using the same top tetheranchor.

Do not secure a child restraint in aposition without a top tether anchorif a national or local law requiresthat the top tether be attached, or if

the instructions that come with thechild restraint say that the top tethermust be attached.

According to accident statistics,children and infants are safer whenproperly restrained in a childrestraint system or infant restraintsystem secured in a rear seatingposition. See Where to Put theRestraint on page 3‑47 foradditional information.

Securing a Child RestraintDesigned for the LATCHSystem

{ WARNING

If a LATCH-type child restraint isnot attached to anchors, the childrestraint will not be able to protectthe child correctly. In a crash, thechild could be seriously injured orkilled. Install a LATCH-type childrestraint properly using theanchors, or use the vehicle safety

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

belts to secure the restraint,following the instructions thatcame with the child restraint andthe instructions in this manual.

{ WARNING

Do not attach more than one childrestraint to a single anchor.Attaching more than one childrestraint to a single anchor couldcause the anchor or attachmentto come loose or even breakduring a crash. A child or otherscould be injured. To reduce therisk of serious or fatal injuriesduring a crash, attach only onechild restraint per anchor.

Page 109: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (53,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-53

{ WARNING

Children can be seriously injuredor strangled if a shoulder belt iswrapped around their neck andthe safety belt continues totighten. Buckle any unused safetybelts behind the child restraint sochildren cannot reach them. Pullthe shoulder belt all the way outof the retractor to set the lock,if the vehicle has one, after thechild restraint has been installed.

Notice: Do not let the LATCHattachments rub against thevehicle’s safety belts. This maydamage these parts. If necessary,move buckled safety belts toavoid rubbing the LATCHattachments.

Do not fold the empty rear seatwith a safety belt buckled. Thiscould damage the safety belt orthe seat. Unbuckle and return thesafety belt to its stowed position,before folding the seat.

If you need to secure more than onechild restraint in the rear seat, seeWhere to Put the Restraint onpage 3‑47.

This system is designed to makeinstallation of child restraints easier.When using lower anchors, do notuse the vehicle's safety belts.Instead use the vehicle's anchorsand child restraint attachments tosecure the restraints. Somerestraints also use another vehicleanchor to secure a top tether.

1. Attach and tighten the lowerattachments to the loweranchors. If the child restraintdoes not have lowerattachments or the desiredseating position does not havelower anchors, secure the childrestraint with the top tether andthe safety belts. Refer to yourchild restraint manufacturerinstructions and the instructionsin this manual.

1.1. Find the lower anchors forthe desired seatingposition.

1.2. Put the child restraint onthe seat.

1.3. Attach and tighten the lowerattachments on the childrestraint to the loweranchors.

2. If the child restraint manufacturerrecommends that the top tetherbe attached, attach and tightenthe top tether to the top tetheranchor, if equipped. Refer to thechild restraint instructions andthe following steps:

2.1. Find the top tether anchor.

Page 110: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (54,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-54 Seats and Restraints

2.2. Route, attach, and tightenthe top tether according toyour child restraintinstructions and thefollowing instructions:

. If the position you are usingdoes not have a headrestor head restraint and youare using a single tether,route the tether over theseatback.

. If the position you are usingdoes not have a headrestor head restraint and youare using a dual tether,route the tether over theseatback.

. If the position you are usinghas an adjustable headrestor head restraint and you

are using a single tether,raise the headrest or headrestraint and route thetether under the headrest orhead restraint and inbetween the headrest orhead restraint posts.

. If the position you are usinghas a fixed headrest orhead restraint and you areusing a single tether, routethe tether around theinboard or outboard side ofthe headrest or headrestraint.

Page 111: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (55,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-55

. If the position you are usinghas a fixed or an adjustableheadrest or head restraintand you are using a dualtether, route the tetheraround the headrest orhead restraint.

3. Before placing a child in thechild restraint, make sure it issecurely held in place. To check,grasp the child restraint at theLATCH path and attempt tomove it side to side and backand forth. There should be nomore than 2.5 cm (1 in) ofmovement, for properinstallation.

Replacing LATCH SystemParts After a Crash

{ WARNING

A crash can damage the LATCHsystem in the vehicle. A damagedLATCH system may not properlysecure the child restraint,resulting in serious injury or evendeath in a crash. To help makesure the LATCH system isworking properly after a crash,see your dealer to have thesystem inspected and anynecessary replacements made assoon as possible.

If the vehicle has the LATCH systemand it was being used during acrash, new LATCH system partsmay be needed.

New parts and repairs may benecessary even if the LATCHsystem was not being used at thetime of the crash.

Securing Child Restraints(Center Front SeatPosition)

{ WARNING

A child in a child restraint in thecenter front seat can be badlyinjured or killed by the frontalairbags if they inflate. Neversecure a child restraint in thecenter front seat. It is alwaysbetter to secure a child restraint ina rear seat.

Do not use child restraints in thecenter front seat position.

Page 112: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (56,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-56 Seats and Restraints

Securing Child Restraints(Right Front SeatPosition)This vehicle has airbags. A rearseat is a safer place to secure aforward-facing child restraint. SeeWhere to Put the Restraint onpage 3‑47.

In addition, the vehicle may have apassenger sensing system which isdesigned to turn off the right frontpassenger frontal airbag undercertain conditions. See PassengerSensing System on page 3‑34 andPassenger Airbag Status Indicatoron page 5‑17 for more information,including important safetyinformation.

A label on the sun visor says,“Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front.” This is because the risk tothe rear-facing child is so great if theairbag deploys.

{ WARNING

A child in a rear-facing childrestraint can be seriously injuredor killed if the right frontpassenger airbag inflates. This isbecause the back of therear-facing child restraint wouldbe very close to the inflatingairbag. A child in a forward-facingchild restraint can be seriouslyinjured or killed if the right frontpassenger airbag inflates and thepassenger seat is in a forwardposition.

The vehicle may have apassenger sensing system whichis designed to turn off the rightfront passenger frontal airbagunder certain conditions.

Even if the passenger sensingsystem, if equipped, has turnedoff the right front passengerfrontal airbag, no system is

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

fail-safe. No one can guaranteethat an airbag will not deployunder some unusualcircumstance, even though it isturned off.

Secure rear-facing child restraintsin a rear seat, even if the airbagis off. If you secure aforward-facing child restraint inthe right front seat, always movethe front passenger seat as farback as it will go. It is better tosecure the child restraint in arear seat.

See Passenger Sensing Systemon page 3‑34 for additionalinformation.

If the child restraint has the LATCHsystem, see Lower Anchors andTethers for Children (LATCHSystem) on page 3‑48 for how andwhere to install the child restraintusing LATCH. If a child restraint is

Page 113: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (57,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-57

secured using a safety belt and ituses a top tether, see LowerAnchors and Tethers for Children(LATCH System) on page 3‑48 fortop tether anchor locations.

Do not secure a child seat in aposition without a top tether anchorif a national or local law requiresthat the top tether be anchored, or ifthe instructions that come with thechild restraint say that the top strapmust be anchored.

In Canada, the law requires thatforward-facing child restraints havea top tether, and that the tether beattached.

You will be using the lap-shoulderbelt to secure the child restraint inthis position. Follow the instructionsthat came with the child restraint.

1. Move the seat as far back as itwill go before securing theforward-facing child restraint.

2. Put the child restraint onthe seat.

3. Pick up the latch plate, and runthe lap and shoulder portions ofthe vehicle's safety belt throughor around the restraint. The childrestraint instructions will showyou how.

4. Push the latch plate into thebuckle until it clicks.

Position the release button onthe buckle so that the safety beltcould be quickly unbuckled ifnecessary.

5. Pull the shoulder belt all the wayout of the retractor to set thelock. When the retractor lock isset, the belt can be tightened butnot pulled out of the retractor.

Page 114: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (58,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-58 Seats and Restraints

6. To tighten the belt, push downon the child restraint, pull theshoulder portion of the belt totighten the lap portion of the belt,and feed the shoulder belt backinto the retractor. When installinga forward-facing child restraint, itmay be helpful to use your kneeto push down on the childrestraint as you tighten the belt.

Try to pull the belt out of theretractor to make sure theretractor is locked. If theretractor is not locked, repeatSteps 5 and 6.

7. Before placing a child in thechild restraint, make sure it issecurely held in place. To check,grasp the child restraint at thesafety belt path and attempt tomove it side‐to‐side and back‐and‐forth. When the childrestraint is properly installed,there should be no more than2.5 cm (1 in) of movement.

If the vehicle is equipped with thepassenger sensing system, andwhen the passenger sensing systemhas turned off the right frontpassenger frontal airbag, the offindicator in the passenger airbagstatus indicator should light and staylit when you start the vehicle. SeePassenger Airbag Status Indicatoron page 5‑17.

If a child restraint has been installedand the on indicator is lit, see “If theOn Indicator is Lit for a ChildRestraint” under Passenger SensingSystem on page 3‑34 for moreinformation.

To remove the child restraint,unbuckle the vehicle safety belt andlet it return to the stowed position.

Securing Child Restraints(Rear Seat Position)When securing a child restraint in arear seating position, study theinstructions that came with the childrestraint to make sure it iscompatible with this vehicle.

If the child restraint has the LATCHsystem, see Lower Anchors andTethers for Children (LATCHSystem) on page 3‑48 for how andwhere to install the child restraintusing LATCH. If a child restraint issecured in the vehicle using asafety belt and it uses a top tether,see Lower Anchors and Tethers forChildren (LATCH System) onpage 3‑48 for top tether anchorlocations.

Do not secure a child seat in aposition without a top tether anchorif a national or local law requiresthat the top tether be anchored, or if

Page 115: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (59,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-59

the instructions that come with thechild restraint say that the top strapmust be anchored.

In Canada, the law requires thatforward-facing child restraints havea top tether, and that the tether beattached.

If the child restraint does not havethe LATCH system, you will beusing the safety belt to secure thechild restraint in this position. Besure to follow the instructions thatcame with the child restraint. Securethe child in the child restraint whenand as the instructions say.

If more than one child restraintneeds to be installed in the rearseat, be sure to read Where to Putthe Restraint on page 3‑47.

The vehicle's lap-shoulder belts forthe first and second row seatingpositions are equipped withfree-falling latch plates. If thevehicle has a third row, thelap-shoulder belts have cinchinglatch plates.

Use the following pictures todetermine the latch plate style:

Free-Falling Latch Plate

Cinching Latch Plate

1. Put the child restraint onthe seat.

Page 116: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (60,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-60 Seats and Restraints

2. Pick up the latch plate, and runthe lap and shoulder portions ofthe vehicle's safety belt throughor around the restraint. The childrestraint instructions will showyou how.

For third row seating positions,with cinching latch plates, tilt thelatch plate to adjust the belt ifneeded.

3. Push the latch plate into thebuckle until it clicks.

Position the release button onthe buckle so that the safety beltcould be quickly unbuckled ifnecessary.

4. For passenger seating positionswith a lap-shoulder belt and afree-falling latch plate, pull therest of the shoulder belt all theway out of the retractor to setthe lock. When installing a childrestraint using a lap-shoulderbelt and a cinching latch plate,skip Step 4 and proceed toStep 5.

Page 117: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (61,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Seats and Restraints 3-61

5. To tighten the belt, push downon the child restraint, pull theshoulder portion of the belt totighten the lap portion of the beltand feed the shoulder belt backinto the retractor. When installinga forward-facing child restraint, itmay be helpful to use your kneeto push down on the childrestraint as you tighten the belt.

For passenger seating positionswith a lap-shoulder belt and afree-falling latch plate, try to pullthe belt out of the retractor to

make sure the retractor islocked. If the retractor is notlocked, repeat Steps 4 and 5.

6. If the child restraint has a toptether, follow the child restraintmanufacturer's instructionsregarding the use of the toptether. See Lower Anchors andTethers for Children (LATCHSystem) on page 3‑48 for moreinformation.

7. Before placing a child in thechild restraint, make sure it issecurely held in place. To check,grasp the child restraint at thesafety belt path and attempt tomove it side-to-side andback-and-forth. When the childrestraint is properly installed,there should be no more than2.5 cm (1 in) of movement.

To remove the child restraint,unbuckle the vehicle safety belt andlet it return to the stowed position.If the top tether is attached to a toptether anchor, disconnect it.

Page 118: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (62,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

3-62 Seats and Restraints

2 NOTES

Page 119: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Storage 4-1

Storage

Storage CompartmentsGlove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1Armrest Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1Rear Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2Center Console Storage . . . . . . 4-2

Additional Storage FeaturesCargo Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2

Roof Rack SystemRoof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3

StorageCompartments

Glove BoxLift up on the glove box lever toopen it.

CupholdersFor vehicles with cupholders locatedin the front and rear of the floorconsole or in the fold down armrest,adjust the front cupholders bymoving the insert forward orrearward.

Pull downward on the lid to accessthe rear floor console cupholders.

There could also be cupholderslocated in the second and third rowseat armrest areas.

Armrest StorageFor vehicles with a rear seatarmrest, pull the loop at the top ofthe armrest down to access thecupholders.

Page 120: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

4-2 Storage

Rear StorageFor vehicles with a rear storagearea, it is located in the rear cargoarea of the vehicle on thedriver side.

Turn the knobs and pull the storagedoor to access. The door can beremoved.

Center Console StorageFor vehicles with a consolecompartment, it is located betweenthe bucket seats.

Press the button and lift the lid toaccess the console compartment.

A cupholder located in the rear ofthe console, swings down for therear seat passenger to use.

Additional StorageFeatures

Cargo Cover

{ WARNING

An unsecured cargo cover couldstrike people in a sudden stop orturn, or in a crash. Store thecargo cover securely or remove itfrom the vehicle.

To use the cargo cover, if equipped:

1. Pull the cover handle toward therear of the vehicle.

2. Latch the cover posts into theretaining sockets on the cargoarea trim panels.

To return the cover to the retractedposition:

1. Pull up on the cover handle torelease the cover posts from theretaining sockets.

2. Let the cover move forward tothe full retracted position.

To remove the cover from a regularwheelbase model:

1. Let the cover go all the way intothe holder.

2. Then, grasping the driver sidecover end cap, push the coverend cap toward the passengerside of the vehicle.

3. Swing the cover rearward andtake it out of the vehicle.

To put the cover in the vehicle:

1. Make sure the cover slot in theholder faces rearward with theround surface facing down.

2. Then, hold the cover at an angleand place the cover end cap intothe slot in the passenger sidetrim panel.

Page 121: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Storage 4-3

3. Move the other end of the coverforward and hold it next to thedriver side trim panel slot.

4. Press the end caps in, to allowthe cover to fit into the trim slot.

5. Pull lightly on the cover holder tomake sure it is secure.

On extended wheelbase modelsthere are two cover positions.The slots furthest forward allowthe cover to be used if the thirdseat is removed or folded down.The cover can be installed andremoved from either side.

Roof Rack System

{ WARNING

If something is carried on top ofthe vehicle that is longer or widerthan the roof rack— like paneling,plywood, or a mattress— thewind can catch it while the vehicleis being driven. The item beingcarried could be violently torn off,and this could cause a collisionand damage the vehicle. Nevercarry something longer or widerthan the roof rack on top of thevehicle unless using a GMcertified accessory carrier.

For vehicles with a roof rack, therack can be used to load items. Forroof racks that do not havecrossrails included, GMCertifiedcrossrails can be purchased as anaccessory. See your dealer foradditional information.

Notice: Loading cargo on theroof rack that weighs more than91 kg (200 lbs) or hangs over therear or sides of the vehicle maydamage the vehicle. Load cargoso that it rests evenly betweenthe crossrails, making sure tofasten cargo securely.

To prevent damage or loss of cargowhen driving, check to make surecrossrails and cargo are securelyfastened. Loading cargo on the roofrack will make the vehicle’s centerof gravity higher. Avoid high speeds,sudden starts, sharp turns, suddenbraking or abrupt maneuvers,otherwise it may result in loss ofcontrol. If driving for a long distance,on rough roads, or at high speeds,occasionally stop the vehicle tomake sure the cargo remains in itsplace.

Do not exceed the maximum vehiclecapacity when loading the vehicle.For more information on vehiclecapacity and loading, see VehicleLoad Limits on page 9‑15.

Page 122: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

4-4 Storage

. If small heavy objects are placedon the roof, cut a piece of 9 mmor 3/8 inch plywood to fit insidethe crossrails and siderails tospread the load. Tie the plywoodto the siderail supports.

. Tie the load and secure it to thecrossrails or the siderailsupports. Use the crossrails onlyto keep the load from sliding. Tomove a crossrail, lift the releaselever up, on both sides of therail. Then slide the crossrail tothe desired position balancingthe force side to side. Press therelease lever down on bothsides of the rail, down to tightenit. Try to slide the crossrail backand forth slightly to make sure itis tight.

. To carry long items, move thecrossrails as far apart aspossible. Tie the load to thecrossrails and the siderails orsiderail supports. Also tie theload to the bumpers, but do nottie the load so tightly that thecrossrails or siderails aredamaged.

. After moving a crossrail, be sureit is securely locked into thesiderail.

A Center High-Mounted Stoplamp(CHMSL) is located above the rearwindow glass.

Make sure items loaded on the roofof the vehicle do not block ordamage the CHMSL.

Page 123: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-1

Instruments andControls

ControlsSteering Wheel Adjustment . . . 5-2Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . 5-2Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4Windshield Wiper/Washer . . . . . 5-4Rear Window Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5

Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8

Warning Lights, Gauges, andIndicatorsWarning Lights, Gauges, andIndicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10

Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12Engine Oil PressureGauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13

Engine Coolant TemperatureGauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14

Voltmeter Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . 5-16Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . 5-16Passenger Airbag StatusIndicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17

Charging System Light . . . . . . 5-18MalfunctionIndicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19

Brake System WarningLight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21

Antilock Brake System (ABS)Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22

Tow/Haul Mode Light . . . . . . . . 5-22StabiliTrak® OFF Light . . . . . . . 5-23Traction Control System(TCS)/StabiliTrak® Light . . . . 5-23

Tire Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . 5-23Engine Oil Pressure Light . . . . 5-24Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . 5-24Security Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . 5-25Front Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . 5-25Cruise Control Light . . . . . . . . . 5-26

Information DisplaysDriver InformationCenter (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26

Vehicle MessagesVehicle Messages . . . . . . . . . . . 5-34Battery Voltage and ChargingMessages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-35

Brake System Messages . . . . 5-35Door Ajar Messages . . . . . . . . . 5-36Engine Cooling SystemMessages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-36

Engine Oil Messages . . . . . . . . 5-37Engine Power Messages . . . . 5-38Fuel System Messages . . . . . . 5-38Key and Lock Messages . . . . . 5-38Lamp Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-38Object Detection SystemMessages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-39

Ride Control SystemMessages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40

Airbag System Messages . . . . 5-41Security Messages . . . . . . . . . . 5-41Tire Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-41Transmission Messages . . . . . 5-42Vehicle ReminderMessages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-43

Washer Fluid Messages . . . . . 5-44

Vehicle PersonalizationVehicle Personalization (WithDIC Buttons) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-44

Page 124: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-2 Instruments and Controls

Universal Remote SystemUniversal Remote System . . . 5-52Universal Remote SystemProgramming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-52

Universal Remote SystemOperation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-56

Controls

Steering WheelAdjustment

To adjust the steering wheel:

1. Hold the steering wheel and pullthe lever.

2. Move the steering wheel upor down.

3. Release the lever to lock thewheel in place.

Do not adjust the steering wheelwhile driving.

Steering Wheel Controls

If equipped, some audio controlscan be adjusted at the steeringwheel.

w (Next): Press to go to the nextfavorite radio station, track on a CD,or folder on an iPod® or USBdevice.

c /x (Previous/End): Press togo to the previous favorite radiostation, track on a CD, or folder on

Page 125: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-3

an iPod® or USB device. Press toreject an incoming call, or end acurrent call.

Radio

To select preset or favorite radiostations:

Press and releasew orc /x togo to the next or previous radiostation stored as a preset orfavorite.

CD/DVD

To select tracks on a CD/DVD:

Press and releasew orc /x togo to the next or previous track.

Selecting Tracks on an iPod orUSB Device (Vehicles without aNavigation System)

1. Press and holdw orc /xwhile listening to a song until thecontents of the current folderdisplay on the radio display.

2. Press and releasew orc /xto scroll up or down the list, thenpress and holdw , or press ¨ toplay the highlighted track.

Navigating Folders on an iPod orUSB Device (Vehicles without aNavigation System):

1. Press and holdw orc /xwhile listening to a song until thecontents of the current folderdisplay on the radio display.

2. Press and holdc /x to goback to the previous folder list.

3. Press and releasew orc /xto scroll up or down the list.. To select a folder, press

and holdw , or press ¨when the folder ishighlighted.

. To go back further in thefolder list, press and holdc /x.

Navigating an iPod or USB Deviceon the Main Audio Screen(Vehicles with a NavigationSystem)

1. Press and releasew orc /xto select the next or previoustrack within the selectedcategory.

2. Press and holdw orc /x tomove quickly through the tracks.

3. Press and release ¨ to move upone track within the selectedcategory.

Navigating an iPod or USB Deviceon the Music Navigator Screen(Vehicles with a NavigationSystem)

1. Press and releasew orc /xto select the next or previoustrack within the selectedcategory.

2. Press and holdw orc /x tomove quickly through the trackswithin the selected category.

Page 126: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-4 Instruments and Controls

3. Press and release ¨ to move upone track within the selectedcategory.

b / g (Mute/Push to Talk): Pressto silence the vehicle speakers only.Press again to turn the sound on.

For vehicles with Bluetooth orOnStar systems, press and hold forlonger than two seconds to interactwith those systems. See Bluetoothon page 7‑48 and OnStar Overviewon page 14‑1 for more information.

SRCE (Source/VoiceRecognition): Press to switchbetween the radio and CD, and forequipped vehicles, the DVD, frontauxiliary, and rear auxiliary.

For vehicles with the navigationsystem, press and hold this buttonfor longer than one second toinitiate voice recognition. See “VoiceRecognition” in the NavigationSystem manual for moreinformation.

¨ (Seek): Press to go to the nextradio station while in AM, FM,or SiriusXM®.

For vehicles with or without anavigation system:

Press ¨ to go to the next track orchapter while sourced to the CD orDVD slot.

Press ¨ to select a track or a folderwhen navigating folders on an iPodor USB device.

For vehicles with a navigationsystem:

1. Press and hold ¨ until a beep isheard, to place the radio intoSCAN mode. A station will playfor five seconds before movingto the next station.

2. To stop the SCAN function,press ¨ again.

While listening to a CD/DVD, pressand hold ¨ to quickly move forwardthrough the tracks. Release to stopon the desired track.

+ e : Press to increase volume.

− e : Press to decrease volume.

HornTo sound the horn, press the centerpad on the steering wheel.

Windshield Wiper/Washer

The front wiper control is located onthe turn and lane-change lever. Turnthe band with the wiper symbol tocontrol the windshield wipers.

8 (Mist): For a single wipe, turnto8 , then release. For several

wipes, hold the band on8 longer.

9 (Off): Turns the windshieldwipers off.

Page 127: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-5

6 (Adjustable Interval Wipes):Turn the band up for more frequentwipes or down for less frequentwipes.

w (Low Speed): Slow wipes.

1 (High Speed): Fast wipes.

Clear ice and snow from the wiperblades before using them. If frozento the windshield, carefully loosen orthaw them. Damaged wiper bladesshould be replaced. See WiperBlade Replacement on page 10‑29.

Heavy snow or ice can overload thewiper motor. A circuit breaker willstop the motor until it cools down.

Windshield Washer

{ WARNING

In freezing weather, do not usethe washer until the windshield iswarmed. Otherwise the washerfluid can form ice on thewindshield, blocking your vision.

L (Washer Fluid): Push thispaddle to spray washer fluid on thewindshield. The wipers clear thewindow and then either stop orreturn to the preset speed.

Rear Window Wiper/WasherThe rear wiper control is located onthe turn and lane-change lever.

To turn the rear wiper on, slide thelever to a wiper position.

( (Off): Turns the wiper off.

5 (Rear Wiper Delay): Turns onthe rear wiper delay.

Z (Rear Wiper): Turns on the rearwiper.

= (Rear Wiper Wash): Press thisbutton on the end of the lever tospray washer fluid on the rearwindow. The wipers will clear therear window and either stop orreturn to your preset speed. Formore washer cycles, press and holdthe button.

The rear window wiper/washer willnot operate if the liftgate or liftglassis open or ajar. If the liftgate orliftglass is opened while the rearwiper is on, the wiper returns to theparked position and stops.

CompassThe vehicle may have a compass inthe Driver Information Center (DIC).

Compass Zone

The zone is set to zone eight uponleaving the factory. Your dealer willset the correct zone for yourlocation.

Under certain circumstances, suchas during a long-distance,cross-country trip or moving to anew state or province, it will benecessary to compensate forcompass variance by resetting thezone through the DIC if the zone isnot set correctly.

Compass variance is the differencebetween the earth's magnetic northand true geographic north. If the

Page 128: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-6 Instruments and Controls

compass is not set to the zonewhere you live, the compass maygive false readings. The compassmust be set to the variance zone inwhich the vehicle is traveling.

To adjust for compass variance, usethe following procedure:

Compass Variance (Zone)Procedure

1. Do not set the compass zonewhen the vehicle is moving. Onlyset it when the vehicle is inP (Park).

Press the vehicle informationbutton until PRESS V TOCHANGE COMPASS ZONEdisplays. Or, if the vehicle doesnot have DIC buttons, press thetrip odometer reset stem untilCHANGE COMPASS ZONEdisplays.

2. Find the vehicle's currentlocation and variance zonenumber on the map.

Zones 1 through 15 areavailable.

3. Press the set/reset button toscroll through and select theappropriate variance zone.

4. Press the trip/fuel button untilthe vehicle heading, forexample, N for North, isdisplayed in the DIC. Or, if thevehicle does not have DICbuttons, press and hold the tripodometer reset stem for

two seconds to select the nextavailable variance zone. Repeatthis step until the appropriatevariance zone is displayed.

5. If calibration is necessary,calibrate the compass. See“Compass CalibrationProcedure” following.

Compass Calibration

The compass can be manuallycalibrated. Only calibrate thecompass in a magnetically cleanand safe location, such as an openparking lot, where driving thevehicle in circles is not a danger.It is suggested to calibrate awayfrom tall buildings, utility wires,manhole covers, or other industrialstructures, if possible.

If CAL should ever appear in theDIC display, the compass should becalibrated.

If the DIC display does not show aheading, for example, N for North,or the heading does not changeafter making turns, there may be a

Page 129: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-7

strong magnetic field interfering withthe compass. Such interferencemay be caused by a magnetic CB orcell phone antenna mount, amagnetic emergency light, magneticnote pad holder, or any othermagnetic item. Turn off the vehicle,move the magnetic item, then turnon the vehicle and calibrate thecompass.

To calibrate the compass, use thefollowing procedure:

Compass Calibration Procedure

1. Before calibrating the compass,make sure the compass zone isset to the variance zone in whichthe vehicle is located. See“Compass Variance (Zone)Procedure” earlier in thissection.

Do not operate any switchessuch as window, sunroof,climate controls, or seats duringthe calibration procedure.

2. Press the vehicle informationbutton until PRESS V TOCALIBRATE COMPASSdisplays. Or, if the vehicle doesnot have DIC buttons, press thetrip odometer reset stem untilCALIBRATE COMPASSdisplays.

3. Press the set/reset button tostart the compass calibration. Or,if the vehicle does not have DICbuttons, press and hold the tripodometer reset stem fortwo seconds to start thecompass calibration.

4. The DIC will displayCALIBRATING: DRIVE INCIRCLES. Drive the vehicle intight circles at less than 8 km/h(5 mph) to complete thecalibration. The DIC will displayCALIBRATION COMPLETE for afew seconds when thecalibration is complete. The DICdisplay will then return to theprevious menu.

ClockTo set the time and date:

1. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN, thenpress the O button to turn theradio on.

2. Press the H button to displayHR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY (hour,minute, month, day, and year).

3. Press the softkey located underany one of the tabs to changethat setting.

4. To increase the time or date, doone of the following:. Press the softkey below the

selected tab.

. Press the ¨ SEEK button.

. Press the\ FWD button.

. Turn the f knob clockwise.

Page 130: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-8 Instruments and Controls

5. To decrease the time or date, doone of the following:

. Press the © SEEK button.

. Press thes REV button.

. Turn the f knobcounterclockwise.

To change the time default settingfrom 12 hour to 24 hour or to changethe date default setting from month/day/year to day/month/year:

1. Press the H button and then thesoftkey located below theforward arrow tab. 12H, 24H, thedate MM/DD (month and day),and DD/MM/ (day and month)displays.

2. Press the softkey located belowthe desired option.

3. Press the H button again toapply the desired option, or letthe screen time out.

Power OutletsThe accessory power outlets can beused to plug in electrical equipment,such as a cell phone or MP3 player.

There are two under the climatecontrols, one inside the center floorconsole, one on the rear of thecenter floor console and oneaccessory power outlet in the rearcargo area on the passenger side.

Remove the cover to access andreplace when not in use.

The accessory power outlets arepowered, even with the ignition off.Continuing to use accessory poweroutlets while the ignition is in LOCK/OFF may cause the vehicle'sbattery to run down.

{ WARNING

Power is always supplied to theoutlets. Do not leave electricalequipment plugged in when thevehicle is not in use because thevehicle could catch fire and causeinjury or death.

Notice: Leaving electricalequipment plugged in for anextended period of time while thevehicle is off will drain thebattery. Always unplug electricalequipment when not in use anddo not plug in equipment thatexceeds the maximum 20 ampererating.

Certain accessory plugs may not becompatible with the accessorypower outlet and could overloadadapter or vehicle fuses. If aproblem is experienced, see yourdealer.

Page 131: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-9

When adding electrical equipment,be sure to follow the properinstallation instructions included withthe equipment. Do not useequipment exceeding themaximum amperage rating of20 amperes. See Add-On ElectricalEquipment on page 9‑78.

Notice: Hanging heavyequipment from the power outletcan cause damage not coveredby the vehicle warranty. Thepower outlets are designed foraccessory power plugs only, suchas cell phone charge cords.

Power Outlet 110 VoltAlternative Current

The vehicle may have a poweroutlet that can be used to plug inelectrical equipment that uses amaximum limit of 150 watts.

The power outlet is located on therear of the center console.

An indicator light on the outlet turnson to show it is in use. The lightcomes on when the ignition is inON/RUN and equipment requiringless than 150 watts is plugged intothe outlet, and no system fault isdetected.

The indicator light does not come onwhen the ignition is in LOCK/OFF orif the equipment is not fully seatedinto the outlet.

If equipment is connected usingmore than 150 watts or a systemfault is detected, a protection circuitshuts off the power supply and theindicator light turns off. To reset thecircuit, unplug the item and plug itback in or turn the RemoteAccessory Power (RAP) off andthen back on. See RetainedAccessory Power (RAP) onpage 9‑24

The power outlet is not designed forand may not work properly, if thefollowing are plugged in:. Equipment with high initial peak

wattage such as:compressor-driven refrigeratorsand electric power tools.

. Other equipment requiring anextremely stable power supplysuch as:microcomputer-controlledelectric blankets, touch sensorlamps, etc.

Page 132: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-10 Instruments and Controls

Warning Lights,Gauges, andIndicatorsWarning lights and gauges cansignal that something is wrongbefore it becomes serious enoughto cause an expensive repair orreplacement. Paying attention to thewarning lights and gauges couldprevent injury.

Warning lights come on when therecould be a problem with a vehiclefunction. Some warning lights comeon briefly when the engine is startedto indicate they are working.

Gauges can indicate when therecould be a problem with a vehiclefunction. Often gauges and warninglights work together to indicate aproblem with the vehicle.

When one of the warning lightscomes on and stays on whiledriving, or when one of the gaugesshows there may be a problem,check the section that explains whatto do. Follow this manual's advice.Waiting to do repairs can be costlyand even dangerous.

Page 133: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-11

Instrument Cluster

English 6-Speed Shown, Metric and 2500 Series Similar

Page 134: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-12 Instruments and Controls

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

SpeedometerThe speedometer shows thevehicle's speed in either kilometersper hour (km/h) or miles perhour (mph).

OdometerThe odometer shows how far thevehicle has been driven, in eitherkilometers or miles.

Trip OdometerThe trip odometer can show how farthe vehicle has been driven sincethe trip odometer was last setto zero.

Press the reset button, located onthe instrument panel cluster next tothe trip odometer display, to togglebetween the trip odometer and theregular odometer. Holding the reset

button for approximately one secondwhile the trip odometer is displayedresets it.

To display the odometer readingwith the ignition off, press the resetbutton.

TachometerThe tachometer displays the enginespeed in revolutions perminute (rpm).

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Fuel Gauge

Metric

English

Page 135: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-13

The fuel gauge, when the ignition ison, shows how much fuel thevehicle has left in the tank.

An arrow on the fuel gaugeindicates the side of the vehicle thefuel door is on.

The gauge first indicates emptybefore the vehicle is out of fuel, andthe vehicle's fuel tank should befilled soon.

When the fuel tank is low, the FUELLEVEL LOW message appears inthe Driver Information Center (DIC).See Fuel System Messages onpage 5‑38 for more information.

Here are some situations ownersmay experience with the fuel gauge.None of these indicate a problemwith the fuel gauge.. At the gas station, the fuel pump

shuts off before the gaugereads full.

. It takes a little more or less fuelto fill up than the fuel gaugeindicated. For example, thegauge may have indicated thetank was half full, but it actuallytook a little more or less thanhalf the tank's capacity to fillthe tank.

. The gauge goes back to emptywhen the ignition is turned off.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Engine Oil PressureGauge

Metric

Page 136: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-14 Instruments and Controls

English

The oil pressure gauge shows theengine oil pressure in psi (poundsper square inch) when the engine isrunning. Canadian vehicles indicatepressure in kPa (kilopascals).

Oil pressure may vary with enginespeed, outside temperature and oilviscosity, but readings above thelow pressure zone indicate thenormal operating range. When theoil pressure reaches the lowpressure zone, the OIL PRESSURELOW STOP ENGINE messageappears in the Driver Information

Center (DIC). See Engine OilMessages on page 5‑37 and EngineOil on page 10‑6 for moreinformation.

A reading in the low pressure zonemay be caused by a dangerouslylow oil level or some other problemcausing low oil pressure.

Notice: Lack of proper engine oilmaintenance can damage theengine. Driving with the engineoil low can also damage theengine. The repairs would not becovered by the vehicle warranty.Check the oil level as soon aspossible. Add oil if required, butif the oil level is within theoperating range and the oilpressure is still low, have thevehicle serviced. Always followthe maintenance schedule forchanging engine oil.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Engine CoolantTemperature Gauge

Metric

Page 137: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (15,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-15

English

This gauge shows the enginecoolant temperature.

It also provides an indicator of howhard the vehicle is working. During amajority of the operation, the gaugereads 100°C (210°F) or less. If youare pulling a load or going up hills, itis normal for the temperature tofluctuate and approach the 122°C(250°F) mark. If the gauge reachesthe 125°C (260°F) mark, it indicatesthat the cooling system is workingbeyond its capacity.

See Engine Overheating onpage 10‑18.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Voltmeter Gauge

When the engine is not running, butthe ignition is on, this gauge showsthe battery's state of charge inDC volts.

When the engine is running, thegauge shows the condition of thecharging system. The charging

system regulates voltage based onthe state of the battery for improvedfuel economy and battery life. Thegauge may transition from a higherto lower or a lower to higherreading, this is normal. Readingsbetween the low and high warningzones indicate the normal operatingrange. The gauge may also readlow during the fuel economy mode,this is normal.

Readings in the low warning zonemay occur when a large number ofelectrical accessories are operatingin the vehicle and the engine is leftat an idle for an extended period.This condition is normal since thecharging system is not able toprovide full power at engine idle. Asengine speeds are increased, thiscondition should correct itself ashigher engine speeds allow thecharging system to create fullpower. If there is a problem with thebattery charging system, this lightwill come on or the SERVICEBATTERY CHARGING SYSTEMDIC message will display.

Page 138: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (16,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-16 Instruments and Controls

See Battery Voltage and ChargingMessages on page 5‑35 andCharging System Light onpage 5‑18 for more information.

Safety Belt Reminders

Driver Safety Belt ReminderLight

There is a driver safety beltreminder light on the instrumentcluster.

When the vehicle is started, thislight flashes and a chime may comeon to remind the driver to fastentheir safety belt. Then the light stayson solid until the belt is buckled.This cycle may continue severaltimes if the driver remains orbecomes unbuckled while thevehicle is moving.

If the driver safety belt is buckled,neither the chime nor the lightcomes on.

Passenger Safety BeltReminder Light

There is a passenger safety beltreminder light near the passengerairbag status indicator. SeePassenger Sensing System onpage 3‑34.

When the vehicle is started, thislight flashes and a chime may comeon to remind passengers to fastentheir safety belt. Then the light stayson solid until the belt is buckled.This cycle continues several times ifthe passenger remains or becomesunbuckled while the vehicle ismoving.

If the passenger safety belt isbuckled, neither the chime nor thelight comes on.

The front passenger safety beltwarning light and chime may turn onif an object is put on the seat suchas a briefcase, handbag, grocerybag, laptop, or other electronicdevice. To turn off the warning lightand/or chime, remove the objectfrom the seat or buckle thesafety belt.

Airbag Readiness LightThis light shows if there is anelectrical problem with the airbagsystem. The system check includesthe airbag sensor(s), passengersensing system (if equipped), thepretensioners, the airbag modules,the wiring, and the crash sensingand diagnostic module. For moreinformation on the airbag system,see Airbag System on page 3‑26.

Page 139: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (17,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-17

The airbag readiness light comes onfor several seconds when thevehicle is started. If the light doesnot come on then, have it fixedimmediately.

{ WARNING

If the airbag readiness light stayson after the vehicle is started orcomes on while driving, it meansthe airbag system might not beworking properly. The airbags inthe vehicle might not inflate in acrash, or they could even inflatewithout a crash. To help avoidinjury, have the vehicle servicedright away.

If there is a problem with the airbagsystem, a Driver Information Center(DIC) message may also come on.See Airbag System Messages onpage 5‑41.

Passenger Airbag StatusIndicatorIf the vehicle has the airbag statusindicator pictured in the followingillustration, then the vehicle has apassenger sensing system for theright front passenger position. Thepassenger airbag status indicator ison the overhead console. SeePassenger Sensing System onpage 3‑34 for important safetyinformation.

In addition, if the vehicle has apassenger sensing system for theright front passenger position, thelabel on the vehicle's sun visorsrefers to “ADVANCED AIRBAGS.”

United States

Canada and Mexico

When the vehicle is started, thepassenger airbag status indicatorwill light ON and OFF, or thesymbols for on and off, for severalseconds as a system check. If youare using remote start, if equipped,to start the vehicle from a distance,you may not see the system check.

Then, after several more seconds,the status indicator will light eitherON or OFF, or either the on or off

Page 140: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (18,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-18 Instruments and Controls

symbol to let you know the status ofthe right front passenger frontalairbag.

If the word ON or the on symbol islit on the passenger airbag statusindicator, it means that the rightfront passenger frontal airbag isenabled (may inflate).

If the word OFF or the off symbol islit on the airbag status indicator, itmeans that the passenger sensingsystem has turned off the right frontpassenger frontal airbag.

If, after several seconds, both statusindicator lights remain on, or if thereare no lights at all, there may be aproblem with the lights or thepassenger sensing system. Seeyour dealer for service.

{ WARNING

If the airbag readiness light evercomes on and stays on, it meansthat something may be wrong

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

with the airbag system. To helpavoid injury to yourself or others,have the vehicle serviced rightaway. See Airbag ReadinessLight on page 5‑16 for moreinformation, including importantsafety information.

Charging System Light

This light comes on briefly when theignition key is turned to START, butthe engine is not running, as acheck to show it is working.

If it does not, have the vehicleserviced by your dealer.

The light should go out once theengine starts. If it stays on,or comes on while driving, therecould be a problem with thecharging system. A charging systemmessage in the Driver InformationCenter (DIC) can also appear. SeeBattery Voltage and ChargingMessages on page 5‑35 for moreinformation. This light could indicatethat there are problems with agenerator drive belt, or that there isan electrical problem. Have itchecked right away. If the vehiclemust be driven a short distance withthe light on, turn off accessories,such as the radio and airconditioner.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Page 141: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (19,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-19

MalfunctionIndicator LampA computer system called OBD II(On-Board Diagnostics-SecondGeneration) monitors the operationof the vehicle to ensure emissionsare at acceptable levels, helping tomaintain a clean environment. Themalfunction indicator lamp comeson when the vehicle is placed inON/RUN, as a check to show it isworking. If it does not, have thevehicle serviced by your dealer. SeeIgnition Positions on page 9‑20.

If the malfunction indicator lampcomes on while the engine isrunning, this indicates that the OBDII system has detected a problemand diagnosis and service might berequired.

Malfunctions often are indicated bythe system before any problem isapparent. Being aware of the lightcan prevent more serious damageto the vehicle. This system alsoassists the service technician incorrectly diagnosing anymalfunction.

Notice: If the vehicle iscontinually driven with this lighton, the emission controls mightnot work as well, the vehicle fueleconomy might not be as good,and the engine might not run assmoothly. This could lead tocostly repairs that might not becovered by the vehicle warranty.

Notice: Modifications made to theengine, transmission, exhaust,intake, or fuel system of thevehicle or the replacement of theoriginal tires with other thanthose of the same TirePerformance Criteria (TPC) canaffect the vehicle's emissioncontrols and can cause this lightto come on. Modifications tothese systems could lead to

costly repairs not covered by thevehicle warranty. This could alsoresult in a failure to pass arequired Emission Inspection/Maintenance test. SeeAccessories and Modifications onpage 10‑3.

This light comes on during amalfunction in one of two ways:

Light Flashing: A misfire conditionhas been detected. A misfireincreases vehicle emissions andcould damage the emission controlsystem on the vehicle. Diagnosisand service might be required.

To prevent more serious damage tothe vehicle:. Reduce vehicle speed.. Avoid hard accelerations.. Avoid steep uphill grades.. If towing a trailer, reduce the

amount of cargo being hauled assoon as it is possible.

Page 142: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (20,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-20 Instruments and Controls

If the light continues to flash, find asafe place to stop and park thevehicle. Turn the vehicle off, wait atleast 10 seconds, and restart theengine. If the light is still flashing,follow the previous steps and seeyour dealer for service as soon aspossible.

Light On Steady: An emissioncontrol system malfunction hasbeen detected on the vehicle.Diagnosis and service might berequired.

The following may correct anemission control systemmalfunction:. Check that the fuel cap is fully

installed. See Filling the Tank onpage 9‑59. The diagnosticsystem can determine if the fuelcap has been left off orimproperly installed. A loose ormissing fuel cap allows fuel toevaporate into the atmosphere.A few driving trips with the capproperly installed should turn thelight off.

. Check that good quality fuel isused. Poor fuel quality causesthe engine not to run asefficiently as designed and maycause stalling after start-up,stalling when the vehicle ischanged into gear, misfiring,hesitation on acceleration,or stumbling on acceleration.These conditions might go awayonce the engine is warmed up.

If one or more of these conditionsoccurs, change the fuel brand used.It may require at least one full tankof the proper fuel to turn the light off.

See Recommended Fuel onpage 9‑56.

If none of the above have made thelight turn off, your dealer can checkthe vehicle. The dealer has theproper test equipment anddiagnostic tools to fix anymechanical or electrical problemsthat might have developed.

Emissions Inspection andMaintenance Programs

Depending on where you live, yourvehicle may be required toparticipate in an emission controlsystem inspection and maintenanceprogram. For the inspection, theemission system test equipment willlikely connect to the vehicle's DataLink Connector (DLC).

The DLC is under the instrumentpanel to the left of the steeringwheel. See your dealer if assistanceis needed.

The vehicle may not passinspection if:. The malfunction indicator lamp is

on with the engine running, or ifthe light does not come on when

Page 143: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (21,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-21

the ignition is turned to ON/RUNwhile the engine is off. See yourdealer for assistance in verifyingproper operation of themalfunction indicator lamp.

. The OBD II (On-BoardDiagnostics) system determinesthat critical emission controlsystems have not beencompletely diagnosed. Thevehicle would be considered notready for inspection. This canhappen if the 12-volt battery hasrecently been replaced or rundown. The diagnostic system isdesigned to evaluate criticalemission control systems duringnormal driving. This can takeseveral days of routine driving.If this has been done and thevehicle still does not pass theinspection for lack of OBD IIsystem readiness, your dealercan prepare the vehicle forinspection.

Brake System WarningLightWith the ignition on, the brakesystem warning light comes onwhen the parking brake is set. If thevehicle is driven with the parkingbrake engaged, a chime soundswhen the vehicle speed is greaterthan 8 km/h (5 mph).

The vehicle brake system consistsof two hydraulic circuits. If onecircuit is not working, the remainingcircuit can still work to stop thevehicle. For normal brakingperformance, both circuits need tobe working.

If the warning light comes on and achime sounds there could be abrake problem. Have the brakesystem inspected right away.

This light can also come on due tolow brake fluid. See Brake Fluid onpage 10‑23 for more information.

Metric English

This light comes on briefly when theignition key is turned to ON/RUN.If it does not come on then, have itfixed so it is ready to warn if there isa problem.

{ WARNING

The brake system might not beworking properly if the brakesystem warning light is on.Driving with the brake systemwarning light on can lead to acrash. If the light is still on afterthe vehicle has been pulled offthe road and carefully stopped,have the vehicle towed forservice.

Page 144: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (22,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-22 Instruments and Controls

If the light comes on while driving,pull off the road and stop carefully.The pedal might be harder to pushor might go closer to the floor. It cantake longer to stop. If the light is stillon, have the vehicle towed forservice. See Towing the Vehicle onpage 10‑82.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Antilock Brake System(ABS) Warning Light

For vehicles with the Antilock BrakeSystem (ABS), this light comes onbriefly when the engine is started.

If it does not, have the vehicleserviced by your dealer. If thesystem is working normally theindicator light then goes off.

If the ABS light stays on, turn theignition off. If the light comes onwhile driving, stop as soon as it issafely possible and turn the ignitionoff. Then start the engine again toreset the system. If the ABS lightstays on, or comes on again whiledriving, the vehicle needs service.If the regular brake system warninglight is not on, the vehicle still hasbrakes, but not antilock brakes.If the regular brake system warninglight is also on, the vehicle does nothave antilock brakes and there is aproblem with the regular brakes.See Brake System Warning Light onpage 5‑21.

For vehicles with a DriverInformation Center (DIC), see BrakeSystem Messages on page 5‑35 forall brake‐related DIC messages.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Tow/Haul Mode Light

For vehicles with the Tow/HaulMode feature, this light comes onwhen the Tow/Haul Mode has beenactivated.

For more information, see Tow/HaulMode on page 9‑32.

Page 145: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (23,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-23

StabiliTrak® OFF Light

This light comes on briefly whilestarting the engine.

If it does not, have the vehicleserviced by your dealer. If thesystem is working normally, theindicator light then goes off.

Press and release the TractionControl System (TCS)/StabiliTrakbutton to turn off TCS, and amessage displays in the DIC.

Press and briefly hold the TCS/StabiliTrak button to turn off theStabiliTrak system; the StabiliTrakOff light comes on and a messageappears in the Driver InformationCenter (DIC).

If the StabiliTrak/TCS system is off,the system does not assist incontrolling the vehicle. Turn on theStabiliTrak/TCS system and theindicator light turns off.

See StabiliTrak® System onpage 9‑42, and Ride Control SystemMessages on page 5‑40 for moreinformation.

Traction Control System(TCS)/StabiliTrak® Light

The TCS/StabiliTrak light comes onbriefly when the engine is started.

If the light does not come on orstays on, have the vehicle servicedby the dealer. If the system isworking normally, the indicator lightturns off.

If the light comes on and stays onwhile driving, and a messagedisplays in the Driver InformationCenter (DIC), have the vehicleserviced by the dealer. See RideControl System Messages onpage 5‑40 for more information.

If the light flashes while driving, thismeans that StabiliTrak or TCS isassisting in controlling the vehicle.See StabiliTrak® System onpage 9‑42 for more information.

Tire Pressure Light

For vehicles with the Tire PressureMonitor System (TPMS), this lightcomes on briefly when the engine isstarted. It provides informationabout tire pressures and the TPMS.

Page 146: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (24,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-24 Instruments and Controls

When the Light Is On Steady

This indicates that one or more ofthe tires are significantlyunderinflated.

A Driver Information Center (DIC)tire pressure message may alsodisplay. See Tire Messages onpage 5‑41. Stop as soon aspossible, and inflate the tires to thepressure value shown on the Tireand Loading Information label. SeeTire Pressure on page 10‑49.

When the Light Flashes First andThen Is On Steady

If the light flashes for about a minuteand then stays on, there may be aproblem with the TPMS. If theproblem is not corrected, the lightwill come on at every ignition cycle.See Tire Pressure MonitorOperation on page 10‑51.

Engine Oil Pressure Light

Notice: Lack of proper engine oilmaintenance can damage theengine. Driving with the engineoil low can also damage theengine. The repairs would not becovered by the vehicle warranty.Check the oil level as soon aspossible. Add oil if required, butif the oil level is within theoperating range and the oilpressure is still low, have thevehicle serviced. Always followthe maintenance schedule forchanging engine oil.

This light comes on briefly whilestarting the engine. If it does not,have the vehicle serviced by yourdealer. If the system is workingnormally the indicator light thengoes off.

If the light comes on and stays on, itmeans that oil is not flowing throughthe engine properly. The vehiclecould be low on oil and it mighthave some other system problem.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Low Fuel Warning Light

This light, under the fuel gauge,comes on briefly while the engine isbeing started.

This light and a chime come onwhen the fuel tank is low on fuel.The Driver Information Center alsodisplays a FUEL LEVEL LOWmessage. See Fuel SystemMessages on page 5‑38 for moreinformation. When fuel is added this

Page 147: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (25,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-25

light and message should go off.If they do not, have the vehicleserviced by your dealer.

Security Light

The security light should come onbriefly as the engine is started. If thesystem is working normally, theindicator light turns off. If it does notcome on, have the vehicle servicedby your dealer.

If the light stays on and the enginedoes not start, there could be aproblem with the theft-deterrentsystem.

This light is also used to indicate thestatus of the anti-theft alarm systemwhen the ignition is turned off. Thelight will flash rapidly if the alarmsystem is arming and one or more

of the monitored entry points is notclosed. The light will stay on if thealarm is arming and all entry pointsare closed.

For information regarding this lightand the vehicle's security system,see Vehicle Alarm System onpage 2‑12.

High-Beam On Light

This light comes on when thehigh-beam headlamps are in use.

See Headlamp High/Low-BeamChanger on page 6‑2.

Front Fog Lamp Light

The fog lamp light comes on whenthe fog lamps are in use.

The light goes out when the foglamps are turned off. See FogLamps on page 6‑6 for moreinformation.

Page 148: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (26,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-26 Instruments and Controls

Cruise Control Light

The cruise control light comes onwhenever the cruise control is set.

The light goes out when the cruisecontrol is turned off. See CruiseControl on page 9‑46 for moreinformation.

Information Displays

Driver InformationCenter (DIC)Your vehicle has a DriverInformation Center (DIC).

The DIC displays information aboutyour vehicle. It also displayswarning messages if a systemproblem is detected.

All messages will appear in the DICdisplay located below thetachometer in the instrument panelcluster.

The DIC comes on when the ignitionis on. After a short delay, the DICwill display the information that waslast displayed before the enginewas turned off.

The DIC has different displayswhich can be accessed by pressingthe DIC buttons located on theinstrument panel, next to thesteering wheel. If the vehicle does

not have DIC buttons, the tripodometer reset stem can be used toaccess some of the menu items.

The DIC displays trip, fuel, andvehicle system information, andwarning messages if a systemproblem is detected.

The DIC also allows some featuresto be customized. See VehiclePersonalization (With DIC Buttons)on page 5‑44 for more information.

DIC Buttons

Page 149: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (27,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-27

The buttons are the trip/fuel, vehicleinformation, customization, and set/reset buttons. The button functionsare detailed in the following pages.

3 (Trip/Fuel): Press to displaythe odometer, trip odometer, fuelrange, average economy, fuel used,timer, instantaneous economy andActive Fuel Management™indicator, and transmissiontemperature. The compass andoutside air temperature will also beshown in the display. Thetemperature will be shown in °C or°F depending on the units selected.

T (Vehicle Information): Pressto display the oil life, units, sideblind zone system on/off, tirepressure readings for vehicles withthe Tire Pressure Monitor System(TPMS), trailer brake gain andoutput information for vehicles withthe Integrated Trailer Brake Control(ITBC) system, engine hours,compass zone setting, and compassrecalibration.

U (Customization): Press tocustomize the feature settings onyour vehicle. See VehiclePersonalization (With DIC Buttons)on page 5‑44 for more information.

V (Set/Reset): Press to set orreset certain functions and to turnoff or acknowledge messages onthe DIC.

Trip/Fuel Menu Items (With DICButtons)

3 (Trip/Fuel): Press to scrollthrough the following menu items:

Odometer

Press the trip/fuel button untilODOMETER displays. This displayshows the distance the vehicle hasbeen driven in either kilometers (km)or miles (mi). Pressing the tripodometer reset stem will alsodisplay the odometer.

To switch between English andmetric measurements, see “Units”later in this section.

Trip Odometer

Press the trip/fuel button until TRIPdisplays. This display shows thecurrent distance traveled in eitherkilometers (km) or miles (mi) sincethe last reset for the trip odometer.Pressing the trip odometer resetstem will also display the tripodometer.

The trip odometer can be reset tozero by pressing the set/resetbutton while the trip odometer isdisplayed. You can also reset thetrip odometer while it is displayed bypressing and holding the tripodometer reset stem.

The trip odometer has a featurecalled the retroactive reset. This canbe used to set the trip odometer tothe number of kilometers (miles)driven since the ignition was lastturned on. This can be used if thetrip odometer is not reset at thebeginning of the trip.

To use the retroactive reset feature,press and hold the set/reset buttonfor at least four seconds. The trip

Page 150: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (28,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-28 Instruments and Controls

odometer will display the number ofkilometers (km) or miles (mi) drivensince the ignition was last turned onand the vehicle was moving. Oncethe vehicle begins moving, the tripodometer will accumulate mileage.For example, if the vehicle wasdriven 8 km (5 mi) before it is startedagain, and then the retroactive resetfeature is activated, the display willshow 8 km (5 mi). As the vehiclebegins moving, the display will thenincrease to 8.2 km (5.1 mi), 8.4 km(5.2 mi), etc.

Fuel Range

Press the trip/fuel button until FUELRANGE displays. This displayshows the approximate number ofremaining kilometers (km) ormiles (mi) the vehicle can be drivenwithout refueling. The display willshow LOW if the fuel level is low.

The fuel range estimate is based onan average of the vehicle's fueleconomy over recent driving historyand the amount of fuel remaining inthe fuel tank. This estimate will

change if driving conditions change.For example, if driving in traffic andmaking frequent stops, this displaymay read one number, but if thevehicle is driven on a freeway, thenumber may change even thoughthe same amount of fuel is in thefuel tank. This is because differentdriving conditions produce differentfuel economies. Generally, freewaydriving produces better fueleconomy than city driving. Fuelrange cannot be reset.

Average Economy

Press the trip/fuel button until AVGECONOMY displays. This displayshows the approximate averageliters per 100 kilometers (L/100 km)or miles per gallon (mpg). Thisnumber is calculated based on thenumber of L/100 km (mpg) recordedsince the last time this menu itemwas reset. To reset AVGECONOMY, press and hold the set/reset button.

Fuel Used

Press the trip/fuel button until FUELUSED displays. This display showsthe number of liters (L) orgallons (gal) of fuel used since thelast reset of this menu item. To resetthe fuel used information, press andhold the set/reset button while FUELUSED is displayed.

Speedometer

The speedometer shows how fastthe vehicle is moving in eitherkilometers per hour (km/h) or milesper hour (mph). The speedometercannot be reset.

Timer

Press the trip/fuel button untilTIMER displays. This display can beused as a timer.

To start the timer, press the set/reset button while TIMER isdisplayed. The display will show theamount of time that has passedsince the timer was last reset, notincluding time the ignition is off.Time will continue to be counted as

Page 151: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (29,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-29

long as the ignition is on, even ifanother display is being shown onthe DIC. The timer will record up to99 hours, 59 minutes and59 seconds (99:59:59) after whichthe display will return to zero.

To stop the timer, press the set/resetbutton briefly while TIMER isdisplayed.

To reset the timer to zero, press andhold the set/reset button whileTIMER is displayed.

Transmission Temperature

Press the trip/fuel button untilTRANS TEMP displays. Thisdisplay shows the temperature ofthe automatic transmission fluid ineither degrees Celsius (°C) ordegrees Fahrenheit (°F).

Instantaneous Economy andActive Fuel Management™Indicator

If your vehicle has this display,press the trip/fuel button until INSTECON V8 displays. This displayshows the current fuel economy at a

particular moment and will changefrequently as driving conditionschange. This display shows theinstantaneous fuel economy in litersper 100 kilometers (L/100 km) ormiles per gallon (mpg). Unlikeaverage economy, this screencannot be reset.

An Active Fuel Managementindicator will display on the rightside of the DIC, while INST ECONdisplays on the left side. Active FuelManagement allows the engine tooperate on either four or eightcylinders, depending on your drivingdemands. When Active FuelManagement is active, V4 willdisplay on the DIC. When ActiveFuel Management is inactive, V8will display. See Active FuelManagement® on page 9‑27 formore information.

Blank Display

This display shows no information.

Vehicle Information MenuItems (With DIC Buttons)

T (Vehicle Information): Pressto scroll through the following menuitems:

Oil Life

Press the vehicle information buttonuntil OIL LIFE REMAININGdisplays. This display shows anestimate of the oil's remaining usefullife. If you see 99%OIL LIFEREMAINING on the display, thatmeans 99% of the current oil liferemains. The engine oil life systemwill alert you to change the oil on aschedule consistent with yourdriving conditions.

When the remaining oil life is low,the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOONmessage will appear on the display.See “CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON”under Engine Oil Messages onpage 5‑37. You should change theoil as soon as you can. See EngineOil on page 10‑6. In addition to theengine oil life system monitoring theoil life, additional maintenance is

Page 152: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (30,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-30 Instruments and Controls

recommended in the MaintenanceSchedule in this manual. SeeMaintenance Schedule onpage 11‑2 for more information.

Remember, you must reset the OILLIFE display yourself after each oilchange. It will not reset itself. Also,be careful not to reset the OIL LIFEdisplay accidentally at any timeother than when the oil has justbeen changed. It cannot be resetaccurately until the next oil change.To reset the engine oil life system,see Engine Oil Life System onpage 10‑9.

Side Blind Zone Alert

If your vehicle has the Side BlindZone Alert (SBZA) system, thisdisplay allows the system to beturned on or off. Once in thisdisplay, press the set/reset button toselect between ON or OFF. If youchoose ON, the system will beturned on. If you choose OFF, thesystem will be turned off. When theSBZA system is turned off, the DICwill display the SIDE BLIND ZONE

ALERT SYSTEM OFF message asa reminder that the system hasbeen turned off. See ObjectDetection System Messages onpage 5‑39 and Side Blind Zone Alert(SBZA) on page 9‑49 for moreinformation.

Units

Press the vehicle information buttonuntil UNITS displays. This displayallows you to select between metricor English units of measurement.Once in this display, press the set/reset button to select betweenMETRIC or units ENGLISH. All ofthe vehicle information will then bedisplayed in the unit ofmeasurement selected.

Tire Pressure

On vehicles with the Tire PressureMonitor System (TPMS), thepressure for each tire can be viewedin the DIC. The tire pressure will beshown in either kilopascals (kPa) orpounds per square inch (psi). Pressthe vehicle information button untilthe DIC displays FRONT

TIRES kPa (PSI) LEFT ##RIGHT ##. Press the vehicleinformation button again until theDIC displays REAR TIRES kPa(PSI) LEFT ## RIGHT ##.

If a low tire pressure condition isdetected by the system whiledriving, a message advising you toadd pressure in a specific tire willappear in the display. See TirePressure on page 10‑49 and TireMessages on page 5‑41 for moreinformation.

If the tire pressure display showsdashes instead of a value, theremay be a problem with your vehicle.If this consistently occurs, see yourdealer for service.

Trailer Gain and Output

On vehicles with the IntegratedTrailer Brake Control (ITBC) system,the trailer brake display appears inthe DIC. Press the vehicleinformation button until TRAILERGAIN and OUTPUT display.

Page 153: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (31,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-31

TRAILER GAIN shows the trailergain setting. This setting can beadjusted from 0.0 to 10.0 with eithera trailer connected or disconnected.To adjust this setting, see“Integrated Trailer Brake ControlSystem” under Towing Equipmenton page 9‑69 for more information.

OUTPUT shows the power output tothe trailer anytime a trailer withelectric brakes is connected. Outputis displayed in 0 to 10 bars. Dashesmay appear in the OUTPUT display.See “Integrated Trailer BrakeControl System” under TowingEquipment on page 9‑69 for moreinformation.

Engine Hours

Press the vehicle information buttonuntil ENGINE HOURS displays. Thisdisplay shows the total number ofhours the engine has run.

Compass Zone Setting

This display allows for setting thecompass zone. See Compass onpage 5‑5

Compass Recalibration

This display allows for calibratingthe compass. See Compass onpage 5‑5

Blank Display

This display shows no information.

Trip Odometer Reset StemMenu Items (With DIC Buttons)

Use the trip odometer reset stem toview the odometer and tripodometer. The Language selectionand Engine Hours display can alsobe accessed with the trip odometerreset stem.

Odometer

Press the trip odometer reset stemuntil ODOMETER displays. Thisdisplay shows the distance thevehicle has been driven in eitherkilometers (km) or miles (mi).

Trip Odometer

Press the trip odometer reset stemuntil TRIP displays. This displayshows the current distance traveled

in either kilometers (km) ormiles (mi) since the last reset for thetrip odometer.

The trip odometer can be reset tozero by pressing and holding the tripodometer reset stem while the tripodometer is displayed.

The trip odometer has a featurecalled the retroactive reset. This canbe used to set the trip odometer tothe number of kilometers (miles)driven since the ignition was lastturned on. This can be used if thetrip odometer is not reset at thebeginning of the trip.

To use the retroactive reset feature,press and hold the trip odometerreset stem for at least four seconds.The trip odometer will display thenumber of kilometers (km) ormiles (mi) driven since the ignitionwas last turned on and the vehiclewas moving. Once the vehiclebegins moving, the trip odometerwill accumulate mileage. Forexample, if the vehicle was driven8 km (5 mi) before it is started again,

Page 154: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (32,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-32 Instruments and Controls

and then the retroactive resetfeature is activated, the display willshow 8 km (5 mi). As the vehiclebegins moving, the display will thenincrease to 8.2 km (5.1 mi), 8.4 km(5.2 mi), etc.

Language

This display allows you to select thelanguage in which the DICmessages will appear. To select alanguage:

1. Press the trip odometer resetstem until ODOMETER displays.

2. While in the ODOMETERdisplay, press and hold the tripodometer reset stem forthree seconds until the currentlyset language displays.

3. Continue to press and hold thetrip odometer reset stem to scrollthrough all of the availablelanguages.

The available selections areENGLISH (default), FRANCAIS(French), ESPANOL (Spanish),and NO CHANGE.

4. Once the desired language isdisplayed, release the tripodometer reset stem to set yourchoice.

Engine Hours

To display the ENGINE HOURS,place the ignition in LOCK/OFF orACC/ACCESSORY, then press andhold the trip odometer reset stem forfour seconds while viewing theODOMETER. This display showsthe total number of hours the enginehas run.

Trip Odometer Reset StemMenu Items (Without DICButtons)

Language

This display allows you to select thelanguage in which the DICmessages will appear. To select alanguage:

1. Press the trip odometer resetstem until ODOMETER displays.

2. While in the ODOMETERdisplay, press and hold the tripodometer reset stem forthree seconds until the currentlyset language displays.

3. Continue to press and hold thetrip odometer reset stem to scrollthrough all of the availablelanguages.

The available languages areENGLISH (default), FRANCAIS(French), ESPANOL (Spanish),and NO CHANGE.

4. Once the desired language isdisplayed, release the tripodometer reset stem to set yourchoice.

Trip Odometer

Press the trip odometer reset stemuntil TRIP displays. This displayshows the current distance traveledin either kilometers (km) ormiles (mi) since the last reset for thetrip odometer.

Page 155: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (33,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-33

The trip odometer can be reset tozero by pressing and holding the tripodometer reset stem while the tripodometer is displayed.

The trip odometer has a featurecalled the retroactive reset. This canbe used to set the trip odometer tothe number of kilometers (miles)driven since the ignition was lastturned on. This can be used if thetrip odometer is not reset at thebeginning of the trip.

To use the retroactive reset feature,press and hold the trip odometerreset stem for at least four seconds.The trip odometer will display thenumber of kilometers (km) ormiles (mi) driven since the ignitionwas last turned on and the vehiclewas moving. Once the vehiclebegins moving, the trip odometerwill accumulate mileage. Forexample, if the vehicle was driven8 km (5 mi) before it is started again,and then the retroactive resetfeature is activated, the display willshow 8 km (5 mi). As the vehicle

begins moving, the display will thenincrease to 8.2 km (5.1 mi), 8.4 km(5.2 mi), etc.

Transmission Temperature

Press the trip odometer reset stemuntil TRANS TEMP displays. Thisdisplay shows the temperature ofthe automatic transmission fluid ineither degrees Celsius (°C) ordegrees Fahrenheit (°F).

Trailer Gain and Output

On vehicles with the IntegratedTrailer Brake Control (ITBC) system,the trailer brake display appears inthe DIC. Press the trip odometerreset stem until TRAILER GAIN andOUTPUT display.

TRAILER GAIN shows the trailergain setting. This setting can beadjusted from 0.0 to 10.0 with eithera trailer connected or disconnected.To adjust this setting, see“Integrated Trailer Brake ControlSystem” under Towing Equipmenton page 9‑69 for more information.

OUTPUT shows the power output tothe trailer anytime a trailer withelectric brakes is connected. Outputis displayed in 0 to 10 bars. Dashesmay appear in the OUTPUT display.See “Integrated Trailer BrakeControl System” under TowingEquipment on page 9‑69 for moreinformation.

Speedometer

The speedometer shows how fastthe vehicle is moving in eitherkilometers per hour (km/h) or milesper hour (mph). The speedometercannot be reset.

Compass Zone Setting

This display allows for setting thecompass zone. See Compass onpage 5‑5 for more information.

Compass Recalibration

This display allows for calibratingthe compass. See Compass onpage 5‑5 for more information.

Page 156: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (34,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-34 Instruments and Controls

Oil Life

To access this display, the vehiclemust be in P (Park). Press the tripodometer reset stem until OIL LIFEREMAINING displays. This displayshows an estimate of the oil'sremaining useful life. If you see99%OIL LIFE REMAINING on thedisplay, that means 99% of thecurrent oil life remains. The engineoil life system will alert you tochange the oil on a scheduleconsistent with your drivingconditions.

When the remaining oil life is low,the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOONmessage will appear on the display.See “CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON”under Engine Oil Messages onpage 5‑37. You should change theoil as soon as you can. See EngineOil on page 10‑6. In addition to theengine oil life system monitoring theoil life, additional maintenance isrecommended in the MaintenanceSchedule in this manual. SeeMaintenance Schedule onpage 11‑2 for more information.

Remember, you must reset the OILLIFE display yourself after each oilchange. It will not reset itself. Also,be careful not to reset the OIL LIFEdisplay accidentally at any timeother than when the oil has justbeen changed. It cannot be resetaccurately until the next oil change.To reset the engine oil life system,see Engine Oil Life System onpage 10‑9.

Relearn Tire Positions

Your vehicle may have this display.To access this display, the vehiclemust be in P (Park). If your vehiclehas the Tire Pressure MonitorSystem (TPMS), after rotating thetires or after replacing a tire orsensor, the system must re-learn thetire positions. To re-learn the tirepositions, see Tire Pressure MonitorSystem on page 10‑50. See TireInspection on page 10‑54, TireRotation on page 10‑54 and TireMessages on page 5‑41 for moreinformation.

Vehicle MessagesMessages displayed on the DICindicate the status of the vehicle orsome action may be needed tocorrect a condition. Multiplemessages may appear one afteranother.

The messages that do not requireimmediate action can beacknowledged and cleared bypressing V (Set/Reset) or the tripodometer reset stem.

The messages that requireimmediate action cannot be cleareduntil that action is performed.

All messages should be takenseriously and clearing the messagedoes not correct the problem.

The following are the possiblemessages and some informationabout them.

Page 157: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (35,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-35

Battery Voltage andCharging Messages

BATTERY LOW STARTVEHICLE

When the vehicle’s battery isseverely discharged, this messagewill display and four chimes willsound. Start the vehicleimmediately. If the vehicle is notstarted and the battery continues todischarge, the climate controls,heated seats, and audio systemswill shut off and the vehicle mayrequire a jump start. These systemswill function again after the vehicleis started.

SERVICE BATTERYCHARGING SYSTEM

On some vehicles, this messagedisplays if there is a problem withthe battery charging system. Undercertain conditions, the chargingsystem light may also turn on in theinstrument panel cluster. SeeCharging System Light onpage 5‑18. Driving with this problem

could drain the battery. Turn off allunnecessary accessories. Have theelectrical system checked as soonas possible. See your dealer.

Brake System Messages

SERVICE BRAKE SYSTEM

This message displays along withthe brake system warning light ifthere is a problem with the brakesystem. See Brake System WarningLight on page 5‑21. If this messageappears, stop as soon as possibleand turn off the vehicle. Restart thevehicle and check for the messageon the DIC display. If the messageis still displayed or appears againwhen you begin driving, the brakesystem needs service as soon aspossible. See your dealer.

SERVICE BRAKES SOON

This message displays if there is aproblem with the brake system.If this message appears, stop assoon as possible and turn off thevehicle. Restart the vehicle and

check for the message on the DICdisplay. If the message is stilldisplayed or appears again whenyou begin driving, the brake systemneeds service. See your dealer.

SERVICE TRAILER BRAKESYSTEM

On vehicles with the IntegratedTrailer Brake Control (ITBC) system,this message displays and a chimesounds when there is a problemwith the ITBC system.

When this message displays, poweris no longer available to the trailerbrakes.

As soon as it is safe to do so,carefully pull your vehicle over tothe side of the road and turn theignition off. Check the wiringconnection to the trailer and turn theignition back on. If this message stilldisplays, either your vehicle or thetrailer needs service. See yourdealer.

Page 158: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (36,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-36 Instruments and Controls

See “Integrated Trailer BrakeControl System” under TowingEquipment on page 9‑69 for moreinformation.

Door Ajar Messages

DRIVER DOOR OPEN

This message displays and a chimesounds if the driver door is not fullyclosed and the vehicle is shifted outof P (Park). Stop and turn off thevehicle, check the door forobstructions, and close the dooragain. Check to see if the messagestill appears on the DIC.

HOOD OPEN

This message displays and a chimesounds if the hood is not fullyclosed. Stop and turn off thevehicle, check the hood forobstructions, and close the hoodagain. Check to see if the messagestill appears on the DIC.

LEFT REAR DOOR OPEN

This message displays and a chimesounds if the driver side rear door isnot fully closed and the vehicle isshifted out of P (Park). Stop and turnoff the vehicle, check the door forobstructions, and close the dooragain. Check to see if the messagestill appears on the DIC.

PASSENGER DOOR OPEN

This message displays and a chimesounds if the front passenger dooris not fully closed and the vehicle isshifted out of P (Park). Stop and turnoff the vehicle, check the door forobstructions, and close the dooragain. Check to see if the messagestill appears on the DIC.

REAR ACCESS OPEN

This message displays and a chimesounds if the liftgate or liftglass isopen while the ignition is in ON/RUN. Turn off the vehicle and checkthe liftgate and liftglass. Restart thevehicle and check for the messageon the DIC display.

RIGHT REAR DOOR OPEN

This message displays and a chimesounds if the passenger side reardoor is not fully closed and thevehicle is shifted out of P (Park).Stop and turn off the vehicle, checkthe door for obstructions, and closethe door again. Check to see if themessage still appears on the DIC.

Engine Cooling SystemMessagesNotice: If you drive the vehiclewhile the engine is overheating,severe engine damage mayoccur. If an overheat warningappears on the instrument clusterand/or DIC, stop the vehicle assoon as possible. See EngineOverheating on page 10‑18.

ENGINE HOT A/C (AirConditioning) TURNED OFF

This message displays when theengine coolant becomes hotter thanthe normal operating temperature.

Page 159: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (37,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-37

See Engine Coolant TemperatureGauge on page 5‑14. To avoidadded strain on a hot engine, the airconditioning compressorautomatically turns off. When thecoolant temperature returns tonormal, the air conditioningcompressor turns back on. You cancontinue to drive your vehicle.

If this message continues to appear,have the system repaired by yourdealer as soon as possible to avoiddamage to the engine.

ENGINE OVERHEATED IDLEENGINE

This message displays when theengine coolant temperature is toohot. Stop and allow the vehicle toidle until it cools down. See EngineCoolant Temperature Gauge onpage 5‑14.

See Overheated Engine ProtectionOperating Mode on page 10‑19 forinformation on driving to a safeplace in an emergency.

ENGINE OVERHEATED STOPENGINE

This message displays and a chimesounds if the engine cooling systemreaches unsafe temperatures foroperation. Stop and turn off thevehicle as soon as it is safe to do soto avoid severe damage. Thismessage clears when the enginehas cooled to a safe operatingtemperature.

Engine Oil Messages

CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON

This message displays when theengine oil needs to be changed.When you change the engine oil, besure to reset the CHANGE ENGINEOIL SOON message. See EngineOil Life System on page 10‑9 forinformation on how to reset themessage. See Engine Oil onpage 10‑6 and MaintenanceSchedule on page 11‑2 for moreinformation.

ENGINE OIL HOT IDLEENGINE

This message displays when theengine oil becomes hotter than thenormal operating temperature. Stopand allow the vehicle to idle until itcools down. See Engine CoolantTemperature Gauge on page 5‑14.

OIL PRESSURE LOW STOPENGINE

Notice: If you drive the vehiclewhile the engine oil pressure islow, severe engine damage mayoccur. If a low oil pressurewarning appears on the DriverInformation Center (DIC), stop thevehicle as soon as possible. Donot drive the vehicle until thecause of the low oil pressure iscorrected. See Engine Oil onpage 10‑6 for more information.

This message displays if low oilpressure levels occur. Stop thevehicle as soon as safely possibleand do not operate it until the causeof the low oil pressure has been

Page 160: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (38,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-38 Instruments and Controls

corrected. Check the oil as soon aspossible and have the vehicleserviced by your dealer. See EngineOil on page 10‑6.

Engine Power Messages

ENGINE POWER IS REDUCED

This message displays and a chimesounds when the cooling systemtemperature gets too hot and theengine further enters the enginecoolant protection mode. SeeEngine Overheating on page 10‑18for further information.

This message also displays whenthe engine power is reduced.Reduced engine power can affectthe vehicle's ability to accelerate.If this message is on, but there is noreduction in performance, proceedto your destination. Theperformance may be reduced thenext time the vehicle is driven. Thevehicle may be driven at a reducedspeed while this message is on, butacceleration and speed may bereduced. Anytime this message

stays on, the vehicle should betaken to your dealer for service assoon as possible.

Fuel System Messages

FUEL LEVEL LOW

This message displays and a chimesounds if the fuel level is low. Refuelas soon as possible. See FuelGauge on page 5‑12 and Fuel onpage 9‑55 for more information.

TIGHTEN GAS CAP

This message may display alongwith the check engine light on theinstrument cluster if the fuel cap isnot tightened properly. SeeMalfunction Indicator Lamp onpage 5‑19. Reinstall the fuel capfully. See Filling the Tank onpage 9‑59. The diagnostic systemcan determine if the fuel cap hasbeen left off or improperly installed.A loose or missing fuel cap allowsfuel to evaporate into the

atmosphere. A few driving trips withthe cap properly installed shouldturn this light and message off.

Key and Lock Messages

REPLACE BATTERY INREMOTE KEY

This message displays if a RemoteKeyless Entry (RKE) transmitterbattery is low. The battery needs tobe replaced in the transmitter. See“Battery Replacement” underRemote Keyless Entry (RKE)System Operation on page 2‑2.

Lamp Messages

TURN SIGNAL ON

This message displays and a chimesounds if a turn signal is left on for1.2 km (0.75 mi). Move the turnsignal/multifunction lever to the offposition.

Page 161: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (39,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-39

Object Detection SystemMessages

PARK ASST BLOCKED SEEOWNERS MANUAL

This message displays if there issomething interfering with the parkassist system. See UltrasonicParking Assist on page 9‑48 formore information.

PARK ASSIST OFF

After the vehicle has been started,this message displays to remind thedriver that the URPA system hasbeen turned off. Press the set/resetbutton or the trip odometer resetstem to acknowledge this messageand clear it from the DIC display. Toturn the URPA system back on, seeUltrasonic Parking Assist onpage 9‑48.

SERVICE PARK ASSIST

This message displays if there is aproblem with the Ultrasonic RearParking Assist (URPA) system. Donot use this system to help you

park. See Ultrasonic Parking Assiston page 9‑48 for more information.See your dealer for service.

SERVICE SIDE BLIND ZONEALERT SYSTEM

If your vehicle has the Side BlindZone Alert (SBZA) system and thismessage displays, both SBZAdisplays will remain on indicatingthere is a problem with the SBZAsystem. If these displays remain onafter continued driving, the systemneeds service. See your dealer. SeeSide Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) onpage 9‑49 for more information.

SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERTSYSTEM OFF

If your vehicle has the Side BlindZone Alert (SBZA) system, thismessage displays when the SBZAsystem has been turned off. SeeSide Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) onpage 9‑49 and Driver InformationCenter (DIC) on page 5‑26 for moreinformation.

SIDE BLIND ZONE SYSTEMUNAVAILABLE

If your vehicle has the Side BlindZone Alert (SBZA) system, thismessage displays when the SBZAsystem is disabled because thesensor is blocked and cannot detectvehicles in your blind zone. Thesensor may be blocked by mud, dirt,snow, ice, or slush. This messagemay also display during heavy rainor due to road spray. It may alsocome on when driving in isolatedareas with no guardrails, trees,or road signs and light traffic. Yourvehicle does not need service. Forcleaning instructions, see “WashingYour Vehicle” in Exterior Care onpage 10‑87. See Side Blind ZoneAlert (SBZA) on page 9‑49 for moreinformation.

Page 162: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (40,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-40 Instruments and Controls

Ride Control SystemMessages

SERVICE STABILITRAK

If your vehicle has StabiliTrak® andthis message displays, it meansthere may be a problem with theStabiliTrak system. If you see thismessage, try to reset the system.Stop; turn off the engine for at least15 seconds; then start the engineagain. If this message still comeson, it means there is a problem. Youshould see your dealer for service.The vehicle is safe to drive,however, you do not have thebenefit of StabiliTrak, so reduceyour speed and drive accordingly.

SERVICE SUSPENSIONSYSTEM

If your vehicle has the Autoride®

suspension system, this messagedisplays when the Autoridesuspension system is not operatingproperly. Have your vehicle servicedby your dealer.

SERVICE TRACTIONCONTROL

If your vehicle has StabiliTrak, thismessage displays when there is aproblem with the Traction ControlSystem (TCS). When this messagedisplays, the system will not limitwheel spin. Adjust your drivingaccordingly. See your dealer forservice. See StabiliTrak® System onpage 9‑42 for more information.

STABILITRAK INITIALIZING

If the vehicle has StabiliTrak, thismessage may come on if theStabiliTrak system has not fullyinitialized because of roadconditions or the incorrect tire size.When the StabiliTrak system is fullyinitialized, the message will turn off.See StabiliTrak® System onpage 9‑42 for more information.If this message continues to bedisplayed for multiple ignition cyclesand on different road surfaces, seeyour dealer for service.

TRACTION XXSTABILITRAK XX

This message displays when thetraction control and/or StabiliTraksystems have been turned on or off.Adjust your driving accordingly. Tolimit wheel spin and realize the fullbenefits of the stabilityenhancement system, you shouldnormally leave StabiliTrak on.However, you should turnStabiliTrak off if the vehicle getsstuck in sand, mud, ice, or snowand you want to rock the vehicle toattempt to free it, or if you aredriving in extreme off-roadconditions and require more wheelspin. See If the Vehicle Is Stuck onpage 9‑14. To turn the StabiliTraksystem on or off, see StabiliTrak®

System on page 9‑42.

Page 163: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (41,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-41

STABILITRAK OFF may alsodisplay when the stability controlhas been automatically disabled.There are several conditions thatcan cause this message to appear.. One condition is overheating,

which could occur if StabiliTrakactivates continuously for anextended period of time.

. The message also displays if thebrake system warning light is on.See Brake System WarningLight on page 5‑21.

. The message could display if thestability system takes longerthan usual to complete itsdiagnostic checks due to drivingconditions.

. The message displays if anengine or vehicle relatedproblem has been detected andthe vehicle needs service. Seeyour dealer.

The message turns off as soon asthe conditions that caused themessage to be displayed are nolonger present.

Airbag System Messages

SERVICE AIR BAG

This message displays if there is aproblem with the airbag system.Have your dealer inspect thesystem for problems. See AirbagReadiness Light on page 5‑16 andAirbag System on page 3‑26 formore information.

Security Messages

SERVICE THEFT DETERRENTSYSTEM

This message displays when thereis a problem with the theft-deterrentsystem. The vehicle may or may notrestart so you may want to take thevehicle to your dealer before turningoff the engine. See ImmobilizerOperation on page 2‑14 for moreinformation.

Tire Messages

SERVICE TIRE MONITORSYSTEM

On vehicles with the Tire PressureMonitor System (TPMS), thismessage displays if a part on theTPMS is not working properly. Thetire pressure light also flashes andthen remains on during the sameignition cycle. See Tire PressureLight on page 5‑23. Severalconditions may cause this messageto appear. See Tire PressureMonitor Operation on page 10‑51 formore information. If the warningcomes on and stays on, there maybe a problem with the TPMS. Seeyour dealer.

TIRE LEARNING ACTIVE

On vehicles with the Tire PressureMonitor System (TPMS), thismessage displays when the TPMSis re-learning the tire positions onyour vehicle. The tire positions mustbe re-learned after rotating the tiresor after replacing a tire or sensor.

Page 164: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (42,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-42 Instruments and Controls

See Tire Inspection on page 10‑54,Tire Rotation on page 10‑54, TirePressure Monitor System onpage 10‑50, and Tire Pressure onpage 10‑49 for more information.

TIRE LOW ADD AIR TO TIRE

On vehicles with the Tire PressureMonitor System (TPMS), thismessage displays when thepressure in one or more of thevehicle's tires needs to be checked.This message also displays LEFTFRT (left front), RIGHT FRT (rightfront), LEFT RR (left rear),or RIGHT RR (right rear) to indicatethe location of the low tire. The lowtire pressure warning light will alsocome on. See Tire Pressure Lighton page 5‑23. You can receive morethan one tire pressure message at atime. To read the other messagesthat may have been sent at thesame time, press the set/resetbutton or the trip odometer resetstem. If a tire pressure messageappears on the DIC, stop as soonas you can. Have the tire pressures

checked and set to those shown onthe Tire Loading Information label.See Tires on page 10‑40, VehicleLoad Limits on page 9‑15, and TirePressure on page 10‑49. The DICalso shows the tire pressure values.See Driver Information Center (DIC)on page 5‑26.

Transmission Messages

GRADE BRAKING DISABLED

This message displays when thegrade braking has been disabledwith the tow/haul mode button onthe end of the shift lever. See Tow/Haul Mode on page 9‑32, AutomaticTransmission on page 9‑28, andCruise Control on page 9‑46.

GRADE BRAKING ENABLED

This message displays when thegrade braking has been enabledwith the tow/haul mode button onthe end of the shift lever. See Tow/Haul Mode on page 9‑32, AutomaticTransmission on page 9‑28, andCruise Control on page 9‑46.

GRADE BRAKING ON

This message displays when thegrade braking has been activatedwhile driving on downhill grades.This message will only appear thefirst time the feature is activated inan ignition cycle. See Tow/HaulMode on page 9‑32, AutomaticTransmission on page 9‑28, andCruise Control on page 9‑46.

SERVICE 4WHEEL DRIVE

If the vehicle has four-wheel drive,this message may display if aproblem occurs with thefour-wheel-drive system. If thismessage appears, stop as soon aspossible and turn off the vehicle.Make sure the key is in the LOCK/OFF position for at least one minuteand then restart the vehicle andcheck for the message on the DICdisplay. If the message is stilldisplayed or appears again whenyou begin driving, thefour-wheel-drive system needsservice. See your dealer.

Page 165: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (43,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-43

TRANSMISSION HOT IDLEENGINE

Notice: Do not drive the vehiclewhile the transmission fluid isoverheating and the transmissiontemperature warning is displayedon the instrument cluster and/orDIC, or the transmission can bedamaged. This could lead tocostly repairs that would not becovered by the warranty.

This message displays and a chimemay sound if the transmission fluidin the vehicle gets hot. Driving withthe transmission fluid temperaturehigh can cause damage to thevehicle. Stop the vehicle and let itidle to allow the transmission tocool. This message clears and thechime stops when the fluidtemperature reaches a safe level.

Vehicle ReminderMessages

CHECK TRAILER WIRING

On vehicles with the IntegratedTrailer Brake Control (ITBC) system,this message may display and achime may sound when one of thefollowing conditions exists:. A trailer with electric brakes

becomes disconnected from thevehicle.

‐ If the disconnect occurs whilethe vehicle is stopped, thismessage clears itself after ashort time.

‐ If the disconnect occurs whilethe vehicle is moving, thismessage stays on until theignition is turned off.

. There is a short in the wiring tothe electric trailer brakes.

When this message displays, poweris no longer available to the trailerbrakes.

As soon as it is safe to do so,carefully pull the vehicle over to theside of the road and turn the ignitionoff. Check the wiring connection tothe trailer and turn the ignition backon. This message clears if the traileris reconnected. This message alsoclears if you acknowledge it. If thismessage still displays, either thevehicle or the trailer needs service.See your dealer.

See “Integrated Trailer BrakeControl System” under TowingEquipment on page 9‑69 for moreinformation.

ICE POSSIBLE DRIVEWITH CARE

This message displays when iceconditions are possible.

TRAILER CONNECTED

On vehicles with the IntegratedTrailer Brake Control (ITBC) system,this message displays briefly whena trailer with electric brakes is firstconnected to the vehicle.

Page 166: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (44,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-44 Instruments and Controls

This message clears itself afterseveral seconds. This message alsoclears if you acknowledge it. Afterthis message clears, the TRAILERGAIN/OUTPUT display appears inthe DIC.

See “TRAILER GAIN/OUTPUT”under Driver Information Center(DIC) on page 5‑26 and “IntegratedTrailer Brake Control System” underTowing Equipment on page 9‑69 formore information.

Washer Fluid Messages

WASHER FLUID LOW ADDFLUID

This message displays when thewindshield washer fluid is low. Fillthe windshield washer fluid reservoiras soon as possible. See EngineCompartment Overview onpage 10‑5 for the location of thewindshield washer fluid reservoir.Also, see Washer Fluid onpage 10‑21 for more information.

VehiclePersonalization

Vehicle Personalization(With DIC Buttons)Your vehicle may havecustomization capabilities that allowyou to program certain features toone preferred setting. Customizationfeatures can only be programmed toone setting on the vehicle andcannot be programmed to apreferred setting for two differentdrivers.

All of the customization options maynot be available on your vehicle.Only the options available will bedisplayed on the DIC.

The default settings for thecustomization features were setwhen your vehicle left the factory,but may have been changed fromtheir default state since then.

The customization preferences areautomatically recalled.

To change customizationpreferences, use the followingprocedure.

Entering the FeatureSettings Menu

1. Turn the ignition on and placethe vehicle in P (Park).

To avoid excessive drain on thebattery, it is recommended thatthe headlamps are turned off.

2. Press the customization buttonto scroll through the availablecustomizable options.

Feature Settings Menu Items

The following are customizationfeatures that allow you to programsettings to the vehicle:

DISPLAY IN ENGLISH

This feature will only display if alanguage other than English hasbeen set. This feature allows you tochange the language in which theDIC messages appear to English.

Page 167: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (45,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-45

Press the customization button untilthe PRESS V TO DISPLAY INENGLISH screen appears on theDIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to display all DICmessages in English.

DISPLAY LANGUAGE

This feature allows you to select thelanguage in which the DICmessages will appear.

Press the customization button untilthe DISPLAY LANGUAGE screenappears on the DIC display. Pressthe set/reset button once to accessthe settings for this feature. Thenpress the customization button toscroll through the following settings:

ENGLISH (default): All messageswill appear in English.

FRANCAIS: All messages willappear in French.

ESPANOL: All messages willappear in Spanish.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

You can also change the languageby pressing the trip odometer resetstem. See “Language” under DICOperation and Displays (WithoutDIC Buttons) earlier in this sectionfor more information.

AUTO DOOR LOCK

This feature allows you to selectwhen the vehicle's doors willautomatically lock. See AutomaticDoor Locks on page 2‑8 for moreinformation.

Press the customization button untilAUTO DOOR LOCK appears on theDIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

SHIFT OUT OF PARK (default):The doors will automatically lockwhen the vehicle is shifted out ofP (Park).

AT VEHICLE SPEED: The doorswill automatically lock when thevehicle speed is above 8 mph(13 km/h) for 3 seconds.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

AUTO DOOR UNLOCK

This feature allows you to selectwhether or not to turn off theautomatic door unlocking feature.It also allows you to select which

Page 168: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (46,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-46 Instruments and Controls

doors and when the doors willautomatically unlock. See AutomaticDoor Locks on page 2‑8 for moreinformation.

Press the customization button untilAUTO DOOR UNLOCK appears onthe DIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

OFF: None of the doors willautomatically unlock.

DRIVER AT KEY OUT: Only thedriver door will unlock when the keyis taken out of the ignition.

DRIVER IN PARK: Only the driverdoor will unlock when the vehicle isshifted into P (Park).

ALL AT KEY OUT: All of the doorswill unlock when the key is takenout of the ignition.

ALL IN PARK (default): All of thedoors will unlock when the vehicle isshifted into P (Park).

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

REMOTE DOOR LOCK

This feature allows you to select thetype of feedback you will receivewhen locking the vehicle with theRemote Keyless Entry (RKE)transmitter. You will not receivefeedback when locking the vehiclewith the RKE transmitter if the doorsare open. See Remote KeylessEntry (RKE) System Operation onpage 2‑2 for more information.

Press the customization button untilREMOTE DOOR LOCK appears onthe DIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

OFF: There will be no feedbackwhen you press the lock button onthe RKE transmitter.

LIGHTS ONLY: The exterior lampswill flash when you press the lockbutton on the RKE transmitter.

HORN ONLY: The horn will soundon the second press of the lockbutton on the RKE transmitter.

HORN & LIGHTS (default): Theexterior lamps will flash when youpress the lock button on the RKEtransmitter, and the horn will soundwhen the lock button is pressedagain within five seconds of theprevious command.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

Page 169: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (47,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-47

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

REMOTE DOOR UNLOCK

This feature allows you to select thetype of feedback you will receivewhen unlocking the vehicle with theRemote Keyless Entry (RKE)transmitter. You will not receivefeedback when unlocking thevehicle with the RKE transmitter ifthe doors are open. See RemoteKeyless Entry (RKE) SystemOperation on page 2‑2 for moreinformation.

Press the customization button untilREMOTE DOOR UNLOCK appearson the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to access thesettings for this feature. Then pressthe customization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

LIGHTS OFF: The exterior lampswill not flash when you press theunlock button on the RKEtransmitter.

LIGHTS ON (default): The exteriorlamps will flash when you press theunlock button on the RKEtransmitter.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

DELAY DOOR LOCK

This feature allows you to selectwhether or not the locking of thevehicle's doors and liftgate will bedelayed. When locking the doorsand liftgate with the power door lockswitch and a door or the liftgate isopen, this feature will delay lockingthe doors and liftgate untilfive seconds after the last door isclosed. You will hear three chimesto signal that the delayed lockingfeature is in use. The key must beout of the ignition for this feature towork. You can temporarily overridedelayed locking by pressing the

power door lock switch twice. SeeDelayed Locking on page 2‑7 formore information.

Press the customization button untilDELAY DOOR LOCK appears onthe DIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

OFF: There will be no delayedlocking of the vehicle's doors.

ON (default): The doors will notlock until 5 seconds after the lastdoor or the liftgate is closed.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

EXIT LIGHTING

This feature allows you to select theamount of time you want theexterior lamps to remain on when it

Page 170: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (48,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-48 Instruments and Controls

is dark enough outside. Thishappens after the key is turned fromON/RUN to LOCK/OFF.

Press the customization button untilEXIT LIGHTING appears on the DICdisplay. Press the set/reset buttononce to access the settings for thisfeature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

OFF: The exterior lamps will notturn on.

30 SECONDS (default): Theexterior lamps will stay on for30 seconds.

1MINUTE: The exterior lamps willstay on for 1 minute.

2MINUTES: The exterior lamps willstay on for 2 minutes.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

APPROACH LIGHTING

This feature allows you to selectwhether or not to have the exteriorlights turn on briefly during low lightperiods after unlocking the vehicleusing the Remote Keyless Entry(RKE) transmitter.

Press the customization button untilAPPROACH LIGHTING appears onthe DIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

OFF: The exterior lights will notturn on when you unlock the vehiclewith the RKE transmitter.

ON (default): If it is dark enoughoutside, the exterior lights will turnon briefly when you unlock thevehicle with the RKE transmitter.

The lights will remain on for20 seconds or until the lock buttonon the RKE transmitter is pressed,or the vehicle is no longer off.

See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)System Operation on page 2‑2 formore information.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

CHIME VOLUME

This feature allows you to select thevolume level of the chime.

Press the customization button untilCHIME VOLUME appears on theDIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

NORMAL: The chime volume willbe set to a normal level.

LOUD: The chime volume will beset to a loud level.

Page 171: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (49,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-49

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

There is no default for chimevolume. The volume will stay at thelast known setting.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

PARK TILT MIRRORS

If your vehicle has this feature, itallows you to select whether or notthe outside mirror(s) willautomatically tilt down when thevehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).See Park Tilt Mirrors on page 2‑18for more information.

Press the customization button untilPARK TILT MIRRORS appears onthe DIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

OFF (default): Neither outsidemirror will be tilted down when thevehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).

DRIVER MIRROR: The driveroutside mirror will be tilted downwhen the vehicle is shifted intoR (Reverse).

PASSENGER MIRROR: Thepassenger outside mirror will betilted down when the vehicle isshifted into R (Reverse).

BOTH MIRRORS: The driver andpassenger outside mirrors will betilted down when the vehicle isshifted into R (Reverse).

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

EASY EXIT RECALL

If your vehicle has this feature, itallows you to select your preferencefor the automatic easy exit seatfeature. See Memory Seats onpage 3‑6 for more information.

Press the customization button untilEASY EXIT RECALL appears onthe DIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

DOOR BUTTON ONLY: Noautomatic seat exit recall will occur.The recall will only occur afterpressing the easy exit seat button.

BUTTON & KEY OUT (default): Ifthe features are enabled through theEASY EXIT SETUP menu, thedriver seat will move back when the

Page 172: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (50,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-50 Instruments and Controls

key is removed from the ignition orafter pressing the easy exit seatbutton.

The automatic easy exit seatmovement will only occur one timeafter the key is removed from theignition. If the automatic movementhas already occurred, and you putthe key back in the ignition andremove it again, the seat will stay inthe original exit position, unless amemory recall took place prior toremoving the key again.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

EASY EXIT SETUP

If your vehicle has this feature, itallows you to select which areas willrecall with the automatic easy exitseat feature. It also allows you toturn off the automatic easy exit

feature. See Memory Seats onpage 3‑6 and EASY EXIT RECALLearlier for more information.

Press the customization button untilEASY EXIT SETUP appears on theDIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press themenu up/down button to scrollthrough the following settings:

OFF: No automatic seat exit willrecall.

SEAT ONLY (Default): The driverseat will recall.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

MEMORY SEAT RECALL

If your vehicle has this feature, itallows you to select your preferencefor the remote memory seat recallfeature. See Memory Seats onpage 3‑6 for more information.

Press the customization button untilMEMORY SEAT RECALL appearson the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to access thesettings for this feature. Then pressthe customization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

OFF (default): No remote memoryseat recall will occur.

ON: The driver seat and, on somevehicles, the outside mirrors willautomatically move to the storeddriving position when the unlockbutton on the Remote Keyless Entry(RKE) transmitter is pressed. Onsome vehicles with the adjustablethrottle and brake pedal feature, thepedals will also automatically move.

Page 173: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (51,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-51

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

REMOTE START

If your vehicle has this feature, itallows you to turn the remote startoff or on. The remote start featureallows you to start the engine fromoutside of the vehicle using theRemote Keyless Entry (RKE)transmitter. See Remote VehicleStart on page 2‑5 for moreinformation.

Press the customization button untilREMOTE START appears on theDIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

OFF: The remote start feature willbe disabled.

ON (default): The remote startfeature will be enabled.

NO CHANGE: No change will bemade to this feature. The currentsetting will remain.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

FACTORY SETTINGS

This feature allows you to set all ofthe customization features back totheir factory default settings.

Press the customization button untilFACTORY SETTINGS appears onthe DIC display. Press the set/resetbutton once to access the settingsfor this feature. Then press thecustomization button to scrollthrough the following settings:

RESTORE ALL (default): Thecustomization features will be set totheir factory default settings.

DO NOT RESTORE: Thecustomization features will not beset to their factory default settings.

To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desiredsetting is displayed on the DIC.

EXIT FEATURE SETTINGS

This feature allows you to exit thefeature settings menu.

Press the customization button untilPRESS V TO EXIT FEATURESETTINGS appears in the DICdisplay. Press the set/reset buttononce to exit the menu.

If you do not exit, pressing thecustomization button again willreturn you to the beginning of thefeature settings menu.

Page 174: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (52,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-52 Instruments and Controls

Exiting the FeatureSettings Menu

The feature settings menu will beexited when any of the followingoccurs:. The vehicle is no longer in

ON/RUN.. The trip/fuel or vehicle

information DIC buttons arepressed.

. The end of the feature settingsmenu is reached and exited.

. A 40 second time period haselapsed with no selection made.

Universal RemoteSystemSee Radio Frequency Statement onpage 13‑20 for informationregarding Part 15 of the FederalCommunications Commission (FCC)rules and Industry CanadaStandards RSS-GEN/210/220/310.

Universal Remote SystemProgramming

Vehicles with the Universal RemoteSystem will have these buttonslocated in the headliner.

This system provides a way toreplace up to three remote controltransmitters used to activate

devices such as garage dooropeners, security systems, andhome automation devices.

Do not use this system with anygarage door opener that does nothave the stop and reverse feature.This includes any garage dooropener model manufactured beforeApril 1, 1982.

Read the instructions completelybefore attempting to program thetransmitter. Because of the stepsinvolved, it may be helpful to haveanother person assist withprogramming the transmitter.

Be sure to keep the original remotecontrol transmitter for use in othervehicles, as well as for futureprogramming. Only the originalremote control transmitter is neededfor Fixed Code programming. Theprogrammed buttons should beerased when the vehicle is sold orthe lease ends. See “ErasingUniversal Home Remote Buttons” inthis section.

Page 175: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (53,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-53

Park the vehicle outside of thegarage when programming a garagedoor. Be sure that people andobjects are clear of the garage dooror gate that is being programmed.

Programming Universal HomeRemote — Rolling Code

For questions or help programmingthe Universal Home RemoteSystem, call 1-866-572-2728 or goto www.learcar2u.com.

Most garage door openers soldafter 1996 are Rolling Code units.

Programming a garage door openerinvolves time-sensitive actions, soread the entire procedure beforestarting. Otherwise, the device willtime out and the procedure will haveto be repeated.

To program up to three devices:

1. From inside the vehicle, pressthe two outside buttons at thesame time for one totwo seconds, and immediatelyrelease them.

2. In the garage, locate the garagedoor opener receiver(motor-head unit). Find the“Learn” or “Smart” button. It canusually be found where thehanging antenna wire isattached to the motor-head unitand may be a colored button.Press this button. After pressingthis button, complete thefollowing steps in less than30 seconds.

3. Immediately return to thevehicle. Press and hold theUniversal Home Remote buttonthat will be used to control thegarage door until the garagedoor moves. The indicator light,above the selected button,should slowly blink. This buttonmay need to be held for up to20 seconds.

4. Immediately, within one second,release the button when thegarage door moves. Theindicator light will blink rapidlyuntil programming is complete.

5. Press and release the samebutton again. The garage doorshould move, confirming thatprogramming is successful andcomplete.

To program another Rolling Codedevice such as an additional garagedoor opener, a security device,or home automation device, repeatSteps 1 through 5, choosing a

Page 176: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (54,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-54 Instruments and Controls

different function button in Step 3than what was used for the garagedoor opener.

If these instructions do not work, thegarage door opener is probably aFixed Code unit. Follow theprogramming instructions that followfor a Fixed Code garage dooropener.

Programming Universal HomeRemote — Fixed Code

For questions or help programmingthe Universal Home RemoteSystem, call 1-866-572-2728 or goto www.learcar2u.com.

Most garage door openers soldbefore 1996 are Fixed Code units.

Programming a garage door openerinvolves time-sensitive actions, soread the entire procedure beforestarting. Otherwise, the device willtime out and the procedure will haveto be repeated.

To program up to three devices:

1. To verify that the garage dooropener is a Fixed Code unit,remove the battery cover on thehand-held transmitter suppliedby the manufacturer of thegarage door opener motor.If there is a row of dip switchessimilar to the graphic above, thegarage door opener is a FixedCode unit. If you do not see arow of dip switches, return to theprevious section forProgramming Universal HomeRemote — Rolling Code.

Your hand-held transmitter canhave between 8 to 12 dipswitches depending on thebrand of transmitter.

The garage door opener receiver(motor head unit) could alsohave a row of dip switches thatcan be used when programmingthe Universal Home Remote.If the total number of switcheson the motor head andhand-held transmitter aredifferent, or if the dip switchsettings are different, use the dipswitch settings on the motorhead unit to program theUniversal Home Remote. Themotor head dip switch settingscan also be used when theoriginal hand-held transmitter isnot available.

Page 177: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (55,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-55

Example of Eight Dip Switcheswith Two Positions

Example of Eight Dip Switcheswith Three Positions

The panel of switches might notappear exactly as they do in theexamples above, but theyshould be similar.

The switch positions on thehand-held transmitter could belabeled as follows:. A switch in the up position

could be labeled as Up,+, or On.

. A switch in the downposition could be labeled asDown, −, or Off.

. A switch in the middleposition could be labeled asMiddle, 0, or Neutral.

2. Write down the 8 to 12 switchsettings from left to right asfollows:. When a switch is in the up

position, write “Left.”. When a switch is in the

down position, write “Right.”. If a switch is set between

the up and down position,write “Middle.”

The switch settings writtendown in Step 2 nowbecome the button strokesto be entered into theUniversal Home Remote inStep 4. Be sure to enter theswitch settings written downin Step 2, in order from left

to right, into the UniversalHome Remote, whencompleting Step 4.

3. From inside your vehicle, firstfirmly press all three buttons atthe same time for aboutthree seconds. Release thebuttons to put the UniversalHome Remote intoprogramming mode.

A. Left Button (Up, +, or On)

B. Middle Button (Middle, 0,or Neutral)

Page 178: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (56,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-56 Instruments and Controls

C. Right Button (Down, −,or Off)

4. The indicator lights will blinkslowly. Enter each switch settingfrom Step 2 into your vehicle'sUniversal Home Remote. Youwill have two and one-halfminutes to complete Step 4. Nowpress one button on theUniversal Home Remote foreach switch setting as follows:. If you wrote “Left,” press

the left button (A) in thevehicle.

. If you wrote “Right,” pressthe right button (C) in thevehicle.

. If you wrote “Middle,” pressthe middle button (B) in thevehicle.

5. After entering all of the switchpositions, once again firmlypress and release all threebuttons at the same time. Theindicator lights will turn on.

6. Press and hold the button thatwill be used to control thegarage door until the garagedoor moves. The indicator lightabove the selected buttonshould slowly blink. This buttonmay need to be held for up to55 seconds.

7. Immediately release the buttonwhen the garage door moves.The indicator light will blinkrapidly until programming iscomplete.

8. Press and release the samebutton again. The garage doorshould move, confirming thatprogramming is successful andcomplete.

To program another Fixed Codedevice such as an additional garagedoor opener, a security device,or home automation device, repeatSteps 1-8, choosing a differentbutton in Step 6 than what was usedfor the garage door opener.

Universal Remote SystemOperationPress and hold the appropriatebutton for at least half of a second.The indicator light will come onwhile the signal is being transmitted.

Reprogramming UniversalHome Remote Buttons

Any of the three buttons can bereprogrammed by repeating theinstructions.

Page 179: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (57,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Instruments and Controls 5-57

Erasing Universal HomeRemote Buttons

The programmed buttons should beerased when the vehicle is sold orthe lease ends.

To erase either Rolling Code orFixed Code settings on theUniversal Home Remote device:

1. Press and hold the two outsidebuttons at the same time forapproximately 20 seconds, untilthe indicator lights, locateddirectly above the buttons, beginto blink rapidly.

2. Once the indicator lights begin toblink, release both buttons. Thecodes from all buttons will beerased.

For help or information on theUniversal Home Remote System,call the customer assistance phonenumber under Customer AssistanceOffices (U.S. and Canada) onpage 13‑5 or Customer AssistanceOffices (Mexico) on page 13‑5.

Page 180: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (58,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

5-58 Instruments and Controls

2 NOTES

Page 181: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Lighting 6-1

Lighting

Exterior LightingExterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . . 6-1Exterior Lamps OffReminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2

Headlamp High/Low-BeamChanger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2

Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2Daytime RunningLamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3

Automatic HeadlampSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3

Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . 6-5Turn and Lane-ChangeSignals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5

Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6AuxiliaryRoof-Mounted Lamp . . . . . . . . . 6-6

Interior LightingInstrument Panel IlluminationControl . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7

Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8

Lighting FeaturesEntry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8Battery Load Management . . . . 6-8Battery Power Protection . . . . . . 6-9

Exterior Lighting

Exterior Lamp Controls

The exterior lamp control is on theinstrument panel to the left of thesteering wheel.

There are four positions:

O (Off): Turns off the automaticheadlamps and Daytime RunningLamps (DRL). Turn the headlampcontrol to the off position again toturn the automatic headlamps orDRL back on.

For vehicles first sold in Canada,the off position will only work whenthe vehicle is shifted into P (Park).

Page 182: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

6-2 Lighting

AUTO (Automatic): Automaticallyturns on the headlamps at normalbrightness, together with thefollowing:. Parking Lamps. Instrument Panel Lights. Taillamps. License Plate Lamps

; (Parking Lamps): Turns on theparking lamps together with thefollowing:. Instrument Panel Lights. Taillamps. License Plate Lamps

2 (Headlamps): Turns on theheadlamps together with thefollowing lamps listed below.. Parking Lamps. Instrument Panel Lights. Taillamps. License Plate Lamps

When the headlamps are turned onwhile the vehicle is on, theheadlamps will turn off automatically10 minutes after the ignition isturned off. When the headlamps areturned on while the vehicle is off,the headlamps will stay on for10 minutes before automaticallyturning off to prevent the batteryfrom being drained. Turn theheadlamp control to off and thenback to the headlamp on position tomake the headlamps stay on for anadditional 10 minutes.

Exterior Lamps OffReminderA reminder chime will sound whenthe headlamps or parking lamps aremanually turned on and the ignitionis off and a door is open. To disablethe chime, turn the light off.

Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer53 (Headlamp High/Low BeamChanger): To change theheadlamps from low to high beam,push the turn signal lever toward theinstrument panel. To return tolow-beam headlamps, pull the levertoward you. Then release it.

When the high beams are on, thisindicator light on the instrumentcluster will also be on.

Flash-to-PassThis feature lets you use thehigh-beam headlamps to signal adriver in front of you that you wantto pass. It works even if theheadlamps are in the automaticposition.

Page 183: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Lighting 6-3

To use it, pull the turn signal levertoward you, then release it.

If the headlamps are in theautomatic position or on low beam,the high-beam headlamps will turnon. They will stay on as long as youhold the lever toward you. Thehigh-beam indicator on theinstrument cluster will come on.Release the lever to return tonormal operation.

Daytime RunningLamps (DRL)Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) canmake it easier for others to see thefront of your vehicle during the day.Fully functional daytime runninglamps are required on all vehiclesfirst sold in Canada.

The DRL system comes on whenthe following conditions are met:. The ignition is on.. The exterior lamp control is

in AUTO.

. The transmission is not in Park.

. The light sensor determines it isdaytime.

When the DRL system is on, onlythe DRL lamps are on. Thetaillamps, sidemarker, instrumentpanel lights, and other lamps will notbe on.

When it begins to get dark, theautomatic headlamp systemswitches from DRL to theheadlamps.

To turn off the DRL lamps, turn theexterior lamp control to the OFFposition and then release. Forvehicles first sold in Canada, thetransmission must be in the P (Park)position before the DRL lamps canbe turned off.

Automatic HeadlampSystemWhen it is dark enough outside, theautomatic headlamp system turnson the headlamps at the normalbrightness, along with the taillamps,

sidemarker, parking lamps, and theinstrument panel lights. The radiolights will also be dim.

To turn off the automatic headlampsystem, turn the exterior lampsswitch to the off position and thenrelease it. For vehicles first sold inCanada, the transmission must bein the P (Park) position before theautomatic headlamp system can beturned off.

The vehicle has a light sensorlocated on the top of the instrumentpanel which regulates when theautomatic headlamps turn on. Donot cover the sensor, otherwise theheadlamps will come on wheneverthe ignition is on.

Page 184: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

6-4 Lighting

The system may also turn on theheadlamps when driving through aparking garage or heavy overcastweather. This is normal.

There is a delay in the transitionbetween the daytime and nighttimeoperation of the Daytime RunningLamps (DRL) and the automaticheadlamp systems so that drivingunder bridges or bright overheadstreet lights does not affect thesystem. The DRL and automaticheadlamp system are only affectedwhen the light sensor detects achange in lighting lasting longerthan the delay.

If the vehicle is started in a darkgarage, the automatic headlampsystem comes on immediately.Once the vehicle leaves the garage,it takes approximately one minutefor the automatic headlamp systemto change to DRL if it is brightenough outside. During that delay,the instrument cluster may not be asbright as usual. Make sure theinstrument panel brightness control

is in the full bright position. SeeInstrument Panel IlluminationControl on page 6‑7.

To idle the vehicle with theautomatic headlamp system off, turnthe control to the off position.

The headlamps will also stay onafter you exit the vehicle. Thisfeature can be programmed usingthe Driver Information Center (DIC).See Vehicle Personalization (WithDIC Buttons) on page 5‑44.

If the vehicle is not equipped withDIC buttons, exit lighting isautomatic. When it is dark enoughoutside, the exterior lamps remainon for 30 seconds after the ignitionis moved from ON/RUN toLOCK/OFF.

For vehicles without a radio, theinstrument panel light remains on for30 seconds with the driver doorclosed. For vehicles with a radio,the instrument panel light remainson for 10 minutes with the driver

door closed. See RetainedAccessory Power (RAP) onpage 9‑24.

The regular headlamp system canbe turned on when needed.

Lights On with Wipers

If the windshield wipers areactivated in daylight with the engineon, and the exterior lamp control isin AUTO, the headlamps, parkinglamps, and other exterior lampscome on. The transition time for thelamps coming on varies based onwiper speed. When the wipers arenot operating, these lamps turn off.Move the exterior lamp control toPor; to disable this feature.

Page 185: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Lighting 6-5

Hazard Warning Flashers

| (Hazard Warning Flashers):Press this button to make the frontand rear turn signal lamps flash onand off. Press again to turn theflashers off.

When the hazard warning flashersare on, the vehicle's turn signals willnot work.

Turn and Lane-ChangeSignals

Move the lever all the way up ordown to signal a turn.

An arrow on the instrument clusterflashes in the direction of the turn orlane change.

Raise or lower the lever for lessthan one second until the arrowstarts to flash to signal a lanechange. This causes the turnsignals to automatically flash threetimes. It will flash six times iftow-haul mode is active. Holding theturn signal lever for more than

one second will cause the turnsignals to flash until you release thelever.

The lever returns to its startingposition whenever it is released.

If after signaling a turn or a lanechange the arrows flash rapidly ordo not come on, a signal bulb maybe burned out.

Have any burned out bulbsreplaced. If a bulb is not burned out,check the fuse. See Fuses andCircuit Breakers on page 10‑33.

Turn Signal On Chime

If the turn signal is left on for morethan 1.2 km (0.75 mi), a chime willsound at each flash of the turnsignal and the message TURNSIGNAL ON will also appear in theDriver Information Control (DIC). Toturn the chime and message off,move the turn signal lever to the offposition.

Page 186: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

6-6 Lighting

Fog Lamps

For vehicles with fog lamps, thecontrol is located next to the exteriorlamp control on the instrumentpanel, to the left of the steeringcolumn.

The ignition must be in the ON/RUNposition for the fog lamps tocome on.

# (Fog Lamps): Press to turn thefog lamps on or off. A light will comeon in the instrument cluster.

When the fog lamps are turned on,the parking lamps automaticallyturn on.

When the headlamps are changedto high beam, the fog lamps also gooff. When the high-beam headlampsare turned off, the fog lamps willcome on again.

Some localities have laws thatrequire the headlamps to be on withthe fog lamps.

AuxiliaryRoof-Mounted LampIf the vehicle has this feature, thisbutton includes wiring provisions fora dealer or a qualified service centerto install an auxiliary roof lamp.

This button is on the overheadconsole.

When the wiring is connected to anauxiliary roof-mounted lamp,pressing the bottom of the buttonwill activate the lamp and illuminatean indicator light at the bottom ofthis button. Pressing the top of thebutton will turn off the roof-mountedlamp and indicator.

The emergency roof lamp circuit isfused at 30 amps, so the totalcurrent draw of the attached lampsshould be less than this value. Theattachment points for the roof lampcircuits are two blunt cut wireslocated above the overheadconsole, a dark green switchedpower wire and a black ground wire.

For more information on roof mountemergency lamp installation, pleasevisit the GM Upfitter website atwww.gmupfitter.com or contact yourdealer.

If the vehicle has this button, thevehicle may have the snow plowprep package. See Adding a SnowPlow or Similar Equipment onpage 9‑78.

Page 187: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Lighting 6-7

Interior Lighting

Instrument PanelIllumination Control

D (Instrument PanelBrightness): This feature controlsthe brightness of the instrumentpanel lights and is located next tothe exterior lamps control.

Push the knob to extend out andthen it can be turned.

Turn the knob clockwise orcounterclockwise to brighten or dimthe instrument panel lights. Turningthe knob to the farthest clockwiseposition turns on the dome lamps.

Dome LampsThe dome lamps are located in theoverhead console.

They come on when any door isopened and turn off after all thedoors are closed.

Turn the instrument panelbrightness knob located below thedome lamp override button,clockwise to the farthest position tomanually turn on the dome lamps.The dome lamps remain on until theknob is turned counterclockwise.

Dome Lamp Override

The dome lamp override button islocated next to the exterior lampscontrol.

k (Dome Off): Press the buttonin and the dome lamps remain offwhen a door is opened. Press thebutton again to return it to theextended position so that the domelamps come on when a door isopened.

Page 188: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

6-8 Lighting

Reading LampsFor vehicles with reading lampsthey are located on the overheadconsole.

To turn on the reading lamps, pressthe button located next to eachlamp. To turn them off, press thebutton again.

The vehicle may also have readinglamps in other locations. To turn thelamps on or off, press the buttonlocated next to the lamp.

The lamps are fixed and cannot beadjusted.

Lighting Features

Entry LightingThe vehicle has an illuminated entryfeature.

When the doors are opened, thedome lamps will come on if thedome override button is in theextended position. If the domeoverride button is pressed in, thelamps will not come on.

Exit LightingThe interior lamps come on whenthe key is removed from the ignition.They turn off automatically in20 seconds. The lights do not comeon if the dome override button ispressed in.

Battery LoadManagementThe vehicle has Electric PowerManagement (EPM) that estimatesthe battery's temperature and stateof charge. It then adjusts the voltagefor best performance and extendedlife of the battery.

When the battery's state of chargeis low, the voltage is raised slightlyto quickly bring the charge back up.When the state of charge is high,the voltage is lowered slightly toprevent overcharging. If the vehiclehas a voltmeter gauge or a voltagedisplay on the Driver InformationCenter (DIC), you may see thevoltage move up or down. This isnormal. If there is a problem, analert will be displayed.

The battery can be discharged atidle if the electrical loads are veryhigh. This is true for all vehicles.This is because the generator(alternator) may not be spinning fast

Page 189: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Lighting 6-9

enough at idle to produce all thepower that is needed for very highelectrical loads.

A high electrical load occurs whenseveral of the following are on, suchas: headlamps, high beams, foglamps, rear window defogger,climate control fan at high speed,heated seats, engine cooling fans,trailer loads, and loads plugged intoaccessory power outlets.

EPM works to prevent excessivedischarge of the battery. It does thisby balancing the generator's outputand the vehicle's electrical needs.It can increase engine idle speed togenerate more power, wheneverneeded. It can temporarily reducethe power demands of someaccessories.

Normally, these actions occur insteps or levels, without beingnoticeable. In rare cases at thehighest levels of corrective action,this action may be noticeable to thedriver. If so, a Driver InformationCenter (DIC) message might be

displayed, such as BATTERY LOWSTART VEHICLE. If this messagedisplays, it is recommended that thedriver reduce the electrical loads asmuch as possible and restart thevehicle. See Battery Voltage andCharging Messages on page 5‑35.

Battery Power ProtectionThis feature shuts off the dome andreading lamps if they are left on formore than 10 minutes when theignition is off. This will keep thebattery from running down.

Page 190: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

6-10 Lighting

2 NOTES

Page 191: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-1

InfotainmentSystem

IntroductionInfotainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . 7-2Overview (Radio withCD (MP3)) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3

Overview (Radio with USB, CD,and DVD (MP3)) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5

Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6

RadioAM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14Rear Side WindowAntenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15

Satellite Radio Antenna . . . . . . 7-16

Audio PlayersCD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16CD/DVD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-21Auxiliary Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-31

Rear Seat InfotainmentRear Seat Entertainment(RSE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-36

Rear Seat Audio (RSA)System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-46

PhoneBluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-48

Trademarks and LicenseAgreementsTrademarks and LicenseAgreements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-55

Introduction

InfotainmentRead the following pages tobecome familiar with the audiosystem's features.

{ WARNING

Taking your eyes off the road forextended periods could cause acrash resulting in injury or deathto you or others. Do not giveextended attention to infotainmenttasks while driving.

This system provides access tomany audio and non audio listings.

To minimize taking your eyes off theroad while driving, do the followingwhile the vehicle is parked:. Become familiar with the

operation and controls of theaudio system.

Page 192: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-2 Infotainment System

. Set up the tone, speakeradjustments, and preset radiostations.

For more information, see DefensiveDriving on page 9‑3.

This vehicle's audio system may beequipped with a noise reductionsystem which can work improperly ifthe audio amplifier, enginecalibrations, exhaust system,microphones, radio, or speakers aremodified or replaced. This couldresult in more noticeable enginenoise at certain speeds.

Notice: Contact your dealerbefore adding any equipment.

Adding audio or communicationequipment could interfere withthe operation of the engine, radio,or other systems, and coulddamage them. Follow federalrules covering mobile radio andtelephone equipment.

The vehicle has RetainedAccessory Power (RAP). With RAP,the audio system can be playedeven after the ignition is turned off.See Retained Accessory Power(RAP) on page 9‑24 for moreinformation.

Navigation/Radio System

For vehicles with a navigation radiosystem, see the separate NavigationSystem manual.

Theft-Deterrent FeatureTheftLock® is designed todiscourage theft of the vehicle'sradio by learning a portion of theVehicle Identification Number (VIN).The radio does not operate if it isstolen or moved to a differentvehicle.

Page 193: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-3

Overview (Radio with CD (MP3))

Overview (Radio with CD (MP3))

A. 4 (Information)

. Press to show informationon the current station ortrack.

B. FAV (Favorites Pages). Press to scroll through the

favorite pages.

C. MENU. Press to open the tone

menu to adjust the bass,midrange, treble, fade, andbalance.

D. Buttons 1 - 6. Saves and selects favorite

stations.

E. EQ (Equalizer). Press to adjust the

equalizer.

F. f (Tone/Tune)

. Press to set the bass ortreble.

. Turn to manually selectradio stations.

G. CAT (Category). Press to display a list of

XM categories.

H. H (Clock)

. Press to set the clock.

Page 194: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-4 Infotainment System

I. BAND. Press to scroll through the

available bands AM, FM,or XM if equipped.

J. © SEEK

. Seeks the previous station.

K. ¨ SEEK

. Seeks the next station.

L. P (Power/Volume)

. Press to turn theinfotainment system onor off.

. Turn to adjust the volume.

M. s REV (Reverse)

. Press to and hold to gobackward fast through atrack.

N. \ FWD (Forward)

. Press to and hold to fastforward through a track.

O. CD/AUX. Press to scroll through

selecting the CD or aauxiliary device.

P. Z Eject

. Press to eject theloaded CD.

Page 195: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-5

Overview (Radio with USB, CD, and DVD (MP3))

Overview (Radio with USB, CD, and DVD (MP3))

A. 4 (Information)

. Press to show informationon the current station ortrack.

B. FAV (Favorites Pages). Press to scroll through the

favorite pages.

C. MENU. Press to open the tone

menu to adjust the bass,midrange, treble, fade, andbalance.

D. DVD Slot

E. Buttons 1 - 6. Saves and selects favorite

stations.

F. EQ (Equalizer). Press to adjust the

equalizer settings.

G. f (Tone/Tune)

. Press to set the bass ortreble.

. Turn to manually selectradio stations.

H. Z DVD

. Press to eject theloaded DVD.

Page 196: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-6 Infotainment System

I. CAT (Category). Press to display a list of

XM categories.

J. H (Clock)

. Press to set the clock.

K. BAND. Press to scroll through the

available bands AM, FM,or XM if equipped.

L. © SEEK

. Seeks the previous station.

M. ¨ SEEK

. Seeks the next station.

N. P (Power/Volume)

. Press to turn theinfotainment system onor off.

. Turn to adjust the volume.

O. CD Slot

P. s REV (Reverse)

. Press to and hold to gobackward fast through atrack.

Q. \ FWD (Forward)

. Press to and hold to fastforward through a track.

R. Z CD

. Press to eject theloaded CD.

S. DVD/CD/AUX. Press to scroll through

selecting the DVD, CD,or an auxiliary device.

OperationVehicles with a USB, CD, and DVDradio have a Bose® SurroundSound System. Some of its featuresare explained later in this sectionunder, “Adjusting the Speakers(Balance/Fade).”

Vehicles with a USB, CD, and DVDradio may have a Rear SeatEntertainment (RSE) system. SeeRear Seat Entertainment (RSE)System on page 7‑36 for moreinformation on the vehicle's RSEsystem.

The DVD player is the top slot onthe radio faceplate. The player iscapable of reading the DTSprogrammed DVD Audio or DVDVideo media, (DTS and DTS DigitalSurround are registered trademarksof Digital Theater Systems, Inc.).

Manufactured under license fromDolby Laboratories. Dolby and thedouble-D symbol are trademarks ofDolby Laboratories.

Using the Radio

O (Power/Volume): Press to turnthe system on and off.

Turn clockwise or counterclockwiseto increase or decrease the volume.

Page 197: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-7

4 (Information) (If Available):Press to switch the display betweenthe radio station frequency and thetime. While the ignition is off, pressthis button to display the time. Pressto display additional text informationrelated to the current FM-RDS orXM station; or CD, MP3, or WMAsong. If information is availableduring XM, CD, MP3, or WMAplayback, the song title informationdisplays on the top line of thedisplay and artist informationdisplays on the bottom line. Wheninformation is not available, “NOINFO” displays.

Speed Compensated Volume(SCV): Radios with SpeedCompensated Volume (SCV)automatically adjusts the radiovolume to compensate for road andwind noise as the vehicle's speedchanges while driving, so that thevolume level stays consistent.

To activate SCV:

1. Set the radio volume to thedesired level.

2. Press the MENU button todisplay the radio setup menu.

3. Press the softkey under theAUTO VOLUM (automaticvolume) tab on the radio display.

4. Press the softkey under thedesired Speed CompensatedVolume setting (OFF, Low, Med,or High) to select the level ofradio volume compensation. Thedisplay times out afterapproximately 10 seconds. Eachhigher setting allows for moreradio volume compensation atfaster vehicle speeds.

Noise CompensationTechnology: Vehicles with the LTZpackage and a Bose Audio Systeminclude the Bose AudioPilot® noisecompensation technology. Whenturned on, AudioPilot continuouslyadjusts the audio systemequalization, to compensate forbackground noise, so that musicalways sounds the same at the setvolume level.

This feature is most effective atlower radio volume settings wherebackground noise can affect howwell the music is heard. At highervolume settings, where the music ismuch louder than the backgroundnoise, there might be little or noadjustments by AudioPilot.

To activate:

1. Set the radio volume to thedesired level.

2. Press the MENU button todisplay the radio setup menu.

3. Press the softkey under theAUTO VOLUM (automaticvolume) tab on the radio display.

4. Press the softkey under the ONtab. The display times out afterapproximately 10 seconds.

For additional information onAudioPilot, please visitwww.bose.com/audiopilot.

Page 198: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-8 Infotainment System

Setting the Tone (Bass/Midrange/Treble)

BASS/MID/TREB (Bass, Midrange,or Treble): To adjust the bass,midrange, or treble:

1. Press the f knob until the tonecontrol tabs display.

2. Highlight the desired tonecontrol tab by doing one of thefollowing:

. Pressing the f knob.

. Press the softkey under thedesired tab.

3. Adjust the setting by doing oneof the following:

. Turn the f knob clockwiseor counterclockwise.

. Press the ¨ SEEK, or ©SEEK button.

. Press the\ FWD, orsREV button.

If a station's frequency is weak or ifthere is static, decrease the treble.

To quickly adjust bass, midrange,or treble to the middle position,press the softkey positioned underthe BASS, MID, or TREB tab formore than two seconds. A beepsounds and the level adjusts to themiddle position.

To quickly adjust all tone andspeaker controls to the middleposition, press the f knob for morethan two seconds until a beepsounds.

EQ (Equalization): Press thisbutton to choose bass and trebleequalization settings designed fordifferent types of music. SelectingMANUAL or changing bass ortreble, returns the EQ to the manualbass and treble settings.

Unique EQ settings can be savedfor each source.

If the radio has a Bose audiosystem, the EQ settings are eitherMANUAL or TALK.

Digital Signal Processing (DSP):Press the EQ button to change theDSP settings (only available onBose systems with the LTZ optionpackage). DSP settings provide achoice of different listeningexperiences.

The following DSP settings areavailable:. Normal — Select this setting to

adjust the audio for normalmode. This provides the bestsound quality for all seatingpositions.

. Driver — Select this setting toadjust the audio for the driver toreceive the best possible soundquality.

. Rear — Select this setting toadjust the audio for the rear seatpassengers to receive the bestpossible sound quality.

Page 199: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-9

. Surround (Centerpoint®) —Select this setting to enableBose Centerpoint. Centerpointsignal processing produces asurround sound listeningexperience from a CD or XMstereo digital audio source.Centerpoint delivers fiveindependent audio channelsfrom conventional two channelstereo recordings. (Not availablefor AM or FM.)

Adjusting the Speakers(Balance/Fade)

BAL/FADE (Balance/Fade): Toadjust the balance or fade:

1. Press the f knob until thespeaker control tabs display.

2. Highlight the desired speakercontrol tab by doing one of thefollowing:

. Pressing the f knob.

. Press the softkey under thedesired tab.

3. Adjust the setting by doing oneof the following:

. Turn the f knob clockwiseor counterclockwise.

. Press the ¨ SEEK, or ©SEEK button.

. Press the\ FWD, orsREV button.

To quickly adjust all speaker andtone controls to the middle position,press the f knob for more thantwo seconds.

If the Rear Seat Audio (RSA) isturned on, the radio disables FADEand mutes the rear speakers.

Radio Messages

Calibration Error: The audiosystem has been calibrated for thevehicle from the factory.If Calibration Error displays, itmeans that the radio has not beenconfigured properly for the vehicleand it must be returned to yourdealer for service.

Locked or Loc: One of thesemessages will display when theTheftLock® system has locked upthe radio. Take the vehicle to yourdealer for service.

If any error occurs repeatedly or ifan error cannot be corrected,contact your dealer.

Page 200: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-10 Infotainment System

Radio

AM-FM Radio

Radio Data System (RDS)

For radios with the Radio DataSystem (RDS) feature, it only workswith FM stations that broadcastRDS information. This system reliesupon receiving specific informationfrom these stations and only workswhen the information is available.While the radio is tuned to anFM-RDS station, the station nameor call letters displays. In rarecases, a radio station couldbroadcast incorrect information thatcauses the radio features to workimproperly. If this happens, contactthe radio station.

4 (Information) (RDS Features):For vehicles with RDS features,press 4 to display additional textinformation related to the currentFM-RDS station. If information isavailable, the song title informationdisplays on the top line of the

display and artist informationdisplays on the bottom line. Wheninformation is not available, “NOINFO” displays.

Finding a Station

BAND: Press to switch betweenAM, FM, or XM™, if equipped.

f (Tune): Turn to manually selectradio stations.

© SEEK: Press to seek theprevious radio station. Press andhold for a few seconds until a beepsounds to scan for radio stations indescending order, press the ©SEEK button again to stop scanningradio stations. The radio only seeksand scans stations with a strongsignal that are in the selected band.

¨ SEEK: Press to seek the nextradio station. Press and hold for afew seconds until a beep sounds toscan for radio stations in ascendingorder, press the ¨ SEEK buttonagain to stop scanning radio

stations. The radio only seeks andscans stations with a strong signalthat are in the selected band.

s REV: Press to manually tune toa radio station in descending order.

\ FWD: Press to manually tune toa radio station in ascending order.

FAV (Favorites): Press to selectdifferent favorite pages for storedradio stations.

Storing Radio Stations

Drivers are encouraged to storeradio station while the vehicle isparked, see Defensive Driving onpage 9‑3. Tune to stored radiostations using the presets, favoritesbutton, and steering wheel controls,if the vehicle has this feature.

Up to 36 stations can beprogrammed as favorites using thesixbutton. Press the FAV button togo through up to six pages offavorites, each having six favoritestations available per page. Each

Page 201: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-11

page of favorites can contain anycombination of AM, FM, or XM,if equipped, stations.

Storing a Radio Station as aFavorite

To store a station as a favorite:

1. Tune to a radio station.

2. Press the FAV button to displaythe page where the station willbe stored.

3. Press and hold one of thesix softkeys until a beep sounds.

4. Repeat Steps 1 through 3 tostore additional radio stations.

The number of favorites pages canbe setup using the MENU button. Tosetup the number of favoritespages:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Press the softkey located belowthe FAV 1-6 tab.

3. Select the number of favoritespages by pressing the softkeylocated below the displayedpage numbers.

4. Press the FAV button, or let themenu time out, to return to theoriginal main radio screenshowing the radio stationfrequency tabs and to begin theprocess of programmingfavorites.

Satellite Radio

SiriusXM® Satellite RadioService

SiriusXM is a satellite radio servicethat is based in the 48 contiguousUnited States and 10 Canadianprovinces. SiriusXM Satellite Radiohas a wide variety of programmingand commercial-free music,coast-to-coast, and in digital-qualitysound. A service fee is required toreceive the SiriusXM service. If theservice needs to be reactivated, theradio will display “No SubscriptionPlease Renew on channel XM1.”

For more information, contactSiriusXM at www.siriusxm.com orcall 1-866-635-2349 (U.S) andwww.xmradio.ca or call1-877-209-0079 (Canada).

4 (Information) (SiriusXM SatelliteRadio Service): For vehicles withSiriusXM, press 4 to displayadditional text information related tothe current SiriusXM channel.If information is available, the songtitle information displays on the topline of the display and artistinformation displays on the bottomline. When information is notavailable, “NO INFO” displays.

Finding a Channel

BAND: Press to switch betweenAM, FM, or SiriusXM, if equipped.

f (Tune): Turn to manually selectan SiriusXM channel.

© SEEK: Press to go to theprevious SiriusXM channel.

¨ SEEK: Press to go to the nextSiriusXM channel.

Page 202: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-12 Infotainment System

s REV: Press to go to theprevious SiriusXM category.

\ FWD: Press to go to the nextSiriusXM category.

FAV (Favorites): Press to selectdifferent favorites pages for storedradio stations.

CAT (Category): The CAT button isused to find SiriusXM channelswhen the radio is in the XM mode.

Finding a Category (CAT)Station

To find XM channels in a category:

1. Press the CAT button to displaythe category tabs. Continuepressing the CAT button until thedesired category name displays.. Radios with CD and DVD

can also navigate thecategory list by pressing the\ FWD or thes REVbuttons.

2. Press either of the two softkeysbelow the desired category tabto immediately tune to the firstSiriusXM station in that category.

To go to the previous or nextSiriusXM station in the selectedcategory, do one of thefollowing:

. Turn the f knob.

. Press the softkey below theright or left arrows in thecategory tab.

. Press © SEEK or ¨ SEEK.

3. To exit the category searchmode, press the FAV button orBAND button to display thefavorites again.

Adding and Removing Categories

Categories cannot be added orremoved while the vehicle is movingfaster than 8 km/h (5 mph).

To add or remove a category:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Press the softkey located belowthe XM CAT tab.

3. Turn the f knob to display thecategory to add or remove.

4. Press the softkey located underthe Add or Remove tab.

To restore all removedcategories, press the softkeyunder the Restore All tab.

5. Repeat the steps to removemore categories.

Storing SiriusXM Channels

Drivers are encouraged to storeSiriusXM channels while the vehicleis parked; see Defensive Driving onpage 9‑3. Tune to stored radiostations using the presets, favoritesbutton, and steering wheel controls,if the vehicle has this feature.

Up to 36 stations can beprogrammed as favorites using thesix softkeys below the radio stationfrequency tabs and by using theFAV button. Press the FAV button togo through up to six pages of

Page 203: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-13

favorites, each having six favoritestations available per page. Eachpage of favorites can contain anycombination of AM, FM,or SiriusXM, if equipped, stations.

Storing an SiriusXM Channel as aFavorite

To store a station as a favorite:

1. Tune to an SiriusXM channel.

2. Press the FAV button to displaythe page where the station willbe stored.

3. Press and hold one of the sixsoftkeys until a beep sounds.

4. Repeat Steps 1 through 3 tostore additional radio stations.

The number of favorites pages canbe set up using the MENU button.To set up the number of favoritespages:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Press the softkey located belowthe FAV 1-6 tab.

3. Select the number of favoritespages by pressing the softkeylocated below the displayedpage numbers.

4. Press the FAV button, or let themenu time out, to return to theoriginal main radio screenshowing the radio stationfrequency tabs and to begin theprocess of programmingfavorites.

SiriusXM Radio Messages

XL (Explicit LanguageChannels): These channels, or anyothers, can be blocked at acustomer's request, by calling1-866-635-2349 (US) or1-877-209-0079 (Canada).

XM Updating: The encryption codein the receiver is being updated, andno action is required. This processshould take no longer than30 seconds.

No XM Signal: The system isfunctioning correctly, but the vehicleis in a location that is blocking the

SiriusXM signal. When the vehicle ismoved into an open area, the signalshould return.

Loading XM: The audio system isacquiring and processing audio andtext data. No action is needed. Thismessage should disappear shortly.

Channel Off Air: This channel isnot currently in service. Tune in toanother channel.

Channel Unauth: This channel isblocked or cannot be received withyour SiriusXM subscription package.

Channel Unavail: This previouslyassigned channel is no longerassigned. Tune to another station.If this station was one of thepresets, choose another station forthat preset button.

No Artist Info: No artistinformation is available at this timeon this channel. The system isworking properly.

Page 204: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-14 Infotainment System

No Title Info: No song titleinformation is available at this timeon this channel. The system isworking properly.

No CAT Info: No categoryinformation is available at this timeon this channel. The system isworking properly.

No Information: No text orinformational messages areavailable at this time on thischannel. The system is workingproperly.

No Subscription Please Renew:The SiriusXM subscription needs tobe reactivated. Contact SiriusXM atwww.siriusxm.com or call1-866-635-2349 (U.S) andwww.xmradio.ca or call1-877-209-0079 (Canada).

CAT Not Found: There are nochannels available for the selectedcategory. The system is workingproperly.

XM Theftlocked: The SiriusXMreceiver in the vehicle could havepreviously been in another vehicle.For security purposes, SiriusXMreceivers cannot be swappedbetween vehicles. If this message isreceived after having the vehicleserviced, check with your dealer.

XM Radio ID: If tuned to channel 0,this message alternates with theSiriusXM Radio eight-digit radio IDlabel. This label is needed toactivate the service.

Unknown: If this message isreceived when tuned to channel 0,there could be a receiver fault.Consult with your dealer.

Check Antenna: If this messagedoes not clear within a short periodof time, the receiver or antennacould have a fault. Consult with yourdealer.

Check XM Receiver: If thismessage does not clear within ashort period of time, the receivercould have a fault. Consult with yourdealer.

XM Not Available: If this messagedoes not clear within a short periodof time, the receiver could have afault. Consult with your dealer.

Radio ReceptionFrequency interference and staticcan occur during normal radioreception if items such as cell phonechargers, vehicle convenienceaccessories, and external electronicdevices are plugged into theaccessory power outlet. If there isinterference or static, unplug theitem from the accessory poweroutlet.

AM

The range for most AM stations isgreater than for FM, especially atnight. The longer range can causestation frequencies to interfere witheach other. For better radioreception, most AM radio stationsboost the power levels during theday, and then reduce these levelsduring the night. Static can alsooccur when things like storms and

Page 205: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (15,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-15

power lines interfere with radioreception. When this happens, tryreducing the treble on the radio.

FM Stereo

FM signals only reach about16 to 65 km (10 to 40 mi). Althoughthe radio has a built-in electroniccircuit that automatically works toreduce interference, some static canoccur, especially around tallbuildings or hills, causing the soundto fade in and out.

SiriusXM® Satellite RadioService

SiriusXM Satellite Radio Servicegives digital radio reception fromcoast to coast in the 48 contiguousUnited States, and in Canada. Justas with FM, tall buildings or hills caninterfere with satellite radio signals,causing the sound to fade in andout. In addition, traveling or standingunder heavy foliage, bridges,garages, or tunnels may cause lossof the SiriusXM signal for a periodof time.

Cellular Phone Usage

Cellular phone usage may causeinterference with the vehicle's radio.This interference may occur whenmaking or receiving phone calls,charging the phone's battery,or simply having the phone on. Thisinterference causes an increasedlevel of static while listening to theradio. If static is received whilelistening to the radio, unplug thecellular phone and turn it off.

Rear Side WindowAntennaThe AM-FM antenna is located inthe passenger rear side windows.Make sure the inside surfaces of therear side windows are not scratchedand that the lines on the glass arenot damaged. If the inside surfacesare damaged, they could interferewith radio reception.

If a cellular telephone antennaneeds to be attached to the glass,make sure that the grid lines for theAM-FM antenna are not damaged.

There is enough space between thegrid lines to attach a cellulartelephone antenna withoutinterfering with radio reception.

Notice: Using a razor blade orsharp object to clear the inside ofthe rear side windows may affectradio reception or damage therear side window antenna.Repairs would not be covered bythe warranty. Do not clear theinside of the rear side windowswith sharp objects.

Notice: Do not apply aftermarketglass tinting with metallic film.The metallic film in some tintingmaterials will interfere with ordistort the incoming radioreception. Any damage caused tothe antenna due to metallic tintingmaterials will not be covered bythe warranty.

Page 206: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (16,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-16 Infotainment System

Satellite Radio AntennaThe XM Satellite Radio antenna islocated on the roof of the vehicle.Keep the antenna clear ofobstructions for clear radioreception.

If the vehicle has a sunroof, theperformance of the XM system (ifequipped) may be affected if thesunroof is open.

Audio Players

CD Player

Care of the CD Player

Do not add any label to a CD.It could get caught in the CD. If aCD is recorded on a personalcomputer and a description label isneeded, try labeling the top of therecorded CD with a marking pen.

The use of CD lens cleaners forCDs is not advised, due to the riskof contaminating the lens of the CDoptics with lubricants internal to theCD player mechanism.

Notice: If a label is added to aCD, more than one CD is insertedinto the slot at a time, or anattempt is made to play scratchedor damaged CDs, the CD playercould be damaged. While usingthe CD player, use only CDs ingood condition without any label,load one CD at a time, and keep

the CD player and the loading slotfree of foreign materials, liquids,and debris.

If an error displays, see “CD PlayerMessages” later in this section.

Care of CDs

If playing a CD-R, the sound qualitycan be reduced due to CD-R orCD-RW quality, the method ofrecording, the quality of the musicthat has been recorded, and theway the CD-R or CD-RW has beenhandled. Handle them carefully.Store CD-R(s) or CD-RW(s) in theiroriginal cases or other protectivecases and away from direct sunlightand dust. The CD player scans thebottom surface of the disc. If thesurface of a CD is damaged, suchas cracked, broken, or scratched,the CD does not play properly or notat all. Do not touch the bottom sideof a CD while handling it; this coulddamage the surface. Pick up CDsby grasping the outer edges or theedge of the hole and the outer edge.

Page 207: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (17,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-17

If the surface of a CD is soiled,clean it with a soft, lint free cloth ordampen a clean, soft cloth in a mild,neutral detergent solution mixedwith water. Make sure the wipingprocess starts from the center tothe edge.

Inserting a CD

Insert a CD partway into the slot,label side up. The player pulls it inand the CD should begin playing.

Ejecting a CD

Z EJECT: Press and release toeject the disc. Remove the CDwhen Remove Disc displays. If thedisc is not removed, after severalseconds, the disc is automaticallypulled back into the player.

Playing a CD

If the ignition or radio is turned off,with a CD in the player, it stays inthe player. When the ignition orradio is turned on, the CD startsplaying where it stopped, if it wasthe last selected audio source. The

CD is controlled by the buttons onthe radio faceplate or by the RSAunit. See Rear Seat Audio (RSA)System on page 7‑46 for moreinformation.

When a CD is inserted, the CDsymbol displays on the left side ofthe radio display. As each new trackstarts to play, the track numberdisplays.

The CD player can play the smaller8 cm (3 inch) single CDs with anadapter ring. Full-size CDs and thesmaller CDs are loaded in the samemanner.

CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press tocycle through CD or Auxiliary whenlistening to the radio. The CD iconand a message showing the discand/or track number displays whena CD is in the player. Press againand the system automaticallysearches for an auxiliary inputdevice, see, Auxiliary Devices onpage 7‑31 for more information. If a

portable audio player is notconnected, “No Input Device Found”displays.

4 (Information): Press to displayadditional text information related tothe current song. If information isavailable, the song title informationdisplays on the top line of thedisplay and artist informationdisplays on the bottom line. Wheninformation is not available, “NOINFO” displays.

f (Tune): Turn to select tracks onthe CD that is currently playing.

© SEEK: Press to go to the start ofthe current track, if more than tenseconds on the CD have played.

Press to go to the previous track ifless than ten seconds on the CDhave played.

Press and hold, or press multipletimes to continue moving backwardthrough the tracks on the CD.

¨ SEEK: Press to go to the nexttrack.

Page 208: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (18,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-18 Infotainment System

Press and hold, or press multipletimes to continue moving forwardthrough the tracks on the CD.

s REV (Fast Reverse): Pressand hold to reverse playback quicklywithin a track.

\ FWD (Fast Forward): Pressand hold to advance playbackquickly within a track.

RDM (Random): Press to listen totracks in random, rather thansequential order. To use random:

1. Press the softkey positionedunder the RDM tab until RandomCurrent Disc displays.

2. Press the softkey again to turnoff random play.

MP3 Supported Files

The Radio with CD (MP3) and theRadio with USB and CD (MP3),have the capability of playing anMP3 CD-R or CD-RW disc.

Format

Radios that have the capability ofplaying MP3s can play .mp3 or .wmafiles that were recorded onto aCD-R or CD-RW disc. The files canbe recorded with the following fixedbit rates: 32 kbps, 40 kbps, 56 kbps,64 kbps, 80 kbps, 96 kbps, 112 kbps,128 kbps, 160 kbps, 192 kbps,224 kbps, 256 kbps, and 320 kbps ora variable bit rate.

Compressed Audio or Mixed ModeDiscs

The radio can play discs thatcontain both uncompressed CDaudio and MP3 files. If both formatsare on the disc, the radio reads allMP3 files first, then theuncompressed CD audio files.

CD‐R or CD‐RW Supported Fileand Folder Structure

The radio supports:. Up to 50 folders.. Up to eight folders in depth.. Up to 50 playlists.

. Up to 255 files.

. Playlists with an .m3u or .wplextension.

. Files with an .mp3, .wma, or .cdafile extension.

Root Directory

The root directory is treated as afolder. Files are stored in the rootdirectory when the disc or storagedevice does not contain folders.Files accessed from the rootdirectory of a CD display asF1 ROOT.

Empty Folder

Folders that do not contain files areskipped, and the player advances tothe next folder that contains files.

Order of Play

Compressed audio files areaccessed in the following order:. Playlists (Px).. Files stored in the root directory.. Files stored in folders in the root

directory.

Page 209: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (19,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-19

Tracks are played in the followingorder:. Play begins from the first track in

the first playlist and continuessequentially through all tracks ineach playlist. When the lasttrack of the last playlist hasplayed, play continues from thefirst track of the first playlist.

. Play begins from the first track inthe first folder and continuessequentially through all tracks ineach folder. When the last trackof the last folder has played,play continues from the firsttrack of the first folder.

File System and Naming

The song name that displays is thesong name that is contained in theID3 tag. If the song name is notpresent in the ID3 tag, then theradio displays the file name withoutthe extension (such as .mp3) as thetrack name.

Track names longer than 32characters or four pages areshortened. The display does notshow parts of words on the lastpage of text and the extension ofthe filename is not displayed.

Preprogrammed Playlists

CDs that have preprogrammedplaylists that were created usingWinAmp™, MusicMatch™, or RealJukebox™ software can beaccessed, however, there is noplaylist editing capability using theradio. These playlists are treated asspecial folders containingcompressed audio song files.

Playlists that have an .m3u or .plsfile extension and are stored on aUSB device may be supported bythe radio with a USB port.

Playlists can be changed by usingthe softkeys below the Sc andc T tabs, the f knob, the © SEEKbutton or the ¨ SEEK button. AnMP3 CD-R or CD-RW that has beenrecorded without using file folders

can be played. If a CD-R or CD-RWcontains more than the maximum of50 folders, 15 playlists, and512 folders and files, the playerallows access and navigates up tothe maximum, but all items over themaximum are not accessible.

Playing an MP3

4 (Information): Press to displayadditional text information related tothe current song. If information isavailable, the song title informationdisplays on the top line of thedisplay and artist informationdisplays on the bottom line. Wheninformation is not available, “NOINFO” displays.

f (Tune): Turn to select MP3 fileson the CD currently playing.

© SEEK: Press to go to the start ofthe track, if more than ten secondshave played. Press and hold orpress multiple times to continuemoving backward through tracks.

Page 210: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (20,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-20 Infotainment System

¨ SEEK: Press to go to the nexttrack. Press and hold or pressmultiple times to continue movingforward through tracks.

s REV (Reverse): Press and holdto reverse playback quickly. Soundis heard at a reduced volume andthe elapsed time of the file displays.Releases REV to resume playing.

\ FWD (Fast Forward): Pressand hold to advance playbackquickly. Sound is heard at a reducedvolume and the elapsed time of thefile displays. Release\ FWD toresume playing. The elapsed time ofthe file displays.

Sc (Previous Folder): Pressthe softkey below the Sc tab togo to the first track in the previousfolder.

c T (Next Folder): Press thesoftkey below thec T tab to go tothe first track in the next folder.

RDM (Random): Press to listen totracks in random, rather thansequential order. To use random:

1. Press the softkey positionedunder the RDM tab until RandomCurrent Disc displays.

2. Press the softkey again to turnoff random play.

h (Music Navigator): Press thesoftkey below theh tab to havethe files played in order by artist oralbum. The player scans the disc tosort the files by artist and album ID3tag information. It can take severalminutes to scan the disc dependingon the number of files on the disc.The radio may begin playing while itis scanning in the background.

When the scan is finished, the discbegins playing files in order byartist. The current artist playing isshown on the second line of thedisplay. Once all songs by that artistare played, the player moves to thenext artist in alphabetical order andbegins playing files by that artist.

To listen to files by another artist,press the softkey located beloweither arrow tab. The disc goes tothe next or previous artist inalphabetical order. Continuepressing either softkey below thearrow tab until the desired artistdisplays.

To change from playback by artist toplayback by album:

1. Press the softkey located belowthe Sort By tab.

2. Press one of the softkeys belowthe album tab from the sortscreen.

3. Press the softkey below theback tab to return to the mainmusic navigator screen.

The album name displays on thesecond line between the arrows andsongs from the current albumbegins to play. Once all songs fromthat album have played, the playermoves to the next album in

Page 211: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (21,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-21

alphabetical order on the CD andbegins playing MP3 files from thatalbum.

To exit music navigator mode, pressthe softkey below the Back tab toreturn to normal MP3 playback.

CD Player Messages

CHECK DISC: If this messagedisplays and/or the CD ejects, itcould be for one of the followingreasons:. It is very hot. When the

temperature returns to normal,the CD should play.

. The road is very rough. Whenthe road becomes smoother, theCD should play.

. The CD is dirty, scratched, wet,or upside down.

. The air is very humid. If so, waitabout an hour and try again.

. There could have been aproblem while burning the CD.

. The label could be caught in theCD player.

If the CD is not playing correctly, forany other reason, try a knowngood CD.

If any error occurs repeatedly or ifan error cannot be corrected,contact your dealer. If the radiodisplays an error message, write itdown and provide it to your dealerwhen reporting the problem.

CD/DVD Player

Care of the CD and DVD Player

Do not add any label to a disc.It could get caught in the CD orDVD player. If a disc is recorded ona personal computer and adescription label is needed, trylabeling the top of the recorded discwith a marking pen.

The use of CD/DVD lens cleaners isnot advised, due to the risk ofcontaminating the lens of the opticswith lubricants internal to the CDand DVD player mechanism.

Notice: If a label is added to aCD, more than one CD is insertedinto the slot at a time, or anattempt is made to play scratchedor damaged CDs, the CD playercould be damaged. While usingthe CD player, use only CDs ingood condition without any label,load one CD at a time, and keepthe CD player and the loading slotfree of foreign materials, liquids,and debris.

If an error displays, see “CDMessages” later in this section.

Care of CDs and DVDs

If playing a CD-R or CD-RW, thesound quality can be reduced due toCD-R or CD-RW quality, the methodof recording, the quality of the musicthat has been recorded, and theway the CD-R or CD-RW has beenhandled. Handle them carefully.Store CD-Rs or CD-RWs in theiroriginal cases or other protectivecases and away from direct sunlightand dust. The CD or DVD playerscans the bottom surface of the

Page 212: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (22,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-22 Infotainment System

disc. If the surface of a disc isdamaged, such as cracked, broken,or scratched, the disc does not playproperly or not at all. Do not touchthe bottom side of a disc whilehandling it; this could damage thesurface. Pick up discs by graspingthe outer edges or the edge of thehole and the outer edge.

If the surface of a disc is soiled,clean it with a soft, lint‐free cloth ordampen a clean, soft cloth in a mild,neutral detergent solution mixedwith water. Make sure the wipingprocess starts from the center tothe edge.

Audio Output

Only one audio source can be heardthrough the speakers at one time.An audio source is defined as DVDslot, CD slot, XM, FM‐AM, frontauxiliary jack, USB port, or rearauxiliary jack.

Press the O button to turn the radioon. The radio can be heard throughall of the vehicle speakers.

Front seat passengers can listen tothe radio (AM, FM, or XM ifequipped) by pressing the BANDbutton or the DVD/CD AUX button toselect CD slot, DVD slot, frontauxiliary input, USB port, or rearauxiliary input (if available).

If a playback device is plugged intothe radio’s front auxiliary input jack,USB port, or the rear auxiliary jack,the front seat passengers are ableto listen to playback from thissource through the vehiclespeakers. See “Using the AuxiliaryInput Jack” in Auxiliary Devices onpage 7‑31, or “Audio/Video (A/V)Jacks” under Rear SeatEntertainment (RSE) System onpage 7‑36 for more information.

In some vehicles, depending onaudio options, the rear speakerscan be muted when the RSA poweris turned on. See Rear Seat Audio(RSA) System on page 7‑46 formore information.

Inserting a Disc

Insert a disc partway into either slot,label side up. The player pulls it inand the disc should begin playing.(Loading a disc into the system,depending on media type andformat, ranges from 5 to 20 secondsfor a CD, and up to 30 seconds for aDVD to begin playing.)

Ejecting a Disc

Z CD (Eject): Press and releaseto eject the disc that is currentlyplaying. The CD ejects from thebottom slot. A beep sounds andEjecting Disc displays. Once thedisc is ejected, Remove Discdisplays. The disc can be removed.If the disc is not removed, afterseveral seconds the discautomatically pulls back into theplayer.

Z DVD (Eject): Press andrelease to eject the disc that iscurrently playing in the top slot.A beep sounds and Ejecting Discdisplays.

Page 213: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (23,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-23

If loading and reading of a disccannot be completed, due tounknown format, etc., and the discfails to eject, press and hold formore than five seconds to force thedisc to eject.

Playing a CD (in Either theDVD or CD Slot)

If the ignition or radio is turned offwith a CD in the player, it stays inthe player. When the ignition orradio is turned on, the CD startsplaying where it stopped, if it wasthe last selected audio source. TheCD is controlled by the buttons onthe radio faceplate or by the RSAunit. See Rear Seat Audio (RSA)System on page 7‑46 for moreinformation. The DVD/CD decks(the upper slot is the DVD deck andthe lower slot is the CD deck) of theradio are compatible with mostaudio CDs, CD-Rs, CD-RWs,and MP3s.

When a CD is inserted, the text tabDVD or CD symbol displays on theleft side of the radio display. Aseach new track starts to play, thetrack number displays.

The CD player can play the smaller8 cm (3 in) single CDs with anadapter ring. Full-size CDs and thesmaller CDs are loaded in the samemanner.

DVD/CD AUX (Auxiliary): Press tocycle through DVD, CD, or Auxiliarywhen listening to the radio. TheDVD/CD text tab and a messageshowing the track or chapternumber will display when a disc is ineither slot. Press the DVD/CD AUXbutton again and the systemautomatically searches for anauxiliary input device; see AuxiliaryDevices on page 7‑31 for moreinformation. If a portable audioplayer is not connected, “No AuxInput Device” displays. If a disc is inboth the DVD slot and the CD slot,the DVD/CD AUX button cyclesbetween the two sources and doesnot indicate “No Aux Input Device.”

If a front auxiliary device isconnected, the DVD/CD AUX buttoncycles through all available options,such as: DVD slot, CD slot, FrontAuxiliary, and Rear Auxiliary (ifavailable). See “Using the AuxiliaryInput Jack” in Auxiliary Devices onpage 7‑31 or “Audio/Video (A/V)Jacks” under Rear SeatEntertainment (RSE) System onpage 7‑36 for more information.

If a disc is inserted into the top DVDslot, the rear seat operator can turnon the video screen and use theremote control to navigate the CD(tracks only) through the remotecontrol.

4 (Information): Press to displayadditional text information related tothe current song. If information isavailable, the song title informationdisplays on the top line of thedisplay and artist informationdisplays on the bottom line. Wheninformation is not available, “NOINFO” displays.

Page 214: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (24,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-24 Infotainment System

f (Tune): Turn to select tracks onthe disc that is currently playing.

© SEEK: Press to go to the start ofthe current track, if more thanfive seconds on the CD haveplayed.

Press to go to the previous track ifless than five seconds on the CDhave played.

Press and hold, or press multipletimes, to continue moving backwardthrough the tracks on the CD.

¨ SEEK: Press to go to the nexttrack.

Press and hold, or press multipletimes, to continue moving forwardthrough the tracks on the CD.

s REV (Fast Reverse): Pressand hold to reverse playback quicklywithin a track.

\ FWD (Fast Forward): Pressand hold to advance playbackquickly within a track.

RDM (Random): Press to listen totracks in random, rather thansequential order. To use random:

1. Press the softkey under theRDM tab until Random CurrentDisc displays.

2. Press the softkey again to turnoff random play.

MP3 and WMA Supported Files

Format

The radio can play .mp3 or .wmafiles that were recorded onto aCD-R or CD-RW disc.

Compressed Audio or Mixed ModeDiscs

The radio plays discs that containboth uncompressed CD audio andMP3/WMA files depending on whichslot the disc is loaded into.

The DVD player only readsuncompressed audio and ignoresMP3/WMA files on a mixedmode disc.

The CD player reads bothuncompressed audio and MP3/WMA files on a mixed mode disc.Uncompressd audio is playedbefore MP3/WMA files. Press theCAT (category) button to togglebetween uncompressed audio andMP3/WMA files.

CD‐R or CD‐RW Supported Fileand Folder Structure

The DVD player supports:. Up to 255 folders.. Up to eight folders in depth.. Up to 15 playlists.. Up to 40 sessions.. Playlists with an .m3u or .wpl

extension.. Files with an .mp3, .wma, or .cda

file extension.

The CD player supports:. Up to 512 files and folders.. Up to 8 folders in depth.

Page 215: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (25,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-25

. Playlists with an .m3u or .wplextension.

. Files with an .mp3, .wma, or .cdafile extension.

Root Directory

The root directory of the disc istreated as a folder. If the rootdirectory has compressed audiofiles, the directory displays as F1ROOT on the radio.

If a disc contains bothuncompressed CD audio and MP3/WMA files, a folder under the rootdirectory called CD accesses all ofthe CD audio tracks on the disc.

Empty Folder

Folders that do not contain files areskipped, and the player advances tothe next folder that contains files.

No Folder

When the disc contains onlycompressed files, the files arelocated under the root folder. Thenext and previous folder functiondoes not function on a disc that was

recorded without folders or playlists.When displaying the name of thefolder, the radio displays ROOT.

When the disc contains onlyplaylists and compressed audiofiles, but no folders, all files arelocated under the root folder. Thefolder down and the folder upbuttons search playlists first andthen go to the root folder. When theradio displays the name of thefolder, the radio displays ROOT.

Order of Play

Compressed audio files areaccessed in the following order:. Playlists (Px).. Files stored in the root directory.. Files stored in folders in the root

directory.

Tracks are played in the followingorder:. Play begins from the first track in

the first playlist and continuessequentially through all tracks ineach playlist. When the last

track of the last playlist hasplayed, play continues from thefirst track of the first playlist.

. Play begins from the first track inthe first folder and continuessequentially through all tracks ineach folder. When the last trackof the last folder has played,play continues from the firsttrack of the first folder.

When play enters a new folder, thedisplay does not automatically showthe new folder name unless thefolder mode has been chosen asthe default display. The new trackname displays.

File System and Naming

The song name that displays is thesong name that is contained in theID3 tag. If the song name is notpresent in the ID3 tag, then theradio displays the file name withoutthe extension (such as .mp3) as thetrack name.

Page 216: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (26,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-26 Infotainment System

Track names longer than32 characters or 4 pages areshortened. Parts of words on thelast page of text and the extensionof the file name do not display.

Preprogrammed Playlists

Preprogrammed playlists that werecreated using WinAmp™,MusicMatch™, or Real Jukebox™software can be accessed; however,they cannot be edited using theradio. These playlists are treated asspecial folders containingcompressed audio song files.

Playlists that have an .m3u or .plsfile extension and are stored on aUSB device may be supported bythe radio with a USB port.

Playing an MP3 or WMA (inEither the DVD or CD Slot)

If a disc is inserted into the top DVDslot, the rear seat operator can turnon the video screen and use theremote control to navigate the CD(tracks only).

f (Tune): Turn to select MP3/WMAfiles.

© SEEK: Press to go to the start ofthe track, if more than five secondshave played. Press and hold orpress multiple times, if less thanfive seconds have played, tocontinue moving backward throughtracks.

¨ SEEK: Press to go to the nexttrack.

Press and hold, or press multipletimes, to continue moving forwardthrough tracks.

s REV (Reverse): Press and holdto reverse playback quickly.

\ FWD (Fast Forward): Pressand hold to advance playbackquickly.

Sc (Previous Folder): Pressthe softkey below the Sc tab togo to the first track in the previousfolder.

c T (Next Folder): Press thesoftkey below thec T tab to go tothe first track in the next folder.

RDM (Random): Press to listen totracks in random, rather thansequential order.

To use random:

1. Press the softkey under theRDM tab until Random CurrentDisc displays

2. Press the same softkey again toturn off random play.

h (Music Navigator): Press thesoftkey below theh tab to playfiles in order by artist or album.

The player scans the disc to sort thefiles by artist and album ID3 taginformation. It can take severalminutes to scan the disc dependingon the number of files on the disc.The radio may begin playing while itis scanning in the background.

When the scan is finished, the discbegins playing files in order byartist. The current artist playing is

Page 217: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (27,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-27

shown on the second line of thedisplay. Once all songs by that artistare played, the player moves to thenext artist in alphabetical order andbegins playing files by that artist.

To listen to files by another artist,press the softkey located beloweither arrow tab. The disc goes tothe next or previous artist inalphabetical order. Continuepressing either softkey below thearrow tab until the artist displays.

To change from playback by artist toplayback by album:

1. Press the softkey below the SortBy tab.

2. Press one of the softkeys belowthe Album tab from the sortscreen.

3. Press the softkey below theBack tab to return to the mainmusic navigator screen.

The album name displays on thesecond line between the arrows,and songs from the current albumbegin to play. Once all songs from

that album have played, the playermoves to the next album inalphabetical order on the CD andbegins playing MP3 files from thatalbum.

To exit music navigator mode, pressthe softkey below the Back tab toreturn to normal MP3 playback.

Using the DVD Player

The DVD player can be controlledby the buttons on the remotecontrol, the RSA system, or by thebuttons on the radio faceplate. See“Remote Control” under Rear SeatEntertainment (RSE) System onpage 7‑36 and Rear Seat Audio(RSA) System on page 7‑46 formore information.

The DVD player is only compatiblewith DVDs of the appropriate regioncode printed on the jacket ofmost DVDs.

The DVD slot of the radio iscompatible with most audio CDsand CD-R/RW, DVD-Video,

DVD-Audio, DVD-R/RW, and DVD+R/RW media, along with MP3 andWMA formats.

If an error message displays on thevideo screen or the radio, see “DVDDisplay Error Messages” underRear Seat Entertainment (RSE)System on page 7‑36, and “CD/DVDPlayer Messages” later in thissection for more information.

Inserting a Disc

Insert a disc partway into the topslot, label side up. The player pullsit in and the disc should beginplaying. “Loading Disc” shows onthe radio display. At the same time,the radio displays a softkey menu ofoption(s). Some discs automaticallyplay the movie while others defaultto the softkey menu display, whichrequires the Play, Enter,or Navigation softkeys to bepressed, either by softkey or by therear seat passenger using theremote control.

Page 218: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (28,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-28 Infotainment System

Loading a disc into the system,depending on media type andformat, ranges from 5 to 20 secondsfor a CD, and up to 30 seconds fora DVD.

Ejecting a Disc

Z DVD (Eject): Press andrelease to eject the disc currentlyplaying in the top slot. A beepsounds and Ejecting Disc displays.

If loading and reading of a disccannot be completed, due tounknown format, etc., and the discfails to eject, press and hold formore than five seconds to force thedisc to eject.

Playing a DVD

DVD/CD AUX (Auxiliary): Press tocycle through DVD, CD, or Auxiliarywhen listening to the radio. TheDVD/CD text tab and a messageshowing the track or chapternumber will display when a disc is ineither slot. Press the DVD/CD AUXbutton again and the systemautomatically searches for an

auxiliary input device; see AuxiliaryDevices on page 7‑31 for moreinformation. If a portable audioplayer is not connected, “No AuxInput Device” displays. If a disc is inboth the DVD slot and the CD slot,the DVD/CD AUX button cyclesbetween the two sources and doesnot indicate “No Aux Input Device.”If a front auxiliary device isconnected, the DVD/CD AUX buttoncycles through all available options,such as: DVD slot, CD slot, frontauxiliary, and rear auxiliary (ifavailable). See “Using the AuxiliaryInput Jack” in Auxiliary Devices onpage 7‑31 or “Audio/Video (A/V)Jacks” under Rear SeatEntertainment (RSE) System onpage 7‑36 for more information.

If a disc is inserted into the top DVDslot, the rear seat operator can turnon the video screen and use theremote control to navigate the CD(tracks only) through the remotecontrol.

O (Power): Press to turn the radioon or off. Turn clockwise orcounterclockwise to increase ordecrease the volume. Press andhold for more than two seconds toturn off the entire radio and RearSeat Entertainment (RSE) systemand to start the Parental Controlfeature. Parental Control preventsthe rear seat occupant fromoperating the Rear Seat Audio(RSA) system or remote control.

A lock symbol displays next to theclock display. The Parental Controlfeature remains on until the knob ispressed and held for more thantwo seconds again, or until thedriver turns the ignition off and exitsthe vehicle.

f (Tune): Turn to select tracks ona CD or DVD.

© SEEK: Press to return to the startof the current track or chapter.Press again to go to the previoustrack or chapter. This button might

Page 219: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (29,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-29

not work when the DVD is playingthe copyright information or thepreviews.

¨ SEEK: Press to go to the nexttrack or chapter. This button mightnot work when the DVD is playingthe copyright information or thepreviews.

s REV (Fast Reverse): Press toquickly reverse the CD or DVD atfive times the normal speed. To stopfast reversing, press again. Thisbutton might not work when theDVD is playing the copyrightinformation or the previews.

\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press tofast forward the CD or DVD atfive times the normal speed. To stopfast forwarding, press again. Thisbutton might not work when theDVD is playing the copyrightinformation or the previews.

Using Softkeys to Play a DVD-V(Video)

Once a DVD-V is inserted, the radiodisplay menu shows several taboptions for playback. Press thesoftkey located under any tab optionduring DVD-V playback.

r / j (Play/Pause): Press eitherthe Play or Pause tab displayed onthe radio, to toggle between pausingor restarting playback of a DVD.If the forward arrow is showing onthe display, the system is in pausemode. If the Pause tab is showingon the display, the system is inplayback mode. If the DVD screenis off, press the play button to turnthe screen on.

Some DVDs begin playing after thepreviews have finished, althoughthere could be a delay of up to30 seconds. If the DVD does notbegin playing the movieautomatically, press the softkeylocated under the play/pausesymbol tag displayed on the radio.

If the DVD still does not play, referto the on-screen instructions,if available.

c (Stop): Press to stop playing,rewinding, or fast forwarding a DVD.

r (Enter): Press to select thechoices that are highlighted inany menu.

y (Menu): Press to access theDVD menu. The DVD menu isdifferent on every DVD. Use thesoftkeys located under thenavigation arrows to navigate thecursor through the DVD menu. Aftermaking a selection press thisbutton. This button only operateswhen using a DVD.

Nav (Navigate): Press to displaydirectional arrows for navigatingthrough the menus.

q (Return): Press to exit thecurrent active menu and return tothe previous menu. This buttonoperates only when a DVD isplaying and a menu is active.

Page 220: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (30,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-30 Infotainment System

The rear seat passenger cannavigate the DVD-V and DVD-Amenus and controls through theremote control. See “RemoteControl” under Rear SeatEntertainment (RSE) System onpage 7‑36 for more information. Thevideo screen automatically turns onwhen the DVD-V is inserted into theDVD slot, and does notautomatically power on when theDVD-A is inserted into the DVD slot.It must be manually turned on bythe rear seat occupant through theremote control power button.

Using Softkeys to Play a DVD-A(Audio)

Once a DVD-A is inserted, the radiodisplay menu shows several taboptions for playback. Press thesoftkey located under any tab optionduring DVD-A playback.

r / j (Play/Pause): Press eitherthe play or pause icon displayed onthe radio, to toggle between pausingor restarting playback of a DVD.If the forward arrow is showing on

the display, the system is in pausemode. If the pause tab is showingon the display, the system is inplayback mode.

q Group r : Press to cyclethrough musical groupings on theDVD-A disc.

Nav (Navigate): Press to displaydirectional arrows for navigatingthrough the menus.

e (Audio Stream): Press to cyclethrough audio stream formatslocated on the DVD-A disc. Thevideo screen shows the audiostream changing.

The rear seat passenger cannavigate the DVD-V and DVD-Amenus and controls through theremote control. See “RemoteControl” under Rear SeatEntertainment (RSE) System onpage 7‑36 for more information. Thevideo screen automatically turns onwhen the DVD-V is inserted into theDVD slot, and does notautomatically power on when theDVD-A is inserted into the DVD slot.

It must be manually turned on bythe rear seat occupant through theremote control power button.

Stopping and ResumingPlayback

To stop playing a DVD withoutturning off the system, press the cbutton on the remote control,or press the softkey located underthe c or the r / j tabs displayedon the radio. If the radio is sourcedto something other than DVD-V,press the DVD/CD AUX button tomake DVD-V the active source.

To resume DVD playback, press ther / j button on the remote control,or press the softkey located underthe r / j tab on the radio. The DVDshould resume play from where itlast stopped if the disc has not beenejected and the stop button has notbeen pressed twice on the remotecontrol. If the disc has been ejectedor the stop button has been pressed

Page 221: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (31,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-31

twice on the remote control, the discresumes playing at the beginning ofthe disc.

CD/DVD Player Messages

Disc Format Error: This messagedisplays if the disc is inserted withthe disc label wrong side up, or ifthe disc is damaged.

Disc Region Error: This messagedisplays if the disc is not from acorrect region.

No Disc Inserted: This messagedisplays if no disc is present whentheZ or DVD/CD AUX button ispressed on the radio.

Optical Error: This messagedisplays if the disc was insertedupside down.

Disk Read Error: This messagedisplays if a disc was inserted withan invalid or unknown format.

Player Error: This messagedisplays if there are disc load ordisc eject problems.. It is very hot. When the

temperature returns to normal,the disc should play.

. The road is very rough. Whenthe road becomes smoother, thedisc should play.

. The disc is dirty, scratched, wet,or upside down.

. The air is very humid. If so, waitabout an hour and try again.

. There was a problem whileburning the disc.

. The label is caught in the CD/DVD player.

If the disc is not playing correctly, forany other reason, try a knowngood disc.

If any error occurs repeatedly or ifan error cannot be corrected,contact your dealer. If the radio

displays an error message, write itdown and provide it to your dealerwhen reporting the problem.

Auxiliary Devices

Using the Auxiliary Input Jack

Radios with an auxiliary input jacklocated on the lower right side of thefaceplate can connect to an externalaudio device such as an iPod®,MP3 player, CD player, for use asanother source for audio listening.This input jack is not an audiooutput; do not plug headphones intothe front auxiliary input jack.

Drivers are encouraged to set upany auxiliary device while thevehicle is in P (Park). SeeDefensive Driving on page 9‑3 formore information on driverdistraction.

To use a portable audio player,connect a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) cable tothe radio's front auxiliary input jack.When a device is connected, press

Page 222: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (32,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-32 Infotainment System

the radio CD/AUX button to beginplaying audio from the device overthe vehicle speakers.

For optimal sound quality, increasethe portable audio device's volumeto the loudest level.

It is always best to power theportable audio device through itsown battery while playing.

O (Power/Volume): Turn clockwiseor counterclockwise to increase ordecrease the volume of the portableplayer. Additional volumeadjustments might have to be madefrom the portable device if thevolume is not loud or soft enough.

BAND: Press to listen to the radiowhen a portable audio device isplaying. The portable audio devicecontinues playing.

CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press toplay a CD when a portable audiodevice is playing. Press again andthe system begins playing audiofrom the connected portable audio

player. If a portable audio player isnot connected, “No Input DeviceFound” displays.

DVD/CD AUX (CD/Auxiliary):Press to cycle through DVD, CD,or Auxiliary when listening to theradio. The DVD/CD text tab and amessage showing track or chapternumber displays when a disc is ineither slot. Press again and thesystem automatically searches foran auxiliary input device, such as aportable audio player. If a portableaudio player is not connected, “NoAux Input Device” displays. If a discis in both the DVD slot and the CDslot the DVD/CD AUX button cyclesbetween the two sources and notindicate “No Aux Input Device”. If afront auxiliary device is connected,the DVD/CD AUX button cyclesthrough all available options, suchas: DVD slot, CD slot, FrontAuxiliary, and Rear Auxiliary (ifavailable). See “Using the AuxiliaryInput Jack(s)” in this section,or “Audio/Video (A/V) Jacks” under,

Rear Seat Entertainment (RSE)System on page 7‑36 for moreinformation.

Using the USB Port

Radios with a USB port can controla USB storage device or an iPodusing the radio buttons and knobs.

USB Support

The USB connector is located onthe instrument panel or in the centerconsole, and uses the USB 2.0standard.

USB Supported Devices. USB Flash Drives. Portable USB Hard Drives. Fifth generation or later iPod. iPod nanos. iPod touch. iPod classic

Not all iPods and USB Drives arecompatible with the USB port.

Page 223: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (33,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-33

Make sure the iPod has the latestfirmware from Apple® for properoperation. iPod firmware can beupdated using the latest iTunes®

application. See www.apple.com/itunes.

For help with identifying your iPod,go to www.apple.com/support.

Radios that have a USB port canplay .mp3 and .wma files that arestored on a USB storage device aswell as AAC files that are stored onan iPod.

USB Supported File and FolderStructure

The radio supports:. Up to 700 folders.. Up to 8 folders in depth.. Up to 65,535 files.. Folder and file names up to

64 bytes.. Files with an .mp3 or .wma file

extension.. AAC files stored on an iPod.

. FAT16

. FAT32

Connecting a USB StorageDevice or iPod

The USB Port can be used tocontrol an iPod or a USB storagedevice.

To connect a USB storage device,connect the device to the USB portlocated in the center console or onthe instrument panel.

To connect an iPod, connect oneend of the USB cable that camewith the iPod to the iPod’s dockconnector and connect the otherend to the USB port located in thecenter console or on the instrumentpanel. If the vehicle is on and theUSB connection works, “OK todisconnect” and a GM logo mayappear on the iPod and iPodappears on the radio display. TheiPod music appears on the radio’sdisplay and begins playing.

The iPod charges while it isconnected to the vehicle if thevehicle is in the ACC/ACCESSORYor ON/RUN position. When thevehicle is turned off, the iPodautomatically powers off and will notcharge or draw power from thevehicle's battery.

If you have an older iPod model thatis not supported, it can still be usedby connecting it to the AuxiliaryInput Jack using a standard 3.5 mm(1/8 in) stereo cable. See “Using theAuxiliary Input Jack” earlier for moreinformation.

Using the Radio to Control aUSB Storage Device or iPod

The radio can control a USBstorage device or an iPod using theradio buttons and knobs and displaysong information on the radio’sdisplay.

f (Tune): Turn to select files.

Page 224: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (34,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-34 Infotainment System

© SEEK: Press to go to the start ofthe track, if more than ten secondshave played. Press and hold orpress multiple times to continuemoving backward through tracks.

¨ SEEK: Press to go to the nexttrack. Press and hold or pressmultiple times to continue movingforward through tracks.

s REV (Reverse): Press and holdto reverse playback quickly. Soundis heard at a reduced volume.Releases REV to resume playing.The elapsed time of the filedisplays.

\ FWD (Fast Forward): Pressand hold to advance playbackquickly. Sound is heard at a reducedvolume. Release\ FWD toresume playing. The elapsed time ofthe file displays.

4 (Information): Press to displayadditional information about theselected track.

Using Softkeys to Control aUSB Storage Device or iPod

The five softkeys below the radiodisplay are used to control thefunctions listed below.

To use the softkeys:

1. Press the first or fifth softkeybelow the radio display todisplay the functions listedbelow, or press the softkeybelow the function if it iscurrently displayed.

2. Press the softkey below the tabwith the function on it to use thatfunction.

j (Pause): Press the softkey belowj to pause the track. The tabappears raised when pause is beingused. Press the softkey below jagain to resume playback.

Back: Press the softkey below theback tab to go back to the maindisplay screen on an iPod, or theroot directory on a USB storagedevice.

c (Folder View): Press thesoftkey belowc to view thecontents of the current folder on theUSB drive. To browse and selectfiles:

1. Press the softkey belowc.

2. Turn f to scroll through the listof folders.

3. Press f to select the desiredfolder. If there is more then onefolder, repeat Steps 1 and 2 untilthe desired folder is reached.

4. Turn f to scroll through the filesin the selected folder.

5. Press f to select the desired fileto be played.

To skip through large lists, the fivesoftkeys can be used to navigate inthe following order:. First softkey, first item in the list.. Second softkey, 1% through the

list each time the softkey ispressed.

Page 225: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (35,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-35

. Third softkey, 5% through the listeach time the softkey is pressed.

. Fourth softkey, 10% through thelist each time the softkey ispressed.

. Fifth softkey, end of the list.

h (Music Navigator): Press thesoftkey belowh to view andselect a file on an iPod, using theiPod's menu system. Files aresorted by:. Playlists. Artists. Albums. Genres. Songs. Composers

To select files:

1. Press the softkey belowh.

2. Turn f to scroll through the listof menus.

3. Press f to select thedesired menu.

4. Turn f to scroll through thefolders or files in theselected menu.

5. Press f to select the desired fileto be played.

To skip through large lists, the fivesoftkeys can be used to navigate inthe following order:. First softkey, first item in the list.. Second softkey, 1% through the

list each time the softkey ispressed.

. Third softkey, 5% through the listeach time the softkey is pressed.

. Fourth softkey, 10% through thelist each time the softkey ispressed.

. Fifth softkey, end of the list.

Repeat Functionality

To use Repeat:

Press the softkey below" or'to select between Repeat All andRepeat Track.

" (Repeat All): Press the softkeybelow" to repeat all tracks. Thetab appears lowered when RepeatAll is being used. This is the defaultmode when a USB storage deviceor iPod is first connected.

' (Repeat Track): Press thesoftkey below' to repeat onetrack. The tab appears raised whenRepeat Track is being used.

Shuffle Functionality

To use Shuffle:

Press the softkey below>,2,C or= to select betweenShuffle Off, Shuffle All Songs/Shuffle Songs, Shuffle Album,or Shuffle Folder.

Page 226: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (36,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-36 Infotainment System

> (Shuffle Off): Press thesoftkey below2 to turn shuffleoff. This is the default mode when aUSB storage device or iPod is firstconnected.

2 (Shuffle All Songs / ShuffleSongs): Press the softkey below= orC to shuffle all songs onthe USB storage device or iPod.

C (Shuffle Album): Press thesoftkey below> to shuffle allsongs in the current album onan iPod.

= (Shuffle Folder): Press thesoftkey below> to shuffle allsongs in the current folder on a USBstorage device.

Rear SeatInfotainment

Rear Seat Entertainment(RSE) SystemThe vehicle may have anOverhead DVD Rear SeatEntertainment (RSE) system. TheRSE system works with thevehicle's audio system. The DVDplayer is part of the front radio. TheRSE system includes a radio with aDVD player, a video display screen,and if the vehicle has a third rowseat, it could have a second videodisplay screen, audio/video jacks,two wireless headphones, and aremote control. See CD/DVD Playeron page 7‑21 for more informationon the vehicle's DVD system.

Before Driving

The RSE is designed for rear seatpassengers only. The driver cannotsafely view the video screen whiledriving and should not try to do so.

In severe or extreme weatherconditions, the RSE system mightnot work until the temperature iswithin the operating range. Theoperating range for the RSE systemis above −20°C (−4°F) or below60°C (140°F). If the temperature ofthe vehicle is outside this range,heat or cool the vehicle until thetemperature is within the operatingrange of the RSE system.

Parental Control

The RSE system may have aParental Control feature, dependingon which radio the vehicle has. Tostart Parental Control, press andhold the radio power button for morethan two seconds to stop all systemfeatures such as: radio, videoscreen, Rear Seat Audio (RSA),DVD, and/or CD. While ParentalControl is on, a padlock icondisplays.

The radio can be turned back onwith a single press of the powerbutton, but the RSE system willremain under Parental Control.

Page 227: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (37,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-37

To turn Parental Control off, pressand hold the radio power button formore than two seconds. The RSEreturns from where it was previouslyleft and the padlock icon disappearsfrom the radio display.

Parental Control can also be turnedoff by inserting or ejecting any disc,pressing the play icon on the radioDVD display menu, or changing anignition position.

Headphones

A. Battery cover

B. Channel 1 or 2 switch

C. Power button

D. Volume control

E. Power indicator light

The RSE includes two 2-channelwireless headphones that arededicated to this system. Channel 1is dedicated to the video screen,while Channel 2 is dedicated toRear Seat Audio (RSA) selections.These headphones can be used tolisten to the radio, CDs, DVDs,MP3s, DVD-As, or any auxiliarysource connected to A/V jacks orthe auxiliary input jack, if the vehiclehas this feature. The wirelessheadphones have a power button,channel 1 or 2 switch, and a volumecontrol.

If the vehicle has a third row videoscreen display, it has two additionalheadphones.

Push the power button to turn onthe headphones. An indicator lightlocated on the headphones comes

on. If the light comes on, but thereis intermittent sound and/or static onthe headphones, or if the indicatorlight does not come on, the batteriesmight need to be replaced. See“Battery Replacement” later in thissection for more information. Switchthe headphones to Off when notin use.

Infrared transmitters are located atthe rear of the overhead console.The headphones shut offautomatically to save the batterypower if the RSE system and RSAare shut off, or if the headphonesare out of range of the transmittersfor more than three minutes. If youmove too far forward or step out ofthe vehicle, the headphones losethe audio signal.

To adjust the volume on theheadphones, use the volume controllocated on the right side.

For optimal audio performance, theheadphones must be worn correctly.Headphones should be worn withthe headband over the top of the

Page 228: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (38,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-38 Infotainment System

head for best audio reception. Thesymbol L (Left) appears on theoutside bottom edge of the ear cupand should be positioned on the leftear. The symbol R (Right) appearson the outside bottom edge of theear cup and should be positioned onthe right ear.

Notice: Do not store theheadphones in heat or directsunlight. This could damage theheadphones and repairs will notbe covered by the warranty.Storage in extreme cold canweaken the batteries. Keep theheadphones stored in a cool, dryplace.

If the foam ear pads attached to theheadphones become worn ordamaged, the pads can be replacedseparately from the headphone set.To purchase replacement ear pads,call 1-888-293-3332, then promptzero (0), or contact your dealer.

Battery Replacement

To change the batteries on theheadphones:

1. Turn the screw to loosen thebattery door located on the leftside of the headphones. Slidethe battery door open.

2. Replace the two batteries in thecompartment. Make sure thatthey are installed correctly, usingthe diagram on the inside of thebattery compartment.

3. Replace the battery door andtighten the door screw.

If the headphones are to be storedfor a long period of time, remove thebatteries and keep them in a cool,dry place.

Audio/Video (A/V) Jacks

Yellow: Video Input

White: Left Audio Input

Red: Right Audio Input

The A/V jacks are color coded tomatch typical home entertainmentsystem equipment.

The A/V jacks, located on the rearof the floor console, allow audio orvideo signals to be connected froman auxiliary device such as acamcorder or a video game unit to

Page 229: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (39,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-39

the RSE system. Adapterconnectors or cables (not included)may be required to connect theauxiliary device to the A/V jacks.Refer to the manufacturer’sinstructions for proper usage.

Power for auxiliary devices is notsupplied by the radio system.

To use the auxiliary inputs of theRSE system, connect an externalauxiliary device to the color-codedA/V jacks and turn both the auxiliarydevice and the video screen poweron. If the video screen is in the DVDplayer mode, pressing the AUX(auxiliary) button on the remotecontrol switches the video screenfrom the DVD player mode to theauxiliary device. The audio of theconnected source can be listened toover the speakers by sourcing theradio to the auxiliary device or bysourcing the RSA to the Rear Auxand listening with the wirelessheadphones on Channel 2 or with

the wired headphones. See “Usingthe Auxiliary Input Jack” underAuxiliary Devices on page 7‑31 formore information about changingthe source.

How to Change the RSE VideoScreen Settings

The screen display mode (normal,full, and zoom), screen brightness,and setup menu language can bechanged from the on screen setupmenu. To change any feature:

1. Press the z (display menu)button on the remote control.

2. Use the remote control n,q,p,o (navigation) arrows andther (enter) button to use thesetup menu.

3. Press the z button again toremove the setup menu from thescreen.

Audio Output

Audio from the DVD player orauxiliary inputs can be heardthrough the following possiblesources:. Wireless headphones. Vehicle speakers. Vehicle-wired headphone jacks

on the RSA system, if thevehicle has this feature.

The RSE system always transmitsthe audio signal to the wirelessheadphones, if there is audioavailable. See “Headphones” earlierin this section for more information.

The DVD player is capable ofoutputting audio to the wiredheadphone jacks on the RSAsystem, if the vehicle has thisfeature. The DVD player can beselected as an audio source on theRSA system. See Rear Seat Audio(RSA) System on page 7‑46 formore information.

Page 230: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (40,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-40 Infotainment System

When a device is connected to theA/V jacks, or the radio's auxiliaryinput jack if the vehicle has thisfeature, the rear seat passengersare able to hear audio from theauxiliary device through the wirelessor wired headphones. The front seatpassengers are able to listen toplayback from this device throughthe vehicle speakers by selectingAUX as the source on the radio.

Video Screen(s)

The video screen(s) are located inthe overhead console.

To use the video screen(s):

1. Push the release button locatedon the overhead console.

2. Move the screen to the desiredposition.

When the video screen is not inuse, push it up into its lockedposition.

If a DVD is playing and the screenis raised to its locked position, thescreen remains on. This is normal,and the DVD continues to playthrough the previous audio source.Use the remote control power buttonor eject the disc to turn off thescreen.

The overhead console contains theinfrared transmitters for the wirelessheadphones and the infraredreceivers for the remote control.They are located at the rear of theconsole.

Notice: Avoid directly touchingthe video screen, as damage mayoccur. See “Cleaning the VideoScreens” later in this section formore information.

Remote Control

To use the remote control, aim it atthe transmitter window at the rear ofthe RSE overhead console andpress the desired button. Directsunlight or very bright light couldaffect the ability of the RSEtransmitter to receive signals fromthe remote control. If the remotecontrol does not seem to beworking, the batteries might need tobe replaced. See “BatteryReplacement” later in this section.

Page 231: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (41,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-41

Objects blocking the line of sightcould also affect the function of theremote control.

If a CD or DVD is in the Radio DVDslot, the remote control O (power)button can be used to turn on thevideo screen display and start thedisc. The radio can also turn on thevideo screen display. See CD/DVDPlayer on page 7‑21 for moreinformation.

Notice: Storing the remotecontrol in a hot area or in directsunlight can damage it, and therepairs will not be covered by thewarranty. Storage in extreme coldcan weaken the batteries. Keepthe remote control stored in acool, dry place.

If the remote control becomes lostor damaged, a new universalremote control can be purchased.If this happens, make sure theuniversal remote control uses acode set of Toshiba®.

Remote Control Buttons

O (Power): Press this button toturn the video screen on and off.

P (Illumination): Press this buttonto turn the remote control backlighton. The backlight automaticallytimes out after 7 to 10 seconds if noother button is pressed while thebacklight is on.

v (Title): Press this button toreturn the DVD to the main menu ofthe DVD. This function could varyfor each disc.

y (Main Menu): Press this buttonto access the DVD menu. The DVDmenu is different on every DVD.Use the navigation arrows to movethe cursor around the DVD menu.After making a selection press theenter button. This button onlyoperates when using a DVD.

n,q, p,o (Menu NavigationArrows): Use the arrow buttons tonavigate through a menu.

r (Enter): Press this button toselect the choice that is highlightedin any menu.

z (Display Menu): Press thisbutton to adjust the brightness,screen display mode (normal, full,or zoom), and display thelanguage menu.

q (Return): Press this button toexit the current active menu andreturn to the previous menu. Thisbutton operates only when thedisplay menu or a DVD menu isactive.

c (Stop): Press this button to stopplaying, fast reversing, or fastforwarding a DVD. Press this buttontwice to return to the beginning ofthe DVD.

s (Play/Pause): Press thisbutton to start playing a DVD. Pressthis button while a DVD is playing topause it. Press it again to continueplaying the DVD.

Page 232: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (42,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-42 Infotainment System

While the DVD is playing, the DVDcan be played slowly by pressingthe play/pause button then pressingthe fast forward button. The DVDcontinues playing in a slow playmode. Also, reverse can be playedslowly by pressing the play/pausebutton and then pressing the fastreverse button. To cancel slow playmode, press the play/pause button.

t (Previous Track/Chapter):Press this button to return to thestart of the current track or chapter.Press this button again to go to theprevious track or chapter. Thisbutton might not work when theDVD is playing the copyrightinformation or the previews.

u (Next Track/Chapter): Pressthis button to go to the beginning ofthe next chapter or track. Thisbutton might not work while theDVD is playing the copyrightinformation or the previews.

r (Fast Reverse): Press thisbutton to quickly reverse the DVD orCD. To stop fast reversing a DVDvideo, press the play/pause button.To stop fast reversing a DVD audioor CD, release the fast reversebutton. This button might not workwhen the DVD is playing thecopyright information or thepreviews.

[ (Fast Forward): Press thisbutton to fast forward the DVD orCD. To stop fast forwarding a DVDvideo, press the play/pause button.

To stop fast forwarding a DVD audioor CD, release the fast forwardbutton. This button might not workwhile the DVD is playing thecopyright information or thepreviews.

e (Audio): Press this button tochange audio tracks on DVDs thathave this feature when the DVD isplaying. The format and content ofthis function vary for each disc.

{ (Subtitles): Press this button toturn on or off subtitles and to movethrough subtitle options when aDVD is playing. The format andcontent of this function vary foreach disc.

AUX (Auxiliary): Press this buttonto switch the system between theDVD player and an auxiliary source.

Page 233: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (43,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-43

If the vehicle has a third row videoscreen, the AUX button controls thesource display on the second rowvideo screen, and the third rowvideo screen as described in thetable below:

AuxButtonPress

SecondRow

Screen

Third RowScreen

DefaultState (NoPress)

DVDMedia

DVDMedia

FirstPress

Aux VideoSource

Aux VideoSource

SecondPress

DVDMedia

Aux VideoSource

ThirdPress

Aux VideoSource

DVDMedia

FourthPress

Return toDefaultState

Return toDefaultState

2 (Camera): Press this button tochange camera angles on DVDsthat have this feature while a DVD isplaying. The format and content ofthis function vary for each disc.

1 through 0 (Numeric Keypad):The numeric keypad provides thecapability of direct chapter or tracknumber selection.

\ (Clear): Press this button withinthree seconds after entering anumeric selection, to clear allnumerical inputs.

} 10 (Double Digit Entries): Pressthis button to select chapter or tracknumbers greater than nine. Pressthis button before entering thenumber.

Battery Replacement

To change the remote controlbatteries:

1. Slide the rear cover back on theremote control.

2. Replace the two batteries in thecompartment. Make sure theyare installed correctly using thediagram on the inside of theremote control.

3. Replace the battery cover.

If the remote control is to be storedfor a long period of time, remove thebatteries and keep them in a cool,dry place.

Page 234: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (44,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-44 Infotainment System

Tips and Troubleshooting Chart

Problem Recommended Action

There is no power. The ignition might not be turned to ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY.

The picture does not fill the screen. There are blackborders on the top and bottom or on both sides, or thepicture looks stretched out.

Check the display mode settings in the setup menu bypressing the display menu button on the remote control.

In auxiliary mode, the picture moves or scrolls. Check the auxiliary input connections at both devices.

The remote control does not work. Check to make sure there is no obstruction between theremote control and the transmitter window.Check the batteries to make sure they are not dead orinstalled incorrectly.

After stopping the player, and pushing Play, sometimesthe DVD starts where it left off and sometimes at thebeginning.

If the stop button was pressed one time, the DVD playerresumes playing where the DVD was stopped. If thestop button was pressed two times, the DVD playerbegins to play from the beginning of the DVD.

The auxiliary source is running, but there is no picture orsound.

Check that the RSE video screen is in the auxiliarysource mode.Check the auxiliary input connections at both devices.

Page 235: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (45,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-45

Tips and Troubleshooting Chart (cont'd)

Problem Recommended Action

Sometimes the wireless headphone audio cuts out orbuzzes.

Check for obstructions, low batteries, reception range,and interference from cellular telephone towers, or use acellular telephone in the vehicle.Check that the headphones are on correctly using the L(left) and R (right) on the headphones.

The remote and/or the headphones are lost. See your dealer for assistance.

The DVD is playing, but there is no picture or sound. Check that the RSE video screen is sourced to the DVDplayer.

DVD Display Error Messages

The DVD display error messagedepends on the radio that is in thevehicle. The video screen candisplay one of the following:

Disc Load/Eject Error: Thismessage displays when there aredisc load or eject problems.

Disc Format Error: This messagedisplays if the disc is inserted withthe disc label wrong side up, or ifthe disc is damaged.

Disc Region Error: This messagedisplays if the disc is not from acorrect region.

No Disc Inserted: This messagedisplays if no disc is present whenZ or DVD AUX is pressed on theradio.

DVD Distortion

Video distortion can occur whenoperating cellular phones, scanners,CB radios, Global Position Systems(GPS)*, two-way radios, mobile faxmachines, or walkie talkies.

It might be necessary to turn off theDVD player when operating one ofthese devices in or near the vehicle.

*Excludes the OnStar® System.

Cleaning the RSE OverheadConsole

When cleaning the RSE overheadconsole surface, use only a cleancloth dampened with clean water.

Page 236: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (46,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-46 Infotainment System

Cleaning the Video Screen

When cleaning the video screen,use only a clean cloth dampenedwith clean water. Use care whendirectly touching or cleaning thescreen, as damage could result.

Rear Seat Audio (RSA)SystemVehicles with this feature allow therear seat passengers to listen toand control any of the musicsources: radio, CDs, DVDs, or otherauxiliary sources. However, the rearseat passengers can only controlthe music sources the front seatpassengers are not listening to(except on some radios where dualcontrol is allowed). For example,rear seat passengers can controland listen to a CD through theheadphones, while the driver listensto the radio through the frontspeakers. The rear seat passengershave control of the volume for eachset of headphones.

The radio functionality is controlledby both the RSA and the front radio.Only one band can be tuned to atone time. Changing the band on theRSA or the front radio will changethe band on the other system,if they are both sourced to the radio.

The RSA functions operate evenwhen the main radio is off. The frontaudio system will display theheadphone icon when the RSA ison, and will disappear from thedisplay when it is off.

Audio can be heard through wiredheadphones (not included) pluggedinto the jacks on the RSA. If thevehicle has this feature, audio canalso be heard on Channel 2 of thewireless headphones.

The audio system mutes the rearspeakers when the RSA audio isactive through the headphones.

P (Power): Press theP button toturn the RSA on or off.

Volume: To increase or decreaseheadphone volume, turn the knobslocated next to the SRCE or PROGbuttons. The left knob controls theleft headphones and the right knobcontrols the right headphones.

SRCE (Source): Press this buttonto switch between the radio (AM/FM), XM™ (if equipped), CD, and ifthe vehicle has these features,DVD, front auxiliary, and rearauxiliary.

Page 237: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (47,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-47

© ¨ (Seek): When listening to FM,AM, or XM™ (if equipped), pressthe left © or right ¨ seek arrow to goto the previous or to the next stationor channel and stay there. Thisfunction is inactive, with someradios, if the front seat passengersare listening to the radio.

Press and hold the left © or right ¨seek arrow until the display flashes,to tune to an individual station. Thedisplay stops flashing after thebuttons have not been pushed formore than two seconds. Thisfunction is inactive, with someradios, if the front seat passengersare listening to the radio.

While listening to a disc, press theleft © seek arrow to go back to thestart of the current track or chapter(if more than ten seconds haveplayed). Press the right ¨ seekarrow to go to the next track orchapter on the disc. This function is

inactive, with some radios, if thefront seat passengers are listeningto the disc.

When a DVD video menu is beingdisplayed, press the left © or right ¨seek arrow to perform a cursor upor down on the menu. Hold the left© or right ¨ arrow to perform acursor left or right on the menu.

PROG (Program): Press thisbutton to go to the next preset radiostation or channel set on the mainradio. This function is inactive, withsome radios, if the front seatpassengers are listening to theradio.

When a CD or DVD audio disc isplaying, press this button to go tothe beginning of the CD or DVDaudio. This function is inactive, withsome radios, if the front seatpassengers are listening to the disc.

When a disc is playing in the CD orDVD changer, press this button toselect the next disc, if multiple discsare loaded. This function is inactive,with some radios, if the front seatpassengers are listening to the disc.

When a DVD video menu is beingdisplayed, press the PROG buttonto perform the menu function, enter.

Page 238: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (48,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-48 Infotainment System

Phone

BluetoothFor vehicles equipped withBluetooth capability, the system caninteract with many cell phones,allowing:. Placement and receipt of calls in

a hands-free mode.. Sharing of the cell phone’s

address book or contact list withthe vehicle.

To minimize driver distraction,before driving, and with the vehicleparked:. Become familiar with the

features of the cell phone.Organize the phone book andcontact lists clearly and deleteduplicate or rarely used entries.If possible, program speed dialor other shortcuts.

. Review the controls andoperation of the infotainmentsystem.

. Pair cell phone(s) to the vehicle.The system may not work withall cell phones. See “Pairing” inthis section for more information.

. If the cell phone has voicedialing capability, learn to usethat feature to access theaddress book or contact list. See“Voice Pass-Thru” in this sectionfor more information.

. See “Storing and Deleting PhoneNumbers” in this section formore information.

{ WARNING

When using a cell phone, it canbe distracting to look too long ortoo often at the screen of thephone or the infotainment(navigation) system. Taking youreyes off the road too long or toooften could cause a crashresulting in injury or death. Focusyour attention on driving.

A Bluetooth system can use aBluetooth-capable cell phone with aHands-Free Profile to make andreceive phone calls. The systemcan be used while the key is in theON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORYposition. The range of the Bluetoothsystem can be up to 9.1 m (30 ft).Not all phones support all functions,and not all phones work with thein-vehicle Bluetooth system. Seewww.gm.com/bluetooth for moreinformation on compatible phones.

Voice Recognition

The Bluetooth system uses voicerecognition to interpret voicecommands to dial phone numbersand name tags.

For additional information, say“Help” while you are in a voicerecognition menu.

Noise: Keep interior noise levels toa minimum. The system may notrecognize voice commands if thereis too much background noise.

Page 239: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (49,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-49

When to Speak: A short tonesounds after the system respondsindicating when it is waiting for avoice command. Wait until the toneand then speak.

How to Speak: Speak clearly in acalm and natural voice.

Audio System

When using the in-vehicle Bluetoothsystem, sound comes through thevehicle's front audio systemspeakers and overrides the audiosystem. Use the audio systemvolume knob, during a call, tochange the volume level. Theadjusted volume level remains inmemory for later calls. To preventmissed calls, a minimum volumelevel is used if the volume is turneddown too low.

Bluetooth Controls

Use the buttons on the steeringwheel to operate the in-vehicleBluetooth system. See SteeringWheel Controls on page 5‑2.

b / g (Push to Talk): Press toanswer incoming calls, confirmsystem information, and startspeech recognition.

c /x (End): Press to end a call,reject a call, or cancel an operation.

Pairing

A Bluetooth-enabled cell phonemust be paired to the Bluetoothsystem and then connected to thevehicle before it can be used. Seethe cell phone manufacturer's userguide for Bluetooth functions beforepairing the cell phone. If a Bluetoothphone is not connected, calls will bemade using OnStar Hands-FreeCalling, if equipped. See OnStarOverview on page 14‑1.

Pairing Information. A Bluetooth phone with MP3

capability cannot be paired tothe vehicle as a phone and anMP3 player at the same time.

. Up to five cell phones can bepaired to the Bluetooth system.

. The pairing process is disabledwhen the vehicle is moving.

. Pairing only needs to becompleted once, unless thepairing information on the cellphone changes or the cell phoneis deleted from the system.

. Only one paired cell phone canbe connected to the Bluetoothsystem at a time.

. If multiple paired cell phones arewithin range of the system, thesystem connects to the firstavailable paired cell phone in theorder that they were first pairedto the system. To connect to adifferent paired phone, see“Connecting to a DifferentPhone” later in this section.

Pairing a Phone

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Bluetooth.” This commandcan be skipped.

Page 240: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (50,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-50 Infotainment System

3. Say “Pair.” The system respondswith instructions and a four-digitPersonal Identification Number(PIN). The PIN is used in Step 5.

4. Start the pairing process on thecell phone that you want to pair.For help with this process, seethe cell phone manufacturer'suser guide.

5. Locate the device named “YourVehicle” in the list on the cellphone. Follow the instructionson the cell phone to enter thePIN provided in Step 3. After thePIN is successfully entered, thesystem prompts you to provide aname for the paired cell phone.This name will be used toindicate which phones arepaired and connected to thevehicle. The system respondswith “<phone name> has beensuccessfully paired” after thepairing process is complete.

6. Repeat Steps 1–5 to pairadditional phones.

Listing All Paired and ConnectedPhones

The system can list all cell phonespaired to it. If a paired cell phone isalso connected to the vehicle, thesystem responds with “is connected”after that phone name.

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Bluetooth.”

3. Say “List.”

Deleting a Paired Phone

If the phone name you want todelete is unknown, see “Listing AllPaired and Connected Phones.”

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Bluetooth.”

3. Say “Delete.” The system askswhich phone to delete.

4. Say the name of the phone youwant to delete.

Connecting to a Different Phone

To connect to a different cell phone,the Bluetooth system looks for thenext available cell phone in theorder in which all the available cellphones were paired. Depending onwhich cell phone you want toconnect to, you may have to usethis command several times.

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Bluetooth.”

3. Say “Change phone.”. If another cell phone is

found, the response will be“<Phone name> is nowconnected.”

. If another cell phone is notfound, the original phoneremains connected.

Page 241: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (51,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-51

Storing and Deleting PhoneNumbers

The system can store up to 30phone numbers as name tags in theHands-Free Directory that is sharedbetween the Bluetooth and OnStarsystems, if equipped.

The following commands are usedto delete and store phone numbers.

Store: This command will store aphone number, or a group ofnumbers as a name tag.

Digit Store: This command allowsa phone number to be stored as aname tag by entering the digits oneat a time.

Delete: This command is used todelete individual name tags.

Delete All Name Tags: Thiscommand deletes all stored nametags in the Hands-Free CallingDirectory and the OnStarTurn-by-Turn Destinations Directory,if equipped.

Using the “Store” Command

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Store.”

3. Say the phone number or groupof numbers you want to store allat once with no pauses, thenfollow the directions given by thesystem to save a name tag forthis number.

Using the “Digit Store” Command

If an unwanted number isrecognized by the system, say“Clear” at any time to clear the lastnumber.

To hear all of the numbersrecognized by the system, say“Verify” at any time.

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Digit Store.”

3. Say each digit, one at a time,that you want to store. Aftereach digit is entered, the system

repeats back the digit it heardfollowed by a tone. After the lastdigit has been entered, say“Store,” and then follow thedirections given by the system tosave a name tag for this number.

Using the “Delete” Command

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Delete.”

3. Say the name tag you want todelete.

Using the “Delete All Name Tags”Command

This command deletes all storedname tags in the Hands-FreeCalling Directory and the OnStarTurn-by-Turn Destinations Directory,if equipped.

To delete all name tags:

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Delete all name tags.”

Page 242: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (52,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-52 Infotainment System

Listing Stored Numbers

The list command will list all storednumbers and name tags.

Using the “List” Command

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Directory.”

3. Say “Hands-Free Calling.”

4. Say “List.”

Making a Call

Calls can be made using thefollowing commands.

Dial or Call: The dial or callcommand can be usedinterchangeably to dial a phonenumber or a stored name tag.

Digit Dial: This command allows aphone number to be dialed byentering the digits one at a time.

Re-dial: This command is used todial the last number used on the cellphone.

Using the “Dial” or “Call”Command

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Dial” or “Call.”

3. Say the entire number withoutpausing, or say the name tag.

Once connected, the person calledwill be heard through the audiospeakers.

Calling 911 Emergency

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Dial” or “Call.”

3. Say “911.”

4. Say “Dial” or “Call.”

Once connected, the person calledwill be heard through the audiospeakers.

Using the “Digit Dial” Command

The digit dial command allows aphone number to be dialed byentering the digits one at a time.

After each digit is entered, thesystem repeats back the digit itheard followed by a tone.

If an unwanted number isrecognized by the system, say“Clear” at any time to clear the lastnumber.

To hear all of the numbersrecognized by the system, say“Verify” at any time.

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Digit Dial.”

3. Say each digit, one at a time,that you want to dial. After eachdigit is entered, the systemrepeats back the digit it heardfollowed by a tone. After the lastdigit has been entered,say “Dial.”

Once connected, the person calledwill be heard through the audiospeakers.

Page 243: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (53,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-53

Using the “Re-dial” Command

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. After the tone, say “Re-dial.”

Once connected, the person calledwill be heard through the audiospeakers.

Receiving a Call

When an incoming call is received,the audio system mutes and a ringtone is heard in the vehicle.

. Press b / g to answer the call.

. Pressc /x to ignore a call.

Call Waiting

Call waiting must be supported onthe cell phone and enabled by thewireless service carrier.

. Press b / g to answer anincoming call when another callis active. The original call isplaced on hold.

. Press b / g again to return tothe original call.

. To ignore the incoming call, noaction is required.

. Pressc /x to disconnect thecurrent call and switch to the callon hold.

Three-Way Calling

Three-way calling must besupported on the cell phone andenabled by the wireless servicecarrier.

1. While on a call, press b / g.2. Say “Three-way call.”

3. Use the dial or call command todial the number of the third partyto be called.

4. Once the call is connected,press b / g to link all callerstogether.

Ending a Call

Pressc /x to end a call.

Muting a Call

During a call, all sounds from insidethe vehicle can be muted so that theperson on the other end of the callcannot hear them.

. To mute a call, press b / g , andthen say “Mute call.”

. To cancel mute, press b / g ,and then say “Un-mute call.”

Transferring a Call

Audio can be transferred betweenthe Bluetooth system and the cellphone.

The cell phone must be paired andconnected with the Bluetoothsystem before a call can betransferred. The connection processcan take up to two minutes after theignition is turned to ON/RUN.

Page 244: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (54,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-54 Infotainment System

Transferring Audio from theBluetooth System to a Cell Phone

During a call with the audio in thevehicle:

1. Press b / g.2. Say “Transfer Call.”

Transferring Audio to theBluetooth System from a CellPhone

During a call with the audio on thecell phone, press b / g. The audiotransfers to the vehicle. If the audiodoes not transfer to the vehicle, usethe audio transfer feature on the cellphone. See your cell phonemanufacturer's user guide for moreinformation.

Voice Pass-Thru

Voice pass-thru allows access to thevoice recognition commands on thecell phone. See your cell phonemanufacturer's user guide to see ifthe cell phone supports this feature.

To access contacts stored in the cellphone:

1. Press and hold b / g fortwo seconds.

2. Say “Bluetooth.” This commandcan be skipped.

3. Say “Voice.” The systemresponds “OK, accessing<phone name>.”

The cell phone's normal promptmessages will go through their cycleaccording to the phone's operatinginstructions.

Dual Tone Multi-Frequency(DTMF) Tones

The Bluetooth system can sendnumbers and the numbers stored asname tags during a call. You canuse this feature when calling amenu-driven phone system.Account numbers can also bestored for use.

Sending a Number or Name TagDuring a Call

1. Press b / g. The systemresponds “Ready,” followed bya tone.

2. Say “Dial.”

3. Say the number or name tagto send.

Clearing the System

Unless information is deleted out ofthe in-vehicle Bluetooth system, itwill be retained indefinitely. Thisincludes all saved name tags in thephone book and phone pairinginformation. For information on howto delete this information, see theprevious section “Deleting a PairedPhone” and the previous sectionson deleting name tags.

Page 245: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (55,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Infotainment System 7-55

Other Information

The Bluetooth® word mark andlogos are owned by the Bluetooth®

SIG, Inc. and any use of such marksby General Motors is under license.Other trademarks and trade namesare those of their respective owners.

See Radio Frequency Statement onpage 13‑20 for informationregarding Part 15 of the FederalCommunications Commission (FCC)rules and Industry CanadaStandards RSS-GEN/210/220/310.

Trademarks andLicense Agreements

Manufactured under license underU.S. Patent #'s: 5,451,942;5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762;6,487,535 & other U.S. andworldwide patents issued &pending. DTS and the Symbol areregistered trademarks and DTSDigital Surround and the DTS logosare trademarks of DTS Inc. AllRights Reserved.

Manufactured under license fromDolby Laboratories. Dolby and thedouble-D symbol are trademarks ofDolby Laboratories.

Page 246: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (56,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

7-56 Infotainment System

2 NOTES

Page 247: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Climate Controls 8-1

Climate Controls

Climate Control SystemsClimate Control Systems . . . . . . 8-1Dual Automatic Climate ControlSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3

Rear Climate Control System(Rear ClimateControl Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9

Rear Climate Control System(with Rear Seat Audio) . . . . . 8-10

Air VentsAir Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12

Climate Control Systems

The heating, cooling, and ventilation in the vehicle can be controlled withthis system.

A. Fan Control

B. REAR (Rear Climate Control)

C. Recirculation

D. Air Delivery Mode Control

E. Air Conditioning

F. Driver and PassengerTemperature Controls

G. Rear Window Defogger

Temperature Control: Move thethumbwheels up or down toincrease or decrease thetemperature on the driver side orthe passenger side of the vehicle forthe dual zone system.

Page 248: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

8-2 Climate Controls

9 (Fan Control): Turn the leftknob clockwise or counterclockwiseto increase or decrease the fanspeed. Turn the knob all the waycounterclockwise to turn the frontsystem off.

Air Delivery Mode Control: Turnclockwise or counterclockwise tochange the airflow direction insidethe vehicle. By positioning the knobbetween two modes, a combinationof those modes is selected.

Select from the following modes:

H (Vent): Air is directed to theinstrument panel outlets.

) (Bi-Level): Air is dividedbetween the instrument panel andfloor outlets. Some air is directedtowards the windshield and sidewindow outlets. Cooler air isdirected to the upper outlets andwarmer air to the floor outlets.

6 (Floor): Air is directed to thefloor outlets, with some of the airdirected to the windshield, sidewindow, and second row floor

outlets. In this mode, the systemautomatically selects outside air.Recirculation cannot be selectedwhen in Floor Mode.

- (Defog): The defog mode isused to clear the windows of fog ormoisture. Air is directed to thewindshield, floor outlets, and sidewindow vents. In this mode, thesystem turns off recirculation andruns the air conditioning compressorunless the outside temperature isclose to freezing. The recirculationmode cannot be selected while inthe defog mode.

0 (Defrost): The defrost mode isused to remove fog or frost from thewindshield more quickly. Air isdirected to the windshield and sidewindow vents, with some directed tothe floor vents. In this mode, thesystem automatically forces outsideair into the vehicle. The recirculationmode cannot be selected while inthe defrost mode. The airconditioning compressor runs

automatically in this setting, unlessthe outside temperature is close tofreezing.

Do not drive the vehicle until all thewindows are clear.

# (Air Conditioning): Press thisbutton to turn the air conditioningsystem on or off. An indicator lightcomes on to show that the airconditioning is on. The airconditioning can be selected in anymode as long as the fan switchis on.

On hot days, open the windows tolet hot inside air escape; then closethem. This helps to reduce the timeit takes for the vehicle to cool down.It also helps the system to operatemore efficiently.

The air conditioning systemremoves moisture from the air, so asmall amount of water might dripunder the vehicle while idling orafter turning off the engine. This isnormal.

Page 249: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Climate Controls 8-3

h (Recirculation): Press thisbutton to turn the recirculation modeon or off. An indicator light comeson to show that recirculation is on.

This mode recirculates and helps toquickly cool the air inside thevehicle. It can be used to helpprevent outside air and odors fromentering the vehicle.

The recirculation mode cannot beused with floor, defrost, or defoggingmodes. If recirculation is selectedwhile in one of those modes, theindicator flashes three times andturns off. The air conditioningcompressor will also come on whenthis mode is activated. While inrecirculation mode the windows mayfog when the weather is cold anddamp. To clear the fog, select eitherthe defog or defrost mode andincrease the fan speed. Therecirculation mode can also beturned off by turning off the engine.

REAR: Press to turn the rearheating and air conditioning on. SeeRear Climate Control System (RearClimate Control Only) on page 8‑9or Rear Climate Control System(with Rear Seat Audio) onpage 8‑10 for more information.

Rear Window Defogger

The rear window defogger uses awarming grid to remove fog from therear window.

1 (Rear Window Defogger):Press this button to turn the rearwindow defogger on or off. Thesystem automatically turns offseveral minutes after it has beenactivated. The defogger can also beturned off by turning off the engine.Do not drive the vehicle until all thewindows are clear.

For vehicles with heated outsiderearview mirrors, the mirrors willheat to help clear fog or frost fromthe surface of the mirror when therear window defog button ispressed.

Notice: Do not use anythingsharp on the inside of the rearwindow. If you do, you could cutor damage the warming grid, andthe repairs would not be coveredby the vehicle warranty. Do notattach a temporary vehiclelicense, tape, a decal, or anythingsimilar to the defogger grid.

Dual Automatic ClimateControl SystemThe heating, cooling, and ventilationin the vehicle can be controlled withthis system. The vehicle also has aflow-through ventilation systemdescribed later in this section.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Page 250: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

8-4 Climate Controls

A. Fan Control

B. AUTO (Automatic Operation)

C. Defrost

D. Recirculation

E. REAR (Rear Climate Control)

F. Air Delivery Mode Control

G. Driver Temperature Control

H. Display

I. Power Button

J. Rear Window Defogger

K. Air Conditioning

L. PASS

M. Passenger Temperature Control

O (On/Off): Press to turn theclimate control system on or off.Outside air still enters the vehicle,and is directed to the floor. Thisdirection can be changed bypressing the mode button.Recirculation can be selected onceyou have selected vent or bi-levelmode. The temperature can also beadjusted using either temperaturebutton. If the air delivery mode ortemperature settings are adjusted

with the system off, the displayilluminates briefly to show thesettings and then returns to off. Thesystem can be turned back on bypressing either O, D, C,# , thedefrost or the AUTO button.

Driver and Passenger SideTemperature Control

The driver and passenger sidetemperature buttons are used toadjust the temperature of the aircoming through the system on thedriver or passenger side of thevehicle. The temperature can beadjusted even if the system isturned off. This is possible sinceoutside air always flows through thesystem as the vehicle is movingforward unless it is set torecirculation mode. See“Recirculation” later in this section.

Press the + or − buttons to increaseor decrease the cabin temperature.The driver side or passenger sidetemperature display shows thetemperature setting decreasing orincreasing.

Page 251: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Climate Controls 8-5

The passenger temperature settingcan be set to match the drivertemperature setting by pressing thePASS button and turning off thePASS indicator.

When in defrost mode thepassenger temperature settingcannot be changed.

Automatic Operation

AUTO (Automatic): Whenautomatic operation is active thesystem will control the insidetemperature, the air delivery, andthe fan speed.

Use the steps below to place theentire system in automatic mode:

1. Press the AUTO button.

When AUTO is selected, thedisplay will change to show thecurrent temperature(s) andAUTO will be lit on the display.The current delivery mode andfan speed will also be displayedfor approximately 5 seconds.

When AUTO is selected, the airconditioning operation and airinlet will be automaticallycontrolled. The air conditioningcompressor will run when theoutside temperature is overabout 4°C (40°F). The air inletwill normally be set to outsideair. If it is hot outside, the airinlet may automatically switch torecirculate inside air to helpquickly cool down the vehicle.The light on the button comes onin recirculation.

2. Set the driver and passengertemperature.

To find your comfort setting, startwith a 23°C (74°F) temperaturesetting and allow about20 minutes for the system toregulate. Use the driver orpassenger temperature buttonsto adjust the temperature settingas necessary. If a temperaturesetting of 15°C (60°F) is chosen,the system remains at the

maximum cooling setting. If atemperature setting of 32°C(90°F) is chosen, the systemremains at the maximum heatsetting. Choosing eithermaximum setting will not causethe vehicle to heat or cool anyfaster.

Do not cover the solar sensorlocated on the top of the instrumentpanel near the windshield. Thissensor regulates air temperaturebased on sun load and also turnson the headlamps. For moreinformation on the solar sensor, see“Sensors” later in this section.

To avoid blowing cold air in coldweather, the system will delayturning on the fan until warm air isavailable. The length of delaydepends on the engine coolanttemperature. Pressing the fanswitch will override this delay andchange the fan to a selected speed.

Page 252: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

8-6 Climate Controls

Manual Operation

D C (Fan Control): Press thesebuttons to increase or decrease thefan speed.

Pressing either fan button while inautomatic control places the fanunder manual control. The fansetting remains displayed and theAUTO light turns off. The airdelivery mode remains underautomatic control.

H G (Air Delivery Mode Control):Press these buttons to change thedirection of the airflow in the vehicle.Repeatedly press either button untilthe desired mode appears on thedisplay. Pressing either mode buttonwhile the system is off changes theair delivery mode without turning thesystem on. Pressing either modebutton while in automatic controlplaces the mode under manualcontrol.

The air delivery mode setting isdisplayed and the AUTO light turnsoff. The fan remains underautomatic control.

H (Vent): Air is directed to theinstrument panel outlets.

) (Bi-Level): Air is dividedbetween the instrument panel andfloor outlets. Some air is directedtowards the windshield and sidewindow outlets.

6 (Floor): Air is directed to thefloor outlets, with some to thewindshield, side window outlets, andsecond row floor outlets. In thismode, the system automaticallyselects outside air.

- (Defog): This mode clears thewindows of fog or moisture. Air isdirected to the windshield, flooroutlets, and side window vents. Inthis mode, the system turns offrecirculation and runs the airconditioning compressor unless theoutside temperature is close tofreezing. The recirculation modecannot be selected while in thedefog mode.

0 (Defrost): This mode removesfog or frost from the windshieldmore quickly. Air is directed to the

windshield and side window vents,with some directed to the floorvents. In this mode, the systemautomatically forces outside air intothe vehicle and runs the airconditioning compressor unless theoutside temperature is close tofreezing. The recirculation modecannot be selected while in thedefrost mode.

The passenger temperature controlcannot be activated while in defrostmode. If the PASS button ispressed, the button indicator flashesthree times and will not work. If thepassenger temperature buttons areadjusted, the driver temperatureindicator changes. The passengertemperature will not be displayed.

If vent, bi-level, or floor mode isselected again, the climate controlsystem displays the previoustemperature settings.

Do not drive the vehicle until all thewindows are clear.

Page 253: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Climate Controls 8-7

# (Air Conditioning): Press toturn the air conditioning (A/C)compressor on and off. An indicatorlight comes on to show that the airconditioning is on.

If this button is pressed when the airconditioning compressor isunavailable, the indicator flashesthree times and then turns off. If theair conditioning is on and theoutside temperature drops below atemperature which is too cool for airconditioning to be effective, the airconditioning light turns off to showthat the air conditioning mode hasbeen canceled.

On hot days, open the windows longenough to let hot inside air escape.This helps to reduce the time ittakes for the vehicle to cool down.It also helps the system to operatemore efficiently.

The air conditioning systemremoves moisture from the air, so asmall amount of water might drip

under the vehicle while idling orafter turning off the engine. This isnormal.

@ (Recirculation): Press to turnthe recirculation mode on or off. Anindicator light comes on to showthat the recirculation is on.

This mode recirculates and helps toquickly cool the air inside thevehicle. It can be used to helpprevent outside air and odors fromentering the vehicle.

The recirculation mode cannot beused with floor, defog, or defrostmodes. If recirculation is selectedwith one of those modes, theindicator light flashes three timesand then turns off. The airconditioning compressor also comeson when this mode is activated.While in recirculation mode thewindows may fog when the weatheris cold and damp. To clear the fog,select either the defog or defrostmode and increase the fan speed.

The recirculation mode can also beturned off by turning off the ignition.

PASS: Press to set the passengertemperature setting to match thedriver temperature setting. ThePASS indicator will turn off. Whenthe passenger temperature settingis set different than the driversetting, the indicator on the PASSbutton illuminates and both thedriver side and passenger sidetemperature displays are shown.

REAR: For vehicles with the rearheat and air conditioning controls.Press to turn the rear climate controlsystem on or off. See Rear ClimateControl System (Rear ClimateControl Only) on page 8‑9 or RearClimate Control System (with RearSeat Audio) on page 8‑10.

Rear Window Defogger

The rear window defogger uses awarming grid to remove fog from therear window.

Page 254: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

8-8 Climate Controls

1 (Rear Window Defogger):Press to turn the rear windowdefogger on or off. It automaticallyturns off several minutes after it hasbeen activated. The defogger canalso be turned off by turning off theengine. Do not drive the vehicle untilall the windows are clear.

Notice: Do not use a razor bladeor sharp object to clear the insiderear window. Do not adhereanything to the defogger gridlines in the rear glass. Theseactions may damage the reardefogger. Repairs would not becovered by your warranty.

Heated Mirrors: Press1 to helpclear fog or frost from the surface ofthe outside mirror. See PowerMirrors on page 2‑16.

Sensors

The solar sensor, located in thedefrost grille in the middle of theinstrument panel, monitors the solarheat. Do not cover the solar sensoror the system will not work properly.

The interior temperature sensorslocated in the headliner above thedriver side seat and if equipped, inthe headliner above the second rowseats measure the temperature ofthe air inside the vehicle.

Page 255: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Climate Controls 8-9

There is also an exteriortemperature sensor located behindthe front grille. This sensor readsthe outside air temperature andhelps maintain the temperatureinside the vehicle. Any cover on thefront of the vehicle could cause afalse reading in the displayedtemperature.

The climate control system uses theinformation from these sensors tomaintain your comfort setting byadjusting the outlet temperature, fanspeed, and the air delivery mode.The system may also supply coolerair to the side of the vehicle facingthe sun. The recirculation mode willalso be used as needed to maintaincool outlet temperatures.

Rear Climate Control System (Rear ClimateControl Only)For vehicles with this system, the rear controls are three knobs located inthe headliner. The system can also be controlled with the front controls.

A. Fan Control

B. Temperature Control

C. Air Delivery Mode Control

REAR: Press the REAR button onthe front climate control system toturn the rear climate control systemon or off. An indicator comes onwhen the rear system is on.

See Climate Control Systems onpage 8‑1 or Dual Automatic ClimateControl System on page 8‑3. Therear system can also be turned offby turning the rear fan knob to the9 position.

Page 256: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

8-10 Climate Controls

Mimic Mode: This mode matchesthe rear climate control to the frontclimate control airflow settings.It comes on when REAR is pressedthe first time.

Independent Mode: This modedirects rear seating airflowaccording to the settings of the rearcontrols. It comes on when any rearcontrol is adjusted.

Temperature Control: Turnclockwise or counterclockwise toincrease or decrease the airflowtemperature into thepassenger area.

Fan Control: Turn clockwise orcounterclockwise to increase ordecrease the fan speed.

Air Delivery Mode Control: Turnclockwise or counterclockwise tochange the direction of the airflow.

H (Vent): Air is directed throughthe headliner outlets.

) (Bi-Level): Air is directedthrough the floor and headlineroutlets. The rear system floor

outlets are located directly behindthe second row seats. The flow canbe divided between vent and flooroutlets depending upon where theknob is placed between the settings.

6 (Floor): Air is directed to thefloor outlets. The rear system flooroutlets are located directly behindthe second row seats.

Rear Climate ControlSystem (with Rear SeatAudio)For vehicles with the rear heat andair conditioning controls, they areintegrated with the rear seat audiocontrols located in the centerconsole. The system can becontrolled from the front controls aswell as the rear controls.

Page 257: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Climate Controls 8-11

Rear Climate Control with Rear Seat Audio Controls

A. Fan Control

B. Air Delivery Mode Control

C. Temperature Control

REAR: Press the REAR button onthe front climate control system toturn the rear climate control systemon or off. An indicator comes onwhen the rear system is on.

The rear climate control system canalso be turned off by pressing andholding the C button. To turn the

system on from the rear seats,press any rear climate controlbutton, except the C button.

Mimic Mode: This mode matchesthe rear climate control to the frontclimate control airflow settings.It comes on when REAR is pressedthe first time.

Independent Mode: This modedirects rear seating airflowaccording to the settings of the rearcontrols.

To turn the system on from the rear,press any rear climate controlbutton, except the C button.

Automatic Operation, IfEquipped

AUTO: Press the air delivery modebutton until this setting is selected tocontrol the inside temperature, airdelivery, and fan speed. AUTOappears in the display whenautomatic operation is active.

+ or − (Increase/DecreaseTemperature): Press the + or −buttons to increase or decrease thecabin temperature. The rear controltemperature display will show thetemperature setting increasing ordecreasing.

The display only indicates climatecontrol functions when the system isin rear independent mode.

Page 258: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

8-12 Climate Controls

Manual Operation

D C (Fan Control): Press thesebuttons on the rear seat audiocontrol panel to increase ordecrease the airflow. Pressing thefan up button when the system is offwill turn the system on. The airdelivery mode will remain underautomatic control.

+ or − (Temperature Control):Press these buttons to adjust thetemperature of the air flowing intothe passenger area. Press the +button for warmer air and press the− button for cooler air.

N (Air Delivery Mode Control):Press the mode button to changethe direction of the airflow in thevehicle. Repeatedly press thebutton until the desired modeappears on the display. Multiplepresses will cycle through thedelivery selections.

Air VentsUse the air outlets located in thecenter and on the side of theinstrument panel to direct theairflow.

Operation Tips. Keep the hood and front air

inlets free of ice, snow, or anyother obstruction (such asleaves). The heater anddefroster will work far better,reducing the chance of foggingthe inside of the windows.

. When you enter a vehicle in coldweather, press the fan up buttonto the maximum fan level beforedriving. This helps clear theintake ducts of snow andmoisture, and reduces thechance of fogging the inside ofthe window.

. Keep the air path under the frontseats clear of objects. This helpsair to circulate throughout thevehicle.

. Adding outside equipment to thefront of the vehicle, such ashood-air deflectors, may affectthe performance of the heatingand air conditioning system.Check with your dealer beforeadding equipment to the outsideof the vehicle.

Page 259: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-1

Driving andOperating

Driving InformationDistracted Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3Drunk Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5Off-Road Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5Driving on Wet Roads . . . . . . . 9-10Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . 9-11Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12If the Vehicle Is Stuck . . . . . . . . 9-14Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . 9-15

Starting and OperatingNew Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . 9-19Adjustable Throttle and BrakePedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20

Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . 9-22Engine Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23

Retained AccessoryPower (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24

Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24Shifting out of Park . . . . . . . . . . 9-26Parking over ThingsThat Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-27

Active Fuel Management® . . . 9-27

Engine ExhaustEngine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-27Running the Vehicle WhileParked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-28

Automatic TransmissionAutomatic Transmission . . . . . 9-28Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-31Tow/Haul Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-32

Drive SystemsFour-Wheel Drive (Two SpeedAutomaticTransfer Case) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-33

Four-Wheel Drive (SingleSpeed AutomaticTransfer Case) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-38

BrakesAntilock BrakeSystem (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-40

Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-41Brake Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-41Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . 9-41

Ride Control SystemsStabiliTrak® System . . . . . . . . . 9-42Locking Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45Continuous DampingControl (CDC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45

Automatic Level Control . . . . . 9-45

Cruise ControlCruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-46

Object Detection SystemsUltrasonic Parking Assist . . . . 9-48Side Blind ZoneAlert (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-49

Rear VisionCamera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-52

FuelFuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-55Recommended Fuel . . . . . . . . . 9-56Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . 9-56California FuelRequirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-56

Page 260: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-2 Driving and Operating

Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . 9-57Fuel Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-57Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol) . . . . . 9-58Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-59Filling a Portable FuelContainer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-60

TowingGeneral TowingInformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-61

Driving Characteristics andTowing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-61

Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-64Towing Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . 9-69Trailer SwayControl (TSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-77

Conversions and Add-OnsAdd-On ElectricalEquipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-78

Adding a Snow Plow orSimilar Equipment . . . . . . . . . . 9-78

Driving Information

Distracted DrivingDistraction comes in many formsand can take your focus from thetask of driving. Exercise goodjudgment and do not let otheractivities divert your attention awayfrom the road. Many localgovernments have enacted lawsregarding driver distraction. Becomefamiliar with the local laws inyour area.

To avoid distracted driving, alwayskeep your eyes on the road, handson the wheel, and mind on the drive.. Do not use a phone in

demanding driving situations.Use a hands-free method toplace or receive necessaryphone calls.

. Watch the road. Do not read,take notes, or look upinformation on phones or otherelectronic devices.

. Designate a front seatpassenger to handle potentialdistractions.

. Become familiar with vehiclefeatures before driving, such asprogramming favorite radiostations and adjusting climatecontrol and seat settings.Program all trip information intoany navigation device prior todriving.

. Wait until the vehicle is parkedto retrieve items that have fallento the floor.

. Stop or park the vehicle to tendto children.

. Keep pets in an appropriatecarrier or restraint.

. Avoid stressful conversationswhile driving, whether with apassenger or on a cell phone.

Page 261: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-3

{ WARNING

Taking your eyes off the road toolong or too often could cause acrash resulting in injury or death.Focus your attention on driving.

Refer to the infotainment section formore information on using thatsystem, including pairing and usinga cell phone.

If equipped, refer to the navigationmanual for information on thatsystem, including pairing and usinga cell phone.

Defensive DrivingDefensive driving means “alwaysexpect the unexpected.” The firststep in driving defensively is to wearthe safety belt. See Safety Belts onpage 3‑16.. Assume that other road users

(pedestrians, bicyclists, andother drivers) are going to be

careless and make mistakes.Anticipate what they might doand be ready.

. Allow enough following distancebetween you and the driver infront of you.

. Focus on the task of driving.

Drunk DrivingDeath and injury associated withdrinking and driving is a globaltragedy.

{ WARNING

Drinking and then driving is verydangerous. Your reflexes,perceptions, attentiveness, andjudgment can be affected by evena small amount of alcohol. Youcan have a serious — or evenfatal — collision if you drive afterdrinking.

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

Do not drink and drive or ride witha driver who has been drinking.Ride home in a cab; or if you arewith a group, designate a driverwho will not drink.

Control of a VehicleBraking, steering, and acceleratingare important factors in helping tocontrol a vehicle while driving.

BrakingBraking action involves perceptiontime and reaction time. Deciding topush the brake pedal is perceptiontime. Actually doing it isreaction time.

Average driver reaction time isabout three-quarters of a second. Inthat time, a vehicle moving at100 km/h (60 mph) travels 20 m(66 ft), which could be a lot ofdistance in an emergency.

Page 262: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-4 Driving and Operating

Helpful braking tips to keep in mindinclude:. Keep enough distance between

you and the vehicle in frontof you.

. Avoid needless heavy braking.

. Keep pace with traffic.

If the engine ever stops while thevehicle is being driven, brakenormally but do not pump thebrakes. Doing so could make thepedal harder to push down. If theengine stops, there will be somepower brake assist but it will beused when the brake is applied.Once the power assist is used up, itcan take longer to stop and thebrake pedal will be harder to push.

Steering

Hydraulic Power Steering

Your vehicle has hydraulic powersteering. It may requiremaintenance. See Power SteeringFluid on page 10‑20.

If power steering assist is lostbecause the engine stops orbecause of a system malfunction,the vehicle can be steered but mayrequired increased effort. See yourdealer if there is a problem.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Curve Tips. Take curves at a reasonable

speed.. Reduce speed before entering a

curve.. Maintain a reasonable steady

speed through the curve. Wait until the vehicle is out of

the curve before acceleratinggently into the straightaway.

Steering in Emergencies. There are some situations when

steering around a problem maybe more effective than braking.

. Holding both sides of thesteering wheel allows you to turn180 degrees without removinga hand.

. Antilock Brake System (ABS)allows steering while braking.

Off-Road Recovery

Page 263: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-5

The vehicle's right wheels can dropoff the edge of a road onto theshoulder while driving. Followthese tips:

1. Ease off the accelerator andthen, if there is nothing in theway, steer the vehicle so that itstraddles the edge of thepavement.

2. Turn the steering wheel aboutone-eighth of a turn, until theright front tire contacts thepavement edge.

3. Turn the steering wheel to gostraight down the roadway.

Loss of Control

Skidding

There are three types of skids thatcorrespond to the vehicle's threecontrol systems:. Braking Skid — wheels are not

rolling.

. Steering or Cornering Skid —too much speed or steering in acurve causes tires to slip andlose cornering force.

. Acceleration Skid — too muchthrottle causes the drivingwheels to spin.

Defensive drivers avoid most skidsby taking reasonable care suited toexisting conditions, and by notoverdriving those conditions. Butskids are always possible.

If the vehicle starts to slide, followthese suggestions:. Ease your foot off the

accelerator pedal and steer theway you want the vehicle to go.The vehicle may straighten out.Be ready for a second skid if itoccurs.

. Slow down and adjust yourdriving according to weatherconditions. Stopping distancecan be longer and vehiclecontrol can be affected whentraction is reduced by water,snow, ice, gravel, or other

material on the road. Learn torecognize warning clues — suchas enough water, ice, or packedsnow on the road to make amirrored surface — and slowdown when you have any doubt.

. Try to avoid sudden steering,acceleration, or braking,including reducing vehicle speedby shifting to a lower gear. Anysudden changes could causethe tires to slide.

Remember: Antilock brakes helpavoid only the braking skid.

Off-Road DrivingFour-wheel-drive vehicles can beused for off-road driving. Vehicleswithout four-wheel drive andvehicles not equipped with AllTerrain (AT) or On-Off Road (OOR)tires must not be driven off-roadexcept on a level, solid surface. Tocontact the tire manufacturer formore information about the original

Page 264: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-6 Driving and Operating

equipment tires, see the LimitedWarranty and Owner AssistanceInformation manual.

Controlling the vehicle is the key tosuccessful off-road driving. One ofthe best ways to control the vehicleis to control the speed.

{ WARNING

When driving off-road, bouncingand quick changes in directioncan easily throw you out ofposition. This could cause you tolose control and crash. You andyour passengers should alwayswear safety belts.

Before Driving Off-Road. Have all necessary maintenance

and service work completed.. Fuel the vehicle, fill fluid levels,

and check inflation pressure inall tires, including the spare,if equipped.

. Read all the information aboutfour-wheel-drive vehicles in thismanual.

. Make sure all underbodyshields, if equipped, are properlyattached.

. Know the local laws that apply tooff-road driving.

To gain more ground clearance ifneeded, it may be necessary toremove the front fascia lowerair dam.

Notice: Operating the vehicle forextended periods without thefront fascia lower air daminstalled can cause improper airflow to the engine. Re‐attach thefront fascia air dam after off-roaddriving.

Loading the Vehicle forOff-Road Driving

{ WARNING

. Unsecured cargo on the loadfloor can be tossed aboutwhen driving over roughterrain. You or yourpassengers can be struck byflying objects. Secure thecargo properly.

. Keep cargo in the cargo areaas far forward and as low aspossible. The heaviest thingsshould be on the floor,forward of the rear axle.

. Heavy loads on the roof raisethe vehicle's center of gravity,making it more likely to rollover. You can be seriously orfatally injured if the vehiclerolls over. Put heavy loadsinside the cargo area, not onthe roof.

Page 265: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-7

For more information about loadingthe vehicle, see Vehicle Load Limitsand Tires.

Environmental Concerns. Always use established trails,

roads, and areas that have beenset aside for public off-roadrecreational driving and obey allposted regulations.

. Do not damage shrubs, flowers,trees, or grasses or disturbwildlife.

. Do not park over things thatburn. See Parking over ThingsThat Burn on page 9‑27.

Driving on Hills

Driving safely on hills requires goodjudgment and an understanding ofwhat the vehicle can and cannot do.

{ WARNING

Many hills are simply too steepfor any vehicle. Driving up hillscan cause the vehicle to stall.Driving down hills can cause lossof control. Driving across hills cancause a rollover. You could beinjured or killed. Do not drive onsteep hills.

Before driving on a hill, assess thesteepness, traction, andobstructions. If the terrain aheadcannot be seen, get out of thevehicle and walk the hill beforedriving further.

When driving on hills:. Use a low gear and keep a firm

grip on the steering wheel.. Maintain a slow speed.. When possible, drive straight up

or down the hill.. Slow down when approaching

the top of the hill.

. Use headlamps even during theday to make the vehicle morevisible.

{ WARNING

Driving to the top of a hill at highspeed can cause an accident.There could be a drop-off,embankment, cliff, or evenanother vehicle. You could beseriously injured or killed. As younear the top of a hill, slow downand stay alert.

. Never go downhill forward orbackward with either thetransmission or transfer case inN (Neutral). The brakes couldoverheat and you could losecontrol.

Page 266: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-8 Driving and Operating

{ WARNING

If the vehicle has the two‐speedautomatic transfer case, shiftingthe transfer case to N (Neutral)can cause your vehicle to rolleven if the transmission is inP (Park). This is because theN (Neutral) position on thetransfer case overrides thetransmission. You or someoneelse could be injured. If leavingthe vehicle, set the parking brakeand shift the transmission toP (Park). Shift the transfer case toany position but N (Neutral).

. When driving down a hill, keepthe vehicle headed straightdown. Use a low gear becausethe engine will work with thebrakes to slow the vehicle andhelp keep the vehicle undercontrol.

{ WARNING

Heavy braking when going downa hill can cause your brakes tooverheat and fade. This couldcause loss of control and you orothers could be injured or killed.Apply the brakes lightly whendescending a hill and use a lowgear to keep vehicle speed undercontrol.

If the vehicle stalls on a hill:

1. Apply the brakes to stop thevehicle, and then apply theparking brake.

2. Shift into P (Park) and thenrestart the engine.. If driving uphill when the

vehicle stalls, shift toR (Reverse), release theparking brake, and backstraight down.

. Never try to turn the vehiclearound. If the hill is steepenough to stall the vehicle,it is steep enough to causeit to roll over.

. If you cannot make it up thehill, back straight downthe hill.

. Never back down a hill inN (Neutral) using only thebrake.

. The vehicle can rollbackward quickly and youcould lose control.

. If driving downhill when thevehicle stalls, shift to alower gear, release theparking brake, and drivestraight down the hill.

3. If the vehicle cannot be restartedafter stalling, set the parkingbrake, shift an automatictransmission into P (Park), andturn the vehicle off.

3.1. Leave the vehicle andseek help.

Page 267: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-9

3.2. Stay clear of the path thevehicle would take if itrolled downhill.

. Avoid turns that take the vehicleacross the incline of the hill.A hill that can be driven straightup or down might be too steep todrive across. Driving across anincline puts more weight on thedownhill wheels which couldcause a downhill slide or arollover.

. Surface conditions can be aproblem. Loose gravel, muddyspots, or even wet grass cancause the tires to slip sideways,downhill. If the vehicle slipssideways, it can hit somethingthat will trip it – a rock, a rut,etc. – and roll over.

. Hidden obstacles can make thesteepness of the incline moresevere. If a rock is driven acrosswith the uphill wheels, or if thedownhill wheels drop into a rutor depression, the vehicle can tilteven more.

. If an incline must be drivenacross, and the vehicle starts toslide, turn downhill. This shouldhelp straighten out the vehicleand prevent the side slipping.

{ WARNING

Getting out of the vehicle on thedownhill side when stoppedacross an incline is dangerous.If the vehicle rolls over, you couldbe crushed or killed. Always getout on the uphill side of thevehicle and stay well clear of therollover path.

Driving in Mud, Sand, Snow,or Ice

Use a low gear when driving inmud – the deeper the mud, thelower the gear. Keep the vehiclemoving to avoid getting stuck.

Traction changes when driving onsand. On loose sand, such as onbeaches or sand dunes, the tirestend to sink into the sand. This

affects steering, accelerating, andbraking. Drive at a reduced speedand avoid sharp turns or abruptmaneuvers.

Traction is reduced on hard packedsnow and ice and it is easy to losecontrol. Reduce vehicle speed whendriving on hard packed snowand ice.

{ WARNING

Driving on frozen lakes, ponds,or rivers can be dangerous. Iceconditions vary greatly and thevehicle could fall through the ice;you and your passengers coulddrown. Drive your vehicle on safesurfaces only.

Page 268: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-10 Driving and Operating

Driving in Water

{ WARNING

Driving through rushing water canbe dangerous. Deep water cansweep your vehicle downstreamand you and your passengerscould drown. If it is only shallowwater, it can still wash away theground from under your tires.Traction could be lost, and thevehicle could roll over. Do notdrive through rushing water.

Notice: Do not drive throughstanding water if it is deepenough to cover the wheel hubs,axles or exhaust pipe. Deep watercan damage the axle and othervehicle parts.

If the standing water is not too deep,drive slowly through it. At fasterspeeds, water splashes on theignition system and the vehicle canstall. Stalling can also occur if youget the tailpipe under water. While

the tailpipe is under water, you willnot be able to start the engine.When going through water, thebrakes get wet, and it might takelonger to stop. See Driving on WetRoads.

After Off-Road Driving

Remove any brush or debris thathas collected on the underbody,or chassis, or under the hood.These accumulations can be a firehazard.

After operation in mud or sand,have the brake linings cleaned andchecked. These substances cancause glazing and uneven braking.Check the body structure, steering,suspension, wheels, tires, andexhaust system for damage andcheck the fuel lines and coolingsystem for any leakage.

More frequent maintenance serviceis required. Refer to theMaintenance Schedule for moreinformation.

Driving on Wet RoadsRain and wet roads can reducevehicle traction and affect yourability to stop and accelerate.Always drive slower in these typesof driving conditions and avoiddriving through large puddles anddeep‐standing or flowing water.

{ WARNING

Wet brakes can cause crashes.They might not work as well in aquick stop and could causepulling to one side. You couldlose control of the vehicle.

After driving through a largepuddle of water or a car/vehiclewash, lightly apply the brakepedal until the brakes worknormally.

Flowing or rushing water createsstrong forces. Driving throughflowing water could cause thevehicle to be carried away. If this

(Continued)

Page 269: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-11

WARNING (Continued)

happens, you and other vehicleoccupants could drown. Do notignore police warnings and bevery cautious about trying to drivethrough flowing water.

Hydroplaning

Hydroplaning is dangerous. Watercan build up under the vehicle'stires so they actually ride on thewater. This can happen if the road iswet enough and you are going fastenough. When the vehicle ishydroplaning, it has little or nocontact with the road.

There is no hard and fast rule abouthydroplaning. The best advice is toslow down when the road is wet.

Other Rainy Weather Tips

Besides slowing down, other wetweather driving tips include:. Allow extra following distance.

. Pass with caution.

. Keep windshield wipingequipment in good shape.

. Keep the windshield washer fluidreservoir filled.

. Have good tires with propertread depth. See Tires onpage 10‑40.

. Turn off cruise control.

Highway HypnosisAlways be alert and pay attention toyour surroundings while driving.If you become tired or sleepy, find asafe place to park the vehicleand rest.

Other driving tips include:. Keep the vehicle well ventilated.. Keep the interior

temperature cool.. Keep your eyes moving — scan

the road ahead and to the sides.. Check the rearview mirror and

vehicle instruments often.

Hill and Mountain RoadsDriving on steep hills or throughmountains is different than drivingon flat or rolling terrain. Tips fordriving in these conditions include:. Keep the vehicle serviced and in

good shape.. Check all fluid levels and brakes,

tires, cooling system, andtransmission.

. Shift to a lower gear when goingdown steep or long hills.

{ WARNING

If you do not shift down, thebrakes could get so hot that theywould not work well. You wouldthen have poor braking or evennone going down a hill. You couldcrash. Shift down to let the engineassist the brakes on a steepdownhill slope.

Page 270: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-12 Driving and Operating

{ WARNING

Coasting downhill in N (Neutral)or with the ignition off isdangerous. The brakes will haveto do all the work of slowing downand they could get so hot thatthey would not work well. Youwould then have poor braking oreven none going down a hill.Steering may also be affectedwhen ignition is off. You couldcrash. Always have the enginerunning and the vehicle in gearwhen going downhill.

. Stay in your own lane. Do notswing wide or cut across thecenter of the road. Drive atspeeds that let you stay in yourown lane.

. Be alert on top of hills;something could be in your lane(stalled car, accident).

. Pay attention to special roadsigns (falling rocks area, windingroads, long grades, passing orno-passing zones) and takeappropriate action.

Winter Driving

Driving on Snow or Ice

Drive carefully when there is snowor ice between the tires and theroad, creating less traction or grip.Wet ice can occur at about 0°C(32°F) when freezing rain begins tofall, resulting in even less traction.Avoid driving on wet ice or infreezing rain until roads can betreated with salt or sand.

Drive with caution, whatever thecondition. Accelerate gently sotraction is not lost. Accelerating tooquickly causes the wheels to spinand makes the surface under thetires slick, so there is even lesstraction.

Try not to break the fragile traction.If you accelerate too fast, the drivewheels will spin and polish thesurface under the tires even more.

The Antilock Brake System (ABS)improves vehicle stability duringhard stops on slippery roads, butapply the brakes sooner than whenon dry pavement. See AntilockBrake System (ABS) on page 9‑40.

Allow greater following distance onany slippery road and watch forslippery spots. Icy patches canoccur on otherwise clear roads inshaded areas. The surface of acurve or an overpass can remain icywhen the surrounding roads areclear. Avoid sudden steeringmaneuvers and braking whileon ice.

Turn off cruise control on slipperysurfaces.

Page 271: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-13

Blizzard Conditions

Being stuck in snow can be aserious situation. Stay with thevehicle unless there is help nearby.If possible, use RoadsideAssistance. See RoadsideAssistance Program (Mexico) onpage 13‑7 or Roadside AssistanceProgram (U.S. and Canada) onpage 13‑11. To get help and keepeveryone in the vehicle safe:. Turn on the hazard warning

flashers.. Tie a red cloth to an outside

mirror.

{ WARNING

Snow can trap engine exhaustunder the vehicle. This maycause exhaust gases to getinside. Engine exhaust containscarbon monoxide (CO) which

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

cannot be seen or smelled. It cancause unconsciousness and evendeath.

If the vehicle is stuck in the snow:. Clear away snow from aroundthe base of your vehicle,especially any that is blockingthe exhaust pipe.

. Check again from time totime to be sure snow doesnot collect there.

. Open a window about 5 cm(2 in) on the side of thevehicle that is away from thewind to bring in fresh air.

. Fully open the air outlets onor under the instrumentpanel.

. Adjust the climate controlsystem to a setting thatcirculates the air inside thevehicle and set the fan speed

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

to the highest setting. See“Climate Control Systems” inthe Index.

For more information aboutcarbon monoxide, see EngineExhaust on page 9‑27.

To save fuel, run the engine for onlyshort periods as needed to warmthe vehicle and then shut the engineoff and close the window most ofthe way to save heat. Repeat thisuntil help arrives but only when youfeel really uncomfortable from thecold. Moving about to keep warmalso helps.

If it takes some time for help toarrive, now and then when you runthe engine, push the acceleratorpedal slightly so the engine runsfaster than the idle speed. Thiskeeps the battery charged to restartthe vehicle and to signal for helpwith the headlamps. Do this as littleas possible to save fuel.

Page 272: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-14 Driving and Operating

If the Vehicle Is StuckSlowly and cautiously spin thewheels to free the vehicle whenstuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow.

If the vehicle has a traction system,it can often help to free a stuckvehicle. Refer to the vehicle'straction system in the Index. If stucktoo severely for the traction systemto free the vehicle, turn the tractionsystem off and use the rockingmethod.

{ WARNING

If the vehicle's tires spin at highspeed, they can explode, and youor others could be injured. Thevehicle can overheat, causing anengine compartment fire or otherdamage. Spin the wheels as littleas possible and avoid goingabove 56 km/h (35 mph).

For information about using tirechains on the vehicle, see TireChains on page 10‑61.

Rocking the Vehicle to Getit Out

Turn the steering wheel left andright to clear the area around thefront wheels. For four-wheel-drivevehicles, shift into Four-Wheel Highor, if the vehicle has a two-speedautomatic transfer case, Four-WheelLow. For vehicles with StabiliTrak®,turn the traction control part of thesystem off. Shift back and forthbetween R (Reverse) and a forwardgear, spinning the wheels as little aspossible. To prevent transmissionwear, wait until the wheels stopspinning before shifting gears.Release the accelerator pedal whileshifting, and press lightly on theaccelerator pedal when thetransmission is in gear. Slowlyspinning the wheels in the forwardand reverse directions causes arocking motion that could free thevehicle. If that does not get the

vehicle out after a few tries, it mightneed to be towed out. Recoveryhooks can be used, if the vehiclehas them. If the vehicle does needto be towed out, see Towing theVehicle on page 10‑82.

Recovery Hooks

{ WARNING

Never pull on recovery hooksfrom the side. The hooks couldbreak and you and others couldbe injured. When using recoveryhooks, always pull the vehiclefrom the front.

Page 273: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (15,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-15

Notice: Never use recoveryhooks to tow the vehicle. Yourvehicle could be damaged and itwould not be covered bywarranty.

For vehicles with recovery hooks atthe front of the vehicle, you can usethem if you are stuck off-road andneed to be pulled to some placewhere you can continue driving.

Vehicle Load LimitsIt is very important to know howmuch weight your vehicle cancarry. This weight is called the

vehicle capacity weight andincludes the weight of alloccupants, cargo, and allnonfactory-installed options.Two labels on your vehicle showhow much weight it wasdesigned to carry, the Tire andLoading Information label andthe Certification/Tire label.

{ WARNING

Do not load the vehicle anyheavier than the GrossVehicle Weight Rating(GVWR), or either themaximum front or rear GrossAxle Weight Rating (GAWR).This can cause systems tobreak and change the way thevehicle handles. This couldcause loss of control and acrash. Overloading can alsoshorten the life of the vehicle.

Tire and Loading InformationLabel

Label Example

A vehicle specific Tire andLoading Information label isattached to the center pillar(B-pillar). With the driver dooropen, you will find the labelattached below the door lockpost (striker). The tire andloading information label showsthe number of occupant seating

Page 274: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (16,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-16 Driving and Operating

positions (A), and the maximumvehicle capacity weight (B) inkilograms and pounds.

The Tire and LoadingInformation label also shows thesize of the original equipmenttires (C) and the recommendedcold tire inflation pressures (D).For more information on tiresand inflation see Tires onpage 10‑40 andTire Pressure onpage 10‑49.

There is also important loadinginformation on the vehicleCertification/Tire label. It tellsyou the Gross Vehicle WeightRating (GVWR) and the GrossAxle Weight Rating (GAWR) forthe front and rear axles. See“Certification/Tire Label” later inthis section.

Steps for Determining CorrectLoad Limit

1. Locate the statement “Thecombined weight ofoccupants and cargo shouldnever exceed XXX kg orXXX lbs” on your vehicle'splacard.

2. Determine the combinedweight of the driver andpassengers that will be ridingin your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combinedweight of the driver andpassengers from XXX kg orXXX lbs.

4. The resulting figure equalsthe available amount of cargoand luggage load capacity.For example, if the “XXX”amount equals 1400 lbs andthere will be five 150 lbpassengers in your vehicle,the amount of available cargo

and luggage load capacity is650 lbs (1400 − 750(5 x 150) = 650 lbs).

5. Determine the combinedweight of luggage and cargobeing loaded on the vehicle.That weight may not safelyexceed the available cargoand luggage load capacitycalculated in Step 4.

6. If your vehicle will be towinga trailer, the load from yourtrailer will be transferred toyour vehicle. Consult thismanual to determine how thisreduces the available cargoand luggage load capacity ofyour vehicle. See TrailerTowing on page 9‑64 forimportant information ontowing a trailer, towing safetyrules and trailering tips.

Page 275: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (17,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-17

Example 1

A. Vehicle Capacity Weight forExample 1 = 453 kg (1,000 lbs)

B. Subtract Occupant Weight @68 kg (150 lbs) × 2 = 136 kg(300 lbs)

C. Available Occupant and CargoWeight = 317 kg (700 lbs)

Example 2

A. Vehicle Capacity Weight forExample 2 = 453 kg (1,000 lbs)

B. Subtract Occupant Weight @68 kg (150 lbs) × 5 = 136 kg(750 lbs)

C. Available Cargo Weight =113 kg (250 lbs)

Example 3

A. Vehicle Capacity Weight forExample 3 = 453 kg (1,000 lbs)

B. Subtract Occupant Weight @91 kg (200 lbs) × 5 = 453 kg(1,000 lbs)

C. Available Cargo Weight =0 kg (0 lbs)

Refer to your vehicle's tire andloading information label forspecific information about yourvehicle's capacity weight andseating positions. The combined

Page 276: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (18,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-18 Driving and Operating

weight of the driver, passengers,and cargo should never exceedyour vehicle's capacity weight.

Certification/Tire Label

A vehicle specific Certification/Tire label is found on the rearedge of the driver door. Thelabel shows the size of yourvehicle's original tires and theinflation pressures needed toobtain the gross weight capacityof your vehicle. This is calledGross Vehicle Weight Rating

(GVWR). The GVWR includesthe weight of the vehicle, alloccupants, fuel, and cargo.

The Certification/Tire label alsotells you the maximum weightsfor the front and rear axles,called Gross Axle Weight Rating(GAWR). To find out the actualloads on your front and rearaxles, you need to go to a weighstation and weigh your vehicle.Your dealer can help you withthis. Be sure to spread out yourload equally on both sides of thecenterline.

Never exceed the GVWR foryour vehicle, or the GAWR foreither the front or rear axle.

The Certification/Tire label alsocontains information about yourFront Axle Reserve Capacity.

And, if you do have a heavyload, you should spread it out.

{ WARNING

Do not load the vehicle anyheavier than the GrossVehicle Weight Rating(GVWR), or either themaximum front or rear GrossAxle Weight Rating (GAWR).This can cause systems tobreak and change the way thevehicle handles. This couldcause loss of control and acrash. Overloading can alsoshorten the life of the vehicle.

Notice: Overloading thevehicle may cause damage.Repairs would not be coveredby the vehicle warranty. Donot overload the vehicle.

The label will help you decidehow much cargo and installedequipment your truck can carry.

Page 277: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (19,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-19

Using heavier suspensioncomponents to get addeddurability might not change yourweight ratings. Ask your dealerto help you load your vehicle theright way.

If you put things inside yourvehicle— like suitcases, tools,packages, or anythingelse— they go as fast as thevehicle goes. If you have to stopor turn quickly, or if there is acrash, they will keep going.

{ WARNING

Things you put inside thevehicle can strike and injurepeople in a sudden stop orturn, or in a crash.

. Put things in the cargoarea of the vehicle. Try tospread the weight evenly.

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

. Never stack heavierthings, like suitcases,inside the vehicle so thatsome of them are abovethe tops of the seats.

. Do not leave anunsecured child restraintin the vehicle.

. When you carry somethinginside the vehicle, secureit whenever you can.

. Do not leave a seat foldeddown unless you need to.

There is also important loadinginformation for off-road driving inthis manual. See “Loading YourVehicle for Off-Road Driving”under Off-Road Driving onpage 9‑5.

Starting andOperating

New Vehicle Break-InNotice: The vehicle does notneed an elaborate break-in. But itwill perform better in the long runif you follow these guidelines:. Keep the vehicle speed at88 km/h (55mph) or less forthe first 805 km (500miles).

. Do not drive at any oneconstant speed, fast or slow,for the first 805 km(500miles). Do not makefull-throttle starts. Avoiddownshifting to brake orslow the vehicle.

. Avoid making hard stops forthe first 322 km (200miles) orso. During this time the newbrake linings are not yetbroken in. Hard stops withnew linings can meanpremature wear and earlierreplacement. Follow this

Page 278: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (20,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-20 Driving and Operating

breaking-in guideline everytime you get new brakelinings.

. Do not tow a trailer duringbreak-in. See Trailer Towingon page 9‑64 for the trailertowing capabilities of thevehicle and moreinformation.

Following break‐in, engine speedand load can be graduallyincreased.

Adjustable Throttle andBrake PedalOn vehicles with this feature, youcan change the position of thethrottle and brake pedals.

No adjustment to the pedals can bemade when the vehicle is inR (Reverse) or while using cruisecontrol.

The control used to adjust thepedals is located on the instrumentpanel below the climate controlsystem.

Press the bottom of the control tomove the pedals closer. Press thetop of the control to move thepedals away.

Before you start driving, fully pressthe brake pedal to confirm theadjustment is right for you. Whiledriving, make only smalladjustments.

The vehicle may have a memoryfunction which lets pedal settings besaved and recalled. See MemorySeats on page 3‑6.

Ignition Positions

The ignition switch has four differentpositions.

To shift out of P (Park), the ignitionmust be in ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY and the regular brakepedal must be applied.

A (STOPPING THE ENGINE/LOCK/OFF): When the vehicle isstopped, turn the ignition switch toLOCK/OFF to turn the engine off.Retained Accessory Power (RAP)

Page 279: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (21,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-21

will remain active. See RetainedAccessory Power (RAP) onpage 9‑24.

This position locks the ignition.It also locks the transmission onautomatic transmission vehicles.The key can be removed inLOCK/OFF.

The steering can bind with thewheels turned off center. If thishappens, move the steering wheelfrom right to left while turning thekey to ACC/ACCESSORY. If thisdoes not work, then the vehicleneeds service.

Do not turn the engine off when thevehicle is moving. This will cause aloss of power assist in the brakeand steering systems and disablethe airbags.

If the vehicle must be shut off in anemergency:

1. Brake using a firm and steadypressure. Do not pump thebrakes repeatedly. This maydeplete power assist, requiringincreased brake pedal force.

2. Shift the vehicle to N (Neutral).This can be done while thevehicle is moving. After shiftingto N (Neutral), firmly apply thebrakes and steer the vehicle to asafe location.

3. Come to a complete stop, shiftto P (Park), and turn the ignitionto LOCK/OFF. On vehicles withan automatic transmission, theshift lever must be in P (Park) toturn the ignition switch to theLOCK/OFF position.

4. Set the parking brake. SeeParking Brake on page 9‑41.

{ WARNING

Turning off the vehicle whilemoving may cause loss of powerassist in the brake and steeringsystems and disable the airbags.While driving, only shut thevehicle off in an emergency.

If the vehicle cannot be pulled over,and must be shut off while driving,turn the ignition to ACC/ACCESSORY.

Notice: Using a tool to force thekey to turn in the ignition couldcause damage to the switch orbreak the key. Use the correctkey, make sure it is all the way in,and turn it only with your hand.If the key cannot be turned byhand, see your dealer.

B (ACC/ACCESSORY): Thisposition lets things like the radioand the windshield wipers operate

Page 280: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (22,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-22 Driving and Operating

while the engine is off. Use thisposition if the vehicle must bepushed or towed.

C (ON/RUN): This position can beused to operate the electricalaccessories and to display someinstrument panel cluster warningand indicator lights. This positioncan also be used for service anddiagnostics, and to verify the properoperation of the malfunctionindicator lamp as may be requiredfor emission inspection purposes.The switch stays in this positionwhen the engine is running. Thetransmission is also unlocked in thisposition on automatic transmissionvehicles.

If you leave the key in the ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN positionwith the engine off, the battery couldbe drained. You may not be able tostart the vehicle if the battery isallowed to drain for an extendedperiod of time.

D (START): This is the position thatstarts the engine. When the enginestarts, release the key. The ignitionswitch returns to ON/RUN fordriving.

A warning tone will sound when thedriver door is opened and theignition is in ACC/ACCESSORY orLOCK/OFF, and the key is in theignition.

Starting the EngineIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Move the shift lever to P (Park) orN (Neutral). The engine will not startin any other position. To restart theengine when the vehicle is alreadymoving, use N (Neutral) only.

Notice: Do not try to shift toP (Park) if the vehicle is moving.If you do, you could damage thetransmission. Shift to P (Park)only when the vehicle is stopped.

Starting Procedure

1. With your foot off the acceleratorpedal, turn the ignition to START.When the engine starts, let go ofthe key. The idle speed will godown as the engine warms. Donot race the engine immediatelyafter starting it. Operate theengine and transmission gentlyto allow the oil to warm up andlubricate all moving parts.

The vehicle has aComputer-Controlled CrankingSystem. This feature assists instarting the engine and protectscomponents. If the ignition key isturned to the START position,and then released when theengine begins cranking, theengine will continue cranking fora few seconds or until thevehicle starts. If the engine doesnot start and the key is held inSTART, cranking will be stoppedafter 15 seconds to preventcranking motor damage. Toprevent gear damage, thissystem also prevents cranking if

Page 281: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (23,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-23

the engine is already running.Engine cranking can be stoppedby turning the ignition switch tothe ACC/ACCESSORY orLOCK/OFF position.

When the Low Fuel warninglamp is on and the FUEL LEVELLOW message is displayed inthe Driver Information Center(DIC), the Computer-ControlledCranking System is disabled toprevent possible vehiclecomponent damage. When thishappens, hold the ignition switchin the START position tocontinue engine cranking.

Notice: Cranking the engine forlong periods of time, by returningthe key to the START positionimmediately after cranking hasended, can overheat and damagethe cranking motor, and drain thebattery. Wait at least 15 secondsbetween each try, to let thecranking motor cool down.

2. If the engine does not start after5-10 seconds, especially in verycold weather (below −18°C or0°F), it could be flooded with toomuch gasoline. Try pushing theaccelerator pedal all the way tothe floor and holding it there asyou hold the key in START forup to a maximum of 15 seconds.Wait at least 15 secondsbetween each try, to allow thecranking motor to cool down.When the engine starts, let go ofthe key and accelerator. If thevehicle starts briefly but thenstops again, repeat these steps.This clears the extra gasolinefrom the engine. Do not race theengine immediately after startingit. Operate the engine andtransmission gently until the oilwarms up and lubricates allmoving parts.

Notice: If you add electrical partsor accessories, you could changethe way the engine operates. Anyresulting damage would not becovered by the vehicle warranty.See Add-On Electrical Equipmenton page 9‑78.

Engine HeaterThe engine coolant heater canprovide easier starting and betterfuel economy during enginewarm-up in cold weather conditionsat or below −18°C (0°F). Vehicleswith an engine heater should beplugged in at least four hours beforestarting. An internal thermostat inthe plug-end of the cord may existwhich will prevent engine coolantheater operation at temperaturesabove −18°C (0°F).

Page 282: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (24,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-24 Driving and Operating

To Use the Engine CoolantHeater

1. Turn off the engine.

2. Open the hood and unwrap theelectrical cord. The cord issecured to the enginecompartment fuse block with aclip. Carefully remove the wiretie which secures the electricalcord. Do not cut theelectrical cord.

3. Plug the cord into a normal,grounded 110-volt AC outlet.

{ WARNING

Plugging the cord into anungrounded outlet could cause anelectrical shock. Also, the wrongkind of extension cord couldoverheat and cause a fire. Youcould be seriously injured. Plugthe cord into a properly groundedthree-prong 110-volt AC outlet.

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

If the cord will not reach, use aheavy-duty three-prong extensioncord rated for at least 15 amps.

4. Before starting the engine, besure to unplug and store thecord as it was before to keep itaway from moving engine parts.If you do not, it could bedamaged.

The length of time the heater shouldremain plugged in depends onseveral factors. Ask a dealer in thearea where you will be parking thevehicle for the best advice on this.

Retained AccessoryPower (RAP)The following vehicle accessoriescan be used for up to 10 minutesafter the engine is turned off:. Audio System. Power Windows

. OnStar System (if equipped)

. Sunroof (if equipped)

These features work when the keyis in ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY. Once the key isturned from ON/RUN to LOCK/OFF,the windows and sunroof continueto work up to 10 minutes until anydoor is opened. The radio continuesto work for up to 10 minutes or untilthe driver door is opened.

Shifting Into Park

{ WARNING

It can be dangerous to get out ofthe vehicle if the shift lever is notfully in P (Park) with the parkingbrake firmly set. The vehicle canroll. If you have left the enginerunning, the vehicle can movesuddenly. You or others could beinjured. To be sure the vehicle willnot move, even when you are on

(Continued)

Page 283: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (25,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-25

WARNING (Continued)

fairly level ground, use the stepsthat follow. If the vehicle has afour-wheel drive transfer casewith a N (Neutral) position, andthe transfer case is in N (Neutral),the vehicle will be free to roll,even if the shift lever is inP (Park). Be sure the transfercase is in a drive gear. If towing atrailer, see Driving Characteristicsand Towing Tips on page 9‑61.

1. Hold the brake pedal down, thenset the parking brake.

See Parking Brake on page 9‑41for more information.

2. Move the shift lever into theP (Park) position by pulling theshift lever toward you andmoving it up as far as it will go.

3. Be sure the transfer case is in adrive gear— not in N (Neutral).

4. Turn the ignition key toLOCK/OFF.

5. Remove the key and take it withyou. If you can leave the vehiclewith the ignition key in yourhand, the vehicle is in P (Park).

Leaving the Vehicle With theEngine Running

{ WARNING

It can be dangerous to leave thevehicle with the engine running.The vehicle could move suddenlyif the shift lever is not fully inP (Park) with the parking brakefirmly set.

If you have four-wheel drive andthe transfer case is in N (Neutral),the vehicle will be free to roll,even if the shift lever is inP (Park). So be sure the transfercase is in a drive gear — not inN (Neutral).

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

And, if you leave the vehicle withthe engine running, it couldoverheat and even catch fire. Youor others could be injured. Do notleave the vehicle with the enginerunning unless you have to.

If you have to leave the vehicle withthe engine running, be sure yourvehicle is in P (Park) and theparking brake is firmly set beforeyou leave it. After you move the shiftlever into P (Park), hold the regularbrake pedal down. Then, see if youcan move the shift lever away fromP (Park) without first pulling it towardyou. If you can, it means that theshift lever was not fully locked intoP (Park).

Page 284: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (26,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-26 Driving and Operating

Torque Lock

If you are parking on a hill and youdo not shift your transmission intoP (Park) properly, the weight of thevehicle may put too much force onthe parking pawl in thetransmission. You may find it difficultto pull the shift lever out of P (Park).This is called torque lock. Toprevent torque lock, set the parkingbrake and then shift into P (Park)properly before you leave the driverseat. To find out how, see ShiftingInto Park on page 9‑24.

When you are ready to drive, movethe shift lever out of P (Park) beforeyou release the parking brake.

If torque lock does occur, you mayneed to have another vehicle pushyours a little uphill to take some ofthe pressure from the parking pawlin the transmission, then you will beable to pull the shift lever out ofP (Park).

Shifting out of ParkThis vehicle is equipped with anelectronic shift lock release system.The shift lock release isdesigned to:. Prevent ignition key removal

unless the shift lever is inP (Park) with the shift leverbutton fully released.

. Prevent movement of the shiftlever out of P (Park), unless theignition is in ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY and the regularbrake pedal is applied.

The shift lock release is alwaysfunctional except in the case of anuncharged or low voltage (less than9 volt) battery.

If the vehicle has an unchargedbattery or a battery with low voltage,try charging or jump starting thebattery. See Jump Starting onpage 10‑77 for more information.

To shift out of P (Park) use thefollowing:

1. Apply the brake pedal.

2. Move the shift lever to thedesired position.

If you still are unable to shift out ofP (Park):

1. Ease the pressure on the shiftlever.

2. While holding down the brakepedal, press the shift lever allthe way into P (Park).

3. Move the shift lever to thedesired position.

If you are still having a problemshifting, then have the vehicleserviced soon.

Page 285: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (27,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-27

Parking over ThingsThat Burn

{ WARNING

Things that can burn could touchhot exhaust parts under thevehicle and ignite. Do not parkover papers, leaves, dry grass,or other things that can burn.

Active Fuel Management®

Vehicles with V8 engines may haveActive Fuel Management. Thissystem allows the engine to operateon either all or half of its cylinders,depending on the driving conditions.

When less power is required, suchas cruising at a constant vehiclespeed, the system will operate inthe half cylinder mode, allowing thevehicle to achieve better fueleconomy. When greater powerdemands are required, such asaccelerating from a stop, passing,or merging onto a freeway, thesystem will maintain full-cylinderoperation.

If the vehicle has an Active FuelManagement indicator, see DriverInformation Center (DIC) onpage 5‑26 for more information onusing this display.

Engine Exhaust

{ WARNING

Engine exhaust contains carbonmonoxide (CO) which cannot beseen or smelled. Exposure to COcan cause unconsciousness andeven death.

Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:. The vehicle idles in areaswith poor ventilation (parkinggarages, tunnels, deep snowthat may block underbodyairflow or tail pipes).

. The exhaust smells orsounds strange or different.

. The exhaust system leaksdue to corrosion or damage.

. The vehicle exhaust systemhas been modified, damaged,or improperly repaired.

(Continued)

Page 286: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (28,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-28 Driving and Operating

WARNING (Continued)

. There are holes or openingsin the vehicle body fromdamage or aftermarketmodifications that are notcompletely sealed.

If unusual fumes are detected orif it is suspected that exhaust iscoming into the vehicle:

. Drive it only with the windowscompletely down.

. Have the vehicle repairedimmediately.

Never park the vehicle with theengine running in an enclosedarea such as a garage or abuilding that has no fresh airventilation.

Running the VehicleWhile ParkedIt is better not to park with theengine running.

If the vehicle is left with the enginerunning, follow the proper steps tobe sure the vehicle will not move.See Shifting Into Park on page 9‑24and Engine Exhaust on page 9‑27.

If parking on a hill and pulling atrailer, see Driving Characteristicsand Towing Tips on page 9‑61.

AutomaticTransmissionIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

If the vehicle is has an automatictransmission, it has an electronicshift position indicator within theinstrument panel cluster. Thisdisplay comes on when the ignitionkey is turned to the ON/RUNposition.

There are several different positionsfor the shift lever.

Heavy Duty 6-Speed AutomaticTransmission Shown (Light Duty

Similar)

See “Range Selection Mode” underManual Mode on page 9‑31.

Page 287: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (29,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-29

P (Park): This position locks therear wheels. It is the best position touse when starting the enginebecause the vehicle cannot moveeasily. When parked on a hill,especially when the vehicle has aheavy load, you might notice anincrease in the effort to shift out ofP (Park). See “Torque Lock” underShifting Into Park on page 9‑24 formore information.

{ WARNING

It is dangerous to get out of thevehicle if the shift lever is not fullyin P (Park) with the parking brakefirmly set. The vehicle can roll.

Do not leave the vehicle when theengine is running. If you have leftthe engine running, the vehiclecan move suddenly. You or otherscould be injured. To be sure thevehicle will not move, even whenyou are on fairly level ground,always set the parking brake and

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

move the shift lever to P (Park).See Shifting Into Park onpage 9‑24 and DrivingCharacteristics and Towing Tipson page 9‑61.

{ WARNING

If the vehicle has a four-wheeldrive transfer case with aN (Neutral) position, and thetransfer case is in N (Neutral), thevehicle will be free to roll— evenif the shift lever is in P (Park). Besure the transfer case is in a drivegear, Two-Wheel Drive High orFour-Wheel Drive High orFour-Wheel Drive Low— not inN (Neutral). See Shifting Into Parkon page 9‑24. Always set theparking brake.

R (Reverse): Use this gear toback up.

Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse)while the vehicle is movingforward could damage thetransmission. The repairs wouldnot be covered by the vehiclewarranty. Shift to R (Reverse) onlyafter the vehicle is stopped.

To rock the vehicle back and forth toget out of snow, ice, or sand withoutdamaging the transmission, see Ifthe Vehicle Is Stuck on page 9‑14.

N (Neutral): In this position, theengine does not connect with thewheels. To restart the engine whenthe vehicle is already moving, useN (Neutral) only. Also, useN (Neutral) when the vehicle isbeing towed.

Page 288: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (30,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-30 Driving and Operating

{ WARNING

Shifting into a drive gear while theengine is running at high speed isdangerous. Unless your foot isfirmly on the brake pedal, thevehicle could move very rapidly.You could lose control and hitpeople or objects. Do not shiftinto a drive gear while the engineis running at high speed.

Notice: Shifting out of P (Park) orN (Neutral) with the enginerunning at high speed maydamage the transmission. Therepairs would not be covered bythe vehicle warranty. Be sure theengine is not running at highspeed when shifting the vehicle.

D (Drive): This position is fornormal driving. It provides the bestfuel economy. If you need morepower for passing, and you are:. Going less than about 55 km/h

(35 mph), push the acceleratorpedal about halfway down.

. Going about 55 km/h (35 mph) ormore, push the accelerator allthe way down.

By doing this, the vehicle shiftsdown to the next gear and hasmore power.

D (Drive) can be used when towinga trailer, carrying a heavy load,driving on steep hills, or for off-roaddriving. You might want to shift thetransmission to a lower gearselection if the transmission shiftstoo often.

Downshifting the transmission inslippery road conditions could resultin skidding. See “Skidding” underLoss of Control on page 9‑5.

The vehicle has a shift stabilizationfeature that adjusts the transmissionshifting to the current drivingconditions in order to reduce rapidupshifts and downshifts. This shiftstabilization feature is designed todetermine, before making anupshift, if the engine is able tomaintain vehicle speed by analyzingthings such as vehicle speed,throttle position, and vehicle load.If the shift stabilization featuredetermines that a current vehiclespeed cannot be maintained, thetransmission does not upshift andinstead holds the current gear. Insome cases, this could appear to bea delayed shift, however thetransmission is operating normally.

The vehicle's transmission usesadaptive shift controls. Adaptiveshift controls continually compareskey shift parameters topre-programmed ideal shifts storedin the transmissions computer. Thetransmission constantly makesadjustments to improve vehicleperformance according to how the

Page 289: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (31,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-31

vehicle is being used, such as witha heavy load or when thetemperature changes. During thisadaptive shift control process,shifting might feel different as thetransmission determines the bestsettings.

When temperatures are very cold,shifting could be delayed providingmore stable shifts until the enginewarms up. Shifts could be morenoticeable with a cold transmission.This difference in shifting is normal.

M (Manual Mode): This positionlets drivers select the range of gearsappropriate for current drivingconditions. If the vehicle has thisfeature, see “Range SelectionMode” under Manual Mode onpage 9‑31.

Notice: Spinning the tires orholding the vehicle in one placeon a hill using only theaccelerator pedal may damagethe transmission. The repair willnot be covered by the vehiclewarranty. If you are stuck, do not

spin the tires. When stopping ona hill, use the brakes to hold thevehicle in place.

Normal Mode Grade Braking

Normal Mode Grade Braking isenabled when the vehicle is started,but is not enabled in RangeSelection Mode. It assists inmaintaining desired vehicle speedswhen driving on downhill grades byusing the engine and transmissionto slow the vehicle. The first timethe system engages for eachignition key cycle, a DIC messagewill be displayed. See TransmissionMessages on page 5‑42.

To disable or enable Normal ModeGrade Braking within the currentignition key cycle, press and holdthe Tow/Haul button forthree seconds. A DIC messagedisplays. See TransmissionMessages on page 5‑42.

For other forms of grade braking,see Tow/Haul Mode on page 9‑32and Cruise Control on page 9‑46.

Manual Mode

Range Selection Mode(Hydra-Matic® 6-SpeedTransmission)

Base Trim Shown (Uplevel Similar)

The vehicle may have a RangeSelection Mode. The RangeSelection Mode helps control thevehicle's transmission and vehiclespeed while driving down hill ortowing a trailer by letting you selecta desired range of gears.

To use this feature, do the following:

1. Move the shift lever toM (Manual Mode).

Page 290: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (32,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-32 Driving and Operating

2. Press the plus/minus buttons,located on the steering columnshift lever, to select the desiredrange of gears for the currentdriving conditions.

When M (Manual Mode) is selecteda number displays next to the M,indicating the current gear.

This number is the highest gear thatcan be used. However, the vehiclecan automatically shift to lowergears as it adjusts to drivingconditions. This means that allgears below that number areavailable. When 5 (Fifth) is selected,1 (First) through 5 (Fifth) gears areautomatically shifted by the vehicle,but 6 (Sixth) cannot be used untilthe plus/minus button located on thesteering column lever is used tochange to the gear.

Grade Braking is not available whenRange Selection Mode is active.See Tow/Haul Mode on page 9‑32.

While using Range Selection Mode,Cruise Control and the Tow/HaulMode can be used.

Notice: Spinning the tires orholding the vehicle in one placeon a hill using only theaccelerator pedal may damagethe transmission. The repair willnot be covered by the vehiclewarranty. If you are stuck, do notspin the tires. When stopping ona hill, use the brakes to hold thevehicle in place.

Low Traction Mode

If the vehicle has the Hydra-Matic®

6-Speed Automatic Transmissionwith the 6.0L engine, it has a LowTraction Mode that assists in vehicleacceleration when road conditionsare slippery, such as with ice orsnow. While the vehicle is at a stop,select the second gear range usingRange Selection Mode. This willlimit torque to the wheels helping toprevent the tires from spinning.

Tow/Haul Mode

The vehicle has a Tow/Haul Mode.The selector button is located on theend of the column shift lever. Youcan use this feature to assist whendriving down steep hills or mountaingrades, towing, or hauling a heavyload, or if there is a need to chargea battery installed in a trailer. SeeTowing Equipment on page 9‑69and Hill and Mountain Roads onpage 9‑11 for more information.

Page 291: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (33,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-33

When Tow/Haul Mode is selectedthe tow/haul indicator light will comeon. See Tow/Haul Mode Light onpage 5‑22.

The Tow/Haul Mode works with theAutoride® feature, if the vehicle hasthis, to enhance the ride whentrailering or with a loaded vehicle.See Continuous Damping Control(CDC) on page 9‑45.

Tow/Haul Mode Grade Braking(6-Speed AutomaticTransmission)

Tow/Haul Mode Grade Braking isonly enabled while the Tow/HaulMode is selected and the vehicle isnot in the Range Selection Mode.See “Tow/Haul Mode” listedpreviously and Manual Mode onpage 9‑31. Tow/Haul Mode GradeBraking assists in maintaining

desired vehicle speeds when drivingon downhill grades by using theengine and transmission to slow thevehicle.

To disable or enable Tow/HaulGrade Braking within the currentignition key cycle, press and holdthe Tow/Haul button forthree seconds. A DIC message willbe displayed. See TransmissionMessages on page 5‑42.

See Towing Equipment onpage 9‑69 for more information.

For other forms of grade braking,see Automatic Transmission onpage 9‑28 and Cruise Control onpage 9‑46.

Drive Systems

Four-Wheel Drive (TwoSpeed AutomaticTransfer Case)If the vehicle has four-wheel drive,you can send the engine's drivingpower to all four wheels for extratraction. Read the following beforeusing four-wheel drive.

Notice: Driving on clean, drypavement in Four-Wheel DriveHigh or Four-Wheel Drive Low foran extended period of time maycause premature wear on thevehicle's powertrain. Do not driveon clean, dry pavement inFour-Wheel Drive High orFour-Wheel Drive Low forextended periods of time.

While driving on clean dry pavementand during tight turns, you mayexperience a vibration in thesteering system.

Page 292: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (34,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-34 Driving and Operating

The vehicle has StabiliTrak®.Shifting into Four-Wheel Drive Lowwill turn Traction Control andStabiliTrak off. See StabiliTrak®

System on page 9‑42.

Front Axle

The front axle engages anddisengages automatically when youshift the transfer case. Some delayfor the axle to engage or disengageis normal.

Automatic Transfer Case

The transfer case knob is located tothe left of the instrument panelcluster.

Use this dial to shift into and out offour-wheel drive.

You can choose among five drivingsettings:

Indicator lights in the switches showyou which setting you are in. Theindicator lights will come on brieflywhen you turn on the ignition andthe last chosen setting will stay on.If the lights do not come on, youshould take the vehicle to yourdealer for service. An indicator lightwill flash while shifting. It will stay onwhen the shift is completed. If forsome reason the transfer casecannot make a requested shift, it willreturn to the last chosen setting.

2 m (Two-Wheel Drive High): Thissetting is used for driving in moststreet and highway situations. Thefront axle is not engaged intwo-wheel drive. This setting alsoprovides the best fuel economy.

AUTO (Automatic Four-WheelDrive): This setting is ideal for usewhen road surface tractionconditions are variable. Whendriving the vehicle in AUTO, thefront axle is engaged, and thevehicle's power is sent to the frontand rear wheels automaticallybased on driving conditions. Drivingin this mode results in slightly lowerfuel economy than Two-WheelDrive High.

4 m (Four-Wheel Drive High): Usethe Four-Wheel Drive High positionwhen you need extra traction, suchas on snowy or icy roads or in mostoff-road situations. This setting alsoengages your front axle to helpdrive the vehicle. This is the bestsetting to use when plowing snow.

4 n (Four-Wheel Drive Low): Thissetting also engages the front axleand delivers extra torque. You maynever need this setting. It sendsmaximum power to all four wheels.You might choose Four-Wheel DriveLow if you are driving off-road in

Page 293: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (35,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-35

deep sand, deep mud, deep snow,and while climbing or descendingsteep hills.

The vehicle has StabiliTrak. Shiftinginto Four-Wheel Drive Low will turnTraction Control and StabiliTrak off.See StabiliTrak® System onpage 9‑42.

{ WARNING

Shifting the transfer case toN (Neutral) can cause the vehicleto roll even if the transmission isin P (Park). You or someone elsecould be seriously injured. Besure to set the parking brakebefore placing the transfer case inN (Neutral). See Parking Brake onpage 9‑41.

N (Neutral): Shift the vehicle'stransfer case to N (Neutral) onlywhen towing the vehicle. SeeRecreational Vehicle Towing onpage 10‑82 or Towing the Vehicleon page 10‑82 for more information.

If the SERVICE 4WHEEL DRIVEmessage stays on, you should takethe vehicle to your dealer forservice. See “SERVICE 4WHEELDRIVE” message underTransmission Messages onpage 5‑42.

Shifting Into Four-Wheel DriveHigh or AUTO (AutomaticFour-Wheel Drive)

Turn the knob to the Four-WheelDrive High or AUTO position. Thiscan be done at any speed, exceptwhen shifting from Four-WheelDrive Low. The indicator light willflash while shifting. It will remain onwhen the shift is completed.

Shifting Into Two-WheelDrive High

Turn the knob to the Two-WheelDrive High position. This can bedone at any speed, except whenshifting from Four-Wheel Drive Low.

See “Shifting Out of Four-WheelDrive Low” in this section for moreinformation.

Shifting Into Four-WheelDrive Low

When Four-Wheel Drive Low isengaged, vehicle speed should bekept below 72 km/h (45 mph).Extended high-speed operationin 4L may damage or shorten the lifeof the drivetrain.

To shift to the Four-Wheel DriveLow position, the ignition must be inON/RUN and the vehicle must bestopped or moving less than 5 km/h(3 mph) with the transmission inN (Neutral). The preferred methodfor shifting into Four-Wheel DriveLow is to have the vehicle moving1.6 to 3.2 km/h (1 to 2 mph). Turn theknob to the Four-Wheel Drive Lowposition. You must wait for theFour-Wheel Drive Low indicator lightto stop flashing and remain onbefore shifting the transmissioninto gear.

Notice: Shifting the transmissioninto gear before the requestedmode indicator light has stoppedflashing could damage the

Page 294: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (36,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-36 Driving and Operating

transfer case. To help avoiddamaging the vehicle, always waitfor the mode indicator lights tostop flashing before shifting thetransmission into gear.

The vehicle may have significantengagement noise and bump whenshifting between Four-Wheel DriveLow and Four-Wheel Drive Highranges or from N (Neutral) while theengine is running.

If the knob is turned to theFour-Wheel Drive Low positionwhen the vehicle is in gear and/ormoving more than 5 km/h (3 mph),the Four-Wheel Drive Low indicatorlight will flash for 30 seconds andnot complete the shift. After30 seconds the transfer case willshift to Four-Wheel DriveHigh mode. With the vehicle movingless than 5 km/h (3 mph) and thetransmission in N (Neutral), attemptthe shift again.

Shifting Out of Four-WheelDrive Low

To shift from Four-Wheel Drive Lowto Four-Wheel Drive High, AUTO,or Two-Wheel Drive High, thevehicle must be stopped or movingless than 5 km/h (3 mph) with thetransmission in N (Neutral) and theignition in ON/RUN. The preferredmethod for shifting out ofFour-Wheel Drive Low is to haveyour vehicle moving 1.6 to 3.2 km/h(1 to 2 mph). Turn the knob to theFour-Wheel Drive High, AUTO,or Two-Wheel Drive High position.You must wait for the Four-WheelDrive High, AUTO, or Two-WheelDrive High indicator light to stopflashing and remain on beforeshifting the transmission into gear.

Notice: Shifting the transmissioninto gear before the requestedmode indicator light has stoppedflashing could damage thetransfer case. To help avoiddamaging the vehicle, always wait

for the mode indicator lights tostop flashing before shifting thetransmission into gear.

The vehicle may have significantengagement noise and bump whenshifting between Four-Wheel DriveLow and Four-Wheel Drive Highranges or from N (Neutral) while theengine is running.

If the knob is turned to theFour-Wheel Drive High, AUTO,or Two-Wheel Drive High switchposition when the vehicle is in gearand/or moving more than 5 km/h(3 mph), the Four-Wheel Drive High,AUTO, or Two-Wheel Drive Highindicator light will flash for30 seconds but will not complete theshift. With the vehicle moving lessthan 5 km/h (3 mph) and thetransmission is in N (Neutral),attempt the shift again.

Page 295: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (37,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-37

Shifting into N (Neutral)

To shift the transfer case toN (Neutral) do the following:

1. Make sure the vehicle is parkedso that it will not roll.

2. Set the parking brake and applythe regular brake pedal. SeeParking Brake on page 9‑41 formore information.

3. Start the vehicle or turn theignition to ON/RUN.

4. Put the transmission inN (Neutral).

5. Shift the transfer case toTwo-Wheel Drive High.

6. Turn the transfer case dialclockwise to N (Neutral) until itstops and hold it there until theN (Neutral) light starts blinking.This will take at least10 seconds. Then slowly releasethe dial to the Four-Wheel DriveLow position. The N (Neutral)light will come on when thetransfer case shift to N (Neutral)is complete.

7. If the engine is running, verifythat the transfer case is inN (Neutral) by shifting thetransmission to R (Reverse) forone second, then shift thetransmission to D (Drive) forone second.

8. Turn the ignition to ACC/ACCESSORY, which will turn theengine off.

9. Place the transmission shiftlever in P (Park).

10. Release the parking brake priorto moving the vehicle.

11. Turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF.

Shifting Out of N (Neutral)

To shift out of N (Neutral) do thefollowing:

1. Set the parking brake and applythe regular brake pedal.

2. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN withthe engine off, and shift thetransmission to N (Neutral).

3. Turn the transfer case dial to thedesired transfer case shiftposition (Two-Wheel Drive High,Four-Wheel Drive High,or AUTO).

After the transfer case hasshifted out of N (Neutral), theN (Neutral) light will go out.

4. Release the parking brake priorto moving the vehicle.

Notice: Shifting the transmissioninto gear before the requestedmode indicator light has stoppedflashing could damage thetransfer case. To help avoiddamaging the vehicle, always waitfor the mode indicator lights tostop flashing before shifting thetransmission into gear.

5. Start the engine and shift thetransmission to the desiredposition.

Excessively shifting the transfercase into or out of the differentmodes may cause the transfer caseto enter the shift protection mode.

Page 296: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (38,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-38 Driving and Operating

This will protect the transfer casefrom possible damage and will onlyallow the transfer case to respond toone shift per 10 seconds. Thetransfer case may stay in this modefor up to three minutes.

Four-Wheel Drive (SingleSpeed AutomaticTransfer Case)If the vehicle has four-wheel drive,you can send the engine's drivingpower to all four wheels for extratraction. Read the following beforeusing four-wheel drive.

Notice: Driving on clean, drypavement in Four-Wheel DriveHigh for an extended period oftime may cause premature wearon the vehicle's powertrain. Donot drive on clean, dry pavementin Four-Wheel Drive High forextended periods of time.

While driving on clean dry pavementand during tight turns, you mayexperience a vibration in thesteering system.

Front Axle

The front axle engages anddisengages automatically when youshift the transfer case. Some delayfor the axle to engage or disengageis normal.

Automatic Transfer Case

The transfer case knob is located tothe left of the instrument panelcluster.

Use this dial to shift into and out offour-wheel drive.

The vehicle has Four-Wheel Drivewith StabiliTrak®. For information onStabiliTrak, see StabiliTrak® Systemon page 9‑42.

You can choose among threedriving settings:

Indicator lights in the switch showyou which setting you are in. Theindicator lights will come on brieflywhen you turn on the ignition andthe last chosen setting will stay on.If the lights do not come on, youshould take the vehicle to yourdealer for service. An indicator lightwill flash while shifting. It will stay onwhen the shift is completed. If forsome reason the transfer casecannot make a requested shift, it willreturn to the last chosen setting.

Page 297: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (39,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-39

2 m (Two-Wheel Drive High): Thissetting is used for driving in moststreet and highway situations. Thefront axle is not engaged intwo-wheel drive. This setting alsoprovides the best fuel economy.

AUTO (Automatic Four-WheelDrive): This setting is ideal for usewhen road surface tractionconditions are variable. Whendriving the vehicle in AUTO, thefront axle is engaged, and thevehicle's power is sent to the frontand rear wheels automaticallybased on driving conditions. Drivingin this mode results in slightly lowerfuel economy than Two-WheelDrive High.

4 m (Four-Wheel Drive High): Usethe Four-Wheel Drive High positionwhen you need extra traction, suchas on snowy or icy roads or in mostoff-road situations. This setting alsoengages the front axle to help drivethe vehicle. This is the best settingto use when plowing snow.

Service Four‐Wheel Drive

If the SERVICE 4WHEEL DRIVEmessage stays on, you should takethe vehicle to your dealer forservice. See “SERVICE 4WHEELDRIVE” message underTransmission Messages onpage 5‑42.

Shifting Into Four-Wheel DriveHigh or AUTO (AutomaticFour-Wheel Drive)

Turn the knob to the Four-WheelDrive High or AUTO position. Thiscan be done at any speed. Theindicator light will flash whileshifting. It will remain on when theshift is completed.

Shifting Into Two-WheelDrive High

Turn the knob to the Two-WheelDrive High position. This can bedone at any speed. The indicatorlight will flash while shifting. It willremain on when the shift iscompleted.

Excessively shifting the transfercase into or out of the differentmodes may cause the transfer caseto enter the shift protection mode.This will protect the transfer casefrom possible damage and will onlyallow the transfer case to respond toone shift per 10 seconds. Thetransfer case may stay in this modefor up to three minutes.

Page 298: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (40,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-40 Driving and Operating

Brakes

Antilock BrakeSystem (ABS)This vehicle has the Antilock BrakeSystem (ABS), an advancedelectronic braking system that helpsprevent a braking skid.

When the engine is started and thevehicle begins to drive away, ABSchecks itself. A momentary motor orclicking noise might be heard whilethis test is going on, and it mighteven be noticed that the brakepedal moves a little. This is normal.

If there is a problem with ABS, thiswarning light stays on. See AntilockBrake System (ABS) Warning Lighton page 5‑22.

If driving safely on a wet road and itbecomes necessary to slam on thebrakes and continue braking toavoid a sudden obstacle, acomputer senses that the wheelsare slowing down. If one of thewheels is about to stop rolling, thecomputer will separately work thebrakes at each wheel.

ABS can change the brake pressureto each wheel, as required, fasterthan any driver could. This can helpthe driver steer around the obstaclewhile braking hard.

As the brakes are applied, thecomputer keeps receiving updateson wheel speed and controlsbraking pressure accordingly.

Remember: ABS does not changethe time needed to get a foot up tothe brake pedal or always decreasestopping distance. If you get tooclose to the vehicle in front of you,there will not be enough time toapply the brakes if that vehicle

suddenly slows or stops. Alwaysleave enough room up ahead tostop, even with ABS.

Using ABS

Do not pump the brakes. Just holdthe brake pedal down firmly and letABS work. You might hear the ABSpump or motor operating and feelthe brake pedal pulsate, but this isnormal.

Braking in Emergencies

ABS allows the driver to steer andbrake at the same time. In manyemergencies, steering can helpmore than even the very bestbraking.

Page 299: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (41,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-41

Parking Brake

Set the parking brake by holding theregular brake pedal down, thenpushing down the parking brakepedal.

If the ignition is on, the brakesystem warning light will come on.See Brake System Warning Light onpage 5‑21.

Notice: Driving with the parkingbrake on can overheat the brakesystem and cause prematurewear or damage to brake systemparts. Make sure that the parking

brake is fully released and thebrake warning light is off beforedriving.

To release the parking brake, holdthe regular brake pedal down, thenpush down momentarily on theparking brake pedal until you feelthe pedal release. Slowly pull yourfoot up off the parking brake pedal.If the parking brake is not releasedwhen you begin to drive, the brakesystem warning light will flash and achime will sound warning you thatthe parking brake is still on.

If you are towing a trailer and areparking on a hill, see DrivingCharacteristics and Towing Tips onpage 9‑61.

Brake AssistThis vehicle has a brake assistfeature designed to assist the driverin stopping or decreasing vehiclespeed in emergency drivingconditions. This feature uses thestability system hydraulic brakecontrol module to supplement the

power brake system underconditions where the driver hasquickly and forcefully applied thebrake pedal in an attempt to quicklystop or slow down the vehicle. Thestability system hydraulic brakecontrol module increases brakepressure at each corner of thevehicle until the ABS activates.Minor brake pedal pulsation orpedal movement during this time isnormal and the driver shouldcontinue to apply the brake pedal asthe driving situation dictates. Thebrake assist feature willautomatically disengage when thebrake pedal is released or brakepedal pressure is quicklydecreased.

Hill Start Assist (HSA)Non‐hybrid vehicles with StabiliTrakhave a Hill Start Assist (HSA)feature, which may be useful whenthe vehicle is stopped on a grade.This feature is designed to preventthe vehicle from rolling, eitherforward or rearward, during vehicle

Page 300: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (42,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-42 Driving and Operating

drive off. After the driver completelystops and holds the vehicle in acomplete standstill on a grade, HSAwill be automatically activated.During the transition period betweenwhen the driver releases the brakepedal and starts to accelerate todrive off on a grade, HSA holds thebraking pressure for a maximum oftwo seconds to ensure that there isno rolling. The brakes willautomatically release when theaccelerator pedal is applied withinthe two‐second window. If thevehicle is equipped with theIntegrated Trailer Brake Control(ITBC) system, HSA may also applythe trailer brakes. It will not activateif the vehicle is in a drive gear andfacing downhill or if the vehicle isfacing uphill and in R (Reverse).There may be situations on minorhills (less than 5% grade) with aloaded vehicle or while pulling atrailer where HSA will not activate.

Ride Control Systems

StabiliTrak® SystemThe vehicle has a vehicle stabilityenhancement system calledStabiliTrak. It is an advancedcomputer-controlled system thatassists the driver with directionalcontrol of the vehicle in difficultdriving conditions.

StabiliTrak activates when thecomputer senses a discrepancybetween the intended path and thedirection the vehicle is actuallytraveling. StabiliTrak selectivelyapplies braking pressure at any oneof the vehicle's brakes to assist thedriver with keeping the vehicle onthe intended path.

StabiliTrak is on automaticallywhenever the vehicle is started. Toassist with directional control of thevehicle, the system should alwaysbe left on. Trailer Sway Control(TSC) is also on automatically whenthe vehicle is started. See TrailerSway Control (TSC) on page 9‑77.

When the vehicle is started andbegins to move, the systemperforms several diagnostic checksto insure there are no problems.The system may be heard or feltwhile it is working. This is normaland does not mean there is aproblem with the vehicle.

If cruise control is being used whenStabiliTrak activates, the cruisecontrol automatically disengages.The cruise control can bere-engaged when road conditionsallow. See Cruise Control onpage 9‑46.

If the system fails to turn on oractivate, the StabiliTrak light alongwith a message will be displayed onthe Driver Information Center (DIC).If a DIC message appears, makesure the StabiliTrak system has notbeen turned off using the TractionControl System (TCS)/StabiliTrakbutton. Then turn the vehicle off,wait 15 seconds, and then turn itback on again to reset the system.If any of the messages still appearon the DIC, the vehicle should be

Page 301: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (43,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-43

taken in for service. For moreinformation on the DIC messages,see Ride Control System Messageson page 5‑40.

The StabiliTrak light will flash on theinstrument panel cluster when thesystem or the TSC feature is bothon and activated.

The system may be heard or feltwhile it is working; this is normal.

The TCS/StabiliTrak button islocated on the instrument panel.

The traction control part ofStabiliTrak can be turned off bypressing and releasing the TCS/StabiliTrak button if both systems(traction control and StabiliTrak)were previously on.

To disable both TCS andStabiliTrak, press and hold the TCS/StabiliTrak button until theStabiliTrak OFF light illuminates andthe appropriate DIC messagedisplays. This will also disable theTSC feature.

Traction control and StabiliTrak canbe turned on by pressing andreleasing the TCS/StabiliTrak buttonif they are not automatically shut offfor any other reason. This will alsoenable the TSC feature.

When the TCS or StabiliTrak systemis turned off, the StabiliTrak lightand the appropriate message will bedisplayed on the DIC to warn thedriver. The vehicle will still havebrake-traction control when tractioncontrol is off, but will not be able touse the engine speed managementsystem. See “Traction ControlOperation” next for moreinformation.

When the TCS has been turned off,system noises may still be heard asa result of the brake-traction controlcoming on.

It is recommended to leave thesystem on for normal drivingconditions, but it may be necessaryto turn the system off if the vehicleis stuck in sand, mud, ice or snow,and you want to “rock” the vehicle toattempt to free it. It may also benecessary to turn off the systemwhen driving in extreme off-roadconditions where high wheel spin isrequired. See If the Vehicle Is Stuckon page 9‑14.

Page 302: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (44,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-44 Driving and Operating

When the transfer case is in 4LO,the stability system is automaticallydisabled, the StabiliTrak light comeson, and the appropriate messagewill appear on the DIC. Both tractioncontrol and StabiliTrak areautomatically disabled in thiscondition.

Traction Control Operation

The TCS is part of the StabiliTraksystem. Traction control limits wheelspin by reducing engine power tothe wheels (engine speedmanagement) and by applyingbrakes to each individual wheel(brake-traction control) asnecessary.

The TCS is enabled automaticallywhen the vehicle is started. It willactivate and the StabiliTrak light willflash if it senses that any of thewheels are spinning or beginning tolose traction while driving. If tractioncontrol is turned off, only thebrake-traction control portion oftraction control will work. Theengine speed management will be

disabled. In this mode, enginepower is not reduced automaticallyand the driven wheels can spinmore freely. This can cause thebrake-traction control to activateconstantly.

Notice: If the wheel(s) of one axleis allowed to spin excessivelywhile the StabiliTrak®, ABS, brakewarning lights, and any relevantDIC messages are displayed, thetransfer case could be damaged.The repairs would not be coveredby the vehicle warranty. Reduceengine power and do not spin thewheel(s) excessively while theselights and messages aredisplayed.

The TCS may activate on dry orrough roads or under conditionssuch as heavy acceleration whileturning or abrupt upshifts/downshiftsof the transmission. When thishappens, a reduction in accelerationmay be noticed, or a noise orvibration may be heard. This isnormal.

If cruise control is being used whenthe system activates, the StabiliTraklight will flash and cruise control willautomatically disengage. Cruisecontrol may be reengaged whenroad conditions allow. See CruiseControl on page 9‑46.

StabiliTrak may also turn offautomatically if it determines that aproblem exists with the system.If the problem does not clear itselfafter restarting the vehicle, see yourdealer for service.

Vehicles with StabiliTrak have aTrailer Sway Control (TSC) feature.See Trailer Sway Control (TSC) onpage 9‑77.

Vehicles with StabiliTrak have a HillStart Assist (HSA) feature. See HillStart Assist (HSA) on page 9‑41.

Adding non-dealer accessories canaffect the vehicle's performance.See Accessories and Modificationson page 10‑3.

Page 303: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (45,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-45

Locking Rear AxleVehicles with a locking rear axle cangive more traction on snow, mud,ice, sand, or gravel. It works like astandard axle most of the time, butwhen traction is low, this feature willallow the rear wheel with the mosttraction to move the vehicle.

Continuous DampingControl (CDC)This vehicle may have a continuousdamping control system calledAutoride®. With this feature,improved vehicle ride and handlingis provided under a variety ofpassenger and loading conditions.

Autoride is fully automatic and usesa computer controller tocontinuously monitor vehicle speed,wheel to body position, lift/dive, andsteering position of the vehicle. Thecontroller then sends signals toeach shock absorber to

independently adjust the dampinglevel to provide the optimumvehicle ride.

Autoride also interact with the tow/haul mode that, when activated, willprovide additional control of theshock absorbers. This additionalcontrol results in better ride andhandling characteristics when thevehicle is loaded or towing a trailer.See “Tow/Haul Mode” under TrailerTowing on page 9‑64 for moreinformation.

Automatic Level ControlThe automatic level control rearsuspension is available on light‐dutyvehicles and comes as a part of theContinuous Damping Control (CDC)suspension, if equipped.

This type of level control is fullyautomatic and will provide a betterleveled riding position as well asbetter handling under a variety ofpassenger and loading conditions.An air compressor connected to therear shocks will raise or lower the

rear of the vehicle to maintainproper vehicle height. The system isactivated when the ignition key isturned to ON/RUN and willautomatically adjust vehicle heightthereafter. The system may exhaust(lower vehicle height) for up toten minutes after the ignition keyhas been turned off. You may hearthe air compressor operating whenthe height is being adjusted.

If a weight‐distributing hitch is beingused, it is recommended to allowthe shocks to inflate, therebyleveling the vehicle prior to adjustingthe hitch.

Page 304: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (46,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-46 Driving and Operating

Cruise Control

{ WARNING

Cruise control can be dangerouswhere you cannot drive safely ata steady speed. So, do not usethe cruise control on windingroads or in heavy traffic.

Cruise control can be dangerouson slippery roads. On such roads,fast changes in tire traction cancause excessive wheel slip, andyou could lose control. Do not usecruise control on slippery roads.

With cruise control, a speed ofabout 40 km/h (25 mph) or more canbe maintained without keeping yourfoot on the accelerator. Cruisecontrol does not work at speedsbelow about 40 km/h (25 mph).

When the brakes are applied, cruisecontrol is turned off.

If the vehicle has StabiliTrak and thesystem begins to limit wheel spin,cruise control will automaticallydisengage. See StabiliTrak® Systemon page 9‑42. When road conditionsallow the cruise control to be safelyused again, it can be turnedback on.

I (On/Off): Press to turn thesystem on or off. The indicator lightis on when cruise control is on andturns off when cruise control is off.

+RES (Resume/Accelerate):Press briefly to make the vehicleresume to a previously set speed,or press and hold to accelerate.

SET− (Set/Coast): Press to set thespeed and activate cruise control ormake the vehicle decelerate.

[ (Cancel): Press to disengagecruise control without erasing theset speed from memory.

Setting Cruise Control

If the cruise button is on when not inuse, it could get bumped and go intocruise when not desired. Keep thecruise control switch off when cruiseis not being used.

The cruise control light on theinstrument panel cluster comes onafter the cruise control has been setto the desired speed.

1. Press theI button.

2. Get up to the desired speed.

3. Press the SET− button locatedon the steering wheel andrelease it.

Page 305: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (47,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-47

4. Take your foot off theaccelerator.

Resuming a Set Speed

If the cruise control is set at adesired speed and then the brakesare applied, the cruise control isdisengaged without erasing the setspeed from memory.

Once the vehicle speed reachesabout 40 km/h (25 mph) or more,press the +RES button on thesteering wheel. The vehicle returnsto the previous set speed and staysthere.

Increasing Speed While UsingCruise Control

If the cruise control system isalready activated,. Press and hold the +RES button

on the steering wheel until thedesired speed is reached, thenrelease it.

. To increase vehicle speed insmall amounts, press the +RESbutton. Each time this is done,the vehicle goes about 1.6 km/h(1 mph) faster.

Reducing Speed While UsingCruise Control

If the cruise control system isalready activated,. Press and hold the SET– button

on the steering wheel until thedesired lower speed is reached,then release it.

. To slow down in small amounts,press the SET– button on thesteering wheel briefly. Each timethis is done, the vehicle goesabout 1.6 km/h (1 mph) slower.

Passing Another Vehicle WhileUsing Cruise Control

Use the accelerator pedal toincrease the vehicle speed. Whenyou take your foot off the pedal, thevehicle will slow down to theprevious set cruise speed.

Using Cruise Control on Hills

How well the cruise control workson hills depends on the vehiclespeed, the load, and the steepnessof the hills. When going up steephills, pressing the accelerator pedalmay be necessary to maintainvehicle speed. When goingdownhill, Cruise Grade Brakinghelps maintain the driver selectedspeed.

Cruise Grade Braking is enabledwhen the vehicle is started andCruise Control is active. It is notenabled in Range Selection Mode.It assists in maintaining driverselected speed when driving ondownhill grades by using the engineand transmission to slow thevehicle.

To disable and enable Cruise GradeBraking for the current ignition keycycle, press and hold the Tow/Haulbutton for three seconds. A DICmessage displays. SeeTransmission Messages onpage 5‑42.

Page 306: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (48,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-48 Driving and Operating

For other forms of Grade Braking,see Automatic Transmission onpage 9‑28 andTow/Haul Mode onpage 9‑32.

Ending Cruise Control

There are three ways to end cruisecontrol:. To disengage cruise control,

step lightly on the brake pedal.

. Press the [ on the steeringwheel.

. To turn off the cruise control,pressI on the steering wheel.

Erasing Speed Memory

The cruise control set speed iserased from memory by pressingtheI button or if the ignition isturned off.

Object DetectionSystems

Ultrasonic Parking AssistIf available, the Ultrasonic RearParking Assist (URPA) system usessensors on the rear bumper toassist with parking and avoidingobjects while in R (Reverse).

{ WARNING

The URPA system does notdetect children, pedestrians,bicyclists, animals, or objectsbelow the bumper or that are tooclose or too far from the vehicle.It is not available at speedsgreater than 8 km/h (5 mph). Toprevent injury, death, or vehicledamage, even with URPA, alwayscheck the area around the vehicleand check all mirrors beforebacking.

How the System Works

URPA comes on automatically whenthe shift lever is moved intoR (Reverse). A single tone soundsto indicate the system is working.

URPA operates only at speeds lessthan 8 km/h (5 mph).

An obstacle is indicated by audiblebeeps. The time between the beepsgets shorter as the vehicleapproaches the obstacle.A continuous tone is heard whenthe distance is less than30 cm (12 in).

To be detected, objects must be atleast 25 cm (10 in) off the groundand below liftgate level. Objectsmust also be within 2.5 m (8 ft) fromthe rear bumper. This distance maybe less during warmer or humidweather.

Page 307: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (49,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-49

Turning the System On and Off

Press this button, located next tothe radio, to disable URPA.

The indicator light comes on andPARK ASSIST OFF displays on theDriver Information Center (DIC).See Object Detection SystemMessages on page 5‑39.

When the System Does NotSeem to Work Properly

The following messages may bedisplayed on the DIC:

SERVICE PARK ASSIST: thismessage occurs, take the vehicle toyour dealer for repair.

PARK ASSIST OFF: This messageoccurs if the driver disables thesystem or if the vehicle is drivenabove 8 km/h (5 mph) inR (Reverse).

PARK ASST BLOCKED SEEOWNERS MANUAL: Thismessage can occur under thefollowing conditions:. The ultrasonic sensors are not

clean. Keep the rear bumperfree of mud, dirt, snow, ice,slush, and frost. The messagemay not clear until frost or icehas melted all around and insidethe sensor.

. A trailer is attached to thevehicle, or a bicycle or an objecthanging out of the liftgate duringthe current or last drive cycle.URPA will return to normaloperation after it is determinedthe object is removed. Thiscould take a few drive cycles.

. A tow bar is attached to thevehicle.

Other conditions may affect systemperformance, such as vibrationsfrom a jackhammer or thecompression of air brakes on a verylarge truck.

Side Blind ZoneAlert (SBZA)If available, the Side Blind ZoneAlert system is a lane changing aidthat assists drivers with avoidingcrashes that occur with vehicles inthe side blind zones.

{ WARNING

SBZA does not detect vehiclesrapidly approaching outside of theside blind zones, pedestrians,bicyclists, or animals. Failure touse proper care when changinglanes may result in injury, death,or vehicle damage. Beforemaking a lane change, always

(Continued)

Page 308: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (50,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-50 Driving and Operating

WARNING (Continued)

check mirrors, glance over yourshoulder, and use the turnsignals.

SBZA Detection Zones

The SBZA sensor covers a zone ofapproximately one lane over fromboth sides of the vehicle, 3.5 m(11 ft). This zone starts at each sidemirror and goes back approximately5.0 m (16 ft). The height of the zone

is approximately between0.5 m (1.5 ft) and 2.0 m (6 ft) off theground.

Use caution while changing laneswhen towing a trailer, as the SBZAdetection zones do not changewhen a trailer is towed.

How the System Works

The SBZA symbol lights up in theside mirrors when the systemdetects a vehicle in the side blindzone, indicating it may be unsafe tochange lanes. Before making a lanechange, check the SBZA display,check all mirrors, glance over yourshoulder, and use the turn signals.

Left Side MirrorDisplay

Right Side MirrorDisplay

When the vehicle is started, bothoutside mirror SBZA displays willbriefly come on to indicate thesystem is operating. When thevehicle is moving forward, the left orright side mirror display will light upif a vehicle is detected in that blindzone. If the turn signal is activatedand a vehicle is also detected onthe same side, the display will flashto give you extra warning not tochange lanes.

At speeds greater then 32 km/h(20 mph), SBZA displays may comeon when approaching or passingother vehicles. SBZA displays maycome on when a passed vehicleremains in or drops back into thedetection zone. SBZA can bedisabled through the DriverInformation Center (DIC). See DriverInformation Center (DIC) onpage 5‑26. If SBZA is disabled bythe driver, the SBZA mirror displayswill not light up.

Page 309: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (51,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-51

When the System Does Not SeemTo Work Properly

Missed alerts can occur undernormal circumstances and willincrease in wet conditions. Thesystem does not need to beserviced. SBZA is designed toignore stationary objects; however,the system may occasionally lightup due to guard rails, signs, trees,shrubs, and other stationary objects.This is normal system operation, thevehicle does not need service.

If the SBZA displays do not light upwhen the system is on and vehiclesare in the blind zone, the systemmay need service. Take the vehicleto your dealer.

SBZA does not operate when theSBZA sensors in the left or rightcorners of the rear bumper arecovered with mud, dirt, snow, ice,slush, or in heavy rainstorms. Forcleaning instructions, see “Washingthe Vehicle” under Exterior Care onpage 10‑87. If the DIC still displaysthe SIDE BLIND ZONE SYSTEM

UNAVAILABLE message aftercleaning the bumper, see yourdealer.

The SBZA displays may remain onif a trailer is attached to the vehicle,or a bicycle or object is extendingout to either side of the vehicle.

When SBZA is disabled for anyreason other than the driver turningit off, it cannot be turned back on.The SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT ONoption will not be selectable if theconditions for normal systemoperation are not met.

SBZA Error Messages

The following messages mayappear in the DIC:

SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERTSYSTEM OFF: This messageindicates that the driver has turnedthe system off.

SIDE BLIND ZONE SYSTEMUNAVAILABLE: This messageindicates that the SBZA system isdisabled either because the sensoris blocked and cannot detect

vehicles in your blind zone, or thevehicle is passing through an openfield of view area, such as thedesert, where there is insufficientdata for operation. This messagemay also activate during heavy rainor due to road spray. The vehicledoes not need service. For cleaning,see “Washing the Vehicle” underExterior Care on page 10‑87.

SERVICE SIDE BLIND ZONEALERT SYSTEM: If this messageappears, both SBZA displays willremain on indicating there is aproblem with the SBZA system.If these displays remain on aftercontinued driving, the system needsservice. Take the vehicle to yourdealer.

FCC Information

See Radio Frequency Statement onpage 13‑20 for informationregarding Part 15 of the FederalCommunications Commission (FCC)rules and Industry CanadaStandards RSS-GEN/210/220/310.

Page 310: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (52,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-52 Driving and Operating

Rear VisionCamera (RVC)If available, the Rear Vision Camera(RVC) system displays part of thescene behind the vehicle.

{ WARNING

The RVC system does not displaychildren, pedestrians, bicyclists,animals, or any other objectlocated outside the camera's fieldof view, below the bumper,or under the vehicle. Perceiveddistances may be different fromactual distances. Do not back thevehicle using only the RVCscreen, during longer, higherspeed backing maneuvers,or where there could be crosstraffic. Failure to use proper carebefore backing may result ininjury, death, or vehicle damage.Always check behind and aroundthe vehicle before backing.

Vehicles without NavigationSystem

The RVC system displays a view ofthe area behind the vehicle. Whenthe vehicle is on and shifted intoR (Reverse) the video imageappears on the inside rearviewmirror. The video image disappearsafter the vehicle is shifted out ofR (Reverse).

Turning the RVC System On or Off

To turn off the RVC system, pressand holdz , located on the insiderearview mirror, until the leftindicator light turns off. The RVCdisplay is now disabled.

To turn the RVC system on, pressand holdz until the left indicatorlight comes on. The RVC systemdisplay will appear in the mirror.

Vehicles with NavigationSystem

The RVC system is designed tohelp the driver when backing up bydisplaying a view of the area behind

the vehicle. When the vehicle isshifted into R (Reverse), the videoimage appears on the navigationscreen. After a delay, the navigationscreen displays the last screen afterthe vehicle is shifted out ofR (Reverse).

Turning the RVC System On or Off

To turn the RVC system on or off:

1. Shift into P (Park).

2. Press MENU to enter theconfigure menu options. Turnthe Multifunction knob until theDisplay feature is highlightedand press the Multifunctionknob. Or press the Displayscreen button

3. Select the Rear Camera Optionsscreen button. The Rear CameraOptions screen displays.

4. Select the Video screen button.When the Video screen button ishighlighted the RVCsystem is on.

Page 311: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (53,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-53

The delay that is received aftershifting out of R (Reverse) isapproximately 10 seconds. Thedelay can be canceled byperforming one of the following:. Pressing a hard key on the

navigation system.. Shifting into P (Park).. Reach a vehicle speed of

8 km/h (5 mph).

Symbols

The navigation system may have afeature that allows for viewingparking assist symbols on thenavigation screen while using theRVC. The Ultrasonic Rear ParkAssist (URPA) system must not bedisabled to use the caution symbols.If URPA has been disabled and thesymbols have been turned on, theRear Parking Assist SymbolsUnavailable error message maydisplay. See Ultrasonic ParkingAssist on page 9‑48.

The symbols appear near objectsdetected by the URPA system. Thesymbol may cover the object whenviewing the navigation screen.

To turn the symbols on or off:

1. Make sure that URPA has notbeen disabled.

2. Shift into P (Park).

3. Press MENU to enter theconfigure menu options. Turnthe Multifunction knob until theDisplay feature is highlightedand press the Multifunctionknob. Or press the Displayscreen button

4. Select the Rear Camera Optionsscreen button. The Rear CameraOptions screen displays.

5. Touch the Symbols screenbutton. The screen button will behighlighted when on.

Guidelines

The RVC system has a guidelineoverlay that can help the driver alignthe vehicle when backing into aparking spot.

To turn the guidelines on or off:

1. Make sure that URPA has notbeen disabled.

2. Shift into P (Park).

3. Press MENU to enter theconfigure menu options. Turnthe Multifunction knob until theDisplay feature is highlightedand press the Multifunctionknob. Or press the Displayscreen button

4. Select the Rear Camera Optionsscreen button. The Rear CameraOptions screen displays.

5. Touch the Guidelines screenbutton. The screen button will behighlighted when on.

Page 312: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (54,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-54 Driving and Operating

RVC Location

The camera is located above thelicense plate.

This shows the field of view that thecamera provides.

A. View displayed by the camera

A. View displayed by the camera

B. Corners of the rear bumper

Displayed images may be further orcloser than they appear. The areadisplayed is limited and objectswhich are close to either corner ofthe bumper or under the bumper donot display.

When the System Does NotSeem To Work Properly

The RVC system might not workproperly or display a clear image if:. The RVC is turned off. See

“Turning the RVC System On orOff” earlier in this section.

. It is dark.

. The sun or the beam ofheadlamps is shining directlyinto the camera lens.

. Ice, snow, mud, or anything elsebuilds up on the camera lens.Clean the lens, rinse it withwater, and wipe it with a softcloth.

Page 313: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (55,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-55

. The back of the vehicle is in anaccident, the position andmounting angle of the cameracan change or the camera canbe affected. Be sure to have thecamera and its position andmounting angle checked at yourdealer.

The RVC system display in therearview mirror may turn off or notappear as expected due to one ofthe following conditions. If thisoccurs the left indicator light on themirror will flash.. A slow flash may indicate a loss

of video signal, or no videosignal present during the reversecycle.

. A fast flash may indicate that thedisplay has been on for themaximum allowable time duringa reverse cycle, or the displayhas reached an OverTemperature limit.

The fast flash conditions areused to protect the video devicefrom high temperatureconditions. Once conditionsreturn to normal the device willreset and the green indicator willstop flashing.

During any of these fault conditions,the display will be blank and theindicator will flash while the vehicleis in R (Reverse) or until theconditions return to normal.

Press and holdz when the leftindicator light is flashing to turn offthe video display along with the leftindicator light.

FuelUse of the recommended fuel is animportant part of the propermaintenance of this vehicle. To helpkeep the engine clean and maintainoptimum vehicle performance, werecommend the use of gasolineadvertised as TOP TIER DetergentGasoline.

Look for the TOP TIER label on thefuel pump to ensure gasoline meetsenhanced detergency standardsdeveloped by auto companies. A listof marketers providing TOP TIERDetergent Gasoline can be found atwww.toptiergas.com. TOP TIERgasoline is only available in the U.S.and Canada.

Page 314: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (56,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-56 Driving and Operating

The eighth digit of the VehicleIdentification Number (VIN) showsthe code letter or number thatidentifies the vehicle's engine. TheVIN is at the top left of theinstrument panel. See VehicleIdentification Number (VIN) onpage 12‑1.

Vehicles that have a yellow fuel capcan use either unleaded gasoline orethanol fuel containing up to 85%ethanol (E85). See Fuel E85 (85%Ethanol) on page 9‑58. For all othervehicles, use only the unleadedgasoline described underRecommended Fuel on page 9‑56.

Recommended FuelUse regular unleaded gasoline witha posted octane rating of 87 orhigher. If the octane rating is lessthan 87, an audible knocking noise,commonly referred to as sparkknock, might be heard when driving.If this occurs, use a gasoline ratedat 87 octane or higher as soon aspossible. If heavy knocking is heardwhen using gasoline rated at87 octane or higher, the engineneeds service.

Gasoline SpecificationsAt a minimum, gasoline should meetASTM specification D 4814. Somegasolines contain anoctane-enhancing additive calledmethylcyclopentadienyl manganesetricarbonyl (MMT). We recommendagainst the use of gasolinescontaining MMT. See Fuel Additiveson page 9‑57.

California FuelRequirementsIf the vehicle is certified to meetCalifornia Emissions Standards, it isdesigned to operate on fuels thatmeet California specifications. Seethe underhood emission controllabel. If this fuel is not available instates adopting California EmissionsStandards, the vehicle will operatesatisfactorily on fuels meetingfederal specifications, but emissioncontrol system performance mightbe affected. The malfunctionindicator lamp could turn on and thevehicle might fail a smog‐check test.See Malfunction Indicator Lamp onpage 5‑19. If this occurs, return toyour authorized dealer for diagnosis.If it is determined that the conditionis caused by the type of fuel used,repairs might not be covered by thevehicle warranty.

Page 315: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (57,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-57

Fuels in ForeignCountriesNever use leaded gasoline or anyother fuel not recommended in theprevious text on fuel. Costly repairscaused by use of improper fuelwould not be covered by the vehiclewarranty.

To check the fuel availability, ask anauto club, or contact a major oilcompany that does business in thecountry where you will be driving.

Fuel AdditivesTo provide cleaner air, all gasolinesin the United States are nowrequired to contain additives thathelp prevent engine and fuel systemdeposits from forming, allowing theemission control system to workproperly. In most cases, nothingshould have to be added to the fuel.However, some gasolines containonly the minimum amount ofadditive required to meet U.S.Environmental Protection Agency

regulations. To help keep fuelinjectors and intake valves cleanand avoid problems due to dirtyinjectors or valves, look for gasolinethat is advertised as TOP TIERDetergent Gasoline. Look for theTOP TIER label on the fuel pump toensure gasoline meets enhanceddetergency standards developed bythe auto companies. A list ofmarketers providing TOP TIERDetergent Gasoline can be found atwww.toptiergas.com.

For customers who do not use TOPTIER Detergent Gasoline regularly,one bottle of GM Fuel SystemTreatment PLUS, added to the fueltank at every engine oil change, canhelp clean deposits from fuelinjectors and intake valves. GM FuelSystem Treatment PLUS is the onlygasoline additive recommended byGeneral Motors. It is available atyour dealer.

Gasolines containing oxygenates,such as ethers and ethanol, andreformulated gasolines might beavailable in your area. We

recommend that you use thesegasolines, if they comply with thespecifications described earlier.However, E85 (85% ethanol) andother fuels containing more than15% ethanol must not be used invehicles that were not designed forthose fuels.

Notice: This vehicle was notdesigned for fuel that containsmethanol. Do not use fuelcontaining methanol. It cancorrode metal parts in the fuelsystem and also damage plasticand rubber parts. That damagewould not be covered under thevehicle warranty.

Some gasolines that are notreformulated for low emissions cancontain an octane-enhancingadditive calledmethylcyclopentadienyl manganesetricarbonyl (MMT); ask the attendantwhere you buy gasoline whether thefuel contains MMT. We recommendagainst the use of such gasolines.Fuels containing MMT can reducespark plug life and affect emission

Page 316: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (58,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-58 Driving and Operating

control system performance. Themalfunction indicator lamp mightturn on. If this occurs, return to yourdealer for service.

Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol)Vehicles that have a yellow fuel capcan use either unleaded gasoline orethanol fuel containing up to 85%ethanol (E85). For all other vehicles,use only the unleaded gasolinedescribed under RecommendedFuel on page 9‑56.

We encourage the use of E85 invehicles that are designed to use it.The ethanol in E85 is a “renewable”fuel, meaning it is made fromrenewable sources such as cornand other crops.

Many service stations will not havean 85% ethanol fuel (E85) pumpavailable. The U.S. Department ofEnergy has an alternative fuelswebsite (www.afdc.energy.gov/afdc/locator/stations/) that can help youfind E85 fuel. Those stations that dohave E85 should have a label

indicating ethanol content. Do notuse the fuel if the ethanol content isgreater than 85%.

At a minimum, E85 should meetASTM Specification D 5798 orCGSB Specification 3.512. Fillingthe tank with fuel mixtures that donot meet ASTM or CGSBspecifications can affect driveabilityand could cause the malfunctionindicator lamp to come on. As theoutside temperature approachesfreezing, ethanol fuel distributorsshould supply winter grade ethanol,the same as with unleadedgasoline.

It is best not to alternate repeatedlybetween gasoline and E85. If youdo switch fuels, it is recommendedthat you add as much fuel aspossible — do not add less than11 L (3 gal) when refueling. Youshould drive the vehicle immediatelyafter refueling for at least 11 km(7 mi) to allow the vehicle to adaptto the change in ethanolconcentration.

E85 has less energy per liter(gallon) than gasoline, so you willneed to refill the fuel tank moreoften when using E85 than whenyou are using gasoline. See Fillingthe Tank on page 9‑59.

Notice: Some additives are notcompatible with E85 fuel and canharm the vehicle's fuel system.Do not add anything to E85.Damage caused by additiveswould not be covered by thevehicle warranty.

Notice: This vehicle was notdesigned for fuel that containsmethanol. Do not use fuelcontaining methanol. It cancorrode metal parts in the fuelsystem and also damage plasticand rubber parts. That damagewould not be covered under thevehicle warranty.

Page 317: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (59,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-59

Filling the Tank

{ WARNING

Fuel vapors and fuel fires burnviolently and can cause injury ordeath.

. To help avoid injuries to youand others, read and followall the instructions on the fuelpump island.

. Turn off the engine whenrefueling.

. Keep sparks, flames, andsmoking materials awayfrom fuel.

. Do not leave the fuel pumpunattended.

. Do not reenter the vehiclewhile pumping fuel.

. Keep children away from thefuel pump and never letchildren pump fuel.

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

. Fuel can spray out if the fuelcap is opened too quickly.This spray can happen if thetank is nearly full, and ismore likely in hot weather.Open the fuel cap slowly andwait for any hiss noise to stopthen unscrew the cap allthe way

The tethered fuel cap is locatedbehind a hinged fuel door on thedriver side of the vehicle. If thevehicle has E85 fuel capability, thefuel cap will be yellow and state thatE85 or gasoline can be used. SeeFuel E85 (85% Ethanol) onpage 9‑58.

To open the fuel door, push therearward center edge in and releaseand it will open.

Page 318: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (60,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-60 Driving and Operating

To remove the fuel cap, turn itslowly counterclockwise. The fuelcap has a spring in it; if the cap isreleased too soon, it will spring backto the right.

While refueling, hang the tetheredfuel cap from the hook on thefuel door.

Be careful not to spill fuel. Do nottop off or overfill the tank and wait afew seconds after you have finishedpumping before removing thenozzle. Clean fuel from paintedsurfaces as soon as possible. SeeExterior Care on page 10‑87.

When replacing the fuel cap, insertthe tether in its hole beforetightening the cap. Turn the fuel capclockwise until it clicks. It will requiremore effort to turn the fuel cap onthe last turn as you tighten it. Makesure the cap is fully installed. Thediagnostic system can determine ifthe fuel cap has been left off orimproperly installed. This would

allow fuel to evaporate into theatmosphere. See MalfunctionIndicator Lamp on page 5‑19.

If the vehicle has a DriverInformation Center (DIC), theTIGHTEN GAS CAP messagedisplays if the fuel cap is notproperly installed.

{ WARNING

If a fire starts while you arerefueling, do not remove thenozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel byshutting off the pump or bynotifying the station attendant.Leave the area immediately.

Notice: If a new fuel cap isneeded, be sure to get the righttype of cap from your dealer. Thewrong type of fuel cap might notfit properly, might cause themalfunction indicator lamp tolight, and could damage the fuel

tank and emissions system. SeeMalfunction Indicator Lamp onpage 5‑19.

Filling a Portable FuelContainer

{ WARNING

Filling a portable fuel containerwhile it is in the vehicle can causefuel vapors that can ignite eitherby static electricity or othermeans. You or others could bebadly burned and the vehiclecould be damaged. Always:

. Use approved fuelcontainers.

. Remove container fromvehicle, trunk, or pickup bedbefore filling.

. Place container on theground.

(Continued)

Page 319: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (61,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-61

WARNING (Continued)

. Place the nozzle inside the fillopening of the containerbefore dispensing fuel, andkeep it in contact with the fillopening until filling iscomplete.

. Do not smoke whilepumping fuel.

Towing

General TowingInformationOnly use towing equipment that hasbeen designed for the vehicle.Contact your dealer or traileringdealer for assistance with preparingthe vehicle for towing a trailer. Readthe entire section before towing atrailer.

For towing a disabled vehicle, seeTowing the Vehicle on page 10‑82.For towing the vehicle behindanother vehicle such as a motorhome, see Recreational VehicleTowing on page 10‑82.

Driving Characteristicsand Towing Tips

Driving with a Trailer

When towing a trailer:. Become familiar with the state

and local laws that apply totrailer towing.

. Do not tow a trailer during thefirst 800 km (500 mi) to preventdamage to the engine, axle,or other parts.

. Then during the first 800 km(500 mi) of trailer towing, do notdrive over 80 km/h (50 mph) anddo not make starts at full throttle.

. Vehicles can tow in D (Drive).Shift the transmission to a lowergear if the transmission shiftstoo often under heavy loads and/or hilly conditions.

{ WARNING

When towing a trailer, exhaustgases may collect at the rear ofthe vehicle and enter if theliftgate, trunk/hatch, or rear-mostwindow is open.

When towing a trailer:. Do not drive with the liftgate,trunk/hatch, or rear-mostwindow open.

(Continued)

Page 320: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (62,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-62 Driving and Operating

WARNING (Continued)

. Fully open the air outlets onor under the instrumentpanel.

. Also adjust the climatecontrol system to a settingthat brings in only outside air.See “Climate Control System”in the Index.

For more information aboutCarbon Monoxide, see EngineExhaust on page 9‑27.

Towing a trailer requires a certainamount of experience. Thecombination you are driving islonger and not as responsive as thevehicle itself. Get acquainted withthe handling and braking of the rigbefore setting out for the open road.

Before starting, check all trailer hitchparts and attachments, safetychains, electrical connectors, lamps,tires, and mirrors. If the trailer haselectric brakes, start the

combination moving and then applythe trailer brake controller by handto be sure the brakes work.

During the trip, check occasionallyto be sure that the load is secureand the lamps and any trailerbrakes still work.

Following Distance

Stay at least twice as far behind thevehicle ahead as you would whendriving the vehicle without a trailer.This can help to avoid heavybraking and sudden turns.

Passing

More passing distance is neededwhen towing a trailer. Thecombination will not accelerate asquickly and is longer so it isnecessary to go much fartherbeyond the passed vehicle beforereturning to the lane.

Backing Up

Hold the bottom of the steeringwheel with one hand. To move thetrailer to the left, move that hand to

the left. To move the trailer to theright, move your hand to the right.Always back up slowly and,if possible, have someoneguide you.

Making Turns

Notice: Making very sharp turnswhile trailering could cause thetrailer to come in contact with thevehicle. The vehicle could bedamaged. Avoid making verysharp turns while trailering.

When turning with a trailer, makewider turns than normal. Do this sothe trailer will not strike softshoulders, curbs, road signs, trees,or other objects. Avoid jerky orsudden maneuvers. Signal well inadvance.

If the trailer turn signal bulbs burnout, the arrows on the instrumentcluster will still flash for turns. It isimportant to check occasionally tobe sure the trailer bulbs are stillworking.

Page 321: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (63,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-63

Driving on Grades

Reduce speed and shift to a lowergear before starting down a long orsteep downgrade. If thetransmission is not shifted down, thebrakes might get hot and no longerwork well.

Vehicles can tow in D (Drive). Shiftthe transmission to a lower gear ifthe transmission shifts too oftenunder heavy loads and/or hillyconditions.

The Tow/Haul Mode may be used ifthe transmission shifts too often.See Tow/Haul Mode on page 9‑32.

When towing at high altitude onsteep uphill grades, consider thefollowing: Engine coolant will boil ata lower temperature than at normalaltitudes. If the engine is turned offimmediately after towing at highaltitude on steep uphill grades, thevehicle may show signs similar toengine overheating. To avoid this,let the engine run while parked,preferably on level ground, with theautomatic transmission in P (Park)

for a few minutes before turning theengine off. If the overheat warningcomes on, see Engine Overheatingon page 10‑18.

Parking on Hills

{ WARNING

Parking the vehicle on a hill withthe trailer attached can bedangerous. If something goeswrong, the rig could start to move.People can be injured, and boththe vehicle and the trailer can bedamaged. When possible, alwayspark the rig on a flat surface.

If parking the rig on a hill:

1. Press the brake pedal, but donot shift into P (Park) yet. Turnthe wheels into the curb if facingdownhill or into traffic if facinguphill.

2. Have someone place chocksunder the trailer wheels.

3. When the wheel chocks are inplace, release the regular brakesuntil the chocks absorb the load.

4. Reapply the brake pedal. Thenapply the parking brake and shiftinto P (Park).

5. Release the brake pedal.

Leaving After Parking on a Hill

1. Apply and hold the brake pedal.

2. Start the engine.

3. Shift into a gear.

4. Release the parking brake.

5. Let up on the brake pedal.

6. Drive slowly until the trailer isclear of the chocks.

7. Stop and have someone pick upand store the chocks.

Page 322: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (64,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-64 Driving and Operating

Maintenance when TrailerTowing

The vehicle needs service moreoften when pulling a trailer. SeeMaintenance Schedule onpage 11‑2. Things that areespecially important in traileroperation are automatictransmission fluid, engine oil, axlelubricant, belts, cooling system, andbrake system. It is a good idea toinspect these before and duringthe trip.

Check periodically to see that allhitch nuts and bolts are tight.

Trailer TowingIf the vehicle has a hybrid engine,see the Hybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Do not tow a trailer during break-in.See New Vehicle Break-In onpage 9‑19 for more information.

{ WARNING

The driver can lose control whenpulling a trailer if the correctequipment is not used or thevehicle is not driven properly. Forexample, if the trailer is tooheavy, the brakes may not workwell— or even at all. The driverand passengers could beseriously injured. The vehicle mayalso be damaged; the resultingrepairs would not be covered bythe vehicle warranty. Pull a traileronly if all the steps in this sectionhave been followed. Ask yourdealer for advice and informationabout towing a trailer with thevehicle.

Notice: Pulling a trailerimproperly can damage thevehicle and result in costlyrepairs not covered by the vehiclewarranty. To pull a trailercorrectly, follow the advice in thissection and see your dealer forimportant information abouttowing a trailer with the vehicle.

To identify the trailering capacity ofthe vehicle, read the information in“Weight of the Trailer” that appearslater in this section.

Trailering is different than justdriving the vehicle by itself.Trailering means changes inhandling, acceleration, braking,durability and fuel economy.Successful, safe trailering takescorrect equipment, and it has to beused properly.

Page 323: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (65,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-65

The following information has manytime-tested, important trailering tipsand safety rules. Many of these areimportant for your safety and that ofyour passengers. So please readthis section carefully before pulling atrailer.

Weight of the Trailer

How heavy can a trailer safely be?

It depends on how the rig is used.Speed, altitude, road grades,outside temperature, and how muchthe vehicle is used to pull a trailerare all important. It can depend onany special equipment on thevehicle, and the amount of tongueweight the vehicle can carry. See“Weight of the Trailer Tongue” laterin this section for more information.

Trailer weight rating (TWR) iscalculated assuming the tow vehiclehas only the driver but all requiredtrailering equipment. Weight ofadditional optional equipment,passengers, and cargo in the towvehicle must be subtracted from thetrailer weight rating.

Use the following chart to determinehow much the vehicle can weigh,based upon the vehicle model andoptions.

Page 324: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (66,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-66 Driving and Operating

Vehicle Axle Ratio Maximum Trailer Weight GCWR*

1500 Series 2WD Short Wheel Base

5.3LV8 3.08 2 495 kg (5,500 lb) 4 990 kg (11,000 lb)

5.3LV8 3.42 2 722 kg (6,000 lb) 5 216 kg (11,500 lb)

5.3LV8 K5L HD Cooling Pkg 3.42 3 856 kg (8,500 lb) 6 350 kg (14,000 lb)

1500 Series 2WD Long Wheel Base

5.3LV8 3.08 2 313 kg (5,100 lb) 4 990 kg (11,000 lb)

5.3LV8 3.42 2 540 kg (5,600 lb) 5 216 kg (11,500 lb)

5.3LV8 K5L HD Cooling Pkg 3.42 3 674 kg (8,100 lb) 6 350 kg (14,000 lb)

1500 Series 4WD Short Wheel Base

5.3LV8 3.08 2 359 kg (5,200 lb) 4 990 kg (11,000 lb)

5.3LV8 3.42 2 586 kg (5,700 lb) 5 216 kg (11,500 lb)

5.3LV8 K5L HD Cooling Pkg 3.42 3 720 kg (8,200 lb) 6 350 kg (14,000 lb)

1500 Series 4WD Long Wheel Base

5.3LV8 3.08 2 268 kg (5,000 lb) 4 990 kg (11,000 lb)

5.3LV8 3.42 2 495 kg (5,500 lb) 5 216 kg (11,500 lb)

5.3LV8 K5L HD Cooling Pkg 3.42 3 629 kg (8,000 lb) 6 350 kg (14,000 lb)

Page 325: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (67,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-67

Vehicle Axle Ratio Maximum Trailer Weight GCWR*

2500 Series 2WD Long Wheel Base

6.0LV8 3.73 4 355 kg (9,600 lb) 7 258 kg (16,000 lb)

2500 Series 4WD Long Wheel Base

6.0LV8 3.73 4 264 kg (9,400 lb) 7 258 kg (16,000 lb)

*The Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR) is the total allowable weight of the completely loaded vehicle andtrailer including any passengers, cargo, equipment and conversions. The GCWR for the vehicle should not beexceeded.

Ask your dealer for traileringinformation or advice, or write us atour Customer Assistance Offices,See Customer Assistance Offices(U.S. and Canada) on page 13‑5 orCustomer Assistance Offices(Mexico) on page 13‑5.

Weight of the Trailer Tongue

The tongue load (A) of any trailer isvery important because it is alsopart of the vehicle weight. TheGross Vehicle Weight (GVW)includes the curb weight of thevehicle, any cargo carried in it, andthe people who will be riding in thevehicle as well as trailer tongueweight. Vehicle options, equipment,

passengers and cargo in the vehiclereduce the amount of tongue weightthe vehicle can carry, which will alsoreduce the trailer weight the vehiclecan tow. See Vehicle Load Limits onpage 9‑15 for more informationabout the vehicle's maximum loadcapacity.

Page 326: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (68,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-68 Driving and Operating

Trailer tongue weight (A) should be10 percent to 15 percent of theloaded trailer weight (B) up to themaximums for vehicle series andhitch type.

Vehicle Series Hitch TypeMaximum Tongue

Weight

1500/2500 Weight Carrying 272 kg (600 lb)

1500/2500 Weight Distributing 453 kg (1,000 lb)

Do not exceed the maximumallowable tongue weight for thevehicle. Choose the shortest hitchextension that will position the hitchball closest to the vehicle. This willhelp reduce the effect of trailertongue weight on the rear axle.

Trailer rating may be limited by thevehicle's ability to carry tongueweight. Tongue weight cannot causethe vehicle to exceed the GVWR(Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) orthe RGAWR (Rear Gross AxleWeight Rating). See “Total Weighton the Vehicle's Tires” later in thissection for more information.

After loading the trailer, weigh thetrailer and then the tongue,separately, to see if the weights are

proper. If they are not, adjustmentsmight be made by moving someitems around in the trailer.

Total Weight on the Vehicle'sTires

Be sure the vehicle's tires areinflated to the inflation pressuresfound on the Certification label onthe drivers door or see Vehicle LoadLimits on page 9‑15 for moreinformation. Make sure not toexceed the GVWR limit for thevehicle, or the RGAWR, with the towvehicle and trailer fully loaded forthe trip including the weight of thetrailer tongue. If using a weightdistributing hitch, make sure not toexceed the RGAWR before applyingthe weight distribution spring bars.

Page 327: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (69,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-69

Weight of the TraileringCombination

It is important that the combinationof the tow vehicle and trailer doesnot exceed any of its weight ratings— GCWR, GVWR, RGAWR, TrailerWeight Rating or Tongue Weight.The only way to be sure it is notexceeding any of these ratings is toweigh the tow vehicle and trailercombination, fully loaded for the trip,getting individual weights for each ofthese items.

Towing Equipment

Hitches

The correct hitch equipment helpsmaintain combination control. Mostsmall-to-medium trailers can betowed with a weight carrying hitchwhich simply features a couplerlatched to the hitch ball. Largertrailers may require a weightdistributing hitch that uses springbars to distribute the trailer tongueweight among the two vehicle andtrailer axles.

See “Weight of the Trailer Tongue”in Trailer Towing on page 9‑64 forrating limits with various hitch types.

Consider using sway controls withany trailer. Ask a traileringprofessional about sway controls orrefer to the trailer manufacturer'srecommendations and instructions.

Weight-Distributing HitchAdjustment

A. Body to Ground Distance

B. Front of Vehicle

When using a weight-distributinghitch, the spring bars should beadjusted so the distance (A) is thesame after coupling the trailer to thetow vehicle and adjusting the hitch.

Safety Chains

Always attach chains between thevehicle and the trailer. Cross thesafety chains under the tongue ofthe trailer to help prevent the tonguefrom contacting the road if itbecomes separated from the hitch.Instructions about safety chainsmay be provided by the hitchmanufacturer or by the trailermanufacturer. If the trailer beingtowed weighs up to 2 271 kg(5,000 lbs) with a factory-installedstep bumper, safety chains may beattached to the attaching points onthe bumper, otherwise, safetychains should be attached to holeson the trailer hitch platform. Alwaysleave just enough slack so thecombination can turn. Never allowsafety chains to drag on the ground.

Page 328: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (70,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-70 Driving and Operating

Trailer Brakes

A loaded trailer that weighs morethan 900 kg (2,000 lbs) needs tohave its own brake system that isadequate for the weight of thetrailer. Be sure to read and followthe instructions for the trailer brakesso they are installed, adjusted andmaintained properly.

Since the vehicle is equipped withStabiliTrak®, the trailer brakescannot tap into the vehicle'shydraulic system.

Trailer Wiring Harness

The vehicle is equipped with thefollowing wiring harnesses fortowing a trailer.

Basic Trailer Wiring

The trailer wiring harness, with aseven-pin connector, is located atthe rear of the vehicle and is tied tothe vehicle's frame. The harnessconnector can be plugged into aseven-pin universal heavy-dutytrailer connector available throughyour dealer.

The seven-wire harness containsthe following trailer circuits:. Yellow: Left Stop/Turn Signal. Dark Green: Right Stop/Turn

Signal. Brown: Taillamps. White: Ground. Light Green: Back-up Lamps. Red: Battery Feed*. Dark Blue: Trailer Brake*

*The fuses for these two circuits areinstalled in the underhood electricalcenter, but the wires are notconnected. They should beconnected by your dealer or aqualified service center.

Heavy-Duty Trailer Wiring HarnessPackage

The vehicle is equipped with theseven-wire trailer towing harness.This harness with a seven-pinuniversal trailer connector isattached to a bracket on the hitchplatform.

The seven-wire harness containsthe following trailer circuits:. Yellow: Left Stop/Turn Signal. Dark Green: Right Stop/Turn

Signal. Brown: Taillamps

Page 329: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (71,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-71

. White: Ground

. Light Green: Back-up Lamps

. Red: Battery Feed*

. Dark Blue: Trailer Brake*

*The fuses for these two circuits areinstalled in the underhood electricalcenter, but the wires are notconnected. They should beconnected by your dealer or aqualified service center.

If charging a remote (non-vehicle)battery, press the tow/haul modebutton located at the end of the shiftlever. This will boost the vehiclesystem voltage and properly chargethe battery. If the trailer is too lightfor tow/haul mode, turn on theheadlamps as a second way toboost the vehicle system andcharge the battery.

Electric Brake Control WiringProvisions

These wiring provisions areincluded with the vehicle as part ofthe trailer wiring package. Theseprovisions are for an electric brakecontroller. The instrument panelcontains blunt cut wires near thedata link connector for the trailerbrake controller. The harnesscontains the following wires:. Dark Blue: Brake Signal to

Trailer Connector. Red/Black: Battery. Light Blue/White: Brake Switch. White: Ground

It should be installed by your dealeror a qualified service center.

If the vehicle is equipped with anITBC, the blunt cuts exist, but arenot connected further in theharness. If an aftermarket trailerbrake controller is installed, theITBC must be disconnected. Do not

power both ITBC and aftermarketcontrollers to control the trailerbrakes at the same time.

Tow/Haul Mode

Pressing this button at the end ofthe shift lever turns on and off thetow/haul mode.

This indicator light on the instrumentpanel cluster comes on when thetow/haul mode is on.

Page 330: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (72,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-72 Driving and Operating

Tow/Haul is a feature that assistswhen pulling a heavy trailer or alarge or heavy load. See Tow/HaulMode on page 9‑32 for moreinformation.

Tow/Haul is designed to be mosteffective when the vehicle andtrailer combined weight is at least75 percent of the vehicle's GrossCombined Weight Rating (GCWR).See “Weight of the Trailer” earlier inthe section. Tow/Haul is most usefulunder the following drivingconditions:. When pulling a heavy trailer or a

large or heavy load throughrolling terrain.

. When pulling a heavy trailer or alarge or heavy load in stop andgo traffic.

. When pulling a heavy trailer or alarge or heavy load in busyparking lots where improved lowspeed control of the vehicle isdesired.

Operating the vehicle in Tow/Haulwhen lightly loaded or with no trailerat all will not cause damage.However, there is no benefit to theselection of Tow/Haul when thevehicle is unloaded. Such aselection when unloaded may resultin unpleasant engine andtransmission driving characteristicsand reduced fuel economy. Tow/Haul is recommended only whenpulling a heavy trailer or a large orheavy load.

Integrated Trailer BrakeControl System

The vehicle may have an IntegratedTrailer Brake Control (ITBC) systemfor electric trailer brakes.

This symbol is located on the TrailerBrake Control Panel on vehicleswith an Integrated Trailer BrakeControl System. The power outputto the trailer brakes is based on theamount of brake pressure beingapplied by the vehicle’s brakesystem. This available power outputto the trailer brakes can be adjustedto a wide range of traileringsituations.

The ITBC system is integrated withthe vehicle’s brake, anti-lock brakeand StabiliTrak systems. In traileringconditions that cause the vehicle’santi-lock brake or StabiliTraksystems to activate, power sent tothe trailer's brakes will beautomatically adjusted to minimizetrailer wheel lock-up. This does notimply that the trailer has theStabiliTrak system.

The vehicle may have a TrailerSway Control (TSC) feature. SeeTrailer Sway Control (TSC) onpage 9‑77.

Page 331: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (73,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-73

The vehicle may have a Hill StartAssist (HSA) feature. See Hill StartAssist (HSA) on page 9‑41.

If the vehicle’s brake, anti-lockbrake or StabiliTrak systems are notfunctioning properly, the ITBCsystem may not be fully functionalor may not function at all. Make sureall of these systems are fullyoperational to ensure fullfunctionality of the ITBC system.

The ITBC system is poweredthrough the vehicle's electricalsystem. Turning the ignition off willalso turn off the ITBC system. TheITBC system is fully functional onlywhen the ignition is in ON orin RUN.

The ITBC system can only be usedwith trailers with electric brakes.

{ WARNING

Connecting a trailer thathas a surge, air,or electric-over-hydraulic trailerbrake system may result inreduced or complete loss of trailerbraking. There may be anincrease in stopping distance ortrailer instability which couldresult in personal injury ordamage to the vehicle, trailer,or other property. Use the ITBCsystem only with electric brakes.

Trailer Brake Control Panel

A. Manual Trailer Brake ApplyLever

B. Trailer Gain Adjustment Buttons

The ITBC system has a controlpanel located on the instrumentpanel to the left of the steeringcolumn. The control panel allowsadjustment to the amount of output,referred to as trailer gain, availableto the electric trailer brakes andallows manual application the trailerbrakes. The Trailer Brake ControlPanel is used along with the Trailer

Page 332: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (74,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-74 Driving and Operating

Brake Display Page on the DIC toadjust and display power output tothe trailer brakes.

Trailer Brake DIC Display Page

The ITBC system displaysmessages into the vehicle’s DriverInformation Center (DIC). SeeDriver Information Center (DIC) onpage 5‑26 for more information.

The display page indicates TrailerGain setting, power output to theelectric trailer brakes, trailerconnection and system operationalstatus.

The Trailer Brake Display Page canbe displayed by performing any ofthe following actions:. Scrolling through the DIC menu

pages using the odometer tripstem or the DIC VehicleInformation button (if equipped).

. Pressing a Trailer Gain button –If the Trailer Brake Display Pageis not currently displayed,pressing a Trailer Gain buttonwill first recall the current Trailer

Gain setting. After the TrailerBrake Display Page is displayed,each press and release of thegain buttons will then cause theTrailer Gain setting to change.

. Activating the Manual TrailerBrake Apply lever

. Connecting a trailer equippedwith electric trailer brakes

All DIC warning and servicemessages must first beacknowledged by the driver bypressing the odometer trip stem orthe DIC Vehicle Information button(if equipped) before the TrailerBrake Display Page can bedisplayed and Trailer Gain can beadjusted.

TRAILER GAIN – This setting isdisplayed anytime the Trailer BrakeDisplay Page is active. This settingcan be adjusted from 0.0 to 10.0with either a trailer connected ordisconnected. To adjust the TrailerGain, press one of the Trailer Gainadjustment buttons located on theTrailer Brake Control Panel. Press

and hold a gain button to cause theTrailer Gain to continuously adjust.To turn the output to the trailer off,adjust the Trailer Gain setting to0.0 (zero).

0.0 (zero) gain is the factory defaultsetting. To properly adjust trailergain, see the Trailer GainAdjustment Procedure later in thissection.

TRAILER OUTPUT – This isdisplayed any time a trailer withelectric brakes is connected. Outputto the electric brakes is based onthe amount of vehicle brakingpresent and relative to the TrailerGain setting. Output is displayedfrom 0 to 10 bars for each gainsetting.

Non-hybrid vehicles with TrailerSway Control (TSC) or Hill StartAssist (HSA), output to the electrictrailer brakes may be displayedwhen the systems are active. SeeTrailer Sway Control (TSC) onpage 9‑77 and Hill Start Assist(HSA) on page 9‑41.

Page 333: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (75,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-75

The Trailer Output will indicate “- - -- - -“ on the Trailer Brake DisplayPage whenever the following occur:. No trailer is connected.. A trailer without electric brakes

is connected (no DIC messageis displayed).

. A trailer with electric brakes hasbecome disconnected (aCHECK TRAILER WIRINGmessage will also be displayedon the DIC).

. There is a fault present in thewiring to the electric trailerbrakes (a CHECK TRAILERWIRING message will also bedisplayed on the DIC).

. There is a fault in the ITBCsystem (a SERVICE TRAILERBRAKE SYSTEM message willalso be displayed in the DIC).

Manual Trailer Brake Apply

The Manual Trailer Brake ApplyLever is located on the Trailer BrakeControl Panel and is used to apply

the trailer’s electric brakesindependent of the vehicle’s brakes.This lever is used in the Trailer GainAdjustment Procedure to properlyadjust the power output to the trailerbrakes. Sliding the lever to the leftwill apply only the trailer brakes.The power output to the trailer isindicated in the Trailer BrakeDisplay Page in the DIC. If thevehicle’s service brakes are appliedwhile using the Manual Trailer BrakeApply Lever, the trailer output powerwill be the greater of the two.

The trailer and the vehicle's brakelamps will come on when eithervehicle braking or manual trailerbrakes are applied.

Trailer Gain Adjustment Procedure

Trailer Gain should be set for aspecific trailering condition and mustbe adjusted any time vehicleloading, trailer loading or roadsurface conditions change.

Setting the Trailer Gain properly isneeded for the best trailer stoppingperformance. A trailer that is

over-gained may result in lockedtrailer brakes. A trailer that isunder-gained may result in notenough trailer braking. Both of theseconditions may result in poorerstopping and stability of the vehicleand trailer.

Use the following procedure tocorrectly adjust Trailer Gain for eachtowing condition:

1. Make sure the trailer brakes arein proper working condition.

2. Connect a properly loaded trailerto the vehicle and make allnecessary mechanical andelectrical connections. SeeVehicle Load Limits onpage 9‑15 for more information.

3. After the electrical connection ismade to a trailer equipped withelectric brakes:. A TRAILER CONNECTED

message will be brieflydisplayed on the DICdisplay.

Page 334: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (76,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-76 Driving and Operating

. The Trailer Brake DisplayPage will appear on theDIC showing TRAILERGAIN and TRAILEROUTPUT.

. In the Trailer Output displayon the DIC, “- - - - - -“ willdisappear if there is noerror present. Connecting atrailer without electricbrakes will not clear the sixdashed lines.

4. Adjust the Trailer Gain by usingthe gain adjustment (+ / -)buttons on the Trailer BrakeControl Panel.

5. Drive the vehicle with the trailerattached on a level road surfacerepresentative of the towingcondition and free of traffic atabout 32 to 40 km/h (20 to25 mph) and fully apply theManual Trailer Brake Applylever.

Adjusting trailer gain at speedslower than 32 to 40 km/h (20 to25 mph) may result in anincorrect gain setting.

6. Adjust the Trailer Gain to justbelow the point of trailer wheellock-up, indicated by trailerwheel squeal or tire smoke whena trailer wheel locks.

Trailer wheel lock-up may notoccur if towing a heavily loadedtrailer. In this case, adjust theTrailer Gain to the highestallowable setting for the towingcondition.

7. Re-adjust Trailer Gain any timevehicle loading, trailer loading orroad surface conditions changeor if trailer wheel lock-up isnoticed at any time while towing

Other ITBC Related DIC Messages

In addition to displaying TRAILERGAIN and TRAILER OUTPUTthrough the DIC, trailer connectionand ITBC system status is displayedin the DIC.

TRAILER CONNECTED – Thismessage will be briefly displayedwhen a trailer with electric brakes isfirst connected to the vehicle. Thismessage will automatically turn offin about ten seconds. The drivercan also acknowledge this messagebefore it automatically turns off.

CHECK TRAILER WIRING – Thismessage will be displayed if:

1. The ITBC system firstdetermines connection to atrailer with electric brakes andthen the trailer harness becomesdisconnected from the vehicle.

If the disconnect occurs whilethe vehicle is stationary, thismessage will automatically turnoff in about thirty seconds. Thismessage will also turn off if thedriver acknowledges thismessage off or if the trailerharness is re-connected.

If the disconnect occurs whilethe vehicle is moving, thismessage will continue until theignition is turned off. This

Page 335: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (77,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-77

message will also turn off if thedriver acknowledges thismessage off or if the trailerharness is re-connected.

2. There is an electrical fault in thewiring to the electric trailerbrakes. This message willcontinue as long as there is anelectrical fault in the trailerwiring. This message will alsoturn off if the driveracknowledges this message off.

To determine if the electrical fault ison the vehicle side or trailer side ofthe trailer wiring harnessconnection, do the following:

1. Disconnect the trailer wiringharness from the vehicle.

2. Turn the ignition OFF.

3. Wait ten seconds, then turn theignition back to RUN.

4. If the CHECK TRAILER WIRINGmessage re-appears, theelectrical fault is on thevehicle side.

If the CHECK TRAILER WIRINGmessage only re-appears whenconnecting the trailer wiringharness to the vehicle, theelectrical fault is on thetrailer side.

SERVICE TRAILER BRAKESYSTEM – This message will bedisplayed when there is a problemwith the ITBC system. If thismessage persists over multipleignition cycles there is problem withthe ITBC system. Take the vehicleto an authorized GM dealer to havethe ITBC system diagnosed andrepaired.

If either the CHECK TRAILERWIRING or SERVICE TRAILERBRAKE SYSTEM message isdisplayed while driving the vehicle,power is no longer available to thetrailer brakes. When trafficconditions allow, carefully pull the

vehicle over to the side of the roadand turn the ignition off. Check thewiring connection to the trailer andturn the ignition back on. If either ofthese messages continues, eitherthe vehicle or trailer needs service.

An authorized GM dealer may beable to diagnose and repairproblems with the trailer. However,any diagnosis and repair of thetrailer is not covered under thevehicle warranty. Please contactyour trailer dealer for assistancewith trailer repairs and trailerwarranty information.

Trailer SwayControl (TSC)Non-hybrid vehicles with StabiliTrakhave a Trailer Sway Control (TSC)feature. If the vehicle is towing atrailer and the system detects thatthe trailer is swaying, the vehiclebrakes are applied without the driverpressing the brake pedal. If thevehicle is equipped with theIntegrated Trailer Brake Control

Page 336: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (78,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-78 Driving and Operating

(ITBC) system, StabiliTrak may alsoapply the trailer brakes. The TCS/StabiliTrak warning light will flash onthe instrument panel cluster to notifythe driver to reduce speed. If thetrailer continues to sway, StabiliTrakwill reduce engine torque to helpslow the vehicle. See StabiliTrak®

System on page 9‑42 for moreinformation.

Adding non‐dealer accessories canaffect the vehicle performance. SeeAccessories and Modifications onpage 10‑3 for more information.

Conversions andAdd-Ons

Add-On ElectricalEquipmentNotice: Some electricalequipment can damage thevehicle or cause components tonot work and would not becovered by the warranty. Alwayscheck with your dealer beforeadding electrical equipment.

Add-on equipment can drain thevehicle's 12-volt battery, even if thevehicle is not operating.

The vehicle has an airbag system.Before attempting to add anythingelectrical to the vehicle, seeServicing the Airbag-EquippedVehicle on page 3‑38 and AddingEquipment to the Airbag-EquippedVehicle on page 3‑38.

Adding a Snow Plow orSimilar EquipmentBefore installing a snow plow on thevehicle, here are some things youneed to know:

Notice: If the vehicle does nothave the snow plow preppackage, adding a plow candamage the vehicle, and therepairs would not be covered bywarranty. Unless the vehicle wasbuilt to carry a snow plow, do notadd one to the vehicle. If thevehicle has the snow plow preppackage, called RPO VYU, thenthe payload the vehicle can carrywill be reduced when a snowplow is installed. The vehicle canbe damaged if either the front orrear axle ratings or the GrossVehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)are exceeded.

Some vehicles are built with aspecial snow plow prep package,called RPO VYU. If the vehicle hasthis option, you can add a plow to it,provided certain weights, such as

Page 337: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (79,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-79

the weights on the vehicle's axlesand the Gross Vehicle WeightRating (GVWR), are not exceeded.

The plow the vehicle can carrydepends on many things, such as:. The options the vehicle came

with, and the weight of thoseoptions.

. The weight and number ofpassengers intended to becarried.

. The weight of items added to thevehicle.

. The total weight of anyadditional cargo intended to becarried.

Say, for example, you have a 318 kg(700 lb) snow plow. The total weightof all occupants and cargo insidethe cab should not exceed 135 kg(300 lb). This means that you mayonly be able to carry one passenger.But, even this may be too much ifthere is other equipment alreadyadding to the weight of the vehicle.

Here are some guidelines for safelycarrying a snow plow on the vehicle:. Make sure the weight on the

front and rear axles does notexceed the axle rating for each.

. For the front axle, if more cargoor passengers must be carried,appropriate counter ballast mustbe installed rear of the rear axle.Counter ballast must be properlysecured so it will not moveduring driving.

. Follow the snow plowmanufacturer'srecommendations regarding rearballast. Rear ballast may berequired to ensure a proper frontand rear weight distribution ratio,even though the actual weight atthe front axle may be less thanthe front axle rating.

. The snow plow manufacturer orinstaller can assist indetermining the amount of rearballast required, to help makesure the snowplow/vehiclecombination does not exceedthe GVW rating, the front andrear axle ratings, and the frontand rear weight distribution ratio.

. The total vehicle must notexceed the GVW rating.

Front axle reserve capacity is thedifference between the front GrossAxle Weight Rating (GAWR) and thefront axle weight of the vehicle withfull fuel and passengers. Basically, itis the amount of weight that can beadded to the front axle beforereaching the front GAWR.

The front axle reserve capacity forthe vehicle can be found in thelower right corner of theCertification/Tire label, as shown.

Page 338: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (80,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-80 Driving and Operating

United States

Canada

In order to calculate the amount ofweight any front accessory, such asa snow plow, is adding to the frontaxle, use the following formula:

(W x (A +W.B.)) /W.B.= Weight theaccessory is adding to thefront axle.

Where:W = Weight of added accessoryA = Distance that the accessoryis in front of the front axleW.B. = Vehicle Wheelbase

For example, adding a 318 kg(700 lb) snow plow actually addsmore than 318 kg (700 lb) to thefront axle. Using the formula, if thesnow plow is 122 cm (4 ft) in front ofthe front axle and the wheel base is305 cm (10 ft), then:

W = 318 kg (700 lb)A = 122 cm (4 ft)W.B. = 305 cm (10 ft)

(W x (A +W.B.))/W.B. =(318 x (122 + 305))/305 = 445 kg(980 lb)

So, if the vehicle's front axle reservecapacity is more than 980 lbs(445 kg), the snow plow could beadded without exceeding thefront GAWR.

Heavier equipment can be added onthe front of the vehicle if it iscompensated for by carrying fewerpassengers, less cargo, or bypositioning cargo toward the rear.This has the effect of reducing theload on the front. However, the front

Page 339: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (81,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Driving and Operating 9-81

GAWR, rear GAWR, and the GrossVehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)must never be exceeded.

{ WARNING

On some vehicles that havecertain front mounted equipment,such as a snow plow, it may bepossible to load the front axle tothe front gross axle weight rating(GAWR) but not have enoughweight on the rear axle to haveproper braking performance. If thebrakes cannot work properly, youcould have a crash. To help thebrakes work properly when asnow plow is installed, alwaysfollow the snow plowmanufacturer or installer'srecommendation for rear ballastto ensure a proper front and rearweight distribution ratio, eventhough the actual front weightmay be less than the frontGAWR, and the total vehicle

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

weight is less than the grossvehicle weight rating (GVWR).Maintaining a proper front andrear weight distribution ratio isnecessary to provide properbraking performance.

Total vehicle reserve capacity is thedifference between the GVWR andthe weight of the vehicle with fullfuel and passengers. It is theamount of weight that can be addedto the vehicle before reachingtheGVWR. Keep in mind thatreserve capacity numbers areintended as a guide when selectingthe amount of equipment or cargothe vehicle can carry. If you areunsure of the vehicle's front, rear,or total weight, go to a weigh stationand weigh the vehicle. Your dealercan also help you with this.

The total vehicle reserve capacityfor the vehicle can be found in thelower right corner of theCertification/Tire label as shownpreviously.

See your dealer for additionaladvice and information about usinga snow plow on the vehicle. Also,see Vehicle Load Limits onpage 9‑15.

Emergency Roof LampProvisions

Vehicles with the RPO VYU snowplow prep package also have anemergency roof lamp provisionpackage, RPO TRW. Wiring for theemergency roof lamp is providedabove the overhead console. SeeAuxiliary Roof-Mounted Lamp onpage 6‑6 for switch location.

Page 340: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (82,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

9-82 Driving and Operating

2 NOTES

Page 341: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-1

Vehicle Care

General InformationGeneral Information . . . . . . . . . . 10-2California Proposition65 Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2

California PerchlorateMaterials Requirements . . . . 10-3

Accessories andModifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3

Vehicle ChecksDoing Your OwnService Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3

Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4Engine CompartmentOverview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5

Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . 10-9Automatic TransmissionFluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10

Engine Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . 10-13Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . 10-18Overheated EngineProtectionOperating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19

Engine Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . 10-20Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-24Four-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25Front Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . 10-27Automatic Transmission ShiftLock Control FunctionCheck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28

Ignition Transmission LockCheck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28

Park Brake and P (Park)Mechanism Check . . . . . . . . 10-28

Wiper BladeReplacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-29

Glass Replacement . . . . . . . . 10-30

Headlamp AimingHeadlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . 10-30

Bulb ReplacementBulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 10-30Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30

Taillamps, Turn Signal,Stoplamps, and Back-UpLamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-31

License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . 10-32Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . 10-32

Electrical SystemElectrical SystemOverload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32

Fuses and CircuitBreakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33

Engine Compartment FuseBlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33

Instrument Panel FuseBlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-37

Wheels and TiresTires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40All-Season Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-41Winter Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42Summer Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42Tire Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . 10-42Tire Designations . . . . . . . . . . . 10-45Tire Terminology andDefinitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-46

Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-49Tire Pressure MonitorSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-50

Page 342: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-2 Vehicle Care

Tire Pressure MonitorOperation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-51

Tire Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-54Tire Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-54When It Is Time for NewTires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-56

Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . 10-56Different Size Tires andWheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-58

Uniform Tire QualityGrading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-59

Wheel Alignment and TireBalance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-60

Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . 10-60Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . 10-62Tire Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-64Secondary Latch System . . . 10-74Full-Size Spare Tire . . . . . . . . 10-76

Jump StartingJump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-77

TowingTowing the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . 10-82Recreational VehicleTowing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-82

Appearance CareExterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-87Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-93

General InformationFor service and parts needs, visityour dealer. You will receivegenuine GM parts and GM-trainedand supported service people.

Genuine GM parts have one ofthese marks:

California Proposition65 WarningMost motor vehicles, including thisone, contain and/or emit chemicalsknown to the State of California to

Page 343: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-3

cause cancer and birth defects orother reproductive harm. Engineexhaust, many parts and systems,many fluids, and some componentwear by-products contain and/oremit these chemicals.

California PerchlorateMaterials RequirementsCertain types of automotiveapplications, such as airbaginitiators, safety belt pretensioners,and lithium batteries contained inRemote Keyless Entry transmitters,may contain perchlorate materials.Special handling may be necessary.For additional information, seewww.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.

Accessories andModificationsAdding non‐dealer accessories ormaking modifications to the vehiclecan affect vehicle performance andsafety, including such things asairbags, braking, stability, ride and

handling, emissions systems,aerodynamics, durability, andelectronic systems like antilockbrakes, traction control, and stabilitycontrol. These accessories ormodifications could even causemalfunction or damage not coveredby the vehicle warranty.

Damage to vehicle componentsresulting from modifications or theinstallation or use of non‐GMcertified parts, including controlmodule or software modifications, isnot covered under the terms of thevehicle warranty and may affectremaining warranty coverage foraffected parts.

GM Accessories are designed tocomplement and function with othersystems on the vehicle. See yourdealer to accessorize the vehicleusing genuine GM Accessoriesinstalled by a dealer technician.

Also, see Adding Equipment to theAirbag-Equipped Vehicle onpage 3‑38.

Vehicle Checks

Doing Your OwnService WorkIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

{ WARNING

It can be dangerous to work onyour vehicle if you do not havethe proper knowledge, servicemanual, tools, or parts. Alwaysfollow owner manual proceduresand consult the service manualfor your vehicle before doing anyservice work.

If doing some of your own servicework, use the proper servicemanual. It tells you much moreabout how to service the vehiclethan this manual can.

Page 344: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-4 Vehicle Care

To order the proper service manual,see Service Publications OrderingInformation on page 13‑16.

This vehicle has an airbag system.Before attempting to do your ownservice work, see Airbag SystemCheck on page 3‑40.

Keep a record with all parts receiptsand list the mileage and the date ofany service work performed. SeeMaintenance Records onpage 11‑15.

Notice: Even small amounts ofcontamination can cause damageto vehicle systems. Do not allowcontaminants to contact thefluids, reservoir caps,or dipsticks.

HoodTo open the hood:

1. Pull the handle with this symbolon it. It is inside the vehicle tothe lower left of the steeringwheel.

2. Then go to the front of thevehicle and locate the secondaryhood release, near the center ofthe grille.

3. Push the secondary hoodrelease to the right.

4. Lift the hood.

Before closing the hood, be sureall the filler caps are on properly.Then bring the hood from fullopen to within 152 mm (6 in)from the closed position, pause,then push the front center of thehood with a swift, firm motion tofully close the hood.

Page 345: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-5

Engine Compartment Overview

5.3L V8 Engine Shown, 6.0L V8 Engine Similar

Page 346: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-6 Vehicle Care

A. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter onpage 10‑13.

B. Coolant Surge Tank andPressure Cap. See CoolingSystem on page 10‑14.

C. Remote Positive (+) Terminal.See Jump Starting onpage 10‑77.

D. Battery on page 10‑24.

E. Remote Negative (−) Terminal(Out of View). See JumpStarting on page 10‑77.

F. Automatic TransmissionDipstick (Out of View). See“Checking the Fluid Level”under Automatic TransmissionFluid on page 10‑10.

G. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See “Whento Add Engine Oil” underEngine Oil on page 10‑6.

H. Engine Oil Dipstick (Out ofView). See “Checking EngineOil” under Engine Oil onpage 10‑6.

I. Engine Cooling Fan (Out ofView). See Cooling System onpage 10‑14.

J. Power Steering Fluid Reservoir.See Power Steering Fluid onpage 10‑20.

K. Brake Master CylinderReservoir. See “Brake Fluid”under Brake Fluid onpage 10‑23.

L. Engine Compartment FuseBlock on page 10‑33.

M. Windshield Washer FluidReservoir. See “Adding WasherFluid” under Washer Fluid onpage 10‑21.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Engine OilTo ensure proper engineperformance and long life, carefulattention must be paid to engine oil.Following these simple, butimportant steps will help protectyour investment:. Always use engine oil approved

to the proper specification and ofthe proper viscosity grade. See“Selecting the Right Engine Oil”in this section.

. Check the engine oil levelregularly and maintain theproper oil level. See “CheckingEngine Oil” and “When to AddEngine Oil” in this section.

. Change the engine oil at theappropriate time. See Engine OilLife System on page 10‑9.

. Always dispose of engine oilproperly. See “What to Do withUsed Oil” in this section.

Page 347: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-7

Checking Engine Oil

It is a good idea to check the engineoil level at each fuel fill. In order toget an accurate reading, the vehiclemust be on level ground. Theengine oil dipstick handle is a loop.See Engine Compartment Overviewon page 10‑5 for the location of theengine oil dipstick.

Obtaining an accurate oil levelreading is essential:

1. If the engine has been runningrecently, turn off the engine andallow several minutes for the oilto drain back into the oil pan.Checking the oil level too soonafter engine shutoff will notprovide an accurate oil levelreading.

{ WARNING

The engine oil dipstick handlemay be hot; it could burn you.Use a towel or glove to touch thedipstick handle.

2. Pull out the dipstick and clean itwith a paper towel or cloth, thenpush it back in all the way.Remove it again, keeping the tipdown, and check the level.

When to Add Engine Oil

If the oil is below the cross-hatchedarea at the tip of the dipstick, add1 L (1 qt) of the recommended oiland then recheck the level. See“Selecting the Right Engine Oil” inthis section for an explanation ofwhat kind of oil to use. For engineoil crankcase capacity, seeCapacities and Specifications onpage 12‑2.

Notice: Do not add too much oil.Oil levels above or below theacceptable operating rangeshown on the dipstick are harmful

to the engine. If you find that youhave an oil level above theoperating range, i.e., the enginehas so much oil that the oil levelgets above the cross-hatchedarea that shows the properoperating range, the engine couldbe damaged. You should drainout the excess oil or limit drivingof the vehicle and seek a serviceprofessional to remove theexcess amount of oil.

See Engine Compartment Overviewon page 10‑5 for the location of theengine oil fill cap.

Add enough oil to put the levelsomewhere in the proper operatingrange. Push the dipstick all the wayback in when through.

Selecting the Right Engine Oil

Selecting the right engine oildepends on both the proper oilspecification and viscosity grade.See Recommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12.

Page 348: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-8 Vehicle Care

Specification

Use and ask for licensed engine oilswith the dexos1® approvedcertification mark. Engine oilsmeeting the requirements for thevehicle should have the dexos1approved certification mark. Thiscertification mark indicates that theoil has been approved to the dexos1specification.

Notice: Failure to use therecommended engine oil orequivalent can result in enginedamage not covered by thevehicle warranty. Check with yourdealer or service provider onwhether the oil is approved to thedexos1 specification.

Viscosity Grade

SAE 5W-30 is the best viscositygrade for the vehicle. Do not useother viscosity grade oils such asSAE 10W-30, 10W-40, or 20W-50.

Cold Temperature Operation: In anarea of extreme cold, where thetemperature falls below −29°C(−20°F), an SAE 0W-30 oil may beused. An oil of this viscosity gradewill provide easier cold starting forthe engine at extremely lowtemperatures. When selecting an oilof the appropriate viscosity grade,always select an oil of the correctspecification. See “Specification”earlier in this section for moreinformation.

Engine Oil Additives/EngineOil Flushes

Do not add anything to the oil. Therecommended oils with the dexosspecification and displaying thedexos certification mark are all thatis needed for good performance andengine protection.

Engine oil system flushes are notrecommended and could causeengine damage not covered by thevehicle warranty.

What to Do with Used Oil

Used engine oil contains certainelements that can be unhealthy foryour skin and could even causecancer. Do not let used oil stay onyour skin for very long. Clean yourskin and nails with soap and water,or a good hand cleaner. Wash orproperly dispose of clothing or ragscontaining used engine oil. See themanufacturer's warnings about theuse and disposal of oil products.

Used oil can be a threat to theenvironment. If you change yourown oil, be sure to drain all the oilfrom the filter before disposal. Neverdispose of oil by putting it in thetrash or pouring it on the ground,into sewers, or into streams orbodies of water. Recycle it by takingit to a place that collects used oil.

Page 349: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-9

Engine Oil Life System

When to Change Engine Oil

This vehicle has a computer systemthat indicates when to change theengine oil and filter. This is basedon a combination of factors whichinclude engine revolutions, enginetemperature, and miles driven.Based on driving conditions, themileage at which an oil change isindicated can vary considerably. Forthe oil life system to work properly,the system must be reset every timethe oil is changed.

On some vehicles, when the systemhas calculated that oil life has beendiminished, a CHANGE ENGINEOIL SOON message comes on toindicate that an oil change isnecessary. See Engine OilMessages on page 5‑37. Changethe oil as soon as possible withinthe next 1 000 km (600mi). It ispossible that, if driving under thebest conditions, the oil life systemmight indicate that an oil change isnot necessary for up to a year. The

engine oil and filter must bechanged at least once a year and,at this time, the system must bereset. For vehicles without theCHANGE ENGINE OIL SOONmessage, an oil change is neededwhen the OIL LIFEREMAINING percentage is near0%. Your dealer has trained servicepeople who will perform this workand reset the system. It is alsoimportant to check the oil regularlyover the course of an oil draininterval and keep it at the properlevel.

If the system is ever resetaccidentally, the oil must bechanged at 5 000 km (3,000 mi)since the last oil change.Remember to reset the oil lifesystem whenever the oil is changed.

How to Reset the Engine OilLife System

Reset the system whenever theengine oil is changed so that thesystem can calculate the nextengine oil change. Always reset theengine oil life to 100% after every oilchange. It will not reset itself. Toreset the system on most vehicles:

1. Display the OIL LIFEREMAINING on the DIC. If thevehicle does not have DICbuttons, the vehicle must be inP (Park) to access this display.See Driver Information Center(DIC) on page 5‑26.

2. Press and hold the SET/RESETbutton on the DIC, or the tripodometer reset stem if thevehicle does not have DICbuttons, for more thanfive seconds. The oil life willchange to 100%.

Page 350: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-10 Vehicle Care

On all vehicles, the Engine Oil LifeSystem can be reset as follows:

1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN withthe engine off.

2. Fully press the accelerator pedalslowly three times withinfive seconds.

3. Display the OIL LIFEREMAINING on the DIC. If thedisplay shows 100%, the systemis reset. See Driver InformationCenter (DIC) on page 5‑26.

If the vehicle has a CHANGEENGINE OIL SOON message and itcomes back on when the vehicle isstarted and/or the OIL LIFEREMAINING is near 0%, the engineoil life system has not been reset.Repeat the procedure.

Automatic TransmissionFluid

When to Check and ChangeAutomatic Transmission Fluid

It is usually not necessary to checkthe transmission fluid level. The onlyreason for fluid loss is atransmission leak or overheatedtransmission. If a small leak issuspected, then use the followingchecking procedures to check thefluid level. However, if there is alarge leak, then it may be necessaryto have the vehicle towed to adealer and have it repaired beforedriving the vehicle further.

Notice: Use of the incorrectautomatic transmission fluid maydamage the vehicle, and thedamages may not be covered bythe vehicle warranty. Always usethe automatic transmission fluidlisted in Recommended Fluidsand Lubricants on page 11‑12.

Change the fluid and filter at thescheduled maintenance intervalslisted in Maintenance Schedule onpage 11‑2. Be sure to use thetransmission fluid listed inRecommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12.

How to Check AutomaticTransmission Fluid

Notice: Too much or too littlefluid can damage thetransmission. Too much canmean that some of the fluid couldcome out and fall on hot engineparts or exhaust system parts,starting a fire. Too little fluidcould cause the transmission tooverheat. Be sure to get anaccurate reading if checking thetransmission fluid.

Before checking the fluid level,prepare the vehicle as follows:

1. Start the engine and park thevehicle on a level surface. Keepthe engine running.

Page 351: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-11

2. Apply the parking brake andplace the shift lever in P (Park).

3. With your foot on the brakepedal, move the shift leverthrough each gear range,pausing for about three secondsin each range. Then, move theshift lever back to P (Park).

4. Allow the engine to idle(500 – 800 rpm) for at least1 minute. Slowly release thebrake pedal.

5. Keep the engine running andpress the Trip/Fuel button or tripodometer reset stem untilTRANS TEMP (TransmissionTemperature) displays on theDriver Information Center (DIC).

6. Using the TRANS TEMPreading, determine and performthe appropriate checkprocedure. If the TRANS TEMPreading is not within the requiredtemperature ranges, allow thevehicle to cool, or operate the

vehicle until the appropriatetransmission fluid temperature isreached.

Cold Check Procedure

Use this procedure only as areference to determine if thetransmission has enough fluid to beoperated safely until a hot checkprocedure can be made. The hotcheck procedure is the mostaccurate method to check the fluidlevel. Perform the hot checkprocedure at the first opportunity.Use this cold check procedure tocheck fluid level when thetransmission temperature isbetween 27°C and 32°C (80°Fand 90°F).

1. Locate the transmission dipstickat the rear of the enginecompartment, on the passengerside of the vehicle.

See Engine CompartmentOverview on page 10‑5 for moreinformation.

2. Flip the handle up, then pull outthe dipstick and wipe it with aclean rag or paper towel.

3. Install the dipstick by pushing itback in all the way; waitthree seconds, and then pull itback out again.

4. Check both sides of the dipstickand read the lower level. Repeatthe check procedure to verify thereading.

Page 352: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-12 Vehicle Care

5. If the fluid level is below theCOLD check band, add onlyenough fluid as necessary tobring the level into the COLDband. It does not take muchfluid, generally less than 0.5 L(1 pt). Do not overfill.

6. Perform a hot check at the firstopportunity after thetransmission reaches a normaloperating temperature between71°C to 93°C (160°F to 200°F).

7. If the fluid level is in theacceptable range, push thedipstick back in all the way, thenflip the handle down to lock thedipstick in place.

Hot Check Procedure

Use this procedure to check thetransmission fluid level when thetransmission fluid temperature isbetween 71°C and 93°C (160°Fand 200°F).

The hot check is the most accuratemethod to check the fluid level. Thehot check should be performed at

the first opportunity in order to verifythe cold check. The fluid level risesas fluid temperature increases, so itis important to ensure thetransmission temperature is withinrange.

1. Locate the transmission dipstickat the rear of the enginecompartment, on the passengerside of the vehicle.

See Engine CompartmentOverview on page 10‑5 for moreinformation.

2. Flip the handle up, then pull outthe dipstick and wipe it with aclean rag or paper towel.

3. Install the dipstick by pushing itback in all the way; waitthree seconds, and then pull itback out again.

4. Check both sides of the dipstickand read the lower level. Repeatthe check procedure to verify thereading.

5. Safe operating level is within theHOT cross hatch band on thedipstick. If the fluid level is notwithin the HOT band, and thetransmission temperature isbetween 71°C and 93°C (160°Fand 200°F), add or drain fluid asnecessary to bring the level intothe HOT band. If the fluid level islow, add only enough fluid tobring the level into the HOTband. It does not take muchfluid, generally less than 0.5 L(1 pt). Do not overfill.

Page 353: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-13

6. If the fluid level is in theacceptable range, push thedipstick back in all the way, thenflip the handle down to lock thedipstick in place.

Consistency of Readings

Always check the fluid level at leasttwice using the procedure describedpreviously. Consistency (repeatablereadings) is important to maintainingproper fluid level. If readings are stillinconsistent, contact the dealer.

Engine Air Cleaner/FilterSee Engine Compartment Overviewon page 10‑5 for the location of theengine air cleaner/filter.

Inspect the air cleaner/filter at thescheduled maintenance intervalsand replace it at the first oil changeafter each 80 000 km (50,000 mi)interval. See Maintenance Scheduleon page 11‑2 for more information.If driving on dusty/dirty conditions,inspect the filter at each engine oilchange.

How to Inspect the Engine AirCleaner/Filter

To inspect the air cleaner/filter,remove the engine air cleaner/filterfrom the vehicle by followingSteps 1 through 6. When the engineair cleaner/filter is removed, lightlyshake it to release loose dust anddirt. If the engine air cleaner/filterremains covered with dirt, a newfilter is required. Never usecompressed air to clean the filter.

Replacing the Engine Air Cleaner/Filter

1. Locate the air cleaner/filterassembly. See EngineCompartment Overview onpage 10‑5.

2. Loosen the four screws on thecover of the housing and lift upthe cover.

Page 354: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-14 Vehicle Care

3. Remove the engine air cleaner/filter from the housing. Careshould be taken to dislodge aslittle dirt as possible.

4. Clean the engine air cleaner/filter sealing surfaces and thehousing.

5. Inspect or replace the engine aircleaner/filter.

6. Reinstall the cover and tightenthe screws.

{ WARNING

Operating the engine with the aircleaner/filter off can cause you orothers to be burned. The aircleaner not only cleans the air; ithelps to stop flames if the enginebackfires. Use caution whenworking on the engine and do notdrive with the air cleaner/filter off.

Cooling SystemIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

The cooling system allows theengine to maintain the correctworking temperature.

5.3L V8 Engine Shown, 6.0LV8 Engine Similar

A. Coolant Surge Tank

B. Coolant Surge TankPressure Cap

C. Engine Cooling Fan(s) (Outof View)

{ WARNING

An electric engine cooling fanunder the hood can start up evenwhen the engine is not runningand can cause injury. Keephands, clothing, and tools awayfrom any underhood electric fan.

{ WARNING

Heater and radiator hoses, andother engine parts, can be veryhot. Do not touch them. If you do,you can be burned.

Do not run the engine if there is aleak. If you run the engine, itcould lose all coolant. That couldcause an engine fire, and youcould be burned. Get any leakfixed before you drive the vehicle.

Page 355: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (15,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-15

Notice: Using coolant other thanDEX-COOL® can cause prematureengine, heater core, or radiatorcorrosion. In addition, the enginecoolant could require changingsooner, at 50 000 km (30,000mi)or 24months, whichever occursfirst. Any repairs would not becovered by the vehicle warranty.Always use DEX-COOL(silicate-free) coolant in thevehicle.

Engine CoolantThe cooling system in the vehicle isfilled with DEX-COOL enginecoolant. This coolant is designed toremain in the vehicle for 5 years or240 000 km (150,000mi), whicheveroccurs first.

The following explains the coolingsystem and how to check and addcoolant when it is low. If there is aproblem with engine overheating,see Engine Overheating onpage 10‑18.

What to Use

{ WARNING

Adding only plain water or someother liquid to the cooling systemcan be dangerous. Plain waterand other liquids, can boil beforethe proper coolant mixture will.The coolant warning system is setfor the proper coolant mixture.With plain water or the wrongmixture, the engine could get toohot but you would not get theoverheat warning. The enginecould catch fire and you or otherscould be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkablewater and DEX-COOL coolant.

Use a 50/50 mixture of clean,drinkable water and DEX-COOLcoolant. If using this mixture,nothing else needs to be added.This mixture:. Gives freezing protection down

to −37°C (−34°F), outsidetemperature.

. Gives boiling protection up to129°C (265°F), enginetemperature.

. Protects against rust andcorrosion.

. Will not damage aluminum parts.

. Helps keep the proper enginetemperature.

Notice: If improper coolantmixture, inhibitors, or additivesare used in the vehicle coolingsystem, the engine couldoverheat and be damaged. Toomuch water in the mixture canfreeze and crack engine coolingparts. The repairs would not becovered by the warranty. Use onlythe proper mixture of engine

Page 356: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (16,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-16 Vehicle Care

coolant for the cooling system.See Recommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12.

Never dispose of engine coolant byputting it in the trash, pouring it onthe ground, or into sewers, streams,or bodies of water. Have the coolantchanged by an authorized servicecenter, familiar with legalrequirements regarding usedcoolant disposal. This will helpprotect the environment and yourhealth.

Checking Coolant

The vehicle must be on a levelsurface when checking the coolantlevel.

Check to see if coolant is visible inthe coolant surge tank. If the coolantinside the coolant surge tank isboiling, do not do anything else untilit cools down. If coolant is visiblebut the coolant level is not at orabove the FULL COLD mark, add a50/50 mixture of clean, drinkablewater and DEX-COOL coolant at the

coolant surge tank, but be sure thecooling system is cool before thisis done.

The coolant surge tank is located inthe engine compartment on thepassenger side of the vehicle. SeeEngine Compartment Overview onpage 10‑5 for more information onlocation.

The coolant level should be at orabove the FULL COLD mark. If it isnot, the vehicle may have a leak inthe cooling system.

How to Add Coolant to theSurge Tank

{ WARNING

You can be burned if you spillcoolant on hot engine parts.Coolant contains ethylene glycoland it will burn if the engine partsare hot enough. Do not spillcoolant on a hot engine.

Notice: This vehicle has aspecific coolant fill procedure.Failure to follow this procedurecould cause the engine tooverheat and be severelydamaged.

{ WARNING

Steam and scalding liquids from ahot cooling system can blow outand burn you badly. Never turnthe cap when the cooling system,including the surge tank pressure

(Continued)

Page 357: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (17,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-17

WARNING (Continued)

cap, is hot. Wait for the coolingsystem and surge tank pressurecap to cool.

If no coolant is visible in the surgetank, add coolant as follows:

1. Remove the coolant surge tankpressure cap when the coolingsystem, including the coolantsurge tank pressure cap andupper radiator hose, is nolonger hot.

Turn the pressure cap slowlycounterclockwise about one fullturn. If a hiss is heard, wait forthat to stop. A hiss means thereis still some pressure left.

2. Keep turning the pressure capslowly and remove it.

3. Fill the coolant surge tank withthe proper mixture to the FULLCOLD mark.

4. With the coolant surge tankpressure cap off, start theengine and let it run until theupper radiator hose can be feltgetting hot. Watch out for theengine cooling fan.

By this time, the coolant levelinside the coolant surge tankmay be lower. If the level islower, add more of the propermixture to the coolant surge tankuntil the level reaches the FULLCOLD mark.

5. Replace the pressure cap tightly.

Page 358: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (18,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-18 Vehicle Care

6. Verify coolant level after engineis shut off and the coolant iscold. If necessary, repeat coolantfill procedure Steps 1–6.

Notice: If the pressure cap is nottightly installed, coolant loss andpossible engine damage mayoccur. Be sure the cap is properlyand tightly secured.

Engine OverheatingThe vehicle has several indicatorsto warn of engine overheating.

There is a coolant temperaturegauge on your vehicle's instrumentpanel. See Engine CoolantTemperature Gauge on page 5‑14.

In addition, ENGINE OVERHEATEDSTOP ENGINE, ENGINEOVERHEATED IDLE ENGINE, andan ENGINE POWER IS REDUCEDmessage comes on in the DriverInformation Center (DIC) on theinstrument panel. See EngineCooling System Messages onpage 5‑36 and Engine PowerMessages on page 5‑38.

If the decision is made not to lift thehood when this warning appears,but instead get service help rightaway. See Roadside AssistanceProgram (Mexico) on page 13‑7 orRoadside Assistance Program (U.S.and Canada) on page 13‑11.

If the decision is made to lift thehood, make sure the vehicle isparked on a level surface.

Then check to see if the enginecooling fans are running. If theengine is overheating, both fansshould be running. If they are not,do not continue to run the engineand have the vehicle serviced.

Notice: Running the enginewithout coolant may causedamage or a fire. Vehicle damagewould not be covered by thewarranty. See Overheated EngineProtection Operating Mode onpage 10‑19 for information ondriving to a safe place in anemergency.

If Steam Is Coming from theEngine Compartment

{ WARNING

Steam from an overheated enginecan burn you badly, even if youjust open the hood. Stay awayfrom the engine if you see or hearsteam coming from it. Turn it offand get everyone away from thevehicle until it cools down. Waituntil there is no sign of steam orcoolant before you openthe hood.

If you keep driving when thevehicles engine is overheated,the liquids in it can catch fire. Youor others could be badly burned.Stop the engine if it overheats,and get out of the vehicle until theengine is cool.

(Continued)

Page 359: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (19,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-19

WARNING (Continued)

See Overheated EngineProtection Operating Mode onpage 10‑19 for information ondriving to a safe place in anemergency.

If No Steam Is Coming fromthe Engine Compartment

The ENGINE OVERHEATED STOPENGINE or the ENGINEOVERHEATED IDLE ENGINEmessage, along with a low coolantcondition, can indicate a seriousproblem.

If an engine overheat warning isdisplayed but no steam can be seenor heard, the problem may not betoo serious. Sometimes the enginecan get a little too hot when thevehicle:. Climbs a long hill on a hot day.. Stops after high-speed driving.. Idles for long periods in traffic.

. Tows a trailer. See TrailerTowing on page 9‑64.

If the overheat warning is displayedwith no sign of steam:

1. Turn the air conditioning off.

2. Turn the heater on to the highesttemperature and to the highestfan speed. Open the windows asnecessary.

3. In heavy traffic, let the engineidle in N (Neutral) while stopped.If it is safe to do so, pull off theroad, shift to P (Park) orN (Neutral) and let theengine idle.

If the temperature overheat gauge isno longer in the overheat zone or anoverheat warning no longerdisplays, the vehicle can be driven.Continue to drive the vehicle slowlyfor about 10 minutes. Keep a safevehicle distance from the vehicle infront. If the warning does not comeback on, continue to drive normally.

If the warning continues, pull over,stop, and park the vehicleright away.

If there is no sign of steam, idle theengine for three minutes whileparked. If the warning is stilldisplayed, turn off the engine until itcools down. Also, see “OverheatedEngine Protection Operating Mode”later in this section.

Overheated EngineProtectionOperating ModeIf an overheated engine conditionexists and the ENGINE POWER ISREDUCED message is displayed,an overheat protection mode whichalternates firing groups of cylindershelps prevent engine damage. Inthis mode, a loss in power andengine performance will be noticed.This operating mode allows thevehicle to be driven to a safe placein an emergency. Driving extended

Page 360: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (20,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-20 Vehicle Care

distances and/or towing a trailer inthe overheat protection modeshould be avoided.

Notice: After driving in theoverheated engine protectionoperating mode, to avoid enginedamage, allow the engine to coolbefore attempting any repair. Theengine oil will be severelydegraded. Repair the cause ofcoolant loss, change the oil andreset the oil life system. SeeEngine Oil on page 10‑6.

Engine FanIf the vehicle has a clutched enginecooling fan, when the clutch isengaged, the fan spins faster toprovide more air to cool the engine.In most everyday driving conditions,the fan is spinning slower and theclutch is not fully engaged. Thisimproves fuel economy and reducesfan noise. Under heavy vehicleloading, trailer towing, and/or highoutside temperatures, the fan speedincreases as the clutch more fully

engages, so an increase in fannoise may be heard. This is normaland should not be mistaken as thetransmission slipping or makingextra shifts. It is merely the coolingsystem functioning properly. The fanwill slow down when additionalcooling is not required and theclutch disengages.

This fan noise may also be heardwhen starting the engine. It will goaway as the fan clutch partiallydisengages.

If the vehicle has electric coolingfans, the fans may be heardspinning at low speed during mosteveryday driving. The fans may turnoff if no cooling is required. Underheavy vehicle loading, trailer towing,high outside temperatures,or operation of the air conditioningsystem, the fans may change tohigh speed and an increase in fannoise may be heard. This is normaland indicates that the coolingsystem is functioning properly. The

fans will change to low speed whenadditional cooling is no longerrequired.

Power Steering FluidIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

See Engine Compartment Overviewon page 10‑5 for reservoir location.

When to Check Power SteeringFluid

It is not necessary to regularlycheck power steering fluid unlessthere is a leak suspected in thesystem or an unusual noise isheard. A fluid loss in this systemcould indicate a problem. Have thesystem inspected and repaired.

Page 361: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (21,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-21

How to Check Power SteeringFluid

To check the power steering fluid:

1. Turn the key off and let theengine compartment cool down.

2. Wipe the cap and the top of thereservoir clean.

3. Unscrew the cap and wipe thedipstick with a clean rag.

4. Replace the cap and completelytighten it.

5. Remove the cap again and lookat the fluid level on the dipstick.

The level should be at the FULLCOLD mark. If necessary, add onlyenough fluid to bring the level up tothe mark.

What to Use

To determine what kind of fluid touse, see Recommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12. Alwaysuse the proper fluid.

Notice: Use of the incorrect fluidmay damage the vehicle and thedamages may not be covered bythe vehicle's warranty. Alwaysuse the correct fluid listed inRecommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12.

Washer Fluid

What to Use

When windshield washer fluid needsto be added, be sure to read themanufacturer's instructions beforeuse. Use a fluid that has sufficientprotection against freezing in anarea where the temperature may fallbelow freezing.

Adding Washer Fluid

The vehicle has a low washer fluidmessage on the DIC that comes onwhen the washer fluid is low. Themessage is displayed for15 seconds at the start of eachignition cycle. When the WASHERFLUID LOW ADD FLUID message

displays, washer fluid will need tobe added to the windshield washerfluid reservoir.

Open the cap with the washersymbol on it. Add washer fluid untilthe tank is full. See EngineCompartment Overview onpage 10‑5 for reservoir location.

Notice. When using concentratedwasher fluid, follow themanufacturer instructions foradding water.

. Do not mix water withready-to-use washer fluid.Water can cause the solutionto freeze and damage thewasher fluid tank and otherparts of the washer system.

Page 362: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (22,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-22 Vehicle Care

. Fill the washer fluid tank onlythree-quarters full when it isvery cold. This allows forfluid expansion if freezingoccurs, which could damagethe tank if it iscompletely full.

. Do not use engine coolant(antifreeze) in the windshieldwasher. It can damage thewindshield washer systemand paint.

BrakesThis vehicle has disc brakes. Discbrake pads have built-in wearindicators that make a high-pitchedwarning sound when the brake padsare worn and new pads are needed.The sound can come and go or beheard all the time the vehicle ismoving, except when applying thebrake pedal firmly.

{ WARNING

The brake wear warning soundmeans that soon the brakes willnot work well. That could lead toa crash. When the brake wearwarning sound is heard, have thevehicle serviced.

Notice: Continuing to drive withworn-out brake pads could resultin costly brake repair.

Some driving conditions or climatescan cause a brake squeal when thebrakes are first applied or lightlyapplied. This does not meansomething is wrong with the brakes.

Properly torqued wheel nuts arenecessary to help prevent brakepulsation. When tires are rotated,inspect brake pads for wear andevenly tighten wheel nuts in theproper sequence to torquespecifications in Capacities andSpecifications on page 12‑2.

Brake linings should always bereplaced as complete axle sets.

Brake Pedal Travel

See your dealer if the brake pedaldoes not return to normal height,or if there is a rapid increase inpedal travel. This could be a signthat brake service might berequired.

Brake Adjustment

Every time the brakes are applied,with or without the vehicle moving,the brakes adjust for wear.

Replacing Brake System Parts

The braking system on a vehicle iscomplex. Its many parts have to beof top quality and work well togetherif the vehicle is to have really goodbraking. The vehicle was designedand tested with top-quality brakeparts. When parts of the brakingsystem are replaced, be sure to getnew, approved replacement parts.If this is not done, the brakes mightnot work properly. For example,

Page 363: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (23,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-23

installing disc brake pads that arewrong for the vehicle, can changethe balance between the front andrear brakes — for the worse. Thebraking performance expected canchange in many other ways if thewrong replacement brake parts areinstalled.

Brake Fluid

The brake master cylinder reservoiris filled with DOT 3 brake fluid. SeeEngine Compartment Overview onpage 10‑5 for the location of thereservoir.

There are only two reasons why thebrake fluid level in the reservoirmight go down:. The brake fluid level goes down

because of normal brake liningwear. When new linings areinstalled, the fluid level goesback up.

. A fluid leak in the brakehydraulic system can also causea low fluid level. Have the brakehydraulic system fixed, since aleak means that sooner or laterthe brakes will not work well.

Do not top off the brake fluid.Adding fluid does not correct a leak.If fluid is added when the linings areworn, there will be too much fluidwhen new brake linings areinstalled. Add or remove brake fluid,as necessary, only when work isdone on the brake hydraulic system.

{ WARNING

If too much brake fluid is added, itcan spill on the engine and burn,if the engine is hot enough. Youor others could be burned, andthe vehicle could be damaged.Add brake fluid only when work isdone on the brake hydraulicsystem. See “Checking BrakeFluid” in this section.

When the brake fluid falls to a lowlevel, the brake warning light comeson. See Brake System WarningLight on page 5‑21.

Refer to the Maintenance Scheduleto determine when to check thebrake fluid. See MaintenanceSchedule on page 11‑2.

Checking Brake Fluid

Check brake fluid by looking at thebrake fluid reservoir. See EngineCompartment Overview onpage 10‑5.

Page 364: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (24,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-24 Vehicle Care

The fluid level should be aboveMIN. If it is not, have the brakehydraulic system checked to see ifthere is a leak.

After work is done on the brakehydraulic system, make sure thelevel is above the MIN but not overthe MAX mark.

What to Add

Use only new DOT 3 brake fluidfrom a sealed container. SeeRecommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12.

Always clean the brake fluidreservoir cap and the area aroundthe cap before removing it. Thishelps keep dirt from entering thereservoir.

{ WARNING

With the wrong kind of fluid in thebrake hydraulic system, thebrakes might not work well. Thiscould cause a crash. Always usethe proper brake fluid.

Notice. Using the wrong fluid canbadly damage brakehydraulic system parts. Forexample, just a few drops ofmineral-based oil, such asengine oil, in the brakehydraulic system candamage brake hydraulicsystem parts so badly thatthey will have to be replaced.Do not let someone put inthe wrong kind of fluid.

. If brake fluid is spilled on thevehicle's painted surfaces,the paint finish can bedamaged. Be careful not tospill brake fluid on thevehicle. If you do, wash it offimmediately.

BatteryIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Refer to the replacement number onthe original battery label when anew battery is needed. See EngineCompartment Overview onpage 10‑5 for battery location.

{ WARNING

Battery posts, terminals, andrelated accessories contain leadand lead compounds, chemicalsknown to the State of California tocause cancer and reproductiveharm. Wash hands after handling.

Page 365: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (25,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-25

Vehicle Storage

{ WARNING

Batteries have acid that can burnyou and gas that can explode.You can be badly hurt if you arenot careful. See Jump Starting onpage 10‑77 for tips on workingaround a battery withoutgetting hurt.

Infrequent Usage: Remove theblack, negative (−) cable from thebattery to keep the battery fromrunning down.

Extended Storage: Remove theblack, negative (−) cable from thebattery or use a battery tricklecharger.

Four-Wheel Drive

Transfer Case

When to Check Lubricant

Refer to Maintenance Schedule onpage 11‑2 to determine when tocheck the lubricant.

How to Check Lubricant

Active Transfer Case

A. Fill Plug

B. Drain Plug

To get an accurate reading, thevehicle should be on a levelsurface.

If the level is below the bottom ofthe fill plug (A) hole, some lubricantwill need to be added. Add enoughlubricant to raise the level to thebottom of the fill plug (A) hole. Usecare not to overtighten the plug.

When to Change Lubricant

Refer to Maintenance Schedule onpage 11‑2 to determine how often tochange the lubricant.

What to Use

Refer to Recommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12 todetermine what kind of lubricantto use.

Front AxleWhen to Check and ChangeLubricant

It is not necessary to regularlycheck front axle fluid unless a leakis suspected, or an unusual noise is

Page 366: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (26,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-26 Vehicle Care

heard. A fluid loss could indicate aproblem. Have it inspected andrepaired.

How to Check Lubricant

To get an accurate reading, thevehicle should be on a levelsurface.

1500 Series

A. Fill Plug

B. Drain Plug

All Except 1500 Series

A. Fill Plug

B. Drain Plug. When the differential is cold, add

enough lubricant to raise thelevel from 0mm (0 in) to 3.2 mm(1/8 in) below the fillplug (A) hole.

. When the differential is atoperating temperature (warm),add enough lubricant to raise thelevel to the bottom of the fillplug (A) hole.

What to Use

Refer to Recommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12 todetermine what kind of lubricantto use.

Rear Axle

When to Check Lubricant

It is not necessary to regularlycheck rear axle fluid unless there isa leak suspected, or an unusualnoise is heard. A fluid loss couldindicate a problem. Have itinspected and repaired.

All axle assemblies are filled byvolume of fluid during production.They are not filled to reach a certainlevel. When checking the fluid levelon any axle, variations in thereadings can be caused by factoryfill differences between the minimumand the maximum fluid volume.Also, if a vehicle has just beendriven before checking the fluidlevel, it may appear lower thannormal because fluid has traveled

Page 367: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (27,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-27

out along the axle tubes and hasnot drained back to the sump area.Therefore, a reading takenfive minutes after the vehicle hasbeen driven will appear to have alower fluid level than a vehicle thathas been stationary for an hour ortwo. Remember that the rear axleassembly must be supported to geta true reading.

How to Check Lubricant

1500 Series

2500 Series

To get an accurate reading, thevehicle should be on a levelsurface.. For the 1500 series, the proper

level is from 1.0 mm to 19.0 mm(0.04 in to 0.75 in) below thebottom of the fill plug hole,located on the rear axle. Addonly enough fluid to reach theproper level.

. For the 2500 series, the properlevel is from 0mm to 13 mm (0 into 1/2 in) below the bottom of the

fill plug hole, located at the frontof the axle. Add only enoughfluid to reach the proper level.

Starter Switch Check

{ WARNING

When you are doing thisinspection, the vehicle couldmove suddenly. If the vehiclemoves, you or others could beinjured.

1. Before starting this check, besure there is enough roomaround the vehicle.

2. Firmly apply both the parkingbrake and the regular brake.See Parking Brake onpage 9‑41.

Do not use the acceleratorpedal, and be ready to turn offthe engine immediately if itstarts.

Page 368: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (28,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-28 Vehicle Care

3. Try to start the engine in eachgear. The vehicle should startonly in P (Park) or N (Neutral).If the vehicle starts in any otherposition, contact your dealer forservice.

Automatic TransmissionShift Lock ControlFunction Check

{ WARNING

When you are doing thisinspection, the vehicle couldmove suddenly. If the vehiclemoves, you or others could beinjured.

1. Before starting this check, besure there is enough roomaround the vehicle. It should beparked on a level surface.

2. Firmly apply the parking brake.See Parking Brake onpage 9‑41.

Be ready to apply the regularbrake immediately if the vehiclebegins to move.

3. With the engine off, turn theignition on, but do not start theengine. Without applying theregular brake, try to move theshift lever out of P (Park) withnormal effort. If the shift levermoves out of P (Park), contactyour dealer for service.

Ignition TransmissionLock CheckWhile parked, and with the parkingbrake set, try to turn the ignition toLOCK/OFF in each shift leverposition.. The ignition should turn to

LOCK/OFF only when the shiftlever is in P (Park).

. The ignition key should comeout only in LOCK/OFF.

Contact your dealer if service isrequired.

Park Brake and P (Park)Mechanism Check

{ WARNING

When you are doing this check,the vehicle could begin to move.You or others could be injuredand property could be damaged.Make sure there is room in frontof the vehicle in case it begins toroll. Be ready to apply the regularbrake at once should the vehiclebegin to move.

Page 369: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (29,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-29

Park on a fairly steep hill, with thevehicle facing downhill. Keepingyour foot on the regular brake, setthe parking brake.. To check the parking brake's

holding ability: With the enginerunning and the transmission inN (Neutral), slowly remove footpressure from the regular brakepedal. Do this until the vehicle isheld by the parking brake only.

. To check the P (Park)mechanism's holding ability:With the engine running, shift toP (Park). Then release theparking brake followed by theregular brake.

Contact your dealer if service isrequired.

Wiper Blade ReplacementWindshield wiper blades should beinspected for wear or cracking. SeeMaintenance Schedule onpage 11‑2.

Replacement blades come indifferent types and are removed indifferent ways.

Front Wiper BladeReplacement

1. Pull the windshield wiper armconnector away from thewindshield.

2. Squeeze the grooved areas oneach side of the blade, and turnthe blade assembly away fromthe arm connector.

3. Install the new blade onto thearm connector and make surethe grooved areas are fully set inthe locked position.

For the proper type and size, seeMaintenance Replacement Parts onpage 11‑14.

Rear Wiper Blade Replacement

1. Lift the wiper blade assembly upand out of the park rest position.

2. Pull the wiper blade assemblyaway from the backglass. Thebackglass wiper blade will notlock in a vertical position, socare should be used whenpulling it away from the vehicle.

Page 370: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (30,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-30 Vehicle Care

3. Turn the wiper blade assembly,and pull it off of the wiper arm.Hold the wiper arm in positionand push the blade away fromthe wiper arm.

4. Replace the wiper blade.

5. Return the wiper blade assemblyto the park rest position.

Glass ReplacementIf the windshield or front side glassmust be replaced, see your dealerto determine the correctreplacement glass.

Headlamp AimingHeadlamp aim has been preset andshould need no further adjustment.

If the vehicle is damaged in a crash,the headlamp aim may be affected.If adjustment to the headlamps isnecessary, see your dealer.

Bulb ReplacementFor the proper type of replacementbulbs, see Replacement Bulbs onpage 10‑32.

For any bulb‐changing procedurenot listed in this section, contactyour dealer.

Halogen Bulbs

{ WARNING

Halogen bulbs have pressurizedgas inside and can burst if youdrop or scratch the bulb. You orothers could be injured. Be sureto read and follow the instructionson the bulb package.

Page 371: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (31,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-31

Taillamps, Turn Signal,Stoplamps, and Back-UpLampsIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for the bulbchanging procedure.

A. Stoplamp/Taillamp

B. Back-up Lamp

C. Taillamp/Turn Signal Lamp

D. Side Marker Lamp

To replace one of these bulbs:

1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgateon page 2‑9.

2. Remove the two screws from thetaillamp assembly.

3. Pull the taillamp assemblyrearward disengaging the twoouter pins on the taillampassembly from the vehicle.

4. Turn the bulb socketcounterclockwise to remove itfrom the taillamp assembly.

5. Pull the old bulb straight outfrom the bulb socket.

6. Press a new bulb into the bulbsocket and install the socket intothe taillamp assembly by turningit clockwise.

7. Reinstall the taillamp assembly.When reinstalling, make sure toline up the pins on the taillampassembly with the vehicle. If thisis not done, the taillampassembly will not be able to beinstalled correctly.

Page 372: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (32,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-32 Vehicle Care

License Plate Lamp

1. Remove the two screws holdingeach of the license plate lampsto the molding that is part of theliftgate.

2. Twist and pull the license platelamp assembly forward throughthe molding opening.

3. Remove the bulb socket fromthe lamp assembly by turning itcounterclockwise.

4. Pull the bulb straight out of thesocket and install the new bulb.

5. Reverse Steps 1–3 to reinstallthe license plate lamp.

Replacement BulbsIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Exterior LampBulb

Number

Back-up Lamp 7441

License Plate Lamp W5WLL

Rear Turn SignalLamp, Taillamp, andStoplamp

3057KX RD

Side Marker Lamp 194

For replacement bulbs not listedhere, contact your dealer.

Electrical System

Electrical SystemOverloadThe vehicle has fuses and circuitbreakers to protect against anelectrical system overload.

When the current electrical load istoo heavy, the circuit breaker opensand closes, protecting the circuituntil the current load returns tonormal or the problem is fixed. Thisgreatly reduces the chance of circuitoverload and fire caused byelectrical problems.

Fuses and circuit breakers protectpower devices in the vehicle.

Replace a bad fuse with a new oneof the identical size and rating.

If there is a problem on the road anda fuse needs to be replaced, thesame amperage fuse can beborrowed. Choose some feature ofthe vehicle that is not needed to useand replace it as soon as possible.

Page 373: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (33,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-33

Headlamp Wiring

An electrical overload may causethe lamps to go on and off, or insome cases to remain off. Have theheadlamp wiring checked right awayif the lamps go on and off orremain off.

Windshield Wipers

If the wiper motor overheats due toheavy snow or ice, the windshieldwipers will stop until the motor coolsand will then restart.

Although the circuit is protectedfrom electrical overload, overloaddue to heavy snow or ice maycause wiper linkage damage.Always clear ice and heavy snowfrom the windshield before using thewindshield wipers.

If the overload is caused by anelectrical problem and not snow orice, be sure to get it fixed.

Fuses and CircuitBreakersIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

The wiring circuits in the vehicle areprotected from short circuits by acombination of fuses, circuitbreakers and fusible thermal links.This greatly reduces the chance offires caused by electrical problems.

Look at the silver-colored bandinside the fuse. If the band is brokenor melted, replace the fuse. Be sureyou replace a bad fuse with a newone of the identical size and rating.

If you ever have a problem on theroad and don't have a spare fuse,you can borrow one that has thesame amperage. Just pick somefeature of your vehicle that you canget along without– like the radio oraccessory power outlet– and use itsfuse, if it is the correct amperage.Replace it as soon as you can.

Engine CompartmentFuse Block

The Engine Compartment FuseBlock is located in the enginecompartment, on the driver side ofthe vehicle. Lift the cover for accessto the fuse/relay block.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Notice: Spilling liquid on anyelectrical component on thevehicle may damage it. Alwayskeep the covers on any electricalcomponent.

To remove fuses, hold the end ofthe fuse between your thumb andindex finger and pull straight out.

Page 374: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (34,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-34 Vehicle Care

Page 375: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (35,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-35

The vehicle may not be equippedwith all of the fuses, relays, andfeatures shown.

Fuses Usage

1 Right Trailer Stop/Turn Lamp

2 Electronic StabilitySuspension Control,Automatic LevelControl Exhaust

3 Left Trailer Stop/Turn Lamp

4 Engine Controls

5 Engine ControlModule, ThrottleControl

6 Trailer BrakeController

7 Front Washer

8 Oxygen Sensors

9 Antilock BrakesSystem 2

Fuses Usage

10 Trailer Back-upLamps

11 Driver SideLow-Beam Headlamp

12 Engine ControlModule (Battery)

13 Fuel Injectors, IgnitionCoils (Right Side)

14 Transmission ControlModule (Battery)

15 Vehicle Back-upLamps

16 Passenger SideLow-Beam Headlamp

17 Air ConditioningCompressor

18 Oxygen Sensors

19 Transmission Controls(Ignition)

20 Fuel Pump

Fuses Usage

21 Fuel System ControlModule

22 Headlamp Washer

23 Rear WindshieldWasher

24 Fuel Injectors, IgnitionCoils (Left Side)

25 Trailer Parking Lamps

26 Driver Side ParkingLamps

27 Passenger SideParking Lamps

28 Fog Lamps

29 Horn

30 Passenger SideHigh-Beam Headlamp

31 Daytime RunningLamps (DRL) (IfEquipped)

32 Driver SideHigh-Beam Headlamp

Page 376: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (36,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-36 Vehicle Care

Fuses Usage

33 Daytime RunningLamps 2 (If Equipped)

34 Sunroof

35 Key Ignition System,Theft DeterrentSystem

36 Windshield Wiper

37 SEO B2 UpfitterUsage (Battery)

38 Electric AdjustablePedals

39 Climate Controls(Battery)

40 Airbag System(Ignition)

41 Amplifier

42 Audio System

43 Miscellaneous(Ignition), CruiseControl

44 Liftgate Release

Fuses Usage

45 Airbag System(Battery)

46 Instrument PanelCluster

47 Not Used

48 Auxiliary ClimateControl (Ignition)

49 Center High-MountedStoplamp (CHMSL)

50 Rear Defogger

51 Heated Mirrors

52 SEO B1 UpfitterUsage (Battery)

53 Accessory PowerOutlet, CigaretteLighter (If Equipped)

54 Automatic LevelControl CompressorRelay

55 Climate Controls(Ignition)

Fuses Usage

56 Engine ControlModule, SecondaryFuel Pump (Ignition)

J-CaseFuses Usage

57 Cooling Fan 1

58 Automatic LevelControl Compressor

59 Heavy Duty AntilockBraking System

60 Cooling Fan 2

61 Antilock BrakeSystem 1

62 Starter

63 Stud 2 (TrailerBrakes)

64 Left Bussed ElectricalCenter 1

65 Electric RunningBoards

Page 377: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (37,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-37

J-CaseFuses

Usage

66 Not Used

67 Transfer Case

68 Stud 1 (TrailerConnector BatteryPower)

69 Mid-Bussed ElectricalCenter 1

70 Climate ControlBlower

71 Power LiftgateModule

72 Left Bussed ElectricalCenter 2

Relays Usage

FAN HI Cooling Fan HighSpeed

FAN LO Cooling Fan LowSpeed

FANCNTRL

Cooling Fan Control

Relays Usage

HDLPLO/HID

Low-Beam Headlamp

FOGLAMP

Front Fog Lamps

A/CCMPRSR

Air ConditioningCompressor

STRTR Starter

PWR/TRN Powertrain

FUELPMP

Fuel Pump

PRKLAMP

Parking Lamps

REARDEFOG

Rear Defogger

RUN/CRNK

Switched Power

Instrument Panel FuseBlock

The instrument panel fuse blockaccess door is located on the driverside edge of the instrument panel.

Pull off the cover to access the fuseblock.

Page 378: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (38,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-38 Vehicle Care

The vehicle may not be equippedwith all of the fuses, relays, andfeatures shown.

Fuses Usage

1 Rear Seats

2 Rear AccessoryPower Outlet

Fuses Usage

3 Steering WheelControls Backlight

4 Driver Door Module

5 Dome Lamps, DriverSide Turn Signal

Fuses Usage

6 Driver Side TurnSignal, Stoplamp

7 Instrument PanelBack Lighting

8 Passenger Side TurnSignal, Stoplamp

9 Passenger DoorModule, Driver Unlock

10 Power Door Lock 2(Unlock Feature)

11 Power Door Lock 2(Lock Feature)

12 Stoplamps, CenterHigh‐MountedStoplamp

13 Rear Climate Controls

14 Power Mirror

15 Body ControlModule (BCM)

16 Accessory PowerOutlets

Page 379: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (39,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-39

Fuses Usage

17 Interior Lamps

18 Power Door Lock 1(Unlock Feature)

19 Rear SeatEntertainment

20 Ultrasonic RearParking Assist, PowerLiftgate

21 Power Door Lock 1(Lock Feature)

22 Driver InformationCenter (DIC)

23 Rear Wiper

24 Cooled Seats

25 Driver Seat Module,Remote Keyless EntrySystem

26 Driver Power DoorLock (Unlock Feature)

CircuitBreaker

Usage

LT DR Driver Side PowerWindow CircuitBreaker

HarnessConnector Usage

LT DRDriver DoorHarnessConnection

BODY Harness Connector

BODY Harness Connector

Center Instrument Panel FuseBlock

The center instrument panel fuseblock is located underneath theinstrument panel, to the left of thesteering column.

Top View

HarnessConnector Usage

BODY 2 Body HarnessConnector 2

BODY 1 Body HarnessConnector 1

BODY 3 Body HarnessConnector 3

HEADLINER 3 HeadlinerHarnessConnector 3

Page 380: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (40,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-40 Vehicle Care

HarnessConnector Usage

HEADLINER 2 HeadlinerHarnessConnector 2

HEADLINER 1 HeadlinerHarnessConnector 1

SEO/UPFITTER SpecialEquipmentOption UpfitterHarnessConnector

CircuitBreaker Usage

CB1 Passenger SidePower Window CircuitBreaker

CB2 Passenger SeatCircuit Breaker

CB3 Driver Seat CircuitBreaker

CB4 Rear Sliding Window

Wheels and Tires

TiresEvery new GM vehicle hashigh-quality tires made by aleading tire manufacturer. Seethe warranty manual forinformation regarding the tirewarranty and where to getservice. For additionalinformation refer to the tiremanufacturer.

{ WARNING

. Poorly maintained andimproperly used tires aredangerous.

. Overloading the tires cancause overheating as aresult of too much flexing.There could be a blowout

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

and a serious crash. SeeVehicle Load Limits onpage 9‑15.

. Underinflated tires posethe same danger asoverloaded tires. Theresulting crash couldcause serious injury.Check all tires frequentlyto maintain therecommended pressure.Tire pressure should bechecked when the tiresare cold.

. Overinflated tires are morelikely to be cut, punctured,or broken by a suddenimpact— such as whenhitting a pothole. Keeptires at the recommendedpressure.

(Continued)

Page 381: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (41,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-41

WARNING (Continued)

. Worn or old tires cancause a crash. If the treadis badly worn,replace them.

. Replace any tires thathave been damaged byimpacts with potholes,curbs, etc.

. Improperly repaired tirescan cause a crash. Onlythe dealer or anauthorized tire servicecenter should repair,replace, dismount, andmount the tires.

. Do not spin the tires inexcess of 56 km/h(35 mph) on slipperysurfaces such as snow,mud, ice, etc. Excessivespinning may cause thetires to explode.

20‐Inch Tires

If the vehicle has 20‐inch P275/55R20 size tires, they areclassified as touring tires andare designed for on road use.The low‐profile, wide treaddesign is not recommended foroff‐road driving. See Off-RoadDriving on page 9‑5, foradditional information.

Notice: Low‐profile tires aremore susceptible to damagefrom road hazards or curbimpact than standard profiletires. Tire and/or wheelassembly damage can occurwhen coming into contactwith road hazards like,potholes, or sharp edgedobjects, or when sliding into acurb. The warranty does notcover this type of damage.Keep tires set to the correctinflation pressure and, when

possible, avoid contact withcurbs, potholes, and otherroad hazards.

All-Season TiresThis vehicle may come withall-season tires. These tires aredesigned to provide good overallperformance on most road surfacesand weather conditions. Originalequipment tires designed to GM'sspecific tire performance criteriahave a TPC specification codemolded onto the sidewall. Originalequipment all-season tires can beidentified by the last two charactersof this TPC code, which willbe “MS.”

Consider installing winter tires onthe vehicle if frequent driving onsnow or ice-covered roads isexpected. All-season tires provideadequate performance for mostwinter driving conditions, but theymay not offer the same level of

Page 382: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (42,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-42 Vehicle Care

traction or performance as wintertires on snow or ice-covered roads.See Winter Tires on page 10‑42.

Winter TiresThis vehicle was not, originally,equipped with winter tires. Wintertires are designed for increasedtraction on snow and ice-coveredroads. Consider installing wintertires on the vehicle if frequentdriving on snow or ice-coveredroads is expected. See your dealerfor details regarding winter tireavailability and proper tire selection.Also, see Buying New Tires onpage 10‑56.

With winter tires, there may bedecreased dry road traction,increased road noise, and shortertread life. After changing to wintertires, be alert for changes in vehiclehandling and braking.

If using winter tires:. Use tires of the same brand and

tread type on all four wheelpositions.

. Use only radial ply tires of thesame size, load range, andspeed rating as the originalequipment tires.

Winter tires with the same speedrating as the original equipment tiresmay not be available for H, V, W, Y,and ZR speed rated tires. If wintertires with a lower speed rating arechosen, never exceed the tire'smaximum speed capability.

Summer TiresThis vehicle may come with highperformance summer tires. Thesetires have a special tread andcompound that are optimized formaximum dry and wet roadperformance. This special tread andcompound will decreaseperformance in cold climates, andon ice and snow. We recommendinstalling winter tires on the vehicleif frequent driving in coldtemperatures or on snow or icecovered roads is expected. SeeWinter Tires on page 10‑42.

Tire Sidewall LabelingUseful information about a tire ismolded into the sidewall. Theexamples show a typicalpassenger and light truck tiresidewall.

Passenger (P-Metric) Tire

(A) Tire Size: The tire sizecode is a combination of lettersand numbers used to define aparticular tire's width, height,aspect ratio, construction type,

Page 383: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (43,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-43

and service description. See the“Tire Size” illustration later in thissection for more detail.

(B) TPC Spec (TirePerformance CriteriaSpecification): Originalequipment tires designed toGM's specific tire performancecriteria have a TPC specificationcode molded onto the sidewall.GM's TPC specifications meet orexceed all federal safetyguidelines.

(C) DOT (Department ofTransportation): TheDepartment of Transportation(DOT) code indicates that thetire is in compliance with theU.S. Department ofTransportation Motor VehicleSafety Standards.

DOT Tire Date ofManufacture: The last fourdigits of the TIN indicate the tiremanufactured date. The first twodigits represent the week(01-52) and the last two digits,the year. For example, the thirdweek of the year 2010 wouldhave a four-digit DOT dateof 0310.

(D) Tire Identification Number(TIN): The letters and numbersfollowing the DOT code are theTire Identification Number (TIN).The TIN shows themanufacturer and plant code,tire size, and date the tire wasmanufactured. The TIN ismolded onto both sides of thetire, although only one side mayhave the date of manufacture.

(E) Tire Ply Material: The typeof cord and number of plies inthe sidewall and under the tread.

(F) Uniform Tire QualityGrading (UTQG): Tiremanufacturers are required tograde tires based on threeperformance factors: treadwear,traction, and temperatureresistance. For moreinformation, see Uniform TireQuality Grading on page 10‑59.

(G) Maximum Cold InflationLoad Limit: Maximum load thatcan be carried and themaximum pressure needed tosupport that load. Forinformation on recommendedtire pressure see Tire Pressureon page 10‑49 and Vehicle LoadLimits on page 9‑15.

Page 384: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (44,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-44 Vehicle Care

Light Truck (LT-Metric) Tire

(A) Tire Size: The tire sizecode is a combination of lettersand numbers used to define aparticular tire's width, height,aspect ratio, construction type,and service description. See the“Tire Size” illustration later in thissection for more detail.

(B) TPC Spec (TirePerformance CriteriaSpecification): Originalequipment tires designed toGM's specific tire performance

criteria have a TPC specificationcode molded onto the sidewall.GM's TPC specifications meet orexceed all federal safetyguidelines.

(C) Dual Tire Maximum Load:Maximum load that can becarried and the maximumpressure needed to support thatload when used in a dualconfiguration. For information onrecommended tire pressure seeTire Pressure on page 10‑49and Vehicle Load Limits onpage 9‑15.

(D) DOT (Department ofTransportation): TheDepartment of Transportation(DOT) code indicates that thetire is in compliance with theU.S. Department ofTransportation Motor VehicleSafety Standards.

DOT Tire Date ofManufacture: The last fourdigits of the TIN indicate the tiremanufactured date. The first twodigits represent the week(01-52) and the last two digits,the year. For example, the thirdweek of the year 2010 wouldhave a four-digit DOT dateof 0310.

(E) Tire Identification Number(TIN): The letters and numbersfollowing the DOT code are theTire Identification Number (TIN).The TIN shows themanufacturer and plant code,tire size, and date the tire wasmanufactured. The TIN ismolded onto both sides of thetire, although only one side mayhave the date of manufacture.

(F) Tire Ply Material: The typeof cord and number of plies inthe sidewall and under the tread.

Page 385: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (45,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-45

(G) Single Tire MaximumLoad: Maximum load that canbe carried and the maximumpressure needed to support thatload when used as a single. Forinformation on recommendedtire pressure see Tire Pressureon page 10‑49 and Vehicle LoadLimits on page 9‑15.

Tire Designations

Tire Size

The examples show a typicalpassenger vehicle and lighttruck tire size.

Passenger (P‐Metric) Tire

(A) Passenger (P‐Metric) Tire:The United States version of ametric tire sizing system. The

letter P as the first character inthe tire size means a passengervehicle tire engineered tostandards set by the U.S. Tireand Rim Association.

(B) Tire Width: The three‐digitnumber indicates the tire sectionwidth in millimeters fromsidewall to sidewall.

(C) Aspect Ratio: A two‐digitnumber that indicates the tireheight‐to‐width measurements.For example, if the tire sizeaspect ratio is 75, as shown initem C of the tire illustration, itwould mean that the tire'ssidewall is 75 percent as high asit is wide.

(D) Construction Code: Aletter code is used to indicatethe type of ply construction inthe tire. The letter R meansradial ply construction; theletter D means diagonal or bias

ply construction; and the letter Bmeans belted‐bias plyconstruction.

(E) Rim Diameter: Diameter ofthe wheel in inches.

(F) Service Description: Thesecharacters represent the loadindex and speed rating of thetire. The load index representsthe load carrying capacity a tireis certified to carry. The speedrating is the maximum speed atire is certified to carry a load.

Light Truck (LT‐Metric) Tire

(A) Light Truck (LT‐Metric)Tire: The United States versionof a metric tire sizing system.The letters LT as the first twocharacters in the tire size mean

Page 386: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (46,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-46 Vehicle Care

a light truck tire engineered tostandards set by the U.S. Tireand Rim Association.

(B) Tire Width: The three‐digitnumber indicates the tire sectionwidth in millimeters fromsidewall to sidewall.

(C) Aspect Ratio: A two‐digitnumber that indicates the tireheight‐to‐width measurements.For example, if the tire sizeaspect ratio is 75, as shown initem C of the light truck (LT‐Metric) tire illustration, it wouldmean that the tire's sidewall is75 percent as high as it is wide.

(D) Construction Code: Aletter code is used to indicatethe type of ply construction inthe tire. The letter R meansradial ply construction; theletter D means diagonal or biasply construction; and the letter Bmeans belted‐bias plyconstruction.

(E) Rim Diameter: Diameter ofthe wheel in inches.

(F) Load Range: Load Range.

(G) Service Description: Theservice description indicates theload index and speed rating of atire. If two numbers are given asin the example, 120/116, thenthis represents the load index forsingle versus dual wheel usage(single/dual). The speed rating isthe maximum speed a tire iscertified to carry a load.

Tire Terminology andDefinitionsAir Pressure: The amount ofair inside the tire pressingoutward on each square inch ofthe tire. Air pressure isexpressed in kPa (kilopascal)or psi (pounds per square inch).

Accessory Weight: Thecombined weight of optionalaccessories. Some examples ofoptional accessories areautomatic transmission, powersteering, power brakes, powerwindows, power seats, and airconditioning.

Aspect Ratio: The relationshipof a tire's height to its width.

Belt: A rubber coated layer ofcords between the plies and thetread. Cords may be made fromsteel or other reinforcingmaterials.

Bead: The tire bead containssteel wires wrapped by steelcords that hold the tire ontothe rim.

Bias Ply Tire: A pneumatic tirein which the plies are laid atalternate angles less than90 degrees to the centerline ofthe tread.

Page 387: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (47,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-47

Cold Tire Pressure: Theamount of air pressure in a tire,measured in kPa (kilopascal)or psi (pounds per square inch)before a tire has built up heatfrom driving. See Tire Pressureon page 10‑49.

Curb Weight: The weight of amotor vehicle with standard andoptional equipment including themaximum capacity of fuel, oil,and coolant, but withoutpassengers and cargo.

DOT Markings: A code moldedinto the sidewall of a tiresignifying that the tire is incompliance with the U.S.Department of Transportation(DOT) Motor Vehicle SafetyStandards. The DOT codeincludes the Tire IdentificationNumber (TIN), an alphanumericdesignator which can also

identify the tire manufacturer,production plant, brand, anddate of production.

GVWR: Gross Vehicle WeightRating. See Vehicle Load Limitson page 9‑15.

GAWR FRT: Gross Axle WeightRating for the front axle. SeeVehicle Load Limits onpage 9‑15.

GAWR RR: Gross Axle WeightRating for the rear axle. SeeVehicle Load Limits onpage 9‑15.

Intended Outboard Sidewall:The side of an asymmetrical tire,that must always face outwardwhen mounted on a vehicle.

Kilopascal (kPa): The metricunit for air pressure.

Light Truck (LT-Metric) Tire: Atire used on light duty trucks andsome multipurpose passengervehicles.

Load Index: An assignednumber ranging from 1 to 279that corresponds to the loadcarrying capacity of a tire.

Maximum Inflation Pressure:The maximum air pressure towhich a cold tire can be inflated.The maximum air pressure ismolded onto the sidewall.

Maximum Load Rating: Theload rating for a tire at themaximum permissible inflationpressure for that tire.

Maximum Loaded VehicleWeight: The sum of curbweight, accessory weight,vehicle capacity weight, andproduction options weight.

Normal Occupant Weight: Thenumber of occupants a vehicleis designed to seat multiplied by68 kg (150 lbs). See VehicleLoad Limits on page 9‑15.

Page 388: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (48,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-48 Vehicle Care

Occupant Distribution:Designated seating positions.

Outward Facing Sidewall: Theside of an asymmetrical tire thathas a particular side that facesoutward when mounted on avehicle. The side of the tire thatcontains a whitewall, bearswhite lettering, or bearsmanufacturer, brand, and/ormodel name molding that ishigher or deeper than the samemoldings on the other sidewallof the tire.

Passenger (P-Metric) Tire: Atire used on passenger cars andsome light duty trucks andmultipurpose vehicles.

Recommended InflationPressure: Vehiclemanufacturer's recommendedtire inflation pressure as shownon the tire placard.

See Tire Pressure onpage 10‑49 and Vehicle LoadLimits on page 9‑15.

Radial Ply Tire: A pneumatictire in which the ply cords thatextend to the beads are laid at90 degrees to the centerline ofthe tread.

Rim: A metal support for a tireand upon which the tire beadsare seated.

Sidewall: The portion of a tirebetween the tread and the bead.

Speed Rating: Analphanumeric code assigned toa tire indicating the maximumspeed at which a tire canoperate.

Traction: The friction betweenthe tire and the road surface.The amount of grip provided.

Tread: The portion of a tire thatcomes into contact withthe road.

Treadwear Indicators: Narrowbands, sometimes called wearbars, that show across the treadof a tire when only 1.6 mm(1/16 in) of tread remains. SeeWhen It Is Time for New Tireson page 10‑56.

UTQGS (Uniform Tire QualityGrading Standards): A tireinformation system that providesconsumers with ratings for atire's traction, temperature, andtreadwear. Ratings aredetermined by tiremanufacturers usinggovernment testing procedures.The ratings are molded into thesidewall of the tire. See UniformTire Quality Grading onpage 10‑59.

Page 389: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (49,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-49

Vehicle Capacity Weight: Thenumber of designated seatingpositions multiplied by68 kg (150 lbs) plus the ratedcargo load. See Vehicle LoadLimits on page 9‑15.

Vehicle Maximum Load on theTire: Load on an individual tiredue to curb weight, accessoryweight, occupant weight, andcargo weight.

Vehicle Placard: A labelpermanently attached to avehicle showing the vehiclecapacity weight and the originalequipment tire size andrecommended inflation pressure.See “Tire and LoadingInformation Label” under VehicleLoad Limits on page 9‑15.

Tire PressureIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Tires need the correct amount ofair pressure to operateeffectively.

Notice: Neither tireunderinflation noroverinflation is good.Underinflated tires, or tiresthat do not have enough air,can result in:. Tire overloading andoverheating which couldlead to a blowout.

. Premature orirregular wear.

. Poor handling.

. Reduced fuel economy.

Overinflated tires, or tires thathave too much air, canresult in:. Unusual wear.. Poor handling.. Rough ride.

. Needless damage fromroad hazards.

The Tire and LoadingInformation label on the vehicleindicates the original equipmenttires and the correct cold tireinflation pressures. Therecommended pressure is theminimum air pressure needed tosupport the vehicle's maximumload carrying capacity.

For additional informationregarding how much weight thevehicle can carry, and anexample of the Tire and LoadingInformation label, see VehicleLoad Limits on page 9‑15. Howthe vehicle is loaded affectsvehicle handling and ridecomfort. Never load the vehiclewith more weight than it wasdesigned to carry.

Page 390: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (50,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-50 Vehicle Care

When to Check

Check the tires once a monthor more.

Do not forget the spare tire. SeeFull-Size Spare Tire onpage 10‑76 for additionalinformation.

How to Check

Use a good quality pocket-typegauge to check tire pressure.Proper tire inflation cannot bedetermined by looking at the tire.Check the tire inflation pressurewhen the tires are cold meaningthe vehicle has not been drivenfor at least three hours or nomore than 1.6 km (1 mi).

Remove the valve cap from thetire valve stem. Press the tiregauge firmly onto the valve toget a pressure measurement.If the cold tire inflation pressurematches the recommendedpressure on the Tire and

Loading Information label, nofurther adjustment is necessary.If the inflation pressure is low,add air until the recommendedpressure is reached. If theinflation pressure is high, presson the metal stem in the centerof the tire valve to release air.

Recheck the tire pressure withthe tire gauge

Return the valve caps on thevalve stems to prevent leaksand keep out dirt and moisture.

Tire Pressure MonitorSystemThe Tire Pressure Monitor System(TPMS) uses radio and sensortechnology to check tire pressurelevels. The TPMS sensors monitorthe air pressure in your tires andtransmit tire pressure readings to areceiver located in the vehicle.

Each tire, including the spare (ifprovided), should be checkedmonthly when cold and inflated tothe inflation pressure recommendedby the vehicle manufacturer on thevehicle placard or tire inflationpressure label. (If your vehicle hastires of a different size than the sizeindicated on the vehicle placard ortire inflation pressure label, youshould determine the proper tireinflation pressure for those tires.)

As an added safety feature, yourvehicle has been equipped with atire pressure monitoring system(TPMS) that illuminates a low tirepressure telltale when one or moreof your tires is significantlyunder-inflated.

Accordingly, when the low tirepressure telltale illuminates, youshould stop and check your tires assoon as possible, and inflate themto the proper pressure. Driving on asignificantly under-inflated tirecauses the tire to overheat and canlead to tire failure. Under-inflationalso reduces fuel efficiency and tire

Page 391: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (51,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-51

tread life, and may affect thevehicle's handling and stoppingability.

Please note that the TPMS is not asubstitute for proper tiremaintenance, and it is the driver'sresponsibility to maintain correct tirepressure, even if under-inflation hasnot reached the level to triggerillumination of the TPMS low tirepressure telltale.

Your vehicle has also beenequipped with a TPMS malfunctionindicator to indicate when thesystem is not operating properly.The TPMS malfunction indicator iscombined with the low tire pressuretelltale. When the system detects amalfunction, the telltale will flash forapproximately one minute and thenremain continuously illuminated.This sequence will continue uponsubsequent vehicle start-ups aslong as the malfunction exists.

When the malfunction indicator isilluminated, the system may not beable to detect or signal low tire

pressure as intended. TPMSmalfunctions may occur for a varietyof reasons, including the installationof replacement or alternate tires orwheels on the vehicle that preventthe TPMS from functioning properly.Always check the TPMS malfunctiontelltale after replacing one or moretires or wheels on your vehicle toensure that the replacement oralternate tires and wheels allow theTPMS to continue to functionproperly.

See Tire Pressure MonitorOperation on page 10‑51.

Federal CommunicationsCommission (FCC) Rules andwith Industry CanadaStandards

See Radio Frequency Statement onpage 13‑20 for informationregarding Part 15 of the FederalCommunications Commission (FCC)Rules and with Industry CanadaStandards RSS-GEN/210/220/310.

Tire Pressure MonitorOperationIf the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

This vehicle may have a TirePressure Monitor System (TPMS).The TPMS is designed to warn thedriver when a low tire pressurecondition exists. TPMS sensors aremounted onto each tire and wheelassembly, excluding the spare tireand wheel assembly. The TPMSsensors monitor the air pressure inthe tires and transmit the tirepressure readings to a receiverlocated in the vehicle.

When a low tire pressure conditionis detected, the TPMS illuminatesthe low tire pressure warning light

Page 392: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (52,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-52 Vehicle Care

located on the instrument cluster.If the warning light comes on, stopas soon as possible and inflate thetires to the recommended pressureshown on the tire loadinginformation label. See Vehicle LoadLimits on page 9‑15.

A message to check the pressure ina specific tire displays in the DriverInformation Center (DIC). The lowtire pressure warning light and theDIC warning message come on ateach ignition cycle until the tires areinflated to the correct inflationpressure. Using the DIC, tirepressure levels can be viewed. Foradditional information and detailsabout the DIC operation anddisplays see Driver InformationCenter (DIC) on page 5‑26 and TireMessages on page 5‑41.

The low tire pressure warning lightmay come on in cool weather whenthe vehicle is first started, and thenturn off as the vehicle is driven. Thiscould be an early indicator that the

air pressure is getting low andneeds to be inflated to the properpressure.

A Tire and Loading Information labelshows the size of the originalequipment tires and the correctinflation pressure for the tires whenthey are cold. See Vehicle LoadLimits on page 9‑15, for an exampleof the Tire and Loading Informationlabel and its location. Also see TirePressure on page 10‑49.

The TPMS can warn about a lowtire pressure condition but it doesnot replace normal tiremaintenance. See Tire Inspectionon page 10‑54, Tire Rotation onpage 10‑54 and Tires onpage 10‑40.

Notice: Tire sealant materials arenot all the same. A non-approvedtire sealant could damage theTPMS sensors. TPMS sensordamage caused by using anincorrect tire sealant is notcovered by the vehicle warranty.Always use only the

GM-approved tire sealantavailable through your dealer orincluded in the vehicle.

TPMS Malfunction Light andMessage

The TPMS will not function properlyif one or more of the TPMS sensorsare missing or inoperable. When thesystem detects a malfunction, thelow tire warning light flashes forabout one minute and then stays onfor the remainder of the ignitioncycle. A DIC warning message alsodisplays. The malfunction light andDIC warning message come on ateach ignition cycle until the problemis corrected. Some of the conditionsthat can cause these to comeon are:. One of the road tires has been

replaced with the spare tire. Thespare tire does not have aTPMS sensor. The malfunctionlight and DIC message shouldgo off after the road tire isreplaced and the sensormatching process is performed

Page 393: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (53,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-53

successfully. See "TPMS SensorMatching Process" later in thissection.

. The TPMS sensor matchingprocess was not done or notcompleted successfully afterrotating the tires. Themalfunction light and the DICmessage should go off aftersuccessfully completing thesensor matching process. See"TPMS Sensor MatchingProcess" later in this section.

. One or more TPMS sensors aremissing or damaged. Themalfunction light and the DICmessage should go off when theTPMS sensors are installed andthe sensor matching process isperformed successfully. Seeyour dealer for service.

. Replacement tires or wheels donot match the original equipmenttires or wheels. Tires and wheelsother than those recommended

could prevent the TPMS fromfunctioning properly. See BuyingNew Tires on page 10‑56.

. Operating electronic devices orbeing near facilities using radiowave frequencies similar to theTPMS could cause the TPMSsensors to malfunction.

If the TPMS is not functioningproperly, it cannot detect or signal alow tire condition. See your dealerfor service if the TPMS malfunctionlight and DIC message comes onand stays on.

TPMS Sensor MatchingProcess

Each TPMS sensor has a uniqueidentification code. The identificationcode needs to be matched to a newtire/wheel position after rotating thevehicle’s tires or replacing one ormore of the TPMS sensors. TheTPMS sensor matching processshould also be performed afterreplacing a spare tire with a roadtire containing the TPMS sensor.The malfunction light and the DIC

message should go off at the nextignition cycle. The sensors arematched to the tire/wheel positions,using a TPMS relearn tool, in thefollowing order: driver side front tire,passenger side front tire, passengerside rear tire, and driver side rear.See your dealer for service or topurchase a relearn tool.

There are two minutes to match thefirst tire/wheel position, andfive minutes overall to match all fourtire/wheel positions. If it takeslonger, the matching process stopsand must be restarted.

The TPMS sensor matching processis outlined below:

1. Set the parking brake.

2. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN withthe engine off.

3. Press Q and K on the RemoteKeyless Entry (RKE) transmitterat the same time forapproximately five seconds. Thehorn sounds twice to signal thereceiver is in relearn mode and

Page 394: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (54,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-54 Vehicle Care

TIRE LEARNING ACTIVEmessage displays on the DICscreen.

4. Start with the driver sidefront tire.

5. Place the relearn tool againstthe tire sidewall, near the valvestem. Then press the button toactivate the TPMS sensor.A horn chirp confirms that thesensor identification code hasbeen matched to this tire andwheel position.

6. Proceed to the passenger sidefront tire, and repeat theprocedure in Step 5.

7. Proceed to the passenger siderear tire, and repeat theprocedure in Step 5.

8. Proceed to the driver side reartire, and repeat the procedure inStep 5. The horn sounds twotimes to indicate the sensoridentification code has beenmatched to the driver side reartire, and the TPMS sensor

matching process is no longeractive. The TIRE LEARNINGACTIVE message on the DICdisplay screen goes off.

9. Turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF.

10. Set all four tires to therecommended air pressurelevel as indicated on the Tireand Loading Information label.

Tire InspectionWe recommend that the tires,including the spare tire, if thevehicle has one, be inspectedfor signs of wear or damage atleast once a month.

Replace the tire if:. The indicators at three or

more places around the tirecan be seen.

. There is cord or fabricshowing through the tire'srubber.

. The tread or sidewall iscracked, cut, or snaggeddeep enough to show cord orfabric.

. The tire has a bump, bulge,or split.

. The tire has a puncture, cut,or other damage that cannotbe repaired well because ofthe size or location of thedamage.

Tire RotationTires should be rotated every12 000 km (7,500 mi). SeeMaintenance Schedule onpage 11‑2.

Tires are rotated to achieve auniform wear for all tires. Thefirst rotation is the mostimportant.

Anytime unusual wear isnoticed, rotate the tires as soonas possible, check for proper tire

Page 395: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (55,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-55

inflation pressure, and check fordamaged tires or wheels. If theunusual wear continues after therotation, check the wheelalignment. See When It Is Timefor New Tires on page 10‑56and Wheel Replacement onpage 10‑60.

Use this rotation pattern whenrotating the tires.

Do not include the spare tire inthe tire rotation.

Adjust the front and rear tires tothe recommended inflationpressure on the Tire andLoading Information label afterthe tires have been rotated. SeeTire Pressure on page 10‑49and Vehicle Load Limits onpage 9‑15.

Reset the Tire Pressure MonitorSystem. See Tire PressureMonitor Operation onpage 10‑51.

Check that all wheel nuts areproperly tightened. See “WheelNut Torque” under Capacitiesand Specifications onpage 12‑2.

{ WARNING

Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on theparts to which it is fastened, canmake wheel nuts become looseafter time. The wheel could come

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

off and cause an accident. Whenchanging a wheel, remove anyrust or dirt from places where thewheel attaches to the vehicle. Inan emergency, a cloth or a papertowel can be used; however, usea scraper or wire brush later toremove all rust or dirt.

Lightly coat the center of thewheel hub with wheel bearinggrease after a wheel change ortire rotation to prevent corrosionor rust build-up. Do not getgrease on the flat wheelmounting surface or on thewheel nuts or bolts.

Page 396: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (56,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-56 Vehicle Care

When It Is Time for NewTiresFactors, such as maintenance,temperatures, driving speeds,vehicle loading, and road conditionsaffect the wear rate of the tires.

Treadwear indicators are one way totell when it is time for new tires.Treadwear indicators appear whenthe tires have only 1.6 mm (1/16 in)or less of tread remaining. Somecommercial truck tires may not havetreadwear indicators.

See Tire Inspection on page 10‑54and Tire Rotation on page 10‑54 foradditional information.

The rubber in tires ages over time.This also applies to the spare tire,if the vehicle has one, even if it isnever used. Multiple factorsincluding temperatures, loadingconditions, and inflation pressuremaintenance affect how fast agingtakes place. GM recommends thattires, including the spare ifequipped, be replaced after sixyears, regardless of tread wear. Thetire manufacturer date is the lastfour digits of the DOT TireIdentification Number (TIN) which ismolded into one side of the tiresidewall. The first two digitsrepresent the week (01-52) and thelast two digits, the year. Forexample, the third week of the year2010 would have a four-digit DOTdate of 0310.

Vehicle Storage

Tires age when stored normallymounted on a parked vehicle. Parka vehicle that will be stored for atleast a month in a cool, dry, cleanarea away from direct sunlight toslow aging. This area should be freeof grease, gasoline or othersubstances that can deterioraterubber.

Parking for an extended period cancause flat spots on the tires thatmay result in vibrations whiledriving. When storing a vehicle forat least a month, remove the tires orraise the vehicle to reduce theweight from the tires.

Buying New TiresGM has developed and matchedspecific tires for the vehicle. Theoriginal equipment tires installedwere designed to meet GeneralMotors Tire Performance CriteriaSpecification (TPC Spec)system rating. When

Page 397: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (57,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-57

replacement tires are needed,GM strongly recommendsbuying tires with the same TPCSpec rating.

GM's exclusive TPC Specsystem considers over a dozencritical specifications that impactthe overall performance of thevehicle, including brake systemperformance, ride and handling,traction control, and tirepressure monitoringperformance. GM's TPC Specnumber is molded onto the tire'ssidewall near the tire size. If thetires have an all-season treaddesign, the TPC Spec numberwill be followed by MS for mudand snow. See Tire SidewallLabeling on page 10‑42 foradditional information.

GM recommends replacing worntires in complete sets of four.Uniform tread depth on all tireswill help to maintain the

performance of the vehicle.Braking and handlingperformance may be adverselyaffected if all the tires are notreplaced at the same time.If proper rotation andmaintenance have been done,all four tires should wear out atabout the same time. See TireRotation on page 10‑54 forinformation on proper tirerotation. However, if it isnecessary to replace only oneaxle set of worn tires, place thenew tires on the rear axle.

{ WARNING

Tires could explode duringimproper service. Attemptingto mount or dismount a tirecould cause injury or death.Only your dealer or authorizedtire service center shouldmount or dismount the tires.

{ WARNING

Mixing tires of different sizes,brands, or types may causeloss of control of the vehicle,resulting in a crash or othervehicle damage. Use thecorrect size, brand, and typeof tires on all wheels.

This vehicle may have adifferent size spare than theroad tires originally installedon the vehicle. When new, thevehicle included a spare tireand wheel assembly with asimilar overall diameter as theroad tires and wheels, so it isall right to drive on it. Thespare tire was developed foruse on this vehicle and will notaffect vehicle handling.

Page 398: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (58,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-58 Vehicle Care

{ WARNING

Using bias-ply tires on thevehicle may cause the wheelrim flanges to develop cracksafter many miles of driving.A tire and/or wheel could failsuddenly and cause a crash.Use only radial-ply tires withthe wheels on the vehicle.

If the vehicle tires must bereplaced with a tire that does nothave a TPC Spec number, makesure they are the same size,load range, speed rating, andconstruction (radial) as theoriginal tires.

Vehicles that have a tirepressure monitoring systemcould give an inaccuratelow-pressure warning if non-TPCSpec rated tires are installed.See Tire Pressure MonitorSystem on page 10‑50.

The Tire and LoadingInformation label indicates theoriginal equipment tires on thevehicle. See Vehicle Load Limitson page 9‑15 for the labellocation and more informationabout the Tire and LoadingInformation label.

Different Size Tires andWheelsIf wheels or tires are installed thatare a different size than the originalequipment wheels and tires, vehicleperformance, including its braking,ride and handling characteristics,stability, and resistance to rollovermay be affected. If the vehicle haselectronic systems such as antilockbrakes, rollover airbags, tractioncontrol, electronic stability control,or All-Wheel Drive, the performanceof these systems can also beaffected.

{ WARNING

If different sized wheels are used,there may not be an acceptablelevel of performance and safety iftires not recommended for thosewheels are selected. Thisincreases the chance of a crashand serious injury. Only use GMspecific wheel and tire systemsdeveloped for the vehicle, andhave them properly installed by aGM certified technician.

See Buying New Tires onpage 10‑56 and Accessories andModifications on page 10‑3.

Page 399: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (59,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-59

Uniform Tire QualityGradingQuality grades can be foundwhere applicable on the tiresidewall between tread shoulderand maximum section width. Forexample:

Treadwear 200 Traction AATemperature A

The following information relatesto the system developed by theUnited States National HighwayTraffic Safety Administration(NHTSA), which grades tires bytreadwear, traction, andtemperature performance. Thisapplies only to vehicles sold inthe United States. The gradesare molded on the sidewalls ofmost passenger car tires. TheUniform Tire Quality Grading(UTQG) system does not applyto deep tread, winter tires,compact spare tires, tires with

nominal rim diameters of10 to 12 inches (25 to 30 cm),or to some limited-productiontires.

While the tires available onGeneral Motors passenger carsand light trucks may vary withrespect to these grades, theymust also conform to federalsafety requirements andadditional General Motors TirePerformance Criteria (TPC)standards.

All Passenger Car Tires MustConform to Federal SafetyRequirements In Addition ToThese Grades.

Treadwear

The treadwear grade is acomparative rating based on thewear rate of the tire when testedunder controlled conditions on aspecified government testcourse. For example, a tire

graded 150 would wear one andone-half (1½) times as well onthe government course as a tiregraded 100. The relativeperformance of tires dependsupon the actual conditions oftheir use, however, and maydepart significantly from thenorm due to variations in drivinghabits, service practices anddifferences in roadcharacteristics and climate.

Traction – AA, A, B, C

The traction grades, fromhighest to lowest, are AA, A, B,and C. Those grades representthe tire's ability to stop on wetpavement as measured undercontrolled conditions onspecified government testsurfaces of asphalt andconcrete. A tire marked C mayhave poor traction performance.Warning: The traction gradeassigned to this tire is based on

Page 400: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (60,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-60 Vehicle Care

straight-ahead braking tractiontests, and does not includeacceleration, cornering,hydroplaning, or peak tractioncharacteristics.

Temperature – A, B, C

The temperature grades are A(the highest), B, and C,representing the tire's resistanceto the generation of heat and itsability to dissipate heat whentested under controlledconditions on a specified indoorlaboratory test wheel. Sustainedhigh temperature can cause thematerial of the tire to degenerateand reduce tire life, andexcessive temperature can leadto sudden tire failure. The gradeC corresponds to a level ofperformance which allpassenger car tires must meetunder the Federal Motor SafetyStandard No. 109. Grades B andA represent higher levels of

performance on the laboratorytest wheel than the minimumrequired by law. Warning: Thetemperature grade for this tire isestablished for a tire that isproperly inflated and notoverloaded. Excessive speed,underinflation, or excessiveloading, either separately or incombination, can cause heatbuildup and possible tire failure.

Wheel Alignment and TireBalanceThe tires and wheels were alignedand balanced at the factory toprovide the longest tire life and bestoverall performance. Adjustments towheel alignment and tire balancingwill not be necessary on a regularbasis. However, check thealignment if there is unusual tirewear or if the vehicle is pulling toone side or the other. If the vehiclevibrates when driving on a smooth

road, the tires and wheels mightneed to be rebalanced. See yourdealer for proper diagnosis.

Wheel ReplacementReplace any wheel that is bent,cracked, or badly rusted orcorroded. If wheel nuts keep comingloose, the wheel, wheel bolts, andwheel nuts should be replaced.If the wheel leaks air, replace it.Some aluminum wheels can berepaired. See your dealer if any ofthese conditions exist.

Your dealer will know the kind ofwheel that is needed.

Each new wheel should have thesame load-carrying capacity,diameter, width, offset, and bemounted the same way as the one itreplaces.

Replace wheels, wheel bolts, wheelnuts, or Tire Pressure MonitorSystem (TPMS) sensors with newGM original equipment parts.

Page 401: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (61,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-61

{ WARNING

Using the wrong replacementwheels, wheel bolts, or wheelnuts can be dangerous. It couldaffect the braking and handling ofthe vehicle. Tires can lose air,and cause loss of control, causinga crash. Always use the correctwheel, wheel bolts, and wheelnuts for replacement.

Notice: The wrong wheel canalso cause problems with bearinglife, brake cooling, speedometeror odometer calibration,headlamp aim, bumper height,vehicle ground clearance, and tireor tire chain clearance to thebody and chassis.

Used Replacement Wheels

{ WARNING

Replacing a wheel with a usedone is dangerous. How it hasbeen used or how far it has beendriven may be unknown. It couldfail suddenly and cause a crash.When replacing wheels, use anew GM original equipmentwheel.

Tire ChainsIf your vehicle is a Hybrid, see theHybrid Supplement for moreinformation.

{ WARNING

If the vehicle has P265/65R18 orP275/55R20 size tires, do not usetire chains. There is not enoughclearance. Tire chains used on avehicle without the proper amount

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

of clearance can cause damageto the brakes, suspension,or other vehicle parts. The areadamaged by the tire chains couldcause loss of control and a crash.

Use another type of tractiondevice only if its manufacturerrecommends it for the vehicle'stire size combination and roadconditions. Follow thatmanufacturer's instructions. Toavoid vehicle damage, drive slowand readjust or remove thetraction device if it is contactingthe vehicle. Do not spin thewheels.

If traction devices are used, installthem on the rear tires.

Page 402: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (62,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-62 Vehicle Care

Notice: If the vehicle has P265/70R17 size tires, use tire chainsonly where legal and only whennecessary. Use chains that arethe proper size for the tires.Install them on the rear tires only.

Do not use chains on the fronttires.

Tighten them as tightly aspossible with the ends securelyfastened. Drive slowly and followthe chain manufacturer'sinstructions. If the chains contactthe vehicle, stop and retightenthem. If the contact continues,slow down until it stops. Drivingtoo fast or spinning the wheelswith chains on will damage thevehicle.

If a Tire Goes FlatIt is unusual for a tire to blowoutwhile driving, especially if the tiresare maintained properly. If air goesout of a tire, it is much more likely toleak out slowly. But if there ever is ablowout, here are a few tips aboutwhat to expect and what to do:

If a front tire fails, the flat tirecreates a drag that pulls the vehicletoward that side. Take your foot offthe accelerator pedal and grip thesteering wheel firmly. Steer tomaintain lane position, and thengently brake to a stop, well off theroad, if possible.

A rear blowout, particularly on acurve, acts much like a skid andmay require the same correction asused in a skid. Stop pressing theaccelerator pedal and steer tostraighten the vehicle. It may bevery bumpy and noisy. Gently braketo a stop, well off the road,if possible.

{ WARNING

Driving on a flat tire will causepermanent damage to the tire.Re-inflating a tire after it has beendriven on while severelyunderinflated or flat may cause ablowout and a serious crash.Never attempt to re-inflate a tirethat has been driven on whileseverely underinflated or flat.Have your dealer or an authorizedtire service center repair orreplace the flat tire as soon aspossible.

{ WARNING

Lifting a vehicle and getting underit to do maintenance or repairs isdangerous without theappropriate safety equipment andtraining. If a jack is provided withthe vehicle, it is designed only for

(Continued)

Page 403: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (63,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-63

WARNING (Continued)

changing a flat tire. If it is used foranything else, you or others couldbe badly injured or killed if thevehicle slips off the jack. If a jackis provided with the vehicle, onlyuse it for changing a flat tire.

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

If a tire goes flat, avoid further tireand wheel damage by driving slowlyto a level place, well off the road,if possible. Turn on the hazardwarning flashers. See HazardWarning Flashers on page 6‑5.

{ WARNING

Changing a tire can bedangerous. The vehicle can slipoff the jack and roll over or fallcausing injury or death. Find a

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

level place to change the tire. Tohelp prevent the vehicle frommoving:

1. Set the parking brake firmly.

2. Put the shift lever inP (Park).

3. For vehicles withfour-wheel-drive with aN (Neutral) transfer caseposition, be sure thetransfer case is in a drivegear — not in N (Neutral).

4. Turn off the engine and donot restart while the vehicleis raised.

5. Do not allow passengers toremain in the vehicle.

6. Place wheel blocks on bothsides of the tire at theopposite corner of the tirebeing changed.

When the vehicle has a flat tire (B),use the following example as aguide to assist in the placement ofthe wheel blocks (A).

A. Wheel Block

B. Flat Tire

The following information explainshow to use the jack and changea tire.

Page 404: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (64,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-64 Vehicle Care

Tire Changing

Removing the Spare Tire andTools

The equipment needed to change aflat tire is stored under the storagetray, located on the driver side trimpanel, over the rear wheelhouse.

Regular Wheelbase Shown,Extended Wheelbase Similar

1. Remove the tray to access thetools by pulling up on the fingerdepression under the jacksymbol.

A. Jack Knob

B. Wing Nut Retaining theTool Bag

C. Wing Nut Retaining theWheel Blocks

2. Turn the wing nut retaining thetool bag (B) counterclockwise toremove it.

3. Turn the jack knob (A)counterclockwise to release thejack and wheel blocks from thebracket.

4. Turn the wing nut retaining thewheel blocks (C)counterclockwise to remove thewheel blocks and the wheelblock retainer.

Use the following tools:

A. Jack

B. Wheel Blocks

C. Jack Handle

D. Jack Handle Extensions

E. Wheel Wrench

Page 405: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (65,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-65

To access the spare tire, refer to thefollowing graphics and instructions:

A. Hoist Assembly

B. Hoist Shaft

C. Hoist Shaft Access Cover/Hole

D. Jack Handle Extensions

E. Wheel Wrench

F. Hoist Cable

G. Tire/Wheel Retainer

H. Spare Tire (Valve StemPointed Down)

I. Hoist Shaft Access Hole

J. Hoist End of Extension Tool

K. Spare Tire Lock

1. Open the hoist shaft accessdoor (C) on the bumper toaccess the spare tire lock (K).

2. To remove the spare tire lock(K), insert the ignition key, turn itclockwise and then pull itstraight out.

3. Assemble the two jack handleextensions (D) and wheelwrench (E), as shown.

4. Insert the open end of theextension (J) through the hole inthe rear bumper (I) (hoist shaftaccess hole).

Be sure the hoist end (J) of theextension connects to the hoistshaft. The ribbed square end ofthe extension is used to lowerthe spare tire.

Page 406: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (66,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-66 Vehicle Care

5. Turn the wheel wrenchcounterclockwise to lower thespare tire to the ground.Continue to turn the wheelwrench until the spare tire canbe pulled out from under thevehicle.

If the spare tire does not lower tothe ground, the secondary latchis engaged causing the tire notto lower. See Secondary LatchSystem on page 10‑74 for moreinformation.

6. Use the wheel wrench hook topull the hoist cable closer toassist in reaching the spare tire.

7. Tilt the tire toward the vehiclewith some slack in the cable toaccess the tire/wheel retainer.Separate the retainer from theguide pin by sliding the retainerup the pin while pressing downon the latch.

Once the retainer is separatedfrom the guide pin, tilt theretainer and pull it through thecenter of the wheel along withthe cable and latch.

8. Put the spare tire near theflat tire.

Removing the Flat Tire andInstalling the Spare Tire

1. Do a safety check beforeproceeding. See If a Tire GoesFlat on page 10‑62 for moreinformation.

Page 407: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (67,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-67

2. If the vehicle has a center capthat covers the wheel fasteners,place the chisel end of the wheelwrench in the slot on the wheeland gently pry the cap out.

If the wheel has a bolt-on hubcap, loosen the plastic nut capsby turning the wheel wrenchcounterclockwise. The plasticnut caps will be retained in thehub cap after it is removed fromthe wheel.

3. Use the wheel wrench to loosenall the wheel nuts. Turn thewheel wrench counterclockwiseto loosen the wheel nuts. Do notremove the wheel nuts yet.

Jacking Locations (Overall View)

A. Front Position

B. Rear Position

Page 408: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (68,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-68 Vehicle Care

4. Position the jack under thevehicle, as shown.

Front Position – 2500 Models

Front Position – 1500 Models

Front Tire Flat: If the flat tire ison a front tire of the vehicle, usethe jack handle and only onejack handle extension. Attachthe wheel wrench to the jackhandle extension. Attach thejack handle to the jack (A).Position the jack on the framebehind the flat tire where theframe sections overlap. Turn thewheel wrench clockwise to raisethe vehicle. Raise the vehicle farenough off the ground so thereis enough room for the spare tireto clear the ground.

Rear Position – All Other Models

Rear Position – 1500 Models

Page 409: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (69,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-69

Rear Tire Flat: If the flat tire ison a rear tire of the vehicle, usethe jack handle (B) and both jackhandle extensions (C). Attachthe wheel wrench (D) to the jackhandle extensions (C). Attachthe jack handle (B) to thejack (A). Use the jacking padprovided on the rear axle. Turnthe wheel wrench (D) clockwiseto raise the vehicle. Raise thevehicle far enough off theground so there is enough roomfor the spare tire to clear theground.

{ WARNING

Getting under a vehicle when it islifted on a jack is dangerous.If the vehicle slips off the jack,you could be badly injured orkilled. Never get under a vehiclewhen it is supported only bya jack.

{ WARNING

Raising the vehicle with the jackimproperly positioned candamage the vehicle and evenmake the vehicle fall. To helpavoid personal injury and vehicledamage, be sure to fit the jack lifthead into the proper locationbefore raising the vehicle.

5. Remove all of the wheel nuts.

6. Take off the flat tire.

7. Remove any rust or dirt from thewheel bolts, mounting surfaces,and spare wheel.

{ WARNING

Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on theparts to which it is fastened, canmake wheel nuts become looseafter time. The wheel could comeoff and cause an accident. Whenchanging a wheel, remove anyrust or dirt from places where thewheel attaches to the vehicle. In

(Continued)

Page 410: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (70,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-70 Vehicle Care

WARNING (Continued)

an emergency, a cloth or a papertowel can be used; however, usea scraper or wire brush later toremove all rust or dirt.

8. Put the wheel nuts back on withthe rounded end of the nutstoward the wheel after mountingthe spare tire.

{ WARNING

Never use oil or grease on boltsor nuts because the nuts mightcome loose. The vehicle's wheelcould fall off, causing a crash.

9. Tighten each wheel nut by hand.Then use the wheel wrench totighten the nuts until the wheel isheld against the hub.

10. Turn the wheel wrenchcounterclockwise to lower thevehicle. Lower the jackcompletely.

11. Tighten the nuts firmly in acrisscross sequence as shownby turning the wheel wrenchclockwise.

{ WARNING

Wheel nuts that are improperly orincorrectly tightened can causethe wheels to become loose orcome off. The wheel nuts shouldbe tightened with a torque wrenchto the proper torque specification

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

after replacing. Follow the torquespecification supplied by theaftermarket manufacturer whenusing accessory locking wheelnuts. See Capacities andSpecifications on page 12‑2 fororiginal equipment wheel nuttorque specifications.

Notice: Improperly tightenedwheel nuts can lead to brakepulsation and rotor damage. Toavoid expensive brake repairs,evenly tighten the wheel nuts inthe proper sequence and to theproper torque specification. SeeCapacities and Specifications onpage 12‑2 for the wheel nuttorque specification.

Page 411: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (71,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-71

When reinstalling the regular wheeland tire, also reinstall either thecenter cap or the bolt-on hub cap,depending on which one thevehicle has.. For center caps, line up the tab

on the center cap with the slot inthe wheel. The cap only goes inone way. Place the cap on thewheel and press until it snapsinto place.

. For bolt-on hub caps, line up theplastic nut caps with the wheelnuts and tighten clockwise byhand to get them started. Thentighten with the wheel wrenchuntil snug.

Storing a Flat or Spare Tireand Tools

{ WARNING

Storing a jack, a tire, or otherequipment in the passengercompartment of the vehicle could

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

cause injury. In a sudden stop orcollision, loose equipment couldstrike someone. Store all these inthe proper place.

Notice: Storing an aluminumwheel with a flat tire under yourvehicle for an extended period oftime or with the valve stempointing up can damage thewheel. Always stow the wheelwith the valve stem pointingdown and have the wheel/tirerepaired as soon as possible.

Store the tire under the rear of thevehicle in the spare tire carrier.Refer to the following graphics andinstructions to help you:

A. Hoist Assembly

B. Hoist Shaft

C. Hoist Shaft Access Cover/Hole

D. Jack Handle Extensions

E. Wheel Wrench

F. Hoist Cable

G. Tire/Wheel Retainer

Page 412: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (72,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-72 Vehicle Care

H. Spare Tire/Flat Tire (Valve StemPointed Down)

I. Hoist Shaft Access Hole

J. Hoist End of Extension Tool

K. Spare Tire Lock

1. Put the tire (H) on the ground atthe rear of the vehicle with thevalve stem pointed down, and tothe rear.

2. Tilt the tire toward the vehicle.Separate the tire/wheel retainerfrom the guide pin. Pull the pinthrough the center of the wheel.Tilt the retainer down throughthe center wheel opening.

Make sure the retainer is fullyseated across the underside ofthe wheel.

3. Assemble the two jack handleextensions (D) and wheelwrench (E) as shown.

4. Insert the open end of theextension (J) through the hole inthe rear bumper (I) (hoist shaftaccess hole).

5. Raise the tire part way upward.Make sure the retainer is seatedin the wheel opening.

6. Raise the tire fully against theunderside of the vehicle byturning the wheel wrenchclockwise until you hear twoclicks or feel it skip twice. Thecable cannot be overtightened.

Page 413: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (73,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-73

7. Make sure the tire is storedsecurely. Push, pull (A), and thentry to turn (B) the tire. If the tiremoves, use the wheel wrench totighten the cable.

8. Reinstall the spare tire lock.

9. Reinstall the hoist shaft accesscover.

To store the tools, do the following:

A. Wheel Blocks

B. Tool Bag with Jack Tools

C. Retaining Bracket

D. Wing Nut Retaining Tool Bag

E. Jack

F. Wing Nut Retaining WheelBlocks

G. Jack Knob

1. Return the tools (wheel wrench,jack handle, and jack handleextensions) to the tool bag (B).

2. Assemble wheel blocks (A) andjack (E) together with thewing nut (F).

3. Position the jack (E) and wheelblocks (A) in the driver side trimpanel over the wheelhouse.

4. Turn the jack knob (G) clockwiseuntil the jack (E) is secured tightin the mounting bracket. Be sureto position the holes in the baseof the jack (E) onto the pin in themounting bracket.

5. Use the retaining bracket (C) tofasten the tool bag (B) on thestud and turn the wing nut (D)clockwise to secure.

Page 414: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (74,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-74 Vehicle Care

6. Return the storage tray to itsoriginal stored position.

Secondary Latch SystemThis vehicle has anunderbody-mounted tire hoistassembly equipped with asecondary latch system. It isdesigned to stop the spare tire fromsuddenly falling off your vehicle. Forthe secondary latch to work, thespare must be installed with thevalve stem pointing down.See “Storing a Flat or Spare Tireand Tools” under Tire Changing onpage 10‑64.

{ WARNING

Before beginning this procedureread all the instructions. Failure toread and follow the instructionscould damage the hoist assemblyand you and others could gethurt. Read and follow theinstructions listed next.

To release the spare tire from thesecondary latch:

1. Check under the vehicle to see ifthe cable end is visible. If thecable is not visible proceed toStep 6.

2. If it is visible, first try to tightenthe cable by turning the wheelwrench clockwise until you heartwo clicks or feel it skip twice.You cannot overtighten thecable.

Page 415: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (75,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-75

3. Loosen the cable by turning thewrench counterclockwise threeor four turns.

4. Repeat this procedure at leasttwo times. If the spare tirelowers to the ground, continuewith Step 5 under “Removing theSpare Tire and Tools” under TireChanging on page 10‑64.

5. If the spare does not lower, turnthe wrench counterclockwiseuntil approximately 15 cm (6 in)of cable is exposed.

6. Stand the wheel blocks on theirshortest ends, with the backsfacing each other.

A. Jack

B. Wheel Blocks

7. Place the bottom edge of thejack (A) on the wheel blocks (B),separating them so that the jackis balanced securely.

8. Attach the jack handle,extension, and wheel wrench tothe jack and place it (with thewheel blocks) under the vehicletoward the front of the rearbumper.

9. Position the center lift point ofthe jack under the center of thespare tire.

Page 416: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (76,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-76 Vehicle Care

10. Turn the wrench clockwise toraise the jack until it lifts theend fitting.

11. Continue raising the jack untilthe spare tire stops movingupward and is held firmly inplace. The secondary latch hasreleased and the spare tire isbalancing on the jack.

12. Lower the jack by turning thewheel wrenchcounterclockwise. Keeplowering the jack until thespare tire slides off the jack oris hanging by the cable.

{ WARNING

Someone standing too closeduring the procedure could beinjured by the jack. If the sparetire does not slide off the jackcompletely, make sure no one isbehind you or on either side ofyou as you pull the jack out fromunder the spare.

13. Disconnect the jack handlefrom the jack and carefullyremove the jack. Use one handto push against the spare whilefirmly pulling the jack out fromunder the spare tire with theother hand.

If the spare tire is hanging fromthe cable, insert the hoist endof extension, and wheelwrench into the hoist shaft holein the bumper and turn thewheel wrench counterclockwiseto lower the spare the rest ofthe way.

14. Turn the wheel wrench in thehoist shaft hole in the bumperclockwise to raise the cableback up if the cable is hangingunder the vehicle.

Have the hoist assembly inspectedas soon as you can. You will not beable to store a spare or flat tireusing the hoist assembly until it hasbeen inspected and/or replaced.

To continue changing the flat tire,see “Removing the Flat Tire andInstalling the Spare Tire” under TireChanging on page 10‑64.

Full-Size Spare TireYour vehicle, when new, had afully-inflated spare tire. A spare tiremay lose air over time, so check itsinflation pressure regularly. See TirePressure on page 10‑49 andVehicle Load Limits on page 9‑15for information regarding proper tireinflation and loading your vehicle.For instruction on how to remove,install or store a spare tire, see“Removing the Flat Tire andInstalling the Spare” and “Storing aFlat or Spare Tire and Tools” underTire Changing on page 10‑64.

Page 417: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (77,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-77

Notice: If the vehicle hasfour-wheel drive and a differentsize spare tire is installed, do notdrive in four-wheel drive until theflat tire is repaired and/orreplaced. The vehicle could bedamaged and the repairs wouldnot be covered by the warranty.Never use four-wheel drive whena different size spare tire isinstalled on the vehicle.

Your vehicle may have a differentsize spare tire than the road tiresoriginally installed on your vehicle.This spare tire was developed foruse on your vehicle, so it is all rightto drive on it. If your vehicle hasfour-wheel drive and the differentsize spare tire is installed, keep thevehicle in two-wheel drive.

After installing the spare tire on yourvehicle, you should stop as soon aspossible and make sure the sparetire is correctly inflated. Have thedamaged or flat road tire repaired orreplaced as soon as you can andinstalled back onto your vehicle.This way, the spare tire will beavailable in case you need it again.

Do not mix tires and wheels ofdifferent sizes, because they will notfit. Keep your spare tire and itswheel together. If your vehicle has aspare tire that does not match yourvehicle's original road tires andwheels in size and type, do notinclude the spare in the tire rotation.

Jump StartingFor more information about thevehicle battery, see Battery onpage 10‑24.

If the vehicle is a Hybrid, see theHybrid manual for more information.

If the vehicle's battery (or batteries)has run down, you may want to useanother vehicle and some jumpercables to start your vehicle. Be sureto use the following steps to do itsafely.

{ WARNING

Batteries can hurt you. They canbe dangerous because:

. They contain acid that canburn you.

. They contain gas that canexplode or ignite.

. They contain enoughelectricity to burn you.

(Continued)

Page 418: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (78,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-78 Vehicle Care

WARNING (Continued)

If you do not follow these stepsexactly, some or all of thesethings can hurt you.

Notice: Ignoring these stepscould result in costly damage tothe vehicle that would not becovered by the warranty.

Trying to start the vehicle bypushing or pulling it will notwork, and it could damage thevehicle.

1. Check the other vehicle. It musthave a 12-volt battery with anegative ground system.

Notice: Only use a vehicle thathas a 12-volt system with anegative ground for jumpstarting. If the other vehicle doesnot have a 12-volt system with anegative ground, both vehiclescan be damaged.

2. Get the vehicles close enoughso the jumper cables can reach,but be sure the vehicles are nottouching each other. If they are,it could cause a groundconnection you do not want. Youwould not be able to start yourvehicle, and the bad groundingcould damage the electricalsystems.

To avoid the possibility of thevehicles rolling, set the parkingbrake firmly on both vehiclesinvolved in the jump startprocedure. Put the automatictransmission in P (Park) or amanual transmission inN (Neutral) before setting theparking brake. If the vehicle hasa four-wheel-drive transfer casewith a N (Neutral) position, besure the transfer case is in adrive gear, not in N (Neutral).

Notice: If any accessories are lefton or plugged in during the jumpstarting procedure, they could bedamaged. The repairs would notbe covered by the vehicle

warranty. Whenever possible,turn off or unplug all accessorieson either vehicle when jumpstarting the vehicle.

3. Turn off the ignition on bothvehicles. Unplug unnecessaryaccessories plugged into theaccessory power outlets. Turnoff the radio and all the lampsthat are not needed. This avoidssparks and helps save bothbatteries. And it could save theradio!

4. Open the hood on the othervehicle and locate thepositive (+) and negative (−)terminal locations on thatvehicle.

Your vehicle has a remotepositive (+) jump startingterminal and a remotenegative (−) jump startingterminal. You should always usethese remote terminals insteadof the terminals on the battery.

Page 419: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (79,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-79

If the vehicle has a remotepositive (+) terminal, it is locatedunder a red plastic cover at thepositive battery post. To uncoverthe remote positive (+) terminal,open the red plastic cover.

The remote negative (−) terminalis a stud located on the rightfront of the engine, where thenegative battery cable attaches.

See Engine CompartmentOverview on page 10‑5 for moreinformation on the location of theremote positive (+) and remotenegative (−) terminals.

{ WARNING

An electric fan can start up evenwhen the engine is not runningand can injure you. Keep hands,clothing and tools away from anyunderhood electric fan.

{ WARNING

Using an open flame near abattery can cause battery gas toexplode. People have been hurtdoing this, and some have beenblinded. Use a flashlight if youneed more light.

Be sure the battery has enoughwater. You do not need to addwater to the battery installed inyour new vehicle. But if a batteryhas filler caps, be sure the rightamount of fluid is there. If it is low,

(Continued)

WARNING (Continued)

add water to take care of thatfirst. If you do not, explosive gascould be present.

Battery fluid contains acid thatcan burn you. Do not get it onyou. If you accidentally get it inyour eyes or on your skin, flushthe place with water and getmedical help immediately.

{ WARNING

Fans or other moving engineparts can injure you badly. Keepyour hands away from movingparts once the engine is running.

Page 420: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (80,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-80 Vehicle Care

5. Check that the jumper cables donot have loose or missinginsulation. If they do, you couldget a shock. The vehicles couldbe damaged too.

Before you connect the cables,here are some basic things youshould know. Positive (+) will goto positive (+) or to a remotepositive (+) terminal if the vehiclehas one. Negative (−) will go to aheavy, unpainted metal enginepart or to a remote negative (−)terminal if the vehicle has one.

Do not connect positive (+) tonegative (−) or you will get ashort that would damage thebattery and maybe other partstoo. And do not connect thenegative (−) cable to thenegative (−) terminal on the deadbattery because this can causesparks.

6. Connect the red positive (+)cable to the positive (+) terminalof the vehicle with the deadbattery. Use a remotepositive (+) terminal if the vehiclehas one.

7. Do not let the other end touchmetal. Connect it to thepositive (+) terminal of the goodbattery. Use a remotepositive (+) terminal if the vehiclehas one.

8. Now connect the blacknegative (−) cable to thenegative (−) terminal of the goodbattery. Use a remotenegative (−) terminal if thevehicle has one.

Do not let the other end touchanything until the next step. Theother end of the negative (−)cable does not go to the deadbattery. It goes to a heavy,unpainted metal engine part orto the remote negative (−)terminal on the vehicle with thedead battery.

9. Connect the other end of thenegative (−) cable to the remotenegative (−) terminal, on thevehicle with the dead battery.

10. Now start the vehicle with thegood battery and run theengine for a while.

11. Try to start the vehicle that hadthe dead battery. If it will notstart after a few tries, itprobably needs service.

Page 421: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (81,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-81

Notice: If the jumper cables areconnected or removed in thewrong order, electrical shortingmay occur and damage thevehicle. The repairs would not becovered by the vehicle warranty.Always connect and remove thejumper cables in the correctorder, making sure that thecables do not touch each other orother metal.

Jumper Cable Removal

A. Heavy, Unpainted Metal EnginePart or Remote Negative (−)Terminal

B. Good Battery or RemotePositive (+) and RemoteNegative (−) Terminals

C. Dead Battery or RemotePositive (+) Terminal

To disconnect the jumper cablesfrom both vehicles do the following:

1. Disconnect the blacknegative (−) cable from thevehicle that had the bad battery.

2. Disconnect the blacknegative (−) cable from thevehicle with the good battery.

3. Disconnect the red positive (+)cable from the vehicle with thegood battery.

4. Disconnect the red positive (+)cable from the other vehicle.

5. Return the remote positive (+)terminal cover, if the vehicle hasone, to its original position.

Page 422: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (82,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-82 Vehicle Care

Towing

Towing the VehicleNotice: Incorrectly towing adisabled vehicle may causedamage. The damage would notbe covered by the vehiclewarranty.

Have the vehicle towed on a flatbedcar carrier or a wheel lift tow truck.If a wheel lift tow truck is used, thedrive wheels cannot contact theroad while the vehicle is beingtowed. A wheel dolly must be usedto lift all drive wheels off the ground.

Consult your dealer or aprofessional towing service if thedisabled vehicle must be towed.

To tow the vehicle behind anothervehicle for recreational purposes,such as behind a motor home, see“Recreational Vehicle Towing” in thissection.

Recreational VehicleTowingIf the vehicle has a hybrid engine,see the hybrid manual for moreinformation.

Recreational vehicle towing meanstowing the vehicle behind anothervehicle – such as behind a motorhome. The two most common typesof recreational vehicle towing areknown as dinghy towing and dollytowing. Dinghy towing is towing thevehicle with all four wheels on theground. Dolly towing is towing thevehicle with two wheels on theground and two wheels up on adevice known as a dolly.

Here are some important things toconsider before recreational vehicletowing:. What is the towing capacity of

the towing vehicle? Be sure toread the tow vehiclemanufacturer'srecommendations.

. What is the distance that will betravelled? Some vehicles haverestrictions on how far and howlong they can tow.

. Is the proper towing equipmentgoing to be used? See yourdealer or trailering professionalfor additional advice andequipment recommendations.

. Is the vehicle ready to betowed? Just as preparing thevehicle for a long trip, make surethe vehicle is prepared to betowed.

Page 423: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (83,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-83

Dinghy Towing

Two-Wheel-Drive Vehicles andFour-Wheel Drive Vehicles with aSingle Speed AutomaticTransfer Case

Notice: If the vehicle is towedwith all four wheels on theground, the drivetraincomponents could be damaged.The repairs would not be coveredby the vehicle warranty. Do nottow the vehicle with all fourwheels on the ground.

Two-wheel-drive vehicles andfour-wheel drive vehicles with asingle speed automatic transfercase should not be towed with allfour wheels on the ground.Two-wheel-drive transmissions haveno provisions for internal lubricationwhile being towed. Four-wheel drivevehicles with a single speedautomatic transfer case have noneutral position and will spin thetransmission when the rearwheels turn.

Four-Wheel Drive Vehicles with aTwo Speed AutomaticTransfer Case

Use the following procedure todinghy tow a four-wheel drivevehicle with a two speed automatictransfer case:

1. Position the vehicle being towedbehind the tow vehicle and shiftthe transmission to P (Park).

2. Turn the engine off and firmly setthe parking brake.

3. Securely attach the vehiclebeing towed to the tow vehicle.

Page 424: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (84,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-84 Vehicle Care

{ WARNING

Shifting a four-wheel-drivevehicle's transfer case intoN (Neutral) can cause the vehicleto roll even if the transmission isin P (Park). The driver or otherscould be injured. Make sure theparking brake is firmly set beforethe transfer case is shifted toN (Neutral).

4. Shift the transfer case toN (Neutral). See SeeFour-Wheel Drive (Single SpeedAutomatic Transfer Case) onpage 9‑38 or Four-Wheel Drive(Two Speed Automatic TransferCase) on page 9‑33.

5. Release the parking brake onlyafter the vehicle being towed isfirmly attached to the towingvehicle.

6. Turn the ignition to LOCK/OFFand remove the key— thesteering wheel will still turn.

After towing, see “Shifting Out ofNeutral” under Four-Wheel Drive(Single Speed Automatic TransferCase) on page 9‑38 or Four-WheelDrive (Two Speed AutomaticTransfer Case) on page 9‑33 for theproper procedure to take the vehicleout of the Neutral position.

Dolly Towing – Front Towing(Front Wheels Off the Ground)

Two-Wheel-Drive Vehicles andFour-Wheel Drive Vehicles with aSingle Speed AutomaticTransfer Case

Notice: If a two-wheel drivevehicle or a four-wheel drivevehicle with a single speedautomatic transfer case is towedwith the rear wheels on theground, the transmission couldbe damaged. The repairs wouldnot be covered by the vehiclewarranty. Never tow the vehiclewith the rear wheels on theground.

Two-wheel-drive vehicles andfour-wheel drive vehicles with asingle speed automatic transfercase should not be towed with therear wheels on the ground.

Two-wheel-drive transmissions haveno provisions for internal lubricationwhile being towed. Four-wheel drivevehicles with a single speedautomatic transfer case have noneutral position and will spin thetransmission when the rearwheels turn.

To dolly tow a two‐wheel‐drivevehicle or a four-wheel drive vehiclewith a single speed automatic

Page 425: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (85,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-85

transfer case, the vehicle must betowed with the rear wheels on thedolly. See “Rear Towing (RearWheels Off the Ground)” later in thissection for more information.

Four-Wheel Drive Vehicles with aTwo Speed AutomaticTransfer Case

Use the following procedure to dollytow a four-wheel drive vehicle fromthe front:

1. Attach the dolly to the towvehicle following the dollymanufacturer's instructions.

2. Drive the front wheels onto thedolly.

3. Shift the transmission toP (Park).

4. Firmly set the parking brake.

{ WARNING

Shifting a four-wheel-drivevehicle's transfer case intoN (Neutral) can cause the vehicleto roll even if the transmission isin P (Park). The driver or otherscould be injured. Make sure theparking brake is firmly set beforethe transfer case is shifted toN (Neutral).

5. Use an adequate clampingdevice designed for towing toensure that the front wheels arelocked into the straight position.

6. Shift the transfer case toN (Neutral). See Four-WheelDrive (Single Speed AutomaticTransfer Case) on page 9‑38 orFour-Wheel Drive (Two SpeedAutomatic Transfer Case) onpage 9‑33.

7. Secure the vehicle to the dollyfollowing the manufacturer'sinstructions.

8. Release the parking brake onlyafter the vehicle being towed isfirmly attached to the towingvehicle.

9. Turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF.

After towing, see “Shifting Out ofN (Neutral)” under Four-Wheel Drive(Single Speed Automatic TransferCase) on page 9‑38 or Four-WheelDrive (Two Speed AutomaticTransfer Case) on page 9‑33.

Page 426: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (86,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-86 Vehicle Care

Rear Towing (Rear Wheels Offthe Ground)

Two-Wheel-Drive Vehicles andFour-Wheel Drive Vehicles with aSingle Speed AutomaticTransfer Case

Use the following procedure to dollytow the vehicle from the rear:

1. Attach the dolly to the towvehicle following the dollymanufacturer's instructions.

2. Drive the rear wheels onto thedolly.

3. Firmly set the parking brake.See Parking Brake onpage 9‑41.

4. Put the transmission in P (Park).

5. Secure the vehicle to the dollyfollowing the manufacturer'sinstructions.

6. Use an adequate clampingdevice designed for towing toensure that the front wheels arelocked into the straight position.

7. For four-wheel drive vehicleswith a single speed automatictransfer case, shift the transfercase into Two-Wheel Drive High.See Four-Wheel Drive (SingleSpeed Automatic Transfer Case)on page 9‑38 or Four-WheelDrive (Two Speed AutomaticTransfer Case) on page 9‑33.

8. Turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF.

Four-Wheel Drive Vehicles with aTwo Speed AutomaticTransfer Case

Use the following procedure to dollytow a four-wheel drive vehicle fromthe rear:

1. Attach the dolly to the towvehicle following the dollymanufacturer's instructions.

2. Drive the rear wheels onto thedolly.

3. Firmly set the parking brake.See Parking Brake onpage 9‑41.

4. Put the transmission in P (Park).

5. Secure the vehicle to the dollyfollowing the manufacturer'sinstructions.

6. Use an adequate clampingdevice designed for towing toensure that the front wheels arelocked into the straight position.

Page 427: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (87,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-87

{ WARNING

Shifting a four-wheel-drivevehicle's transfer case intoN (Neutral) can cause the vehicleto roll even if the transmission isin P (Park). The driver or otherscould be injured. Make sure theparking brake is firmly set beforethe transfer case is shifted toN (Neutral).

7. Shift the transfer case toN (Neutral). See Four-WheelDrive (Single Speed AutomaticTransfer Case) on page 9‑38 orFour-Wheel Drive (Two SpeedAutomatic Transfer Case) onpage 9‑33.

8. Turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF.

After towing, see “Shifting Out ofN (Neutral)” under Four-Wheel Drive(Single Speed Automatic TransferCase) on page 9‑38 or Four-WheelDrive (Two Speed AutomaticTransfer Case) on page 9‑33.

Appearance Care

Exterior Care

Washing the Vehicle

To preserve the vehicle's finish,wash it often and out of directsunlight.

Notice: Do not usepetroleum-based, acidic,or abrasive cleaning agents asthey can damage the vehicle'spaint, metal, or plastic parts.If damage occurs, it would not becovered by the vehicle's warranty.Approved cleaning products canbe obtained from your dealer.Follow all manufacturerdirections regarding correctproduct usage, necessary safetyprecautions, and appropriatedisposal of any vehicle careproduct.

Notice: Avoid usinghigh-pressure washes closer than30 cm (12 in) to the surface of thevehicle. Use of power washers

exceeding 8,274 kPa (1,200 psi)can result in damage or removalof paint and decals.

Rinse the vehicle well, beforewashing and after, to remove allcleaning agents completely. If theyare allowed to dry on the surface,they could stain.

Dry the finish with a soft, cleanchamois or an all-cotton towel toavoid surface scratches and waterspotting.

Finish Care

Application of aftermarket clearcoatsealant/wax materials is notrecommended. If painted surfacesare damaged, see your dealer tohave the damage assessed andrepaired. Foreign materials such ascalcium chloride and other salts, icemelting agents, road oil and tar, treesap, bird droppings, chemicals fromindustrial chimneys, etc., candamage the vehicle's finish if theyremain on painted surfaces. Washthe vehicle as soon as possible.If necessary, use non-abrasive

Page 428: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (88,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-88 Vehicle Care

cleaners that are marked safe forpainted surfaces to remove foreignmatter.

Occasional hand waxing or mildpolishing should be done to removeresidue from the paint finish. Seeyour dealer for approved cleaningproducts.

Do not apply waxes or polishes touncoated plastic, vinyl, rubber,decals, simulated wood, or flat paintas damage can occur.

Notice: Machine compounding oraggressive polishing on abasecoat/clearcoat paint finishmay damage it. Use onlynon-abrasive waxes and polishesthat are made for a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish on thevehicle.

To keep the paint finish looking new,keep the vehicle garaged orcovered whenever possible.

Protecting Exterior Bright MetalParts

Regularly clean bright metal partswith water or chrome polish onchrome or stainless steel trim,if necessary.

For aluminum, never use auto orchrome polish, steam, or causticsoap to clean. A coating of wax,rubbed to a high polish, isrecommended for all bright metalparts.

Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses and Emblems

Use only lukewarm or cold water, asoft cloth, and a car washing soapto clean exterior lamps, lenses andemblems. Follow instructions under"Washing the Vehicle" in thissection.

Windshield and Wiper Blades

Clean the outside of the windshieldwith glass cleaner.

Clean rubber blades using a lint-freecloth or paper towel soaked withwindshield washer fluid or a milddetergent. Wash the windshieldthoroughly when cleaning theblades. Bugs, road grime, sap, anda buildup of vehicle wash/waxtreatments may cause wiperstreaking.

Replace the wiper blades if they areworn or damaged. Damage can becaused by extreme dustyconditions, sand, salt, heat, sun,snow, and ice.

Weatherstrips

Apply silicone grease onweatherstrips to make them lastlonger, seal better, and not stick orsqueak. Lubricate weatherstripsonce a year. Black marks fromrubber material on painted surfacescan be removed by rubbing with aclean cloth. See RecommendedFluids and Lubricants onpage 11‑12.

Page 429: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (89,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-89

Tires

Use a stiff brush with tire cleaner toclean the tires.

Notice: Using petroleum-basedtire dressing products on thevehicle may damage the paintfinish and/or tires. When applyinga tire dressing, always wipe offany overspray from all paintedsurfaces on the vehicle.

Wheels and Trim—Aluminumor Chrome

Use a soft, clean cloth with mildsoap and water to clean the wheels.After rinsing thoroughly with cleanwater, dry with a soft, clean towel.A wax may then be applied.

Notice: Chrome wheels and otherchrome trim may be damaged ifthe vehicle is not washed afterdriving on roads that have beensprayed with magnesium,calcium, or sodium chloride.These chlorides are used onroads for conditions such as ice

and dust. Always wash thechrome with soap and water afterexposure.

Notice: To avoid surface damage,do not use strong soaps,chemicals, abrasive polishes,cleaners, brushes, or cleanersthat contain acid on aluminum orchrome-plated wheels. Use onlyapproved cleaners. Also, neverdrive a vehicle with aluminum orchrome-plated wheels through anautomatic car wash that usessilicone carbide tire cleaningbrushes. Damage could occurand the repairs would not becovered by the vehicle warranty.

Steering, Suspension, andChassis Components

Visually inspect the front and rearsuspension and steering system fordamaged, loose, or missing parts orsigns of wear. Inspect the powersteering for proper hook-up, binding,leaks, cracks, chafing, etc. Visually

check constant velocity joints,rubber boots, and axle seals forleaks.

Body Component Lubrication

Lubricate all key lock cylinders,hood hinges, liftgate hinges, and thesteel fuel door hinge unless thecomponents are plastic. Applyingsilicone grease on weatherstripswith a clean cloth will make themlast longer, seal better, and not stickor squeak.

Underbody Maintenance

Use plain water to flush dirt anddebris from the vehicle's underbody.Your dealer or an underbody carwashing system can do this. If notremoved, rust and corrosion candevelop.

Sheet Metal Damage

If the vehicle is damaged andrequires sheet metal repair orreplacement, make sure the bodyrepair shop applies anti-corrosion

Page 430: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (90,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-90 Vehicle Care

material to parts repaired orreplaced to restore corrosionprotection.

Original manufacturer replacementparts will provide the corrosionprotection while maintaining thevehicle warranty.

Finish Damage

Quickly repair minor chips andscratches with touch-up materialsavailable from your dealer to avoidcorrosion. Larger areas of finishdamage can be corrected in yourdealer's body and paint shop.

Chemical Paint Spotting

Airborne pollutants can fall uponand attack painted vehicle surfacescausing blotchy, ring-shapeddiscolorations, and small, irregulardark spots etched into the paintsurface.

Interior CareTo prevent dirt particle abrasions,regularly clean the vehicle's interior.Immediately remove any soils. Notethat newspapers or dark garmentsthat can transfer color to homefurnishings can also permanentlytransfer color to the vehicle'sinterior.

Use a soft bristle brush to removedust from knobs and crevices on theinstrument cluster. Using a mildsoap solution, immediately removehand lotions, sunscreen, and insectrepellent from all interior surfaces orpermanent damage may result.

Your dealer may have products forcleaning the interior. Use cleanersspecifically designed for thesurfaces being cleaned to preventpermanent damage. Apply allcleaners directly to the cleaningcloth. Do not spray cleaners directlyon any switches or controls.Cleaners should be removedquickly. Never allow cleaners to

remain on the surface beingcleaned for extended periodsof time.

Cleaners may contain solvents thatcan become concentrated in theinterior. Before using cleaners, readand adhere to all safety instructionson the label. While cleaning theinterior, maintain adequateventilation by opening the doors andwindows.

To prevent damage, do not cleanthe interior using the followingcleaners or techniques:. Never use a razor or any other

sharp object to remove a soilfrom any interior surface.

. Never use a brush with stiffbristles.

. Never rub any surfaceaggressively or with excessivepressure.

Page 431: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (91,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-91

. Do not use laundry detergents ordishwashing soaps withdegreasers. For liquid cleaners,use approximately 20 drops per3.78 L (1 gal) of water.A concentrated soap solution willleave a residue that createsstreaks and attracts dirt. Do notuse solutions that contain strongor caustic soap.

. Do not heavily saturate theupholstery when cleaning.

. Do not use solvents or cleanerscontaining solvents.

Interior Glass

To clean, use a terry cloth fabricdampened with water. Wipe dropletsleft behind with a clean dry cloth.Commercial glass cleaners may beused, if necessary, after cleaningthe interior glass with plain water.

Notice: To prevent scratching,never use abrasive cleaners onautomotive glass. Abrasive

cleaners or aggressive cleaningmay damage the rear windowdefogger.

Notice: Cleaning the windshieldwith water during the first three tosix months of ownership willreduce tendency to fog.

Speaker Covers

Vacuum around a speaker covergently, so that the speaker will notbe damaged. Clean spots with justwater and mild soap.

Coated Moldings

Coated moldings should be cleaned.. When lightly soiled, wipe with a

sponge or soft lint-free clothdampened with water.

. When heavily soiled, use warmsoapy water.

Fabric/Carpet/Suede

Start by vacuuming the surfaceusing a soft brush attachment. If arotating brush attachment is beingused during vacuuming, only use iton the floor carpet. Before cleaning,gently remove as much of the soilas possible using one of thefollowing techniques:. Gently blot liquids with a paper

towel. Continue blotting until nomore soil can be removed.

. For solid soils, remove as muchas possible prior to vacuuming.

To clean:

1. Saturate a clean lint-freecolorfast cloth with water or clubsoda. Microfiber cloth isrecommended to prevent linttransfer to the fabric or carpet.

2. Remove excess moisture bygently wringing until water doesnot drip from the cleaning cloth.

Page 432: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (92,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-92 Vehicle Care

3. Start on the outside edge of thesoil and gently rub toward thecenter. Fold the cleaning cloth toa clean area frequently toprevent forcing the soil in to thefabric.

4. Continue gently rubbing thesoiled area until there is nolonger any color transfer fromthe soil to the cleaning cloth.

5. If the soil is not completelyremoved, use a mild soapsolution followed only by clubsoda or plain water.

If the soil is not completelyremoved, it may be necessary touse a commercial upholsterycleaner or spot lifter. Test a smallhidden area for colorfastness beforeusing a commercial upholsterycleaner or spot lifter. If ringformation occurs, clean the entirefabric or carpet.

Following the cleaning process, apaper towel can be used to blotexcess moisture.

Cleaning High Gloss Surfacesand Vehicle Information andRadio Displays

For vehicles with high glosssurfaces or vehicle displays, use amicrofiber cloth to wipe surfaces.Before wiping the surface with themicrofiber cloth, use a soft bristlebrush to remove dirt that couldscratch the surface. Then use themicrofiber cloth by gently rubbing toclean. Never use window cleanersor solvents. Periodically hand washthe microfiber cloth separately,using mild soap. Do not use bleachor fabric softener. Rinse thoroughlyand air dry before next use.

Notice: Do not attach a devicewith a suction cup to the display.This may cause damage andwould not be covered by thewarranty.

Instrument Panel, Leather,Vinyl, & Other Plastic Surfaces

Use a soft microfiber clothdampened with water to removedust and loose dirt. For a morethorough cleaning, use a softmicrofiber cloth dampened with amild soap solution.

Notice: Soaking or saturatingleather, especially perforatedleather, as well as other interiorsurfaces, may cause permanentdamage. Wipe excess moisturefrom these surfaces aftercleaning and allow them to drynaturally. Never use heat, steam,spot lifters, or spot removers. Donot use cleaners that containsilicone or wax-based products.Cleaners containing thesesolvents can permanently changethe appearance and feel of leatheror soft trim and are notrecommended.

Page 433: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (93,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Vehicle Care 10-93

Do not use cleaners that increasegloss, especially on the instrumentpanel. Reflected glare can decreasevisibility through the windshieldunder certain conditions.

Notice: Use of air fresheners maycause permanent damage toplastics and painted surfaces.If an air freshener comes incontact with any plastic orpainted surface in the vehicle,blot immediately and clean with asoft cloth dampened with a mildsoap solution. Damage caused byair fresheners would not becovered by the vehicle warranty.

Cargo Cover andConvenience Net

Wash with warm water and milddetergent. Do not use chlorinebleach. Rinse with cold water, andthen dry completely.

Care of Safety Belts

Keep belts clean and dry.

{ WARNING

Do not bleach or dye safety belts.It may severely weaken them. Ina crash, they might not be able toprovide adequate protection.Clean safety belts only with mildsoap and lukewarm water.

Floor Mats

{ WARNING

If a floor mat is the wrong size oris not properly installed, it caninterfere with the pedals.Interference with the pedals cancause unintended accelerationand/or increased stoppingdistance which can cause a crashand injury. Make sure the floormat does not interfere with thepedals.

Use the following guidelines forproper floor mat usage.. The original equipment floor

mats were designed for thevehicle. If the floor mats needreplacing, it is recommendedthat GM certified floor mats bepurchased. Non-GM floor matsmay not fit properly and mayinterfere with the pedals. Alwayscheck that the floor mats do notinterfere with the pedals.

. Use the floor mat with thecorrect side up. Do not turnit over.

. Do not place anything on top ofthe driver side floor mat.

. Use only a single floor mat onthe driver side.

. Do not place one floor mat ontop of another.

Page 434: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (94,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

10-94 Vehicle Care

2 NOTES

Page 435: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Service and Maintenance 11-1

Service andMaintenance

General InformationGeneral Information . . . . . . . . . . 11-1

Maintenance ScheduleMaintenance Schedule . . . . . . . 11-2

Special Application ServicesSpecial ApplicationServices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8

Additional Maintenanceand CareAdditional Maintenanceand Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8

Recommended Fluids,Lubricants, and PartsRecommended Fluids andLubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12

Maintenance ReplacementParts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-14

Maintenance RecordsMaintenance Records . . . . . . 11-15

General InformationYour vehicle is an importantinvestment. This section describesthe required maintenance for thevehicle. Follow this schedule to helpprotect against major repairexpenses resulting from neglect orinadequate maintenance. It mayalso help to maintain the value ofthe vehicle if it is sold. It is theresponsibility of the owner to haveall required maintenance performed.

Your dealer has trained technicianswho can perform requiredmaintenance using genuinereplacement parts. They have up‐to‐date tools and equipment for fastand accurate diagnostics. Manydealers have extended evening andSaturday hours, courtesytransportation, and onlinescheduling to assist with serviceneeds.

Your dealer recognizes theimportance of providingcompetitively priced maintenanceand repair services. With trained

technicians, the dealer is the placefor routine maintenance such as oilchanges and tire rotations andadditional maintenance items liketires, brakes, batteries, and wiperblades.

Notice: Damage caused byimproper maintenance can lead tocostly repairs and may not becovered by the vehicle warranty.Maintenance intervals, checks,inspections, recommended fluids,and lubricants are important tokeep the vehicle in good workingcondition.

The Tire Rotation and RequiredServices are the responsibility of thevehicle owner. It is recommended tohave your dealer perform theseservices every 12 000 km/7,500 mi.Proper vehicle maintenance helps tokeep the vehicle in good workingcondition, improves fuel economy,and reduces vehicle emissions.

Page 436: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

11-2 Service and Maintenance

Because of the way people usevehicles, maintenance needs vary.There may need to be morefrequent checks and services. TheAdditional Required Services ‐Normal are for vehicles that:. Carry passengers and cargo

within recommended limits onthe Tire and Loading Informationlabel. See Vehicle Load Limitson page 9‑15.

. Are driven on reasonable roadsurfaces within legal drivinglimits.

. Use the recommended fuel. SeeRecommended Fuel onpage 9‑56.

Refer to the information in theMaintenance Schedule AdditionalRequired Services ‐ Normal chart.

The Additional Required Services ‐Severe are for vehicles that are:. Mainly driven in heavy city traffic

in hot weather.. Mainly driven in hilly or

mountainous terrain.

. Frequently towing a trailer.

. Used for high speed orcompetitive driving.

. Used for taxi, police, or deliveryservice.

Refer to the information in theMaintenance Schedule AdditionalRequired Services ‐ Severe chart.

{ WARNING

Performing maintenance work canbe dangerous and can causeserious injury. Performmaintenance work only if therequired information, proper tools,and equipment are available.If they are not, see your dealer tohave a trained technician do thework. See Doing Your OwnService Work on page 10‑3.

MaintenanceScheduleOwner Checks and Services

At Each Fuel Stop. Check the engine oil level. See

Engine Oil on page 10‑6.

Once a Month. Check the tire inflation

pressures. See Tire Pressure onpage 10‑49.

. Inspect the tires for wear. SeeTire Inspection on page 10‑54.

. Check the windshield washerfluid level. See Washer Fluid onpage 10‑21.

Engine Oil Change

When the CHANGE ENGINE OILSOON message displays, have theengine oil and filter changed withinthe next 1 000 km/600 mi. If drivenunder the best conditions, theengine oil life system might notindicate the need for vehicle service

Page 437: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Service and Maintenance 11-3

for more than a year. The engine oiland filter must be changed at leastonce a year and the oil life systemmust be reset. Your trained dealertechnician can perform this work.If the engine oil life system is resetaccidentally, service the vehiclewithin 5 000 km/3,000 mi since thelast service. Reset the oil lifesystem when the oil is changed.See Engine Oil Life System onpage 10‑9.

Tire Rotation and RequiredServices Every 12 000 km/7,500 mi

Rotate the tires, if recommended forthe vehicle, and perform thefollowing services. See TireRotation on page 10‑54.. Check engine oil level and oil

life percentage. If needed,change engine oil and filter, andreset oil life system. See EngineOil on page 10‑6 and Engine OilLife System on page 10‑9.

. Check engine coolant level. SeeEngine Coolant on page 10‑15.

. Check windshield washer fluidlevel. See Washer Fluid onpage 10‑21.

. Visually inspect windshield wiperblades for wear, cracking,or contamination. See ExteriorCare on page 10‑87. Replaceworn or damaged wiper blades.See Wiper Blade Replacementon page 10‑29.

. Check tire inflation pressures.See Tire Pressure onpage 10‑49.

. Inspect tire wear. See TireInspection on page 10‑54.

. Visually check for fluid leaks.

. Inspect engine air cleaner filter.See Engine Air Cleaner/Filter onpage 10‑13.

. Inspect brake system.

. Visually inspect steering,suspension, and chassiscomponents for damaged, loose,

or missing parts or signs ofwear. See Exterior Care onpage 10‑87.

. Check restraint systemcomponents. See Safety SystemCheck on page 3‑25.

. Visually inspect fuel system fordamage or leaks.

. Visually inspect exhaust systemand nearby heat shields forloose or damaged parts.

. Lubricate body components. SeeExterior Care on page 10‑87.

. Check starter switch. See StarterSwitch Check on page 10‑27.

. Check automatic transmissionshift lock control function. SeeAutomatic Transmission ShiftLock Control Function Check onpage 10‑28.

. Check ignition transmission lock.See Ignition Transmission LockCheck on page 10‑28.

Page 438: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

11-4 Service and Maintenance

. Check parking brake andautomatic transmission parkmechanism. See Park Brake andP (Park) Mechanism Check onpage 10‑28.

. Check accelerator pedal fordamage, high effort, or binding.Replace if needed.

. Visually inspect gas strut forsigns of wear, cracks, or otherdamage. Check the hold openability of the strut. See yourdealer if service is required.

. Inspect sunroof track and seal,if equipped. See Sunroof onpage 2‑22.

. Check hybrid low pressurecoolant level, if equipped.

. Verify spare tire key lockoperation and lubricate asneeded. See Tire Changing onpage 10‑64.

Page 439: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Service and Maintenance 11-5

Page 440: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

11-6 Service and Maintenance

Footnotes — MaintenanceSchedule Additional RequiredServices — Normal

(1) Check all fuel and vapor linesand hoses for proper hook-up,routing, and condition. Check thatthe purge valve, if the vehicle hasone, works properly. Replace asneeded.

(2) Or every four years, whichevercomes first.

(3) Do not directly power wash thetransfer case output seals. Highpressure water can overcome theseals and contaminate the transfercase fluid. Contaminated fluid willdecrease the life of the transfercase and should be replaced.

(4) Or every five years, whichevercomes first. See Cooling System onpage 10‑14.

(5) Or every 10 years, whichevercomes first.

(6) Inspect for fraying, excessivecracking, or damage; replace,if needed.

Page 441: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Service and Maintenance 11-7

Page 442: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

11-8 Service and Maintenance

Footnotes — MaintenanceSchedule Additional RequiredServices — Severe

(1) Check all fuel and vapor linesand hoses for proper hook-up,routing, and condition. Check thatthe purge valve, if the vehicle hasone, works properly. Replace asneeded.

(2) Or every four years, whichevercomes first.

(3) Do not directly power wash thetransfer case output seals. Highpressure water can overcome theseals and contaminate the transfercase fluid. Contaminated fluid willdecrease the life of the transfercase and should be replaced.

(4) Or every five years, whichevercomes first. See Cooling System onpage 10‑14.

(5) Or every 10 years, whichevercomes first.

(6) Inspect for fraying, excessivecracking, or damage; replace,if needed.

Special ApplicationServices. Severe Commercial Use

Vehicles Only: Lubricate chassiscomponents every 5 000 km/3,000 mi.

. Have underbody flushing serviceperformed once a year.

AdditionalMaintenance and CareYour vehicle is an importantinvestment and caring for it properlymay help to avoid future costlyrepairs. To maintain vehicleperformance, additionalmaintenance services may berequired. It is recommended thatyour dealer perform these services— their trained dealer techniciansknow your vehicle best. Your dealercan also perform a thoroughassessment with a multi‐pointinspection to recommend when yourvehicle may need attention. Thefollowing list is intended to explainthe services and conditions to lookfor that may indicate services arerequired.

Page 443: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Service and Maintenance 11-9

Battery

The battery supplies power to startthe engine and operate anyadditional electrical accessories.. To avoid break‐down or failure to

start the vehicle, maintain abattery with full cranking power.

. Trained dealer technicians havethe diagnostic equipment to testthe battery and ensure that theconnections and cables arecorrosion‐free.

Belts. Belts may need replacing if they

squeak or show signs ofcracking or splitting.

. Trained dealer technicians caninspect the belts andrecommend replacement whennecessary.

Brakes

Brakes stop the vehicle and arecrucial to safe driving.. Signs of brake wear may include

chirping, grinding, or squealingnoises, or difficulty stopping.

. Trained dealer technicians haveaccess to tools and equipmentto inspect the brakes andrecommend quality partsengineered for the vehicle.

Fluids

Proper fluid levels and approvedfluids protect the vehicle’s systemsand components. SeeRecommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12 for GMapproved fluids.. Engine oil and windshield

washer fluid levels should bechecked at every fuel fill.

. Instrument cluster lights maycome on to indicate that fluidsmay be low and need to befilled.

Hoses

Hoses transport fluids and shouldbe regularly inspected to ensurethat there are no cracks or leaks.With a multi‐point inspection, yourdealer can inspect the hoses andadvise if replacement is needed.

Lamps

Properly working headlamps,taillamps, and brake lamps areimportant to see and be seen onthe road.. Signs that the headlamps need

attention include dimming, failureto light, cracking, or damage.The brake lamps need to bechecked periodically to ensurethat they light when braking.

. With a multi‐point inspection,your dealer can check the lampsand note any concerns.

Page 444: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

11-10 Service and Maintenance

Shocks and Struts

Shocks and struts help aid in controlfor a smoother ride.. Signs of wear may include

steering wheel vibration, bounce/sway while braking, longerstopping distance, or uneventire wear.

. As part of the multi‐pointinspection, trained dealertechnicians can visually inspectthe shocks and struts for signsof leaking, blown seals,or damage, and can advisewhen service is needed.

Tires

Tires need to be properly inflated,rotated, and balanced. Maintainingthe tires can save money, fuel, andcan reduce the risk of tire failure.. Signs that the tires need to be

replaced include three or morevisible treadwear indicators; cordor fabric showing through therubber; cracks or cuts in thetread or sidewall; or a bulge orsplit in the tire.

. Trained dealer technicians caninspect and recommend the righttires. Your dealer can alsoprovide tire/wheel balancingservices to ensure smoothvehicle operation at all speeds.Your dealer sells and servicesname brand tires.

Vehicle Care

To help keep the vehicle looking likenew, vehicle care products areavailable from your dealer. Forinformation on how to clean andprotect the vehicle’s interior andexterior, see Interior Care onpage 10‑90 and Exterior Care onpage 10‑87.

Wheel Alignment

Wheel alignment is critical forensuring that the tires deliveroptimal wear and performance.. Signs that the alignment may

need to be adjusted includepulling, improper vehiclehandling, or unusual tire wear.

. Your dealer has the requiredequipment to ensure properwheel alignment.

Page 445: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Service and Maintenance 11-11

Windshield

For safety, appearance, and thebest viewing, keep the windshieldclean and clear.. Signs of damage include

scratches, cracks, and chips.. Trained dealer technicians can

inspect the windshield andrecommend proper replacementif needed.

Wiper Blades

Wiper blades need to be cleanedand kept in good condition toprovide a clear view.. Signs of wear include streaking,

skipping across the windshield,and worn or split rubber.

. Trained dealer technicians cancheck the wiper blades andreplace them when needed.

Page 446: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

11-12 Service and Maintenance

Recommended Fluids, Lubricants, and Parts

Recommended Fluids and LubricantsFluids and lubricants identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your dealer.

Usage Fluid/Lubricant

Engine Oil Use only engine oil licensed to the dexos1 specfication, or equivalent, ofthe proper SAE viscosity grade. ACDelco dexos1 Synthetic Blend isrecommended. See Engine Oil on page 10‑6.

Engine Coolant 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and use only DEX-COOL Coolant.See Engine Coolant on page 10‑15.

Hydraulic Brake System DOT 3 Hydraulic Brake Fluid (GM Part No. 12377967, inCanada 89021320).

Windshield Washer Automotive windshield washer fluid that meets regional freeze protectionrequirements.

Power Steering System GM Power Steering Fluid (GM Part No. 89021184, in Canada 89021186).

Automatic Transmission DEXRON®-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid.

Key Lock Cylinders Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube (GM Part No. 12346241, inCanada 10953474).

Chassis Lubrication Chassis Lubricant (GM Part No. 12377985, in Canada 88901242) orlubricant meeting requirements of NLGI #2, Category LB or GC-LB.

Page 447: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Service and Maintenance 11-13

Usage Fluid/Lubricant

Front Axle (1500 Series Vehicles withFour-Wheel Drive)

SAE 80W-90 Axle Lubricant (GM Part No. 89021671, inCanada 89021672).

Front Axle (2500 Series Vehicles withFour-Wheel Drive)

SAE 75W-90 Synthetic Axle Lubricant (GM Part No. 89021677, inCanada 89021678).

Rear Axle SAE 75W-90 Synthetic Axle Lubricant (GM Part No. 89021677, inCanada 89021678).

Transfer Case (Four-Wheel Drive) DEXRON®-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid.

Front Axle Propshaft Spline orOne-Piece Propshaft Spline

(Two-Wheel Drive with Auto. Trans.)

Spline Lubricant, Special Lubricant (GM Part No. 12345879, inCanada 10953511).

Hood Hinges Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube (GM Part No. 12346241, inCanada 10953474).

Outer Tailgate Handle Pivot Points Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube (GM Part No. 12346241, inCanada 10953474).

Weatherstrip Conditioning Weatherstrip Lubricant (GM Part No. 3634770, in Canada 10953518) orDielectric Silicone Grease (GM Part No. 12345579, in Canada 10953481).

Weatherstrip Squeaks Synthetic Grease with Teflon, Superlube (GM Part No. 12371287, inCanada 10953437).

Page 448: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

11-14 Service and Maintenance

Maintenance Replacement PartsReplacement parts identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your dealer.

Maintenance Replacement Parts

Part GM Part Number ACDelco Part Number

Engine Air Cleaner/Filter

Standard Filter 15908916* A3086C*

High Capacity Filter 15908915 A3085C

Oil Filter 89017524 PF48

Spark Plugs 12621258 41-110

Wiper Blades

Front – 55.0 cm (21.6 in) 25877402 —

Rear – 30.0 cm (11.8 in) 25820122 —

*15908915 (A3085C) high-capacity air cleaner filter may be substituted.

Page 449: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (15,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Service and Maintenance 11-15

Maintenance RecordsAfter the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and thetype of services performed in the boxes provided. Retain all maintenance receipts.

DateOdometerReading

Serviced By Services Performed

Page 450: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (16,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

11-16 Service and Maintenance

DateOdometerReading

Serviced By Services Performed

Page 451: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Technical Data 12-1

Technical Data

Vehicle IdentificationVehicle IdentificationNumber (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1

Service Parts IdentificationLabel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1

Vehicle DataCapacities andSpecifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2

Engine Drive Belt Routing . . . 12-4

Vehicle Identification

Vehicle IdentificationNumber (VIN)

This legal identifier is in the frontcorner of the instrument panel, onthe left side of the vehicle. It can beseen through the windshield fromoutside. The VIN also appears onthe Vehicle Certification and ServiceParts labels and certificates of titleand registration.

Engine Identification

The eighth character in the VIN isthe engine code. This codeidentifies the vehicle's engine,specifications, and replacementparts. See “Engine Specifications”under Capacities and Specificationson page 12‑2 for the vehicle'sengine code.

Service PartsIdentification LabelThis label, on the inside of the glovebox, has the following information:. Vehicle Identification

Number (VIN).. Model designation.. Paint information.. Production options and special

equipment.

Do not remove this label from thevehicle.

Page 452: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

12-2 Technical Data

Vehicle Data

Capacities and SpecificationsIf your vehicle is a Hybrid, see the Hybrid manual for more information.

The following approximate capacities are given in metric and English conversions. See Recommended Fluids andLubricants on page 11‑12 for more information.

ApplicationCapacities

Metric English

Air Conditioning Refrigerant For the air conditioning system refrigerant type andcharge amount, see the refrigerant label under the

hood. See your dealer for more information.

Cooling System

5.3L V8 17.3 L 18.3 qt

6.0L V8 16.5 L 17.4 qt

Engine Oil with Filter 5.7 L 6.0 qt

Fuel Tank

Regular 98.4 L 26.0 gal

Extended 1500 Series 119.2 L 31.5 gal

Extended 2500 Series 147.6 L 39.0 gal

Page 453: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Technical Data 12-3

ApplicationCapacities

Metric English

Transmission Fluid (Pan Removal and Filter Replacement)

6L80-E Transmission 5.7 L 6.0 qt

6L90-E Transmission 6.0 L 6.3 qt

Transfer Case Fluid 1.5 L 1.6 qt

Wheel Nut Torque 190Y 140 lb ft

All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level, as recommended in thismanual. Recheck fluid level after filling.

Engine Specifications

Engine VIN Code Spark Plug Gap

5.3L V8 FlexFuel with Active Fuel Management™ (IronBlock) (LMG)

0 1.02mm (0.040 in)

5.3L V8 FlexFuel with Active Fuel Management™(AluminumBlock) (LC9)

7 1.02mm (0.040 in)

6.0L V8 (Iron Block) (L96) G 1.02 mm (0.040 in)

Page 454: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

12-4 Technical Data

Engine Drive Belt Routing

If the vehicle is a hybrid, see thehybrid supplement for moreinformation.

Page 455: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-1

CustomerInformation

Customer InformationCustomer SatisfactionProcedure (U.S. andCanada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2

Customer SatisfactionProcedure (Mexico) . . . . . . . . 13-4

Customer Assistance Offices(U.S. and Canada) . . . . . . . . . 13-5

Customer Assistance Offices(Mexico) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5

Customer Assistance for TextTelephone (TTY) Users (U.S.and Canada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6

Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . 13-6GM Mobility ReimbursementProgram (U.S. andCanada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7

Roadside Assistance Program(Mexico) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7

Roadside AssistanceProgram (U.S. andCanada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11

Scheduling ServiceAppointments (U.S. andCanada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-12

Courtesy TransportationProgram (U.S. andCanada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13

Collision Damage Repair(U.S. and Canada) . . . . . . . . 13-14

Service PublicationsOrdering Information . . . . . . 13-16

Reporting Safety DefectsReporting Safety Defects tothe United StatesGovernment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-17

Reporting Safety Defects tothe CanadianGovernment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-18

Reporting Safety Defects toGeneral Motors . . . . . . . . . . . 13-18

Vehicle Data Recording andPrivacyVehicle Data Recording andPrivacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-19

Event Data Recorders . . . . . . 13-19OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20Navigation System . . . . . . . . . 13-20Radio FrequencyIdentification (RFID) . . . . . . . 13-20

Radio FrequencyStatement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20

Page 456: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-2 Customer Information

Customer Information

Customer SatisfactionProcedure (U.S. andCanada)Your satisfaction and goodwill areimportant to your dealer and toChevrolet. Normally, any concernswith the sales transaction or theoperation of the vehicle will beresolved by your dealer's sales orservice departments. Sometimes,however, despite the best intentionsof all concerned, misunderstandingscan occur. If your concern has notbeen resolved to your satisfaction,the following steps should be taken:

STEP ONE: Discuss your concernwith a member of dealershipmanagement. Normally, concernscan be quickly resolved at that level.If the matter has already beenreviewed with the sales, service,or parts manager, contact the ownerof your dealership or the generalmanager.

STEP TWO: If after contacting amember of dealership management,it appears your concern cannot beresolved by your dealership withoutfurther help, in the U.S., call theChevrolet Customer AssistanceCenter at 1-800-222-1020. InCanada, call General Motors ofCanada Customer Care Centre at1-800-263-3777 (English),or 1-800-263-7854 (French).

We encourage you to call thetoll-free number in order to give yourinquiry prompt attention. Have thefollowing information available togive the Customer Assistancerepresentative:. Vehicle Identification

Number (VIN). This is availablefrom the vehicle registration ortitle, or the plate at the top left ofthe instrument panel and visiblethrough the windshield.

. Dealership name and location.

. Vehicle delivery date andpresent mileage.

When contacting Chevrolet,remember that your concern willlikely be resolved at a dealer'sfacility. That is why we suggestfollowing Step One first.

STEP THREE — U.S. Owners:Both General Motors and yourdealer are committed to makingsure you are completely satisfiedwith your new vehicle. However,if you continue to remain unsatisfiedafter following the procedureoutlined in Steps One and Two, youcan file with the Better BusinessBureau (BBB) Auto Line® Programto enforce your rights.

The BBB Auto Line Program is anout-of-court program administeredby the Council of Better BusinessBureaus to settle automotivedisputes regarding vehicle repairs orthe interpretation of the New VehicleLimited Warranty. Although you maybe required to resort to this informaldispute resolution program prior tofiling a court action, use of theprogram is free of charge and yourcase will generally be heard within

Page 457: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-3

40 days. If you do not agree with thedecision given in your case, youmay reject it and proceed with anyother venue for relief availableto you.

You may contact the BBB Auto LineProgram using the toll-freetelephone number or write them atthe following address:

BBB Auto Line ProgramCouncil of Better Business Bureaus,Inc.4200 Wilson BoulevardSuite 800Arlington, VA 22203-1838

Telephone: 1-800-955-5100www.dr.bbb.org/goauto

This program is available in all50 states and the District ofColumbia. Eligibility is limited byvehicle age, mileage, and otherfactors. General Motors reservesthe right to change eligibilitylimitations and/or discontinue itsparticipation in this program.

STEP THREE — CanadianOwners: In the event that you donot feel your concerns have beenaddressed after following theprocedure outlined in Steps Oneand Two, General Motors of CanadaLimited wants you to be aware of itsparticipation in a no-chargeMediation/Arbitration Program.General Motors of Canada Limitedhas committed to binding arbitrationof owner disputes involvingfactory-related vehicle serviceclaims. The program provides forthe review of the facts involved byan impartial third party arbiter, andmay include an informal hearingbefore the arbiter. The program isdesigned so that the entire disputesettlement process, from the timeyou file your complaint to the finaldecision, should be completed inabout 70 days. We believe ourimpartial program offers advantagesover courts in most jurisdictionsbecause it is informal, quick, andfree of charge.

For further information concerningeligibility in the Canadian MotorVehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP),call toll-free 1-800-207-0685, or callthe General Motors Customer CareCentre, 1-800-263-3777 (English),1-800-263-7854 (French),or write to:

The Mediation/Arbitration Programc/o Customer Care CentreGeneral Motors of Canada LimitedMail Code: CA1-163-0051908 Colonel Sam DriveOshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7

Your inquiry should be accompaniedby the Vehicle IdentificationNumber (VIN).

Page 458: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-4 Customer Information

Customer SatisfactionProcedure (Mexico)

Did you get the Warranty ExtensionPlan? This plan is recommended byGeneral Motors to supplement thewarranty included with the newvehicle purchase.

See your dealer for details.

Customer AssistanceProcedure

Owner satisfaction and goodwill arevery important to your dealer andGeneral Motors.

Normally, any problem with thetransaction, sale, or usage of thevehicle must be handled by yourdealer sales or service departments.However, we recognize that despite

the good intentions of all partiesinvolved, sometimes amisunderstanding may occur.

If you have a problem that has notbeen satisfactorily handled throughthe normal means, we suggest thefollowing steps:

STEP ONE

Explain your case to your dealerservice agent, service manager,dealer sales agent, or salesmanager, depending on your case.

Make sure that they have allnecessary information. They areinterested in your continualsatisfaction.

STEP TWO

If you are not satisfied, pleasecontact the general manager or yourdealership owner to ask for theirhelp. If they are not able to resolveyour case, ask them to contact theright people at General Motors forsupport, if needed.

STEP THREE

If your case is not resolved in areasonable amount of time by yourdealer, please call the GeneralMotors Customer AssistanceCenter (CAC) and provide thefollowing information:. Name. Address. Phone number. Model year. Brand. Vehicle Identification

Number (VIN). Mileage. Delivery date. Description of the problem. Dealership name. Dealership address

See Customer Assistance Offices(U.S. and Canada) on page 13‑5 orCustomer Assistance Offices(Mexico) on page 13‑5.

Page 459: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-5

Customer AssistanceOffices (U.S. and Canada)Chevrolet encourages customers tocall the toll-free number forassistance. However, if a customerwishes to write or e-mail Chevrolet,the letter should be addressed to:

United States and Puerto Rico

Chevrolet Motor DivisionChevrolet Customer AssistanceCenterP.O. Box 33170Detroit, MI 48232-5170www.Chevrolet.com

1-800-222-10201-800-833-2438 (For TextTelephone Devices (TTYs))Roadside Assistance:1-800-243-8872

From U.S. Virgin Islands:

1-800-496-9994

Canada

General Motors of Canada LimitedCustomer Care Centre, Mail Code:CA1-163-0051908 Colonel Sam DriveOshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7www.gm.ca

1-800-263-3777 (English)1-800-263-7854 (French)1-800-263-3830 (For TextTelephone devices (TTYs))Roadside Assistance:1-800-268-6800

Overseas

Please contact the local GeneralMotors Business Unit.

Customer AssistanceOffices (Mexico)To contact the Customer AssistanceCenter (CAC), use the phonenumbers listed in this section.Customer assistance is availableMonday through Friday, 08:00 to20:00 hours, and Saturdays from08:00 to 15:00 hours.

All e-mail inquiries to the CustomerAssistance Center (CAC) should besent to: [email protected].

Mexico

From Mexico City

5329-0811

From Other Mexico Locations

01-800-466-0811

United States and Canada

1-866-466-8190

Costa Rica

00-800-052-1005

Guatemala

1-800-999-5252

Panama

00-800-052-0001

Dominican Republic

1-888-751-5301

Page 460: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-6 Customer Information

El Salvador

800-6273

Honduras

800-0122-6101

Customer Assistance forText Telephone (TTY)Users (U.S. and Canada)To assist customers who are deaf,hard of hearing, or speech-impairedand who use Text Telephones(TTYs), Chevrolet has TTYequipment available at its CustomerAssistance Center. Any TTY user inthe U.S. can communicate withChevrolet by dialing:1-800-833-2438. TTY users inCanada can dial 1-800-263-3830.

Online Owner Center

Online Owner Experience(U.S.) my.chevrolet.com

The Chevrolet online ownerexperience is a one-stop resourcethat allows interaction withChevrolet and keeps importantvehicle-specific information in oneplace.

Membership Benefits

E (Vehicle Information):Download owner manuals and viewvehicle-specific how-to videos.

G (Maintenance Information):View maintenance schedules,required alerts, OnStar onboardvehicle diagnostic information, andschedule service appointments.

I (Service History): Viewprintable dealer-recorded servicerecords and self-recorded servicerecords.

D (Preferred DealerInformation): Select a preferreddealer and view dealer location,maps, phone numbers, and hours.

J (Warranty TrackingInformation): Track the vehicle’swarranty information.

J (Recall Information): Viewactive recalls or search by VehicleIdentification Number (VIN). SeeVehicle Identification Number (VIN)on page 12‑1.

H (Other Account Information):View GM Card, SiriusXM Satelliteradio, and OnStar accountinformation.

F (Live Chat Support): Chat livewith online help representatives.

Visit my.chevrolet.com to registeryour vehicle.

Page 461: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-7

Chevrolet Owner Centre(Canada) chevroletowner.ca

Take a trip to the Chevrolet OwnerCentre:. Chat live with online help

representatives.. Use the Vehicle Tools section.. Access third party enthusiast

sites and social media networks.. Locate owner resources such as

lease-end, financing, andwarranty information.

. Retrieve your favorite articles,quizzes, tips, and multimediagalleries organized into theFeatures and Auto CareSections.

. Download the owner manual foryour vehicle, quickly and easily.

. Find theChevrolet-recommendedmaintenance services for yourvehicle.

GM MobilityReimbursement Program(U.S. and Canada)

This program is available toqualified applicants for costreimbursement of eligibleaftermarket adaptive equipmentrequired for the vehicle, such ashand controls or a wheelchair/scooter lift for the vehicle.

For more information on the limitedoffer, visit www.gmmobility.com orcall the GM Mobility AssistanceCenter at 1-800-323-9935. TextTelephone (TTY) users, call1-800-833-9935.

General Motors of Canada also hasa Mobility Program. Call1-800-GM-DRIVE (463-7483) fordetails. TTY users call1-800-263-3830.

Roadside AssistanceProgram (Mexico)As a new owner, your vehicle isautomatically enrolled in theRoadside Assistance program. Theservices are available at no costunder the terms and conditions ofthe program. The RoadsideAssistance program is not part of,or included, in the coverageprovided by the New Vehicle LimitedWarranty.

Roadside Assistance providesassistance to the driver andpassengers while driving the vehiclewithin your city of residence or onany passable road in Mexico, theUnited States, and Canada.Services are subject to the

Page 462: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-8 Customer Information

limitations described in the followingpages. Program coverage varies bycountry.

Roadside Assistance is available24 hours a day, 365 days ofthe year.

This program expires two yearsfrom the date of the invoice for thevehicle, regardless of vehiclemileage and changes in vehicleownership.

For more information about therenewal of this program at the endof its term, contact the ChevroletCustomer Assistance Center at01-800-466-0800.

Services Provided. Flat Tire Change: If unable to

change a flat tire, RoadsideAssistance will provide towingservice to the nearest authorizedChevrolet dealership. It is theowner's responsibility for therepair or replacement of the tire.

This service is limited to thetransfer of the vehicle to therepair facility.

. Emergency Fuel Delivery:Delivery of enough fuel for thevehicle to get to the nearestservice station.

. Lock-Out Service: Service tounlock the vehicle if you arelocked out.

. Battery Jump Start: Service tojump start a dead battery.

. *Emergency Messages:Transmission of urgent phonemessages.

. *Emergency Calls: Call foremergency services.

. *Dealership LocationAssistance: Informationregarding addresses andtelephone numbers for Chevroletdealers.

. Emergency Towing: Tow to thenearest dealer for warrantyservice if the vehicle cannot bedriven.

If the vehicle is involved in anaccident during the commissionof a crime, administrativeviolation, or breach of trafficregulations, RoadsideAssistance will not provideservice. When the vehicle is notaccessible to be towed, allmaneuvers required to access itwill be at the owner's expense.

If the vehicle is in another cityoutside of your residence,Roadside Assistance is limitedto moving the vehicle to thenearest dealer. If you would likethe vehicle moved to a differentdealer, you will be asked tocover the difference in cost atthe time of the move.

If the vehicle cannot be receivedby the nearest Chevrolet dealerdue to scheduling conflicts, thevehicle will be taken to a safeplace where it will remain for up

Page 463: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-9

to 48 hours until it can be takento the dealer. If the storage costsexceed the amount authorized,the owner is responsible to paythe difference at the time ofservice. Contact RoadsideAssistance for more informationon authorized amounts.

. *Trip Interruption: This serviceis provided if you are preventedfrom further usage of yourvehicle while traveling and it isnot possible for the nearestChevrolet dealership to repairthe vehicle the same day,requiring the vehicle to stay atthe dealership for a night ormore. If this happens, in additionto the previously listed servicesand prior to confirmation by thedealership, you are entitled tochoose one of the followingalternatives, within the limits ofexisting Roadside Assistanceprogram guidelines. If the costsexceed the amount authorized

for these services, you must paythe difference at the time ofservice.

Roadside Assistance willcoordinate hotelaccommodations for all vehicletravelers for up to two nights.

A rental car will be provided forup to two days and the vehiclemust be returned to its originaldestination, excluding vehicleswith a carrying capacity greaterthan 3.5 tons.

Complimentary Transportation: Ifyou prefer to continue your tripto the intended destination orreturn to your place ofresidence, and the trip requiresmore than eight hours driving onthe road, transportation for thedriver and passengers by firstclass bus or coach commercialairline will be provided to alocation chosen by RoadsideAssistance, depending on

availability at the chosendestination. Restrictions applybased on vehicle specifications.

If you are on the road, taxiservice to the nearest busstation or airport will beprovided.

. *ComplimentaryTransportation for Vehicle PickUp: Transportation to pick upyour vehicle after repairs arecomplete. Once the dealer hasreported that the vehicle hasbeen repaired, RoadsideAssistance will provide bus orcommercial airline one-wayservice (subject to availability)for the person designated by youto collect your vehicle at thedealership's location if you or thedesignated person are not in thesame town or city as thedealership.

*These services are not provided forU.S. or Canada residents. Allservices provided in the U.S. and

Page 464: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-10 Customer Information

Canada are at the owner's expenseand will be reimbursed by RoadsideAssistance.

Services Not Included in RoadsideAssistance

Roadside Assistance does notcover or reimburse services for thefollowing:. Events caused by fraud or bad

faith by the driver.. Vehicle immobilization situations

due to a major force orunforeseen circumstances, suchas natural phenomena of anextraordinary nature,earthquakes, volcanic eruptions,and other cyclonic storms.

. Vehicle immobilization situationsarising from car accidentscaused by the driver of thevehicle or third parties. Thismeans any occurrence thatcauses physical injury to theoccupants and/or the vehiclecaused by external forces.

. Acts of terrorism, riot or uproar,armed forces or police actionswhich prevent timely delivery ofassistance services.

. Food service, beverages,telephone calls, or other extracosts. Accommodation costsapply only to Mexico per theterms and conditions of theRoadside Assistance program.

. Any damage to the vehiclewithout intent, derived from theservices provided.

. Cost of towing a trailer whenchoosing a Chevrolet dealer thatis nearest to the temporarystorage facility for the disabledvehicle.

. Cost of all maneuvers requiredto access the vehicle when it isnot available to be towed.

. Cost of fuel provided.

Routine vehicle repair costs are notcovered by the RoadsideAssistance program. For moreinformation, see your new vehiclewarranty.

Contacting Roadside Assistance

Roadside Assistance services are ofno cost to you and available24 hours a day, 365 days a year.Costs are only incurred in situationsthat exceed the limits of theprogram, some of which are listedpreviously in this section.

To contact Roadside Assistance byphone, use the following numbers:

Mexico

01-800-466-0800

United States

1-866-466-8901

Canada

1-800-268-6800

E-mail

[email protected]

Page 465: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-11

Chevrolet reserves the right to makeany changes or discontinue theRoadside Assistance program atany time without notification.

Roadside AssistanceProgram (U.S. andCanada)For U.S.-purchased vehicles, call1-800-243-8872; (Text Telephone(TTY): 1-888-889-2438).

For Canadian-purchased vehicles,call 1-800-268-6800.

Service is available 24 hours a day,365 days a year.

Calling for Assistance

When calling Roadside Assistance,have the following informationready:. Your name, home address, and

home telephone number.. Telephone number of your

location.. Location of the vehicle.

. Model, year, color, and licenseplate number of the vehicle.

. Odometer reading, VehicleIdentification Number (VIN), anddelivery date of the vehicle.

. Description of the problem.

Coverage

Services are provided up to 5 years/160 000 km (100,000mi), whichevercomes first.

In the U.S., anyone driving thevehicle is covered. In Canada, aperson driving the vehicle withoutpermission from the owner is notcovered.

Roadside Assistance is not a part ofthe New Vehicle Limited Warranty.Chevrolet and General Motors ofCanada Limited reserve the right tomake any changes or discontinuethe Roadside Assistance program atany time without notification.

Chevrolet and General Motors ofCanada Limited reserve the right tolimit services or payment to anowner or driver if they decide the

claims are made too often, or thesame type of claim is made manytimes.

Services Provided. Emergency Fuel Delivery:

Delivery of enough fuel for thevehicle to get to the nearestservice station.

. Lock-Out Service: Service tounlock the vehicle if you arelocked out. A remote unlock maybe available if you have OnStar.For security reasons, the drivermust present identificationbefore this service is given.

. Emergency Tow from a PublicRoad or Highway: Tow to thenearest Chevrolet dealer forwarranty service, or if the vehiclewas in a crash and cannot bedriven. Assistance is also givenwhen the vehicle is stuck in thesand, mud, or snow.

Page 466: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-12 Customer Information

. Flat Tire Change: Service tochange a flat tire with the sparetire. The spare tire, if equipped,must be in good condition andproperly inflated. It is the owner'sresponsibility for the repair orreplacement of the tire if it is notcovered by the warranty.

. Battery Jump Start: Service tojump start a dead battery.

Services Not Included inRoadside Assistance. Impound towing caused by

violation of any laws.. Legal fines.. Mounting, dismounting,

or changing of snow tires,chains, or other traction devices.

. Towing or services for vehiclesdriven on a non-public road orhighway.

Services Specific toCanadian-Purchased Vehicles. Fuel Delivery: Reimbursement

is approximately $5 Canadian.Diesel fuel delivery may berestricted. Propane and otherfuels are not provided throughthis service.

. Lock-Out Service: Vehicleregistration is required.

. Trip Interruption Benefits andAssistance: Must be over250 kilometers from where yourtrip was started to qualify.General Motors of CanadaLimited requirespre-authorization, originaldetailed receipts, and a copy ofthe repair orders. Onceauthorization has been received,the Roadside Assistance advisorwill help to make arrangementsand explain how to receivepayment.

. Alternative Service: Ifassistance cannot be providedright away, the RoadsideAssistance advisor may givepermission to get localemergency road service. You willreceive payment, up to $100,after sending the original receiptto Roadside Assistance.Mechanical failures may becovered, however any cost forparts and labor for repairs notcovered by the warranty are theowner responsibility.

Scheduling ServiceAppointments (U.S. andCanada)When the vehicle requires warrantyservice, contact your dealer andrequest an appointment. Byscheduling a service appointmentand advising the service consultantof your transportation needs, yourdealer can help minimize yourinconvenience.

Page 467: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-13

If the vehicle cannot be scheduledinto the service departmentimmediately, keep driving it until itcan be scheduled for service,unless, of course, the problem issafety related. If it is, please callyour dealership, let them know this,and ask for instructions.

If your dealer requests you to bringthe vehicle for service, you areurged to do so as early in the workday as possible to allow forsame-day repair.

Courtesy TransportationProgram (U.S. andCanada)To enhance your ownershipexperience, we and our participatingdealers are proud to offer CourtesyTransportation, a customer supportprogram for vehicles with theBumper-to-Bumper (Base WarrantyCoverage period in Canada),extended powertrain, and/orhybrid-specific warranties in boththe U.S. and Canada.

Several Courtesy Transportationoptions are available to assist inreducing inconvenience whenwarranty repairs are required.

Courtesy Transportation is not apart of the New Vehicle LimitedWarranty. A separate bookletentitled “Limited Warranty andOwner Assistance Information”furnished with each new vehicleprovides detailed warranty coverageinformation.

Transportation Options

Warranty service can generally becompleted while you wait. However,if you are unable to wait, GM helpsto minimize inconvenience byproviding several transportationoptions. Depending on thecircumstances, your dealer can offerone of the following:

Shuttle Service

Shuttle service is the preferredmeans of offering CourtesyTransportation. Dealers may provideshuttle service to get you to your

destination with minimal interruptionof your daily schedule. This includesone-way or round-trip shuttle servicewithin reasonable time and distanceparameters of your dealer's area.

Public Transportation or FuelReimbursement

If the vehicle requires overnightwarranty repairs, and publictransportation is used instead ofyour dealer's shuttle service, theexpense must be supported byoriginal receipts and can only be upto the maximum amount allowed byGM for shuttle service. In addition,for U.S. customers, should youarrange transportation through afriend or relative, limitedreimbursement for reasonable fuelexpenses may be available. Claimamounts should reflect actual costsand be supported by originalreceipts. See your dealer forinformation regarding the allowanceamounts for reimbursement of fuelor other transportation costs.

Page 468: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-14 Customer Information

Courtesy Rental Vehicle

Your dealer may arrange to provideyou with a courtesy rental vehicle orreimburse you for a rental vehiclethat you obtain if the vehicle is keptfor an overnight warranty repair.Rental reimbursement will be limitedand must be supported by originalreceipts. This requires that you signand complete a rental agreementand meet state/provincial, local, andrental vehicle provider requirements.Requirements vary and may includeminimum age requirements,insurance coverage, credit card, etc.You are responsible for fuel usagecharges and may also beresponsible for taxes, levies, usagefees, excessive mileage, or rentalusage beyond the completion of therepair.

It may not be possible to provide alike vehicle as a courtesy rental.

Additional ProgramInformation

All program options, such as shuttleservice, may not be available atevery dealer. Please contact yourdealer for specific information aboutavailability. All CourtesyTransportation arrangements will beadministered by appropriate dealerpersonnel.

General Motors reserves the right tounilaterally modify, change,or discontinue CourtesyTransportation at any time and toresolve all questions of claimeligibility pursuant to the terms andconditions described herein at itssole discretion.

Collision Damage Repair(U.S. and Canada)If the vehicle is involved in acollision and it is damaged, have thedamage repaired by a qualifiedtechnician using the properequipment and quality replacementparts. Poorly performed collision

repairs diminish the vehicle resalevalue, and safety performance canbe compromised in subsequentcollisions.

Collision Parts

Genuine GM Collision parts are newparts made with the same materialsand construction methods as theparts with which the vehicle wasoriginally built. Genuine GMCollision parts are the best choice toensure that the vehicle's designedappearance, durability, and safetyare preserved. The use of GenuineGM parts can help maintain the GMNew Vehicle Limited Warranty.

Recycled original equipment partsmay also be used for repair. Theseparts are typically removed fromvehicles that were total losses inprior crashes. In most cases, theparts being recycled are fromundamaged sections of the vehicle.A recycled original equipment GMpart may be an acceptable choice tomaintain the vehicle's originallydesigned appearance and safety

Page 469: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (15,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-15

performance; however, the history ofthese parts is not known. Such partsare not covered by the GM NewVehicle Limited Warranty, and anyrelated failures are not covered bythat warranty.

Aftermarket collision parts are alsoavailable. These are made bycompanies other than GM and maynot have been tested for the vehicle.As a result, these parts may fitpoorly, exhibit premature durability/corrosion problems, and may notperform properly in subsequentcollisions. Aftermarket parts are notcovered by the GM New VehicleLimited Warranty, and any vehiclefailure related to such parts is notcovered by that warranty.

Repair Facility

GM also recommends that youchoose a collision repair facility thatmeets your needs before you everneed collision repairs. Your dealermay have a collision repair centerwith GM-trained technicians andstate‐of‐the‐art equipment, or be

able to recommend a collision repaircenter that has GM-trainedtechnicians and comparableequipment.

Insuring the Vehicle

Protect your investment in the GMvehicle with comprehensive andcollision insurance coverage. Thereare significant differences in thequality of coverage afforded byvarious insurance policy terms.Many insurance policies providereduced protection to the GMvehicle by limiting compensation fordamage repairs through the use ofaftermarket collision parts. Someinsurance companies will notspecify aftermarket collision parts.When purchasing insurance, werecommend that you ensure that thevehicle will be repaired with GMoriginal equipment collision parts.If such insurance coverage is notavailable from your currentinsurance carrier, consider switchingto another insurance carrier.

If the vehicle is leased, the leasingcompany may require you to haveinsurance that ensures repairs withGenuine GM Original EquipmentManufacturer (OEM) parts orGenuine Manufacturer replacementparts. Read the lease carefully, asyou may be charged at the end ofthe lease for poor quality repairs.

If a Crash Occurs

If there has been an injury, callemergency services for help. Do notleave the scene of a crash until allmatters have been taken care of.Move the vehicle only if its positionputs you in danger, or you areinstructed to move it by a policeofficer.

Give only the necessary informationto police and other parties involvedin the crash.

For emergency towing seeRoadside Assistance Program(Mexico) on page 13‑7 or RoadsideAssistance Program (U.S. andCanada) on page 13‑11.

Page 470: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (16,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-16 Customer Information

Gather the following information:. Driver name, address, and

telephone number.. Driver license number.. Owner name, address, and

telephone number.. Vehicle license plate number.. Vehicle make, model, and

model year.. Vehicle Identification

Number (VIN).. Insurance company and policy

number.. General description of the

damage to the other vehicle.

Choose a reputable repair facilitythat uses quality replacement parts.See “Collision Parts” earlier in thissection.

If the airbag has inflated, see WhatWill You See after an AirbagInflates? on page 3‑33.

Managing the Vehicle DamageRepair Process

In the event that the vehicle requiresdamage repairs, GM recommendsthat you take an active role in itsrepair. If you have a pre-determinedrepair facility of choice, take thevehicle there, or have it towed there.Specify to the facility that anyrequired replacement collision partsbe original equipment parts, eithernew Genuine GM parts or recycledoriginal GM parts. Remember,recycled parts will not be covered bythe GM vehicle warranty.

Insurance pays the bill for the repair,but you must live with the repair.Depending on your policy limits,your insurance company mayinitially value the repair usingaftermarket parts. Discuss this withthe repair professional, and insist onGenuine GM parts. Remember,if the vehicle is leased, you may beobligated to have the vehiclerepaired with Genuine GM parts,even if your insurance coveragedoes not pay the full cost.

If another party's insurancecompany is paying for the repairs,you are not obligated to accept arepair valuation based on thatinsurance company's collision policyrepair limits, as you have nocontractual limits with that company.In such cases, you can have controlof the repair and parts choices aslong as the cost stays withinreasonable limits.

Service PublicationsOrdering Information

Service Manuals

Service Manuals have the diagnosisand repair information on theengines, transmission, axle,suspension, brakes, electrical,steering, body, etc.

Service Bulletins

Service Bulletins give additionaltechnical service informationneeded to knowledgeably serviceGeneral Motors cars and trucks.

Page 471: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (17,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-17

Each bulletin contains instructionsto assist in the diagnosis andservice of the vehicle.

Owner Information

Owner publications are writtenspecifically for owners and intendedto provide basic operationalinformation about the vehicle. TheOwner Manual includes theMaintenance Schedule for allmodels.

In-Portfolio: Includes a Portfolio,Owner Manual, and WarrantyBooklet.

RETAIL SELL PRICE:$35.00 (U.S.) plus handling andshipping fees.

Without Portfolio: OwnerManual only.

RETAIL SELL PRICE:$25.00 (U.S.) plus handling andshipping fees.

Current and Past Models

Technical Service Bulletins andManuals are available for currentand past model GM vehicles.

ORDER TOLL FREE:1-800-551-4123 Monday – Friday8:00 AM – 6:00 PM Eastern Time

For Credit Card Orders Only(VISA-MasterCard-Discover), visitHelm, Inc. at: www.helminc.com.

Or write to:

Helm, IncorporatedAttention: Customer Service47911 Halyard DrivePlymouth, MI 48170

Prices are subject to change withoutnotice and without incurringobligation. Allow ample time fordelivery.

All listed prices are quoted in U.S.funds. Make checks payable in U.S.funds.

Reporting SafetyDefects

Reporting Safety Defectsto the United StatesGovernmentIf you believe that your vehiclehas a defect which could causea crash or could cause injury ordeath, you should immediatelyinform the National HighwayTraffic Safety Administration(NHTSA) in addition to notifyingGeneral Motors.

If NHTSA receives similarcomplaints, it may open aninvestigation, and if it finds thata safety defect exists in a groupof vehicles, it may order a recalland remedy campaign.However, NHTSA cannotbecome involved in individualproblems between you, yourdealer, or General Motors.

Page 472: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (18,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-18 Customer Information

To contact NHTSA, you may callthe Vehicle Safety Hotlinetoll-free at 1-888-327-4236(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go tohttp://www.safercar.gov; orwrite to:

Administrator, NHTSA1200 New Jersey Avenue, S.E.Washington, D.C. 20590

You can also obtain otherinformation about motorvehicle safety fromhttp://www.safercar.gov.

Reporting Safety Defectsto the CanadianGovernmentIf you live in Canada, and youbelieve that the vehicle has a safetydefect, notify Transport Canadaimmediately, and notify GeneralMotors of Canada Limited. CallTransport Canada at1-800-333-0510 or write to:

Transport CanadaRoad Safety Branch80 rue NoelGatineau, QC J8Z 0A1

Reporting Safety Defectsto General MotorsIn addition to notifying NHTSA (orTransport Canada) in a situation likethis, notify General Motors.

Call 1-800-222-1020, or write:

Chevrolet Motor DivisionChevrolet Customer AssistanceCenterP.O. Box 33170Detroit, MI 48232-5170

In Canada, call 1-800-263-3777(English) or 1-800-263-7854(French), or write:

General Motors of Canada LimitedCustomer Care Centre, Mail Code:CA1-163-0051908 Colonel Sam DriveOshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7

Page 473: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (19,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

Customer Information 13-19

Vehicle DataRecording andPrivacyThe vehicle has a number ofcomputers that record informationabout the vehicle’s performance andhow it is driven. For example, thevehicle uses computer modules tomonitor and control engine andtransmission performance, tomonitor the conditions for airbagdeployment and deploy them in acrash, and, if equipped, to provideantilock braking to help the drivercontrol the vehicle. These modulesmay store data to help the dealertechnician service the vehicle.Some modules may also store dataabout how the vehicle is operated,such as rate of fuel consumption oraverage speed. These modules mayretain personal preferences, such asradio presets, seat positions, andtemperature settings.

Event Data RecordersThis vehicle is equipped with anevent data recorder (EDR). Themain purpose of an EDR is torecord, in certain crash or nearcrash-like situations, such as an airbag deployment or hitting a roadobstacle, data that will assist inunderstanding how a vehicle’ssystems performed. The EDR isdesigned to record data related tovehicle dynamics and safetysystems for a short period of time,typically 30 seconds or less. TheEDR in this vehicle is designed torecord such data as:. How various systems in your

vehicle were operating;. Whether or not the driver and

passenger safety belts werebuckled/fastened;

. How far (if at all) the driver wasdepressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,

. How fast the vehicle wastraveling.

These data can help provide abetter understanding of thecircumstances in which crashes andinjuries occur. NOTE: EDR data arerecorded by your vehicle only if anon-trivial crash situation occurs; nodata are recorded by the EDR undernormal driving conditions and nopersonal data (e.g., name, gender,age, and crash location) arerecorded. However, other parties,such as law enforcement, couldcombine the EDR data with the typeof personally identifying dataroutinely acquired during a crashinvestigation.

To read data recorded by an EDR,special equipment is required, andaccess to the vehicle or the EDR isneeded. In addition to the vehiclemanufacturer, other parties, such aslaw enforcement, that have thespecial equipment, can read theinformation if they have access tothe vehicle or the EDR.

GM will not access this data orshare it with others except: with theconsent of the vehicle owner or,

Page 474: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (20,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

13-20 Customer Information

if the vehicle is leased, with theconsent of the lessee; in responseto an official request by police orsimilar government office; as part ofGM's defense of litigation throughthe discovery process; or, asrequired by law. Data that GMcollects or receives may also beused for GM research needs or maybe made available to others forresearch purposes, where a need isshown and the data is not tied to aspecific vehicle or vehicle owner.

OnStar®

If the vehicle is equipped withOnStar® and has an activesubscription, additional data may becollected through the OnStarsystem. This includes informationabout the vehicle’s operation; aboutcollisions involving the vehicle; theuse of the vehicle and its features;and, in certain situations, thelocation and approximate GPSspeed of the vehicle. Refer to the

OnStar Terms and Conditions andPrivacy Statement on the OnStarwebsite.

Navigation SystemIf the vehicle is equipped with anavigation system, use of thesystem may result in the storage ofdestinations, addresses, telephonenumbers, and other trip information.See the navigation manual forinformation on stored data and fordeletion instructions.

Radio FrequencyIdentification (RFID)RFID technology is used in somevehicles for functions such as tirepressure monitoring and ignitionsystem security, as well as inconnection with conveniences suchas Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)transmitters for remote door locking/unlocking and starting, andin-vehicle transmitters for garagedoor openers. RFID technology inGM vehicles does not use or record

personal information or link with anyother GM system containingpersonal information.

Radio FrequencyStatementThis vehicle has systems thatoperate on a radio frequency thatcomply with Part 15 of the FederalCommunications Commission (FCC)rules and with Industry CanadaStandards RSS‐GEN/210/220/310.

Operation is subject to the followingtwo conditions:

1. The device may not causeharmful interference.

2. The device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may causeundesired operation of thedevice.

Changes or modifications to any ofthese systems by other than anauthorized service facility could voidauthorization to use this equipment.

Page 475: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

OnStar 14-1

OnStar

OnStar OverviewOnStar Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-1

OnStar ServicesEmergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-3Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-5

OnStar Additional InformationOnStar AdditionalInformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-5

OnStar Overview

If equipped, this vehicle has acomprehensive, in-vehicle systemthat can connect to a live Advisorfor Emergency, Security, Navigation,Connection, and DiagnosticServices.

The OnStar system status light isnext to the OnStar buttons. If thestatus light is:. Solid Green: System is ready.. Flashing Green: On a call.. Red: Indicates a problem.

PressQ or call 1-888-4ONSTAR(1-888-466-7827) to speak to anAdvisor.

Press= to:

. Make a call, end a call,or answer an incoming call.

. Give OnStar Hands-Free Callingvoice commands.

. Give OnStar Turn-by-TurnNavigation voice commands.Requires the available Directionsand Connections service plan.

PressQ to connect to a liveAdvisor to:. Verify account information or

update contact information.. Get driving directions. Requires

the available Directions andConnections service plan.

. Receive On-DemandDiagnostics for a check of thevehicle’s key operating systems.

. Receive Roadside Assistance.

Page 476: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

14-2 OnStar

Press the OnStar Emergency button> to get a priority connection to anEmergency Advisor available24/7 to:. Get help for an emergency.. Be a Good Samaritan or

respond to an AMBER Alert.. Get crisis assistance and

evacuation routes.

OnStar Services

EmergencyWith Automatic Crash Response,the built-in system can automaticallyconnect to help in most crashes,even if help cannot be requested.

Press> to connect to anEmergency Advisor. GPStechnology is used to identify thevehicle location and can providecritical information to emergencypersonnel. The Advisor is alsotrained to offer critical assistance inemergency situations before firstresponders arrive.

SecurityOnStar provides services like StolenVehicle Assistance, Remote IgnitionBlock, and Roadside Assistance,if the vehicle is equipped with theseservices. OnStar can unlock thevehicle doors remotely, if it is

equipped with automatic door locks,and can help police locate thevehicle if it is stolen.

NavigationOnStar navigation requires theDirections and Connectionsservice plan.

PressQ to receive directions orhave them sent to the vehiclenavigation screen, if equipped.Destinations can also be forwardedto the vehicle from MapQuest.com.The OnStar mapping database iscontinuously updated. Visitwww.onstar.com for coverage maps.

Turn-by-Turn Navigation

1. PressQ to connect to a liveAdvisor.

2. Request directions.

3. Directions are downloaded to thevehicle.

4. Follow the voice-guidedcommands.

Page 477: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

OnStar 14-3

Using Voice CommandsDuring a Planned Route

Cancel Route

1. Press=. System responds:“OnStar ready,” then a tone. Say“Cancel route.” Systemresponds: “Do you want tocancel directions?”

2. Say “Yes.” System responds:“OK, request completed, thankyou, goodbye.”

Route Preview

1. Press=. System responds:“OnStar ready,” then a tone.

2. Say “Route preview.” Systemresponds with the next threemaneuvers.

3. Say “Goodbye.” Exits voicecommands.

Repeat

1. Press=. System responds:“OnStar ready,” then a tone.

2. Say “Repeat.” System respondswith the last direction given, thenresponds with “OnStar ready,”then a tone.

3. Say “Goodbye.” Exits voicecommands.

Get My Destination

1. Press=. System responds:“OnStar ready,” then a tone.

2. Say “Get my destination.”System responds with addressand the distance to thedestination, then responds with“OnStar ready,” then a tone.

3. Say “Goodbye.” Exits voicecommands.

Other Navigation ServicesAvailable from OnStar

OnStar eNav: Allows subscribersto send destinations fromMapQuest.com to their Turn-by-TurnNavigation or screen-basednavigation system. When ready, thedirections will be downloaded to thevehicle.

Destination Download: PressQ,then request the Advisor todownload directions to thenavigation system in the vehicle.After the call ends, press the “Go”button on the navigation screen tobegin driving directions.

Destinations can also bedownloaded on the go. Forinformation about eNav, DestinationDownload, and coverage maps visitwww.onstar.com.

ConnectionsOnStar Hands-Free Calling allowscalls to be made and received fromthe vehicle. The vehicle can also becontrolled from a cell phone throughthe OnStar RemoteLink mobile app.See www.onstar.com forcoverage maps.

Hands-Free Calling

1. Press=. System responds:“OnStar ready.”

Page 478: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

14-4 OnStar

2. Say “Call.” System responds:“Please say the name or numberto call.”

3. Say the entire number withoutpausing, including a “1” and thearea code. System responds:“OK calling.”

Calling 911 Emergency

1. Press=. The system responds“OnStar Ready,” followed bya tone.

2. Say “Call.” The system responds“Please say the name or numberto call.”

3. Say “911” without pausing. Thesystem responds “911.”

4. Say “Call.” The system responds“OK, dialing 911.”

Retrieve My Number

1. Press=. System responds:“OnStar ready.”

2. Say “My number.” Systemresponds: “Your OnStarHands-Free Calling number is.”

End a Call

Press=. System responds: “Callended.”

Store a Name Tag for SpeedDialing

1. Press=. System responds:“OnStar ready.”

2. Say “Store.” System responds:“Please say the number youwould like to store.”

3. Say the entire number withoutpausing. System responds:“Please say the name tag.”

4. Pick a name tag. Systemresponds: “About to store <nametag>. Does that sound OK?”

5. Say “Yes” or say “No” to tryagain. System responds: “OK,storing <name tag>.”

Place a Call Using a StoredNumber

1. Press=. System responds:“OnStar ready.”

2. Say “Call <name tag>.” Systemresponds: “OK, calling<name tag>.”

Verify Minutes and Expiration

Press= and say “Minutes” then“Verify” to check how many minutesremain and their expiration date.

OnStar Mobile App

Download the OnStar RemoteLinkmobile app to your iPhone, Android,or BlackBerry smartphone to checkvehicle fuel level, oil life, or tirepressure; to start the vehicle (ifequipped) or unlock it; or to connectto an OnStar Advisor. For OnStarRemoteLink information andcompatibility, see www.onstar.com.

Page 479: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

OnStar 14-5

DiagnosticsOnStar Vehicle Diagnostics willperform a vehicle check everymonth. It will check the engine,transmission, antilock brakes, andmajor vehicle systems. It alsochecks the tire pressures, if thevehicle is equipped with the TirePressure Monitoring System. If adiagnostics check is neededbetween e-mails, pressQ, and anAdvisor can run a check.

OnStar AdditionalInformationTransferring Service

PressQ to request account transfereligibility information. The Advisorcan assist in canceling or removingaccount information. If OnStarreceives information that vehicleownership has changed, OnStarmay send a voice message to thevehicle, requesting updated accountinformation.

Reactivation for SubsequentOwners

PressQ and follow the prompts tospeak to an Advisor as soon aspossible after acquiring the vehicle.The Advisor will update vehiclerecords and will explain the OnStarservice offers and options available.

How OnStar Service Works

Automatic Crash Response,Emergency Services, Crisis Assist,Stolen Vehicle Assistance, Vehicle

Diagnostics, Remote Door Unlock,Roadside Assistance, Turn-by-TurnNavigation, and Hands-Free Callingare available on most vehicles. Notall OnStar services are availableeverywhere or on all vehicles. Formore information, a full descriptionof OnStar services, systemlimitations, and OnStar terms andconditions, see www.onstar.com(U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada);contact OnStar at 1-888-4ONSTAR(1-888-466-7827) or TTY1-877-248-2080; or pressQ tospeak with an Advisor. OnStarservices require a vehicle electricalsystem, wireless service, and GPSsatellite technologies to be availableand operating for features tofunction properly. These systemsmay not operate if the battery isdischarged or disconnected.

OnStar service cannot work unlessyour vehicle is in a place whereOnStar has an agreement with awireless service provider for servicein that area, and the wirelessservice provider has coverage,

Page 480: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

14-6 OnStar

network capacity, reception, andtechnology compatible with OnStarservice. Service involving locationinformation about the vehicle cannotwork unless GPS signals areavailable, unobstructed, andcompatible with the OnStarhardware. OnStar service may notwork if the OnStar equipment is notproperly installed or it has not beenproperly maintained. If equipment orsoftware is added, connected,or modified, OnStar service may notwork. Other problems beyond thecontrol of OnStar may preventservice such as hills, tall buildings,tunnels, weather, electrical systemdesign and architecture of thevehicle, damage to the vehicle in acrash, or wireless phone networkcongestion or jamming.

See Radio Frequency Statement onpage 13‑20 for informationregarding Part 15 of the FederalCommunications Commission (FCC)rules and Industry CanadaStandards RSS-GEN/210/220/310.

Services for People withDisabilities

Advisors provide services to helpsubscribers with physical disabilitiesand medical conditions.

PressQ for help with:

. Locating a gas station with anattendant to pump gas.

. Finding a hotel, restaurant, etc.,that meets accessibility needs.

. Providing directions to theclosest hospital or pharmacy inurgent situations.

TTY Users

OnStar has the ability tocommunicate to the deaf,hard-of-hearing, or speech-impairedcustomers while in the vehicle. Theavailable dealer-installed TTYsystem can provide in-vehicleaccess to all of the OnStar services,except Virtual Advisor and OnStarTurn-by-Turn Navigation.

OnStar.com

The website provides access toaccount information, manages theOnStar subscription, and allowsviewing of videos of each service.Get subscription plan pricing andsign up for OnStar VehicleDiagnostics. Click on the “MyAccount” tab on the home page.

OnStar Personal IdentificationNumber (PIN)

A PIN is needed to access some ofthe OnStar services, like RemoteDoor Unlock and Stolen VehicleAssistance. You will be prompted tochange the PIN the first time whenspeaking with an Advisor. Tochange the OnStar PIN, call OnStarand provide the Advisor with thecurrent number.

Page 481: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

OnStar 14-7

Warranty

OnStar equipment may bewarranted as part of the NewVehicle Limited Warranty. Themanufacturer of the vehiclefurnishes detailed warrantyinformation.

Languages

The vehicle can be programmed torespond in French or Spanish.PressQ and ask an Advisor.Advisors can speak French orSpanish.

Potential Issues

Some OnStar services are disabledafter five days. OnStar cannotperform Remote Door Unlock orStolen Vehicle Assistance after thevehicle has been off continuouslyfor five days. After five days, OnStarcan contact Roadside Assistanceand a locksmith to help gain accessto the vehicle.

Global PositioningSystem (GPS). Obstruction of the GPS can

occur in a large city with tallbuildings; in parking garages;around airports; in tunnels,underpasses, or parkinggarages; or in an area with verydense trees. If GPS signals arenot available, the OnStar systemshould still operate to callOnStar. However, OnStar couldhave difficulty identifying theexact location.

. In emergency situations, OnStarcan use the last stored GPSlocation to send to emergencyresponders.

. A temporary loss of GPS cancause loss of the ability to senda Turn-by-Turn Navigation route.The Advisor may give a verbalroute or may ask for a call backafter the vehicle is driven into anopen area.

Cellular and GPS Antennas

Avoid placing items over or near theantenna to prevent blocking cellularand GPS signal reception. Cellularreception is required for OnStar tosend remote signals to the vehicle.

Unable to Connect to OnStarMessage

If there is limited cellular coverageor the cellular network has reachedmaximum capacity, this messagemay come on. PressQ to try thecall again or try again after driving afew miles into another cellular area.

Vehicle and Power Issues

OnStar services require a vehicleelectrical system, wireless service,and GPS satellite technologies to beavailable and operating for featuresto function properly. These systemsmay not operate if the battery isdischarged or disconnected.

Page 482: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

14-8 OnStar

Add-on Electrical Equipment

The OnStar system is integratedinto the electrical architecture of thevehicle. Do not add any electricalequipment. See Add-On ElectricalEquipment on page 9‑78. Addedelectrical equipment may interferewith the operation of the OnStarsystem and cause it to not operate.

Privacy

The complete OnStar PrivacyStatement may be found atwww.onstar.com. Privacy-sensitiveusers of wireless communicationsare cautioned that the privacy of anyinformation sent via wireless cellularcommunications cannot be assured.Third parties may unlawfullyintercept or access transmissionsand private communications withoutconsent.

Page 483: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (1,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

INDEX i-1

AAccessories andModifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3

Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24Active Fuel Management® . . . . . 9-27Add-On ElectricalEquipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-78

Adding a Snow Plow orSimilar Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-78

Additional InformationOnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-5

Adjustable Throttle andBrake Pedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20

AdjustmentsLumbar, Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4

Air Cleaner/Filter, Engine . . . . . 10-13Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12Airbag SystemCheck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-40How Does an AirbagRestrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-32

Passenger SensingSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-34

What Makes an AirbagInflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-32

Airbag System (cont'd)What Will You See after anAirbag Inflates? . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-33

When Should an AirbagInflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-30

Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . .3-28AirbagsAdding Equipment to theVehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-38

Passenger Status Indicator . . .5-17Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-16Servicing Airbag-EquippedVehicles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-38

System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-26AlarmVehicle Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-12

AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10AntennaRear Side Window . . . . . . . . . . . .7-15Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-16

Antilock BrakeSystem (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-40Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22

Appearance CareExterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-87Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90

Armrest Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1

Assistance Program,Roadside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7, 13-11

Audio Players . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-16CD/DVD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-21

Audio SystemRadio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-14Rear Seat (RSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-46Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . 7-2

AutomaticDimming Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-18Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8Headlamp System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3Level Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-45Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-28Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . 10-10

Automatic TransmissionManual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-31Shift Lock ControlFunction Check . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28

AuxiliaryDevices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-31Roof Mounted Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6

Axle, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25Axle, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26

Page 484: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (2,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

i-2 INDEX

BBattery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-24Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-77Load Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8Power Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9Voltage and ChargingMessages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-35

Blade Replacement, Wiper . . . 10-29Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-48BrakePedal and AdjustableThrottle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-20

System Warning Light . . . . . . . .5-21Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22Antilock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-40Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-41Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-41System Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .5-35

Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3Break-In, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . . 9-19Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30License Plate Lamps . . . . . . . 10-32Taillamps, Turn Signal,Stoplamps, andBack-up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . 10-31

Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-56

CCalibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5CaliforniaFuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . .9-56Perchlorate MaterialsRequirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-3

Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2Camera, Rear Vision . . . . . . . . . . 9-52Canadian Vehicle Owners . . . . . . . . iiiCapacities andSpecifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2

Carbon MonoxideEngine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-27Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-12

CargoCover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2

Cautions, Danger, andWarnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv

CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16CD/DVD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-21Center Console Storage . . . . . . . . 4-2Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61Charging System Light . . . . . . . . 5-18CheckEngine Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-19IgnitionTransmission Lock . . . . . . . . 10-28

Child RestraintsInfants and YoungChildren . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-43

Lower Anchors andTethers for Children . . . . . . . . .3-48

Page 485: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (3,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

INDEX i-3

Child Restraints (cont'd)Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-41Securing . . . . . . . . . . 3-55, 3-56, 3-58Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-45

Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33CleaningExterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-87Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90

Climate Control Systems . . . . . . . 8-1Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1Dual Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3Heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9, 8-10

Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7Cluster, Instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11Collision Damage Repair . . . . . 13-14Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5ConnectionsOnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-3

Continuous DampingControl (CDC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45

Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3Convex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15CoolantEngine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15Engine TemperatureGauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14

Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14Engine Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .5-36

Courtesy TransportationProgram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13

CoverCargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2

Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-46Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-26

Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . 13-6Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-5Text Telephone (TTY)Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-6

Customer InformationService PublicationsOrdering Information . . . . . . 13-16

Customer SatisfactionProcedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2, 13-4

DDamage Repair, Collision . . . . . 13-14Danger, Warnings, andCautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv

Data Recorders, Event . . . . . . . 13-19Daytime RunningLamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3

Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7DevicesAuxiliary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-31

DiagnosticsOnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-5

Distracted Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7DoorAjar Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-36Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6Power Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7

Drive Belt Routing, Engine . . . . . 12-4Driver InformationCenter (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26

DrivingCharacteristics andTowing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-61

Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3Drunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3For Better Fuel Economy . . . . .1-27Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . 9-11If the Vehicle is Stuck . . . . . . . . .9-14Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5

Page 486: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (4,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

i-4 INDEX

Driving (cont'd)Off-Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . .9-15Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-12

Dual Automatic ClimateControl System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3

DVDRear Seat EntertainmentSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-36

DVD/CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-21

EE85 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-58Electrical Equipment,Add-On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-78

Electrical SystemEngine CompartmentFuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33

Fuses and CircuitBreakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33

Instrument Panel FuseBlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-37

Overload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32

EmergencyOnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-2

EngineAir Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . 10-13Check and Service EngineSoon Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-19

Compartment Overview . . . . . . .10-5Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15Coolant TemperatureGauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14

Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14Cooling System Messages . . .5-36Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . .12-4Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-27Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-23Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-9Oil Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-37Oil Pressure Gauge . . . . . . . . . .5-13Overheated ProtectionOperating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19

Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18Power Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24Running While Parked . . . . . . . .9-28Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-22

Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8Equipment, Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-69Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . 13-19Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8Extender, Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . 3-25Exterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . . . 6-1Exterior Lamps Off Reminder . . . 6-2

FFanEngine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20

FeaturesMemory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9

Filter,Engine Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . 10-13

Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2Flashers, Hazard Warning . . . . . . 6-5Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-62Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-64

Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-93

Page 487: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (5,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

INDEX i-5

FluidAutomatic Transmission . . . . 10-10Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23Four-Wheel DriveTransfer Case . . . . . . . . .9-33, 9-38

Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21

Fog LampsBulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6

Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-17Four-WheelDrive . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25, 9-33, 9-38

Front Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25Front Fog LampLight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-25

Front SeatsAdjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3Heated and Ventilated . . . . . . . . . 3-8

Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-55Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-57E85 (85% Ethanol) . . . . . . . . . . .9-58Economy Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-27Filling a Portable FuelContainer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-60

Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-59Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . .9-57

Fuel (cont'd)Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . .9-56Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . .5-24Management, Active . . . . . . . . . .9-27Recommended . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-56Requirements, California . . . . .9-56System Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38

Full-Size Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . 10-76FusesEngine CompartmentFuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33

Fuses and CircuitBreakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-33

Instrument Panel FuseBlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-37

GGarage Door Opener . . . . . . . . . . 5-52Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-52

GasolineSpecifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-56

GaugesEngine CoolantTemperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14

Engine Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . .5-13Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12Voltmeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15Warning Lights andIndicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-10

General InformationService and Maintenance . . . . . 11-1Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-61Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2

Glass Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1GM Mobility ReimbursementProgram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7

Page 488: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (6,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

i-6 INDEX

HHalogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . 6-5Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2HeadlampsAiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 10-30Daytime RunningLamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3

Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . .5-25High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . 6-2

HeatedRear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9

Heated and Ventilated FrontSeats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8

Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18HeaterEngine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-23

Heating and Air Conditioning . . . 8-1High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . 5-25Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . 9-11

Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . 9-41Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4How to Wear Safety BeltsProperly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18

IIgnition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20Ignition Transmission LockCheck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28

Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14Infants and Young Children,Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43

Infotainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . 1-2Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii

JJump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-77

KKey and Lock Messages . . . . . . . 5-38Keyless EntryRemote (RKE) System . . . . . . . . 2-2

Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1

LLabeling, Tire Sidewall . . . . . . . . 10-42LampsAuxiliary RoofMounted Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6

Daytime Running (DRL) . . . . . . . 6-3Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7Exterior Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1Exterior Lamps OffReminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2

License Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32Malfunction Indicator . . . . . . . . .5-19Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8

Lap Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19LATCH SystemReplacing Parts after aCrash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-55

Page 489: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (7,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

INDEX i-7

LATCH, Lower Anchors andTethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . 3-48

Level ControlAutomatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-45

LiftgateCarbon Monoxide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9

LightingEntry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8Illumination Control . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7

LightsAirbag Readiness . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-16Antilock Brake System(ABS) Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22

Brake System Warning . . . . . . .5-21Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-18Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-26Engine Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . .5-24Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2Front Fog Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-25High-Beam On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-25High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . 6-2Low Fuel Warning . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . .5-16Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-25StabiliTrak® OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23

Lights (cont'd)Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23Tow/Haul Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22Traction Control System(TCS)/StabiliTrak® . . . . . . . . . .5-23

Locking Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45LocksAutomatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8

Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . 5-24Lower Anchors and Tethersfor Children (LATCHSystem) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-48

Lumbar Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4

MMaintenanceRecords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-15

Maintenance ScheduleRecommended Fluidsand Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-12

Transfer Case . . . . . . . . . .9-33, 9-38Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . 5-19Manual Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-31Memory Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9Memory Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6MessagesAirbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-41Battery Voltage andCharging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-35

Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-35Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-36Engine Cooling System . . . . . . .5-36Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-37Engine Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38Fuel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38Key and Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38Object Detection System . . . . .5-39Ride Control System . . . . . . . . . .5-40

Page 490: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (8,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

i-8 INDEX

Messages (cont'd)Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-41Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-41Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-42Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-34Vehicle Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-43Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-44

MirrorsAutomatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . .2-18Automatic DimmingRearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19

Convex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-17Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-18Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16Manual Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19Park Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-18Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16Trailer Tow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16

Monitor System, TirePressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-50

NNavigationOnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-2Vehicle Data Recordingand Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20

New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . 9-19

OObject Detection SystemMessages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-39

Object Detection, Side BlindZone Alert (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . . 9-49

Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12

Off-Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4

OilEngine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-6Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . .10-9Engine Oil PressureGauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13

Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-37Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24

Older Children, Restraints . . . . . 3-41Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . 13-6OnStar®

System, In Brief . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-28OnStar® AdditionalInformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-5

OnStar® Connections . . . . . . . . . . 14-3OnStar® Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . 14-5OnStar® Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2OnStar® Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2OnStar® Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-1OnStar® Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2Operation, InfotainmentSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6

OrderingService Publications . . . . . . . . 13-16

OutletsPower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8

Overheated EngineProtectionOperating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19

Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . 10-18Overview, InfotainmentSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-3, 7-5

Page 491: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (9,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

INDEX i-9

PParkShifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-24Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-26Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-18

ParkingAssist, Ultrasonic . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-48Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-41Brake and P (Park)Mechanism Check . . . . . . . . 10-28

Over Things That Burn . . . . . . .9-27Passenger Airbag StatusIndicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17

Passenger Sensing System . . . 3-34Perchlorate MaterialsRequirements, California . . . . . 10-3

PersonalizationVehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-44

PhoneBluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-48

PowerDoor Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8Protection, Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9Retained Accessory (RAP) . . .9-24

Power (cont'd)Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-20

Power Assist Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12Pregnancy, Using SafetyBelts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24

PrivacyRadio FrequencyIdentification (RFID) . . . . . . . 13-20

ProgramCourtesy Transportation . . . . 13-13

Proposition 65 Warning,California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2

RRadio FrequencyIdentification (RFID) . . . . . . . . 13-20Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-20

RadiosAM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-10CD/DVD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-21Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-14Satellite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11

Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-45

Rear Climate ControlSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9, 8-10

Rear Seat Audio (RSA)System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-46

Rear Seat EntertainmentSystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-36Rear Seat Audio (RSA) . . . . . . .7-46

Rear SeatsHeated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9

Rear Side Window Antenna . . . 7-15Rear Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2Rear Vision Camera (RVC) . . . . 9-52Rear Window Washer/Wiper . . . . 5-5Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . .2-19

Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4RecommendedFuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-56

Recommended Fluids andLubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12

RecordsMaintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-15

Page 492: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (10,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

i-10 INDEX

Recreational VehicleTowing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-82

Reimbursement Program,GM Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7

Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2

Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5ReplacementGlass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30

Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . 10-32Replacement PartsAirbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-40Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-14

Replacing Airbag System . . . . . . 3-40Replacing LATCH SystemParts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . 3-55

Replacing Safety BeltSystem Parts after a Crash . . . 3-26

Reporting Safety DefectsCanadian Government . . . . . . 13-18General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-18U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . 13-17

RestraintsWhere to Put . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-47

Retained AccessoryPower (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24

Ride Control SystemsMessages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-40

RoadsDriving, Wet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10

Roadside AssistanceProgram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7, 13-11

RoofSunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-22

Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-54Routing, Engine Drive Belt . . . . . 12-4Running the Vehicle WhileParked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-28

SSafety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25How to Wear Safety BeltsProperly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-18

Safety Belts (cont'd)Lap Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-24Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . .3-19Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-16Replacing after a Crash . . . . . .3-26Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . .3-24

Safety Defects ReportingCanadian Government . . . . . . 13-18General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-18U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . 13-17

Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8Safety System Check . . . . . . . . . . 3-25Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11Scheduling Appointments . . . . . 13-12SeatsAdjustment, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2Heated and Ventilated Front . . . 3-8Heated, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9Lumbar Adjustment, Front . . . . . 3-4Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6Power Adjustment, Front . . . . . . 3-3Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4Second Row . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9Third Row Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13

Second Row Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9

Page 493: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (11,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

INDEX i-11

Secondary Latch System . . . . . 10-74Securing ChildRestraints . . . . . . . . 3-55, 3-56, 3-58

SecurityLight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-25Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-41OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-2Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-12Vehicle Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-12

ServiceAccessories andModifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-3

Doing Your Own Work . . . . . . . .10-3Engine Soon Light . . . . . . . . . . . .5-19Maintenance Records . . . . . . .11-15Maintenance, GeneralInformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1

Parts Identification Label . . . . .12-1Publications OrderingInformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-16

Scheduling Appointments . . . 13-12

Servicing the Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38Shift Lock Control FunctionCheck, AutomaticTransmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28

ShiftingInto Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-24Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-26

Side Blind Zone Alert . . . . . . . . . . 9-49Signals, Turn andLane-Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5

Snow Plow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-78Specifications andCapacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2

Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12StabiliTrakOFF Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-42

Start Assist, Hills . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-41Start Vehicle, Remote . . . . . . . . . . 2-5Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . . . 10-27Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-22Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4Fluid, Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2

StepsPower Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-12

Stoplamps and Back-up LampsBulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 10-31

StorageRear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2

Storage AreasArmrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1Cargo Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2Center Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3

Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ivSystemInfotainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1Roof Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3

Page 494: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (12,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

i-12 INDEX

TTachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12TaillampsBulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 10-31

Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . 13-6Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . 2-14Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-14

Third-Row Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13Throttle, Adjustable . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7TiresBuying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . 10-56Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-64Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-45Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-58Full-Size Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-76If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . 10-62Inflation Monitor System . . . . 10-51Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-54Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-41Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23Pressure Monitor System . . . 10-50Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-54Secondary Latch System . . . 10-74Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42

Tires (cont'd)Terminology andDefinitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-46

Uniform Tire QualityGrading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-59

Wheel Alignment and TireBalance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-60

Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . 10-60When It Is Time for NewTires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-56

Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42Tow/Haul Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-32Tow/Haul Mode Light . . . . . . . . . . 5-22TowingDriving Characteristics . . . . . . . .9-61Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-69General Information . . . . . . . . . .9-61Recreational Vehicle . . . . . . . . 10-82Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-64Trailer Sway Control (TSC) . . .9-77Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-82

TractionControl System (TCS)/StabiliTrak® Light . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23

TrailerSway Control (TSC) . . . . . . . . . .9-77Tow Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-64

Transfer Case . . . . . . . . . . . 9-33, 9-38TransmissionAutomatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-28Fluid, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-42

Transportation Program,Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-13

Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12Turn and Lane-ChangeSignals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5

Turn SignalBulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 10-31

UUltrasonic Parking Assist . . . . . . 9-48Uniform Tire QualityGrading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-59

Universal Remote System . . . . . 5-52Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-56Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-52

Using This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii

Page 495: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (13,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

INDEX i-13

VVehicleAlarm System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-12Canadian Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iiiControl . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3IdentificationNumber (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-1

Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-15Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-34Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-44Reminder Messages . . . . . . . . . .5-43Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-12Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-82

Vehicle CareTire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-49

Ventilation, Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21Voltmeter Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15

WWarningBrake System Light . . . . . . . . . . .5-21

Warning Lights, Gauges,and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10

Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ivCautions and Danger . . . . . . . . . . . .ivHazard Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5

Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-44

WheelsAlignment and TireBalance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-60

Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-58Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-60

When It Is Time for NewTires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-56

Where to Put the Restraint . . . . 3-47

Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-20

WindshieldWiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4

WinterDriving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-12

Winter Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-42Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . 10-29WipersRear Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5

Page 496: 2013 Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual M · Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12 Black plate (4,1) iv Introduction Danger, Warnings, and Cautions Warning

Black plate (14,1)Chevrolet Tahoe/Suburban Owner Manual - 2013 - crc2 - 8/14/12

i-14 INDEX

2 NOTES